‘ ‘ *Mm‘ “Ml-z; 4.. a -'»‘v J g} 1 \9, .4 ~ -‘\Q .5‘ .k ‘31 ‘y ': I “(KL ‘ §$fiéf§iz~ , 3 ‘ N ~ 3 ti "4-; -G ; ~ . ‘A P. \ q€:%$ r m 3'41! ~ I215. ,_ . , 5:. .e' r ‘ ‘ *1! a'p'z' .U‘. 1% "ii - A ‘ m m‘ a. @2952“ E z » 5.: **~ y ‘9% ‘ A v4 “a .. , ‘ l r 2&1‘ ? ‘ a‘ . mg‘ “,3 _ »='.'>“~ ' I . L Y x (a i h: S 4 a; H 4, p5» Qfi}. ‘h #1 , "' N ‘\g‘FhfxJh ' . . . -.‘_ \ v_ \ - ‘I \r a ~. 1 *twéirk w ' ‘affair? ' ’ V - '1' 43‘ v 3“ ‘ ‘ ‘ v ' é'fi‘ii‘QRkfi‘QH-IS‘ \ “" ' - ., "~- ‘ , tag?‘ ,1 <5 i‘ , V . . mgmywhkgmu“ _ . Q'N r a: 1+ " $11335‘; 1 ‘ix .1 £31?!“ .pb ’<’S‘_ ‘' ‘ i L'iwkégim‘éfi ‘,z-zéwg‘ti‘kt ' ~ 3' "9Q 3|}, MK 31$‘ 54 $3.52? ,v w " a“? ‘1 -.‘.~ ' xi‘wéfim v N.’ 1r 3!» if‘: 11%‘, ,iv 1 g; 1 v‘ "a. * A “$3 " Q‘ ‘ v» 3”“ y ‘1 *1 "K'fxqh, - ~J‘n- .\ - ' 1‘ \‘r . ‘n ‘Ra-($3: Wm A q: " €u1..,‘€\~<- -\.~&=;§:&2$;»é 1,, .; ’* " ‘li’i‘f‘e ‘65k ‘vwV-mn'zl *3." ~ 4‘, “W “3% -< "S. \fd‘t'g \ "3"‘ ~ »'>’1.\\~’: *3‘ ' ' 1:2 dw~§$bfiz A. 2-3». ugpgkfig .3‘ ‘ X “45w” #1, ix‘ pggécpfl‘ ', \ A‘; " wuééaéilkffi? I“ \& ‘5\+.>na%"\,‘1 k" 11k“ \13 3 v w- wflmfia ‘ ‘ mi'wzz- m ‘>2: ‘ "~* , Qaéi'g‘ ‘ ‘$523’- ‘ * mi,’ ‘$93!’. 3 '' ‘PW-fie; . '1 \ ~--~ . ~ -, ‘3: w . u , h- v; ~ ,_ ._ ‘{l£‘1‘:.‘~-£§‘,w .Q'MA ‘X. 43-; - _ ‘* , ‘ ‘ _\\ 3 T 1”; ‘413:0 ‘L L1 Kim’. M ifs; 5}“ “ §¥fib¢$§h ‘a ‘fi-{éQ-c \‘5 T‘w. ~ “2-1? V wklil‘pak (h - v - '42':§":';\2‘3\,;’~ ., 13:‘ ; ‘j - ’-.,»=‘\*\*3-. ‘ ‘51%) : vigegybs, “M v “ it‘; “532%; ‘A? , V" a ‘ 1:; _~i‘~ 4-, 3r- ‘, ‘N. J" \g“ ,1‘ Xx1-»wh,\.€ "ficifimfi‘xk‘fifiy‘ ' ~13~\¢ e; a “mi? 2 :9 g; 1395*,‘ \‘Kr—igsqithu ‘\QZRG; \» Q. ‘ 49 \ ~ ‘5* . n d m ‘av-9"‘; * mm‘ ’\ w \\ Wfqébsgm 7 @113 h ‘v "baa". gé‘afiQ‘ ‘ . ‘0V 1 ‘if, h it’; x“? w- ’ ~ ( '- " ’ “2" ~'>‘§'s‘§‘(1 éx " .~ “ex-ax N - Ma Q» 81. - -- ‘5; - ., @ ‘nan v V '7 ‘1R! _ r‘ “a Xv“; Xi‘ ‘*1 . ‘ k ~ “\s,“ ' "map, .k‘a'ififi' 31%" \Z a "M 4‘ 53;“ ' 3* l‘ 1' “ x" \' A '5 ‘* ‘~‘ 1 ' ~ "‘ H‘i‘fi's'b' I ‘_ ‘ \v v 154:?“ ‘f, - H‘- {fwvm -. 4 $3.‘ - ' “ . ix U a: IV, ‘ X. z.‘ ‘ J1 ; p, ‘It “7 a \‘Tk , U 0.3,.‘ V,‘ x.‘ ‘ \~ - wvw 21%;; 1 i ' ' - ‘ - * M Y . s. 1 X g‘; ' \é ,ww‘ Hi- \ x 3:» L “k a} \ “K31 “3&3” ‘I 0%, V ‘*mki‘vv 1 a \x um % - \ w“ -..-..~ ‘EUQm-w. Y %x ‘2 530 m . ‘\w 1;; ‘=5. 8 12-; Q s‘ , ,. - *"émw 0'5: / \Q. _ x I \i‘qt. ‘3x4 . 3mg?‘ * mi?“ ‘" w‘méx ‘ 3\‘-"""§*‘\,§u“ s: ‘Mag’ "~\~\~ ‘ - .~ i ‘5*. ‘s ? > . ftvkégx'z‘ . "1‘ ‘02" .1 " ‘*y'ig‘: g‘s‘x * 4 _ _ ‘f- ‘Szfigp. n ‘:1‘ “W3; ‘m 2‘. .W: k‘ A; ‘ fig‘??? 5&3‘ w v I.‘ w, < “1,, '.”‘ 1w 1 \ \a Q:- \ Q - f 1 ‘ _‘ ‘033,31 , v ~ 1‘- pkafi‘fix'A '5‘211'33' is} - w " " ~ ' - \R" ‘ " ‘ ‘a - 'r u ‘ ~:,-‘1'\‘w~ .. q, * v ‘ l *v at» a v > “ .25,‘ pg“ 5‘ (‘x-‘l ‘ 3',“ 53.5211‘ né‘kvfi; .. \. y, . _ ,{p \ v‘ N‘, 3: QQMQ ‘ ' $5135?‘ " ‘3 Q‘ '. ‘u ‘< \ i‘. '- {E ‘E 151.‘ 44".“; . ‘I \ x , I’ \ > N". 1* v r > > ‘ 1 ‘m “*"’*“ v 1 H , _ v n 1 ,. a w. 1mg“; ~ 7 _ v x ’ I ‘ a ‘as ' “W”? x "m 1 g . » 1 . m» _ §-~ ~ ‘ -_~ \ ,, 32-. ‘a \vnl ‘ Qvk‘ r‘; ‘ fwiw , * - "32.12% . ‘l ‘f ‘ , -'$ 4 M, - ‘\‘llx‘. ‘$33 55'.‘ ?%s$_~“:駑:\§ y‘ u >-, ‘i \ - \- v ‘ v . R & \ \x'u; ‘1'1- \“I{ ‘ ' a ’ balk‘ \ 12%.‘: 1- ‘_ \fikwq » .\ q‘ , . l w ¢€Q¢$€2-gxx a»? a xém ' l 7 Mr ' ~ 1 >3" 5, > 'r a . ‘ 'v‘lké‘f,‘ ‘ ’\ --‘'\ _ ‘8% a‘ W fig-s , a‘ A 1 ""' \ ".1" u ‘ r,<\ ' . v Hv‘éléliwgi ‘ " '* . Q‘g ->, g; i F2“: w p1,‘; _ {,rgfi‘. a“ “'1 ‘\v: I‘ ‘_ 3‘ ‘gm § 11563‘ 0 x ' ' ' ' ‘ r" ' 4~ W193‘ ‘*v _ .;_~ -\-:~“A§1§s&\%w%ww Egg?.Emfiawwwé 5%a?{251.5%5??? wvi... . .a. s.-i,.$........,!.1.l......, .5 . . .. v1.1.3.5‘)! 1N- .JHHUHIHWHHM .HHHHILMJHJW. a... IHH" * \ Sh? iii" a... r , . .7 i! 1.; !\.....r. i \ J . i }..|: > 1 . . x..\.\‘§§£l . £11k: _.__,_ iméfléfifi ._...M_.._W._._T ,‘_=M.......H.._._M.__ .l ‘A’. Tum‘ .llr- Tmfv’innml ._ .. _.__._.=_._._.___._\_._W_._Em ,, I... I. II.. Mn‘ , V‘ I. I] ..III "II .II .Il. ..I' m I, ..II\. .VI , Ill. ‘1 :l . E . ‘; g _ mIjifl’LIL-fi-d— ' CQMPBETE TESTRUCT :Fumerous'schemes for imp QHE $ AMERICAETPRINTLR AFMAEUAL-QF TYPOGRAPHY . “ containing Ptactical directiona for I. ' departments of a printin P {3. 5' \fi 11 as n--. ‘J6 IONS F05 &P"QEFFICES: with R€V€Fal useful tables. 08 g forms in in @very variety, hints to authors, etc. BY THOMAS KACKEILAR PHILADEIEHlA: Macfiellar; Smiths & Jordan é‘, FOURTEENT H EDITION. e33 ‘ . . -' HE fourteenth edltlon of the Amerzmrz Przm‘er conforms entirely with the previous one. PHILADELPHIA, ‘ 0cz‘ofier, 1883. r 7, $5 _ 9 ¢<>> -<>_> eat? ‘THE UNIVERSlTY 0F M\CH\GAN UBRARIES iii NOTE TO THE ELEVENTH EDITION. HE success of the American Printer is without a parallel in typographical literature; ten editions, or about ten thousand copies, having been disposed of since the day of publication. The present edition has been abridged and condensed in some respects, and con- siderably enlarged in others. As it stands at present, we think it will be found the most practical manual of printing extant. The pages have been reset in a type that finds much favour in the eyes of admirers of fine typography. PHILADELPHIA, Yanum'y, 1878. Gt—Ql 0 ‘Q 390% gig}; ‘3 x!‘ {,‘kliw , u ‘iw-C‘RLI “if” $11.1’ 7! PREFACE TO FIRST EDITION. SEFULNESS rather than originality has been aimed at in the preparation of the AMERICAN PRINTER, which is offered as an improvement on the typographical work formerly published by us. In addi- tion to the results of actual personal experience em- bodied in the volume, information has been gathered and extracts have been freely made from various publications, such as Anzes and Dz'bdin's Yjipogmplzicat Antiquities, Tlzoinas’s History of Printing, D'nzpeflqy's Dictionaij/ 0f Printers and Printing, Savage’s Diction— ary of Printing, fo/znson’s Yj/pograp/zia, C/zaméers's Eng/ctopwdia, Beaa’nell ’s Guide to Yj'jfiogmplz , as well as other books referred to in the notes. The work has been prepared amid the manifold interruptions incident to business life; yet we think nothing has been over- looked that is essential for the instruction of the learner or for the assistance of the workman. Vi PREFACE T0 FIRST EDITIOIV. Besides the matter relating to practical typography, the volume contains a sketch of the discovery of printing, and notices of type-founding, stereotyping, electrotyping, and lithography. The implements employed in typo- graphy are described and their uses explained; and complete schemes for imposition are laid down. The valuable tables and the plans of cases for various lan- guages, and for music and labour-saving rule, will be found extremely useful; as well as the extensive lists of abbreviations and of foreign words and phrases, and orthographical hints. Special attention has been given in setting forth the functions and duties of the foreman and proof-reader, so that the operations of an office may be prosecuted with efficiency, comfort, and economy. Authors and publishers, as well as typographical amateurs, may consult the volume with profit; and, in— deed, any intelligent person will find it a serviceable companion. if?’ r y a,‘ ' -c i _ ‘- ,/ Pit’. >57:- _ t I?‘ (if i / 4: . CONTENTS. PAGE. RISE AND PROGRESS OF PRINTING. . . . . . . . . . . . 15-50 Discovery of Printing—Laurentius Koster—Geinsfieisch—Guten- berg—Fust—Bible printed—Peter Schoeffer—Caxton—Ulrich Zell -—Lambert Palmaert—Abraham Colorito—Humphreys and De Vinne on the invention of printing—Lenox’s collection of rare Bibles —- Ancient typographical peculiarities — Catchwords — In- vention of Signatures—Printing introduced into America—Type- founding in Europe—Decree of the Star Chamber—Type-founding in America—Prices of Type--Stereotyping—Electrotyping—Litho- graphy—Engraving—W'alk over a type-foundry. IMPLEMENTS on TooLs OF THE ART. . . . . . . . . . . 51-120 Types—Roman letter—Italic—Black—Anglo-Saxon—Names and sizes of type—Gradations of type—Table of proportions of type— A Bill of Pica—A Fount of type—Capitals—Small capitals— Points—Apostrophe—Hyphen—Parenthesis and Bracket—Refer- ences—Accents—Numerals—Arabic figures—Old-style figures— Cancelled figures Fractions—Signs—Metal rules or dashes— Braces—Spaces -—Two-line letters—Quadrates—Quotations—La- hour-saving quotation furniture—Hollow quadrates—Circular quadrates—Labour-saving curvatures—Leads—Flowers and bor- tiers—Brass rule—Brass labour-saving rule—Improved labour- saving rule case—Earliest written sounds—Hieroglyphic alphabet —Runic alphabets—Anglo-Saxon alphabet and plan of cases— German alphabet and plan of cases—Greek alphabet and plan of cases—Hebrew alphabet and plan of cases—Comparative table of bodies of Music type—Music composition—Music cases—Modern conveniences. CO.\Il-’OSITION.......................I21—I4o General remarks—Requisites in an apprentice—American cases—— Position of a compositor—Laying type—Dislributing—Composing — Spacing— Justifying —- Head-lines — Notes — Blanking —— Para- graphs—Indexes—Titles—Dedications—Contents —Prefaces—Sig- naturing—Errata—Ironical rules—Advice to apprentices—Ironical rules for beginners in business. v11 viii CONTENTS. 1M POSITION . General remarks—Tying up pages—Laying pages—Making up furniture—Making the margin—Locking up forms—Memoranda— Nomenclature of sheets—Schemes for imposing, from folio to 128mo. PRooF-READING AND CORRECTING. . . . . . . . . . .|., THE Qualifications of a reader—Should be a printer—Indebtedness of authors to proof-readers— Process 'of reading—Proof record— Errors made in correcting—Two readers desirable—Punctuation— Alterations in proof—Stower’s remarks—Revise—Correcting in the metal—Capricious alterations—Proper method of correcting—Over- running—Hints to authors—Table of proof-marks,with explanations —'l‘nble of signatures. FoREMAN on OVERSEER. General duties—Treatment of compositors—Punctuality—Morning duties-Knowledge of all materials on hand—Order—Overseeing work—Regulating takes of copy—Prompt reading and correcting— Memorandum— Press-book— Press duties —Warehouse——Casting off copy—Managing hurried work—Companionships—Taking copy—Making tip—Dividing the letter—Making up furniture— Imposing and distributing letter—Correcting—Transposition of pages—Rules to be observed in a printing-office. PRESS AND ITS WORKING . History of the printing-press—Blaeu, its first improver—Ramage press—Stanhope press—Clyrner or Columbian press—Smith press —\Vashington press—Adams’s bed-and-platen power-press—Inven- tion of the Cylinder press—Frederick Konig—William Nicholson -—Dr. Kinsley—Applegath and Cowper—Account of the house of R. Hoe & C0.—-Stop Cylinder press—Cottrell & Babcock presses—— Campbell presses—Richard M. Hoe’s type-revolving printing machine—Bullock perfecting press—T he Walter perfecting press— The Hoe perfecting press-Presses at the Centennial Exhibition, I876—Railroad-ticket printing and numbering press—Job presses—— Ruggles, Hoe,Gordon, Degener,Wells , and Cally—Franklin press— Nonpareil press—Fire-fiy press—Liberty press—Globe press— Peerless press—Universal press—Amateur presses—Folding ma- chines—Setting up a \Vashington press—Setting up the roller- stand-Composition rollers—Melting kettle—Covering tympans— Wetting paper—Blankets—Making ready a form on a hand-press— Pulling—Rules and remedies for pressmen—Ley-trough—Making ready on cylinder presses—Fine hand-presswork—Printing wood- PAGE. 141-199 200-217 218¢234 235-292 CONTENTS. 1x PAGE. THE PRESS AND ITS WORKING.—'-(Continued) . . . , . . . 235-292 cuts—Card printing—Gold printing—Bronze printing—Printing in colours—Ink stone and muller—How to use dry colours—How to multiply colours—Contrast of colours—oiling a press—How to treat wood type. WAREHOUSE DEPARTMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293-299 W'arehouseman—Warehouse-Book—Receipt of paper and delivery of sheets—Giving out paper to wet—Over-sheets—Hanging up paper to dry—Taking down sheets when dry—Filling in and press- ing sheets—Counting out and putting away sheets—Standard sizes of machine-made paper—Table for giving out paper for a thousand copies. JOBBING FACILITIES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300-310 Selection of type and presses—How to make a paying business— Memorandum order—Estimate book—Ames’s paper and card scale —-Le Blond’s chart—Cabinets and cases—Rules for the govern- ment ofa job ofi'ice—Job composing-sticks—Patent quoins—Llorner quadratcs—Shooting sticks—Mitering machine—Lead cutter— Perl'orating machines—Imposing stone—Copy-holder—Paper and ' card cutters—Megill’s patent gauge pin—Extension feed-guide— Automatic counters—Patent ink fountain—Iron furniture. USEFULRECEIPTS.....................3II—3I7 How to make printers’ rollers—German preservative for rollers— Directions for recasting rollers—Printers’ Iey—Paste—Mucilage— GIue—Gum—Magenta surface paper—Coloured writing inks—Fire- proof ink—Printing ink varnish—Lithographic transfer ink—To give dark printing inks a bronze or changeable hue—An ink for marking tin or zinc—Drying preparations—Silvering solutions—To sdften leather belting—How to open a ball of twine—To prevent adhesion of paper—To detect ground wood in paper--French gold printing—Transfer varnish—To make paper waterproof—To pre- serve books—To restore engravings. OR'I‘HOGRAPHICAL . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318-332 Discrepancies—a or an before a vowel 0r silent Iz—o or o/i—atv'e and z'ble—z'm or in and em or en—in and mz—z'se and z'ze—ar anil ' our—sz‘on and tiara—Farther and further—Peas and peasa— Omission of s in the possessive case—Formation of the plurals of words compounded of a noun and an adjective—Pointing of numbers, weights, measures, &c.—Derivation of English words—Rules for spelling—Plurals of nouns. X CONTENTS. PAGE. How To SECURE COPYRIGHTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333-335 Application to be made to Librarian of Congress—Fees—Copies to be deposited, under penalty—Form of notice—Penalty for false notice—Authors may reserve the right to translate or dramatize— Form of notice—Term of copyright—Renewal—Assignment—Each volume must be copyrighted—Paintings, statues, models, or designs —Copyrights cannot be granted upon trade-marks or labels—Fee for registering at Patent Office—Name and style of applicant must be stated in the application. 5 THE METRIC SYSTEM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336,337 TECHNICAL TERMS OF THE CRAFT. . . . . . . . . . . . 338-343 ABBREVIATIONS......................344-356 FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357-372 INDEX..........................373-383 4..@/~ _, _ r wpmppgfitl 5&3. ! I“ ' ll \ ll maria 02% ll #3 film so . 8. t ‘i {ab eh i 2 in} ' u ¢$01 __._.t , 1 lg oc ‘all: 55, It): hit 80 ~ 8113a $1M‘; 5% woly \. l Jill ‘l time rw'th mm 2111 lb ll‘ ‘ ‘like liters {130% ~41 12:: K ‘i \< HORN-BOOK OF THE SEVENTEENTH CENTURY. --fl.-:'.-- --- ra.__ " ‘=‘?;'>;;!.-_Iif'G-i~ »_-' m “‘ " ' "A I, __ — ‘m 0‘ 'lm in" s55"! Llltlm 911 an lib‘; '' a l . Ella t e an a t W. iggfibz 0 Uigli‘gfijfi '2 5- mt‘ will 'bh lei) m “liar . ,‘uwtballomh he tbyfian / ifimgnomemuttlflfby imllb H hon» m ép’artl) M ttiziniemfi \ 1% nap ourhmlpbr 1 11min’; weuzuuttrtl’pflffezazm l at b we“ ii :1‘: 11861. } 2a 11% no 111 0 e ,yiépi": , y l s is F! '3 X1 THE SONG OF THE PRINTER ICK and click Goes the type in the stick, As the printer stands at his case; His eyes glance quick, and his fingers pick The type at a rapid pace ; And one by one as the letters go, Words are piled up steady and slow— Steady and slow, But still they grow, And words of fire they soon will glow; Wonderful words, that without a sound Traverse the earth to its utmost bound; Words that shall make The tyrant quake,- And the fetters of the oppress'd shall break; Words that can crumble an army's might, Or treble its strength in a righteous fight. Yet the types they look but leaden and dumb. As he puts them in place with finger and thumb ,- But the printer smiles, And his work beguiles By chanting a song as the letters he piles, With pick and click, Like the world’s chronometer, tick! tick! tick} 0, where is the man with such simple tools Can govern the world as I ? With a printing press, an iron stick, And a little leaden die, With paper of white, and ink of black, I support the Right, and the Wrong attack. Say, where is he, or who may he be, That can rival the printer's power? To no monarchs that live the wall doth he give : Their sway lasts only an hour; While the printer still grows, and God only knows When his might shall cease to tower ! Anon. Gain‘, \ I,___._/‘ 6\ 47 THE it‘ r’ 6 (Pi—3 —~——€°§<'. Wiggles}? r QIRINTER-a Leaks-w 12/ I‘ 9*‘ __..&-~ 6‘ ._'1L\ I v) '4 as,“ WM Hereby, tongues are known, knowledge groweth, judgment increaseth, boo/cs are dispersed, the Scrzlzfiture is read, stories be opened, times compared, truth discerned, falsehood detected and with finger pointed , and (all as I said) through the benefit of Printing. ' Fox's MARTYRs. A t the very epoch when the greatness of Burgundy was most swiftly ripening, another weapon was secretly forging, more potent in the great struggle for freedom than any which the wit or hand of man has ever devised or wielded. I/Vhen Phi/z} the Good, in the full blaze of his power, and flushed with the triumphs iy’ territorial aggrandizement, was instituting at Bruges the order qf the Golden Fleece, “to the glory of God, of the blessed Virgin, and of the holy Andrew, patron saint of the Burgundz'an family,” and enrolling the names of the kings and princes who were to be honoured with its symbols, at that very moment, an obscure citizen of Haarlenz, one Lorenz Coster, or Lawrence the Sea-ton, succeeded in printing a little grammar, by means of movable types. The invention of printing was accomplished, but it was not ushered in with such a blaze of glory as heralded the contemporaneous erection of the Golden Fleece. The humble setter of types did not deem emperors and princes alone worthy his companionship. His invention sent no thrill of admiration throughout Christen- dom; and yet, what was the good Philzlt of Burgundy, with his Ii'nzghts of the Golden Fleece, and all their effielgent trumpery, in the eye of humanity and civilization, compared with the poor sexton and his wooden tyjfie .9 MoTLEv’s RISE OF THE DUTCH REPUBLIC, Vol. i, 45. \ \ Q__.._.w__'—';' .*_’*___,__6) U My.) XIV 111151‘ firm :Igrinitr. RISE AND PROGRESS OF PRINTING. DISCOVERY OF PRINTING. HE credit of inventing the art which per- ' petuates the history and achievements of all the arts and sciences has been obsti- nately contested, several cities having ad- vanced rival claims to the honour of the discovery. This, however, should be no matter of surprise when we consider that the inventor of a new art, unprotected by law, would naturally endeavour to conceal its processes for his own use and advantage. After due consideration, we agree With Isaiah Thomas in the opinion that the probabilities point to LAURENTIUS (sometimes called Coster, Roster, and Kustos) as the discoverer of the art of printing“) (1) The earliest testimony in favour of Koster is contained in a German volume published at Cologne in 1499, known as the C/z ronz'cle qf Cologne, which was printed by Ulrich Zell, originally of Mayence, and a well-known follower of Gutenberg and his system. Under the heading “Of the art of printing books, when and where, and by whom, was invented the inexpressibly useful art of printing books,” the author says, “Although the art, as now practised, was discovered at Mayence, neverthe- less the first idea came from Holland, and the Donati, which had been previously printed there. Those books are therefore the origin of the art."—See Hump/z rays, ch. iii. and iv. \Ve cite further the following well-known account :— “About one hundred and twenty-eight years ago, Laurens Zanssen Coster in- habited a decent and fashionable house in the city of Haarlem, situated on the market- place, opposite the royal palace. The name of Coster was assumed, and inherited from his ancestors, who had long enjoyed the honourable and lucrative oftice of 15 I 6 DISCO VERY 0/" PRL’VT/JVG. Laurentius lived at Haarlem and was a man of property. He seems to have been engaged in printing books from wood blocks or plates, well known to antiquaries as the Bloc/e Books, in which the reading matter was illustrated by rude pictures. Fragments of works so printed by him are still in existence. Among others, the celebrated Biblz'a Paupemm, executed be- tween 1410 and 1420, has been attributed to him. It was only natural that his thoughts should be led to the production of single types, as a means of cheapening and facilitating his work. These were first made of wood, and afterward of tin. The date of his invention of separate types is given as about the year 1429. Other dates have been stated, ranging from coster or sexton to the church. This man deserves to be restored to the honour of being the first inventor of printing, of which he has been unjustly deprived by others, who have enjoyed the praises due to him alone. As he was walking in the wood contiguous to the city, which was the general custom of the richer citizens and men of leisure, in the afternoon and on holidays, he began to cut letters on the bark of the beech; with these letters he enstamped marks upon paper in a contrary direc- tion, in the manner of a seal, until at length he formed a few lines for his own amusement and for the use of the children of his brothcr-in-law. This succeeding so well, he attempted greater things; and, being a man of genius and reflection, he invented, with the aid of his brother- or son-in-law, Thomas Pietrison, a thicker and more adhesive ink, as the common ink was too thin and made blotted marks. \Vith this ink he was able to print blocks and figures, to which he added letters. I have seen specimens of his printing in this manner. In the beginning he printed on one side only. This was a Dutch book, entitled Sfiz'cgal wzser Be/wudem'sse. That it was one of the first books printed after the invention of the art, appears from the leaves, which are pasted together, that the naked sides might not be offensive to the eyes; and none at first were printed in a more perfect manner. As this new species of traffic attracted numerous customers, thus did the profits arising from it increase his love for the art and his diligence in the exercise of it. “ He engaged workmen, which was the source of the mischief. Among these work- men was one ]an : whether his surname be that of Faust, or any other, is ofno great importance to me, as I will not disturb the dead, whose consciences must have smote them sufficiently while living. This Jan, who assisted at the printing press under oath, after he had learned the art of casting the types, setting them, and other articles belonging to the art, and thought himself sufiiciently instructed, having watched the opportunity, as he could not find a better, he packed up the types and the other articles on Christmas eve, while the family was engaged in celebrating the festival, and stole away with them. He first fled to Amsterdam, thence to Cologne, until he could establish himself at Mentz, as a secure place, where he might open shop and reap the fruits of his knavery. It is a known fact that within the twelve months (that is, in the year 1440) he published the Alexandr! Gal/2' Doc- trz'lmle, (a grammar at that time in high repute,) with Pez‘v'z' Hz'spanz' Tracmtz'bus Logz'cz's, with the same letters which Laurens had used. These were undoubtedly the first products of his press. These are the principal circumstances that I have collected from creditable persons far advanced in years, which they have transmitted like a flaming torch from hand to hand; I have also m.t with others who have confirmed the same."—lladrz'anu.r Yunzl'us, 1568. DZSCO VERY 0F PRINTING.‘ I7 1422 to 1436. The first of his printed books, it is claimed, was the Speculum Humana’ Salvationis, of which about ten copies are now known to be in existence. A small primer, or Abecea’arium, in our opinion, shows all the marks of the first attempt of an experimenter in a new art. Koster died in 1439. The necessity for employing workmen to assist in prosecu- ting the art led to the divulging of the secret. Among these men, it is supposed, was John Geinsfieisch, (or Gutenberg, Senior,) who, after learning the processes, returned to Hentz, his native place, and communicated the secret to his nephew, John Gutenberg, an ingenious artist of Strasburg. It is in evidence that the latter, in connection with two partners, spent a considerable amount of money in some private experiments. These appear to have occupied several years, from I436 to 1439, when a legal contest arose as to the rights of one of the partners whose zealous activity had caused his death. Guten- berg continued at Strasburg till I444, when, his means being exhausted, he rejoined his uncle at Mentz. Here he renewed his experiments, and, needing money, he procured an intro- duction to John Fust, a capitalist and money—lender, who seems to have been struck with the importance of the work, and who advanced a considerable amount (all the tools and presses being pledged as security) in furtherance of the enter- prise. Two years were occupied in making the types and necessary machinery, when the great work of printing the Bible was begun. There can be little doubt that, during all his years of experiment, Gutenberg had executed smaller books, one of which is surmised to have been a reproduction of the Dutch Specular/n of Koster. The Donatns of I451‘, the Appeal against the Turks of I454, and the Letters of Indul- gence of I454 and I455, all appeared before the Biblefl) which (1) The first copies of the Bible are not dated, and do not contain the printer's name. Only a few impressions have been preserved to the present time; indeed, they were entirely lost to the world until the latter half of the last century, when a copy was discovered in the library of Cardinal Mazarin in Paris; hence, the few existing copies are generally spoken of as Mazarin Bibles. Some of these were printed on vellum, but the earliest copies were on paper. There are only six copies now extant; two of which are in the United States, one belonging to the collection of the late Mr. George Brinley of Connecticut, and the other owned by Mr.James Lenox of New York. These two copies are on paper. The Brinley copy is said to have a leaf or two in fac-simile, while that belonging to Mr. Lenox is perfect in every respect. This, together with his probably unequalled collection of- Bibles, is destined by the owner to enrich the magnificent Lenox Library, just founded in 2-s- I 8 DISCO VERY OF I’It’INTI/VG. was not published till 1455 or 1456. This great book marked an era in the artfll It is painful to be told that about this time Fust foreclosed the mortgage, and the entire work with all the materials passed into his possession. It seems, however, that Guten- berg succeeded in re-establishing a press, and continued to practise the art, but produced no work at all comparable with the Bible. He died about 1468. , After securing possession of the establishment, Fust en- gaged the service of Peter Schoefi’er, who had been apprentice or assistant to Gutenberg, and who was distinguished for scholarship as well as mechanical skill. His skill and the improvements made by him in the art soon led Fust to take him into partnership, and the Bible, the Psalter, and other important works were produced. Schoefi‘er was further re- warded by the hand of the grand-daughter of F ust. From this rapid summary, we may conclude, I. That the merit of the invention of printing, however rude it may have been, belongs to Koster of Haarlem; 2.That Gutenberg placed the art on a permanent foundation; and, 3. That its eco- nomical application was insured by Peter Schoeffer’s invention of cast metal types”) New York by this excellent and wisely beneficent man. The four remaining copies are in Europe, two of which were recently sold in London at auction; one on vel- lum selling for $20,000, and the other, on paper, bringing $14,000. (1) “ The names of Koster and Gutenberg will ever remain associated with its positive invention; and to Koster, if we are to be guided by a vast mass of un- answerable evidence in his favour, must be assigned the glory of achieving the first actual steps in that art, of which Gutenberg was soon destined, not only to extend and solidify the basis, but to raise at once upon that basis a most noble superstruc- ture.”—Ilumphreys, 1). 5o. (2) For detailed and conflicting accounts, see Humphreys’s History qfthe Art 0/’ Printing, (London,) and De Vinne’s Invention of Printing, (New York.) Humphreys dispassionately goes over the ground, and while giving due credit to Gutenberg, awards to Koster the honour of the invention of the art of printing. A perusal of De Vinne, on the other hand, leaves the impression of an efi'ort to prove a preconceived opinion, every probability in favour of Koster being curtly set aside, and every perchance on the side of Gutenberg being regarded as incon- trovertible fact. De Vinne derides the idea that types were at first cut, and not cast or founded; and this in the face of the fact that in the earliest printed books, there are not two letters ofone kind that are precisely alike in a page; that is, every letter a varies somewhat from all other a's, and so with b and all other letters. This could not be the case if the types were cast or founded. To support his view, De Vinne copies from De la Borde a wood engraving representing letters cut and sawn apart; and from the imperfection of this experiment argues that the first types could not DISCOVERY 01*‘ PRfJl/TING. 19 It was of course impossible to conceal the knowledge of an 'art so useful to man, and within ten years after the publica- tion of the great Bible presses were established in several German cities, in Rome and other parts of Italy, and soon thereafter in France and England. have been cut. This proves nothing except the incapacity of the experimenter. A dozen years ago an ingenious man in Philadelphia produced copper-headed types in a mass on type-metal bodies, which had to be cut apart singly. The specimen of these types here given proves conclusively that the thing can be done far better than was done by Koster on wood or metal, though his types were ten times larger than these :— abedefghljklmnopqrstuvwxyzA BC DEFGIIIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ New York New Jersey Mississippi Georgia Virginia Louisiana Tennessee Arkansas Kentucky New Hampshire Maine Massachusetts Kansas \Ve have repeated the experiment in our own foundry with Long Primer type, and with a similar result. These experiments are sufiicient to show the ungroundedness of Mr. De Vinne's argument. He further states that in some of the specimens given by him, the letters have been so worn that they have run into one another; but the fact is, such letters were logotypes, and cut on the same block. Any accurate type- founder can verify this fact almost at a glance. In a lecture by Mr._]osiah Marples, an accurate English printer, before the Liverpool Literary and Philosophical Society on Typefomza’ers and T yfiefoundz'ng. the speaker alluded to Caxton and his types, and to Mr.Vincent Figgins's reproduction of the “ Game of Chesse,” whose nephew had enabled him to exhibit a copy of the same to the meeting. “ Mr. Vincent Fig- gins, whose skill as a practical type-founder,” it was remarked, “entitled his opinion to great weight, believed that the book was not printed from types such as were cast by Schoefi'er, but from types which were cast with solid faces, upon which were cut with the graver each letter separately. To this Mr. Figgins attributed the fact that in the original book no pure style ofletters was used, but a mixture between the old black and that called Secretary; that no two letters were exactly alike, and that frequent use was made of logotypes." Mr. De Vinne finds some difficulty in demolishing the Koster “legend " (as he and Van der Linde call it) in the fact that the existence of numerous volumes and fragments of ancient printing have to be somehow accounted for; and he thereupon adopts the hypothesis of an unknown printer, to whom he attributes these early productions. The admittedly ancient water-marks in the paper he rules out, simply because such water-marks were used long afterward. He gives fac-simile specimens of the types used in these books; but, in violation of all the laws of probability, he gives the inferior specimens last. The necessities of his theory compelled him to this course, the natural order being the reverse of the one adopted by him. The inferior specimens show clearly the first attempts of an inventor, an inventor too who had before been a block printer. The succeeding books show as clearly the successive stages of improvement, the last stage of which was equal or even superior to any thing executed by Gutenberg before the appearance of the great Bible. This “unknown printer” was doubtless Koster. It is by no means a wild question whether the credit of even the first Bible be- longs to Gutenberg or to Peter Schoefi‘er; for, after the dissolution of the partnership between Gutenberg and F ust, the former produced nothing worthy of note, while Schtnfi'er printed the Bible again, as well as other works, notably the Psalter, a most wonderful specimen of ancient typography. Schatfi‘er appears to be as undoubtedly 20 DISCOVERY OF PRINTING. - \/Villiam Caxton acquired a knowledge of the art in Ger- many, and carried it into practice at Westminster in England. The year 1477 is now accepted as the date of the introduction, the first book printed with a date in England being the Dz'ez‘es and Sayinges of the Philosophers, emprynted by me, William Caxton, at Weslmesz‘re, the yew/e of our Lom’ meeealxxoz'j. He had previously printed, without a date, The Reezzyell of > the Hz'stowj/es of T roye, which was followed by The Game and Playe of the Chesse, fynyss/zz'd the last day of mamhe'lhe er of our lord god. a. thousand fom'e homlerd and lxxz'z'z'z'. These were, however, printed at Bruges; so, according to Mr. William Blades, “the first indisputable date we have to stand on is the printing of The Dietes in 1477.” Though at that time over sixty years old, Caxton was no- table for his industrious habit. He was possessed of good sense and sound judgment; steady, persevering, active, zeal- ous, and liberal in his devices for that important art which he introduced into England, labouring not only as a printer, but as translator and author. The productions of his press amount to sixty-four. In the churchwardens’ books of St. Margaret’s Parish, W'estminster, his death is thus recorded: “ 1491. Item, atte bureyng of \IVilIiam Caxton, for iiii. torches vjs. viijd. Item, for the belle atte same bureyng, vja’.” The Bible was printed in Spanish at Valencia in 1479 by Lambert Palmaert, a German; but so completely was it after- ward suppressed by the Inquisition that only four leaves now remain in the archives of Valencia. The first Hebrew Bible ever printed came from the press of Abraham Colorito, at Soncino, in I488——a very remarkable work. Iceland had its printing-office in 1530, at which a Bible was printed in 1584. the inventor of type-founding as Koster was of printing,—Gutenberg was neither, though we must award him high credit for his skill in availing himself of the know- ledge derived from Koster, and his perseverance through a series of years. But the almost impenetrable cloud of mystery that surrounds the discovery of printing should induce a spirit of modesty and hesitancy that is not at all characteristic of Mr. De Vinne and his like-minded predecessors. Neither ifs, buts, nor perhapses, nor strained inferences prove any thing except the weakness of the argument that rests upon them. \Ve are entirely satisfied that the types used by the first printers were not cast or founded in a mode at all approximating to the modern method. The question is, not who was the first type-founder in the modern style, but who was the first printer with movable types, no matter whether of wood, pewter, or tin; and we repeat that we coincide with the judicious Isaiah Thomas in the opinion that Laurens Koster was that man. ANCIENT PECULIARJT/ES. 21 ANCIENT PECULIARITIES. THE pages were either large or small folios, but sometimes quartos, and, the early books were therefore cumbrous and unhandy. Aldus Manuccio, of Venice, was the first to introduce the octavo form. The leaves were without running titles, direction-words, paginal numbers, or divisions into paragraphs. The character itself was a rude old Gothic (similar to that now known as Old English or Blaze/e) mixed with Secretary, designed to imitate the handwriting of the times; the words were printed so close to one another that the matter was not easily read. To avoid divisions, the early printers used vowels with a mark of abbreviation over them to denote that one or more letters were omitted in the word: ag. copose for compose, copletio for completion, &c. No punctuation-marks were used, except the colon and full point; but an oblique stroke (/) was after a while introduced, for which the comma was finally substituted. Logotypes were frequently employed. Orthography was various and arbitrary. Proper names and sentences were often begun with small letters, as well as the first words in lines of poetry. Blanks were left for the places of titles, initial letters, and other ornaments, to be supplied afterward by illuminators, whose calling did not long survive the masterly improvements made by the printers in this branch of their art. These orna- ments were exquisitely fine, and curiously variegated with the most beautiful colours, and even with gold and silver. The margins, likewise, were frequently charged with a variety of figures, of saints, birds, beasts, monsters, flowers, 8zc., which sometimes had relation to the contents of the page, though frequently none at all. These embellishments were often very costly. The name of the printer, place of his residence, 81c. were either omitted or put at the end of the book, with some pious ejaculation or doxology. The date was also omitted, or involved in some cramped design, or printed either at full length or in numerical letters, and sometimes partly one and partly the other: thus, One 22 PRINTING [IV Ajl/IERICA. Thousand CCCC and lxxiiii; but always placed at the end of the book. - There was no variety of character, nor intermixture of R0- man and Italic, which were later inventions; but the pages were printed in a Gothic letter of the same size throughout. Catch—words at the end of the foot-line (now generally abolished) were first used at Venice, by Vindeline de Spire. The inventor of signatures is said to have been Antonio Zarotti of Milan, about 1470. Books were often encased in massive coverings, which were ornamented with florid and arabesque designs. jewels and precious metals, the finest stuffs, and the most gorgeous colours were sometimes employed. Scaliger says, that his grandmother had a printed Psalter, the cover of which was two inches thick. On the inner side was a receptacle, containing a small silver crucifix, with the name of Berenz'ca Codronz'a de la Scala behind it. . Two or three hundred copies of a work were considered to be a large edition. ' PRINTING IN AMERICA. RINTING was introduced into America at Mexico by the Viceroy Mendoza in 1536. The first book printed was the Escala espiritual de San Yuan Climaco, of which no copy is known to exist; but the oldest American book now extant is the .Manual de Adultos, dated 1540, of which only the last four leaves are to be found in the library of the Cathedral of To- ledo. The name of the earliest printer is a matter of question. Cambridge, Massachusetts, is entitled to the distinction of having the first printing-press in North America, which was under the charge of Stephen Daye, For this press the colony was mainly indebted to the Rev. Jesse Glover, a noncon— formist minister possessed of a considerable estate, who had left England to settle among his friends in Massachusetts. Some gentlemen of Amsterdam also “gave towards furnish- ing of a printing-press with letters, forty-nine pounds and something more.” This was about 1638. The first book issued was the Bay Psalm-Boole, in 1640. The first book issued in the Middle Colonies was an Alma- nac, printed by William Bradford in 1685, near Philadelphia. PRINTING IN AMERICA. 23 Bradford was brought out from England in 1682 by IIVilliam Penn. As the government of Pennsylvania became very restrictive in regard to the press, Bradford in 1693 removed to New York, and was appointed printer to that colony, where he established in 1725 the New York Gazelle, the first news- paper published there. He died May 23, 1752, after an active and useful life of eighty-nine yearsfl) ' The first newspaper in America was the Boston News Lei‘- ler, which was first issued by john Campbell on Monday, April 24, 1704: it was regularly published for nearly seventy-two years. The second was the Boston Gazelle, begun December 21, I719. The third was the American Weekly 1W67’6u1’j/,ISSU€CI in Philadelphia, by Andrew Bradford, on December 22, 1719. James Franklin, an elder brother of Benjamin, established the New England Conmnl, August 17, 1721. The oldest living paper of the United States is the .Nezo Hampshire Gazelle, published at Portsmouth, now (Oct. 7, 1877) one hundred and twenty—one years old. The NOVZ/l American and United States Gazelle leads the existing daily press of this country in point of antiquity. It is the successor of the Pennsylvania Packet, (begun in 1771 and becoming a daily paper in 1784,) and is still the chief commercial journal of Philadelphia. The first paper—mill in America was established near Ger- mantown, Pa., in 1690, by \Villiam Rittenhousefizl (1) Two copies of Bradford's Almanac are known to be in existence. We give the Address of THE PRINTER TO THE READERS. Hereby underftand that after great charge 8: Trouble, I have brought that GREAT ART & MYSTERY OF PRINTING into this part of America; believing it may be of great fcrvice to you in feveral refpects; hoping to find encouragement, not only in this Altnanack, but what elfe I fhall enter upon for the ufe & fervice of the Inhabitants of thefe Parts. Some irregularities there be in this Diary, which I defire you to pafs by this year; for being lately come hither, my materials were mifplaced & out of order, whereupon I was forced to ufe Figures & Letters of various Sizes: but underftanding the want of some- thing of this nature, & being importuned thereto, I ventured to make public this; defiring you to accept thereof; & by the next (as I find encouragement) ihall endeavour to have things compleat. And for the cafe of Clarks, Scriveniers, &c., I propofe to print blank Bills, Bonds, Letters of Attorney, Indentures, Warrants, etc., & what elfe prefents itfelf, wherein I (hall be ready to ferve you; and remain your friend. ‘ Philadelphia, the W. BRADFORD. 10th month, 1685. (2) Mr. Horatio Gates Jones, of Philadelphia, in his introduction to Frame’s Short Description of Pennsilvania, gives further interesting particulars. See, also, Munsell’s Chronology, 810. of Paper and Paper Making, Albany, N. Y., 1876. 2 4 T YPE-FO UIVDIN G [IV E UR OPE. TYPE-FOUNDING IN EUROPE. OR a long period after the discovery of printing, it seems that type-founding, printing, and binding went under the general term of printing, and that printers cast the types used by them, and printed and bound the works executed in their establishments. Type-founding became a distinct calling early in the seventeenth century. A decree of the Star Chamber, made july II, 1637, ordained the following regulations con- cerning English founders :- “That there shall be four founders of letters for printing, and no more. “That the Archbishop of Canterbury, or the Bishop of Lon- don, with six other high commissioners, shall supply the places of those four as they shall become void. “That no master-founder shall keep above two apprentices at one time. “That all journeyman-founders be employed by the mas- ters of the trade, and that idle journeymen be compelled to work, upon pain of imprisonment and such other punishment as the court shall think fit. “That no master-founder of letters shall employ any other person in any work belonging to the casting or founding of letters than freemen or apprentices to the trade, save only in pulling off the knots of metal hanging at the end of the letters when they are first cast; in which work every master-founder may employ one boy only, not bound to the trade.” By the same decree, the number of master-printers in Eng- land was limited to twenty. Regulations like the above were in force till 1693. The “polyglot founders,” as they have been called, were suc- ceeded by joseph Moxon and others. But the‘ English were unable to compete with the superior productions of the Dutch founders, until the advent of William Caslon, who, by the beauty and excellence of his type, surpassed his Batavian competitors, when the importation of foreign type ceased, and his founts were, in turn, exported to the Continent. By an act subsequently passed, no founder was to cast any letter for printing, no joiner to make any press, no smith to forge any iron-work for a press; no person to bring from parts TYPE-FOUNDL/VG [1V AjlfEPlC/I. 25 beyond the seas any letters founded or cast for printing; nor any person to buy any letters or any other materials belong- ing unto printing; without application to the master and ward— ens of the Company of Stationers. TYPE-FOUNDING IN AMERICA. AFOUNDRY, principally for German type, was established at Germantown, Pennsylvania, about the year 1735, by Christopher Saur, (or Sower,) a printer, who executed in Ger— man the first quarto Bible printed in America, as well as other valuable works in the German language. Three editions of the Bible were printed—viz., in the years 1743, 1763, and 1776, the latter two by his son. In 1739, Saur published a news- paper in Germantown. An abortive attempt was made about 1768 to set up a foundry at Boston by a Mr. Mitchelson from Scotland, and another in Connecticut in 1769 by Abel Buel. In 1775, Dr. Franklin brought from Europe to Philadelphia the materials for a foundry; but little use of them was made. John Baine, a type-founder of Edinburgh, sent a relative to this country with tools for a foundry at the close of the Revo- lutionary War, and soon after came over himself. They carried on the business till I790, when Mr. Baine died, and his kins- man returned to Scotland. A Dutch founder, Adam G. Mappa, settled at New York about 1787, and cast Dutch and German faces, as well as Roman styles and several Oriental alphabets. \Vant of capital prevented his success, and many of his matrices passed into the possession of Binny 8: Ronaldsonfll In 1796, type-founding was commenced in Philadelphia by Archibald Binny and James Ronaldson, natives of the city of Edinburgh, where Binny had carried on the same business. Their assortment was not extensive, but it embraced the essential founts,——Brevier, Bourgeois, Long Primer, Small Pica, Pica, and two-line letters. They were obliging and attentive, and in twenty years made a fortune. They improved their (l) The remainder of this article was mostly furnished by the late Mr. George Bruce, of New York. 3 2 6 T YPE-FO UN'DIN G IN‘ A IlIERI CA . foundry according to the increase of printing and the conse- quent demands of the trade, extending their assortment from Pearl, of 180 lines in a foot, to 12-line Pica, having 6 lines. Binny made an important improvement in the type-mould, by which a caster could cast 6ooo letters in a day with as much ease as he before could cast 4ooo.<1) According to Holmes’s American Annals, about 200 news- papers were printed in the United States in the year 1801, of which 17 were issued daily, 7 three times a week, 30 twice a week, and 146 weekly. There must also have been at the same time as many as 60 ofiices engaged in miscellaneous printing. The whole business had increased threefold in eleven years. Another type-foundry was put in successful operation in Baltimore, about 1805, by Samuel Sower & Co. It had in it some moulds and matrices which had been used by Christopher Sower, who had printed in Germantown, near Philadelphia, and cast his own types. He printed with German characters; but now the foundry was revived with excellent Roman and Italic letters, and among other extraordinary things it had the size called Diamond, with a smaller face than had ever been cast before. It was the smallest type in the world. The demand for type was very brisk till the war of 1812 commenced, and the foundries were generally three or four months in arrears in their execution of orders. The names of the newspapers published in the United States in April, 1810, are given in T homas’s History of Print- ing, and amount to 359, of which 27 were daily papers, 38 (1) After the retirement of Binny & Ronaldson, Richard Ronaldson carried on the business of this foundry until 1833, when he in turn was succeeded by Lawrence Johnson and George F. Smith. Mr. Johnson, a man of great energy and enterprise, had (contemporaneously with Jedediah Howe) introduced stereotyping into Philadel- phia, and now both callings were incorporated. Ten years afterward, Mr. Smith retired; and in the year 1845 Mr. Johnson associated with him Thomas MacKellar, john F. Smith, and Richard Smith, who had, as it were, grown up with the business. The foundry now quickly grew in importance, and won a wide reputation. A quar- terly periodical, entitled the Typographic Advertiser, edited by the first-named junior member, was (and still is) issued and circulated at home and in foreign lands; while its finely-printed Specimen Books showed that the foundry was making rapid progress. Mr. Johnson died in 1860, and was succeeded by his three partners, who, with Peter A._Iordan, constitute the present firm, now known as MacKellar, Smiths & jordan, under whose management the establishment has been brought to rank at least equal with the first in the world. Their new Specimen Book may be regarded as a unique mechanical and literary production. TYPEJ'OKLVDZNG [N All/IEIBZCA. 27 were printed twice, 15 three times, and 279 once in a week. Add those required for general printing, and the whole num- ber of offices could not be less than 5oo,——being an increase of 240 in nine years, and some of them using several thousand pounds of type for book-printing. In 1811, Elihu White established a type-foundry in New ' York. He had been long engaged, in connection with Mr. \Ning, in the manufacture of printing types at Hartford, Con— necticut, upon a plan of their own invention, by which twenty or thirty letters were cast at once; but, abandoning that invention, he adopted the old plan of casting, and, having a good assortment of faces and bodies, his removal to New York was a great convenience to its printers, and they gave him a very satisfactory support. But the principal business in type-founding still continued for some years to be done in Philadelphia. ‘ In 1813, another type-foundry was begun in the city of New York, by D. & G. Bruce, principally to cast types for their own use. They had carried on book-printing for seven years, and had now become acquainted with the stereotype art,—Mr. David Bruce having visited England in 1812 and acquired it by purchase and actual labour. For ordinary printing, it was cus_ tomary to bevel off the body of the type at the face end, or shoulder, as it is usually called, which unfitted it for making a strong stereotype plate in the most approved way: hence the necessity for casting type expressly for stereotype. Their first fount was Bourgeois, with which they cast two sets of plates of the New Testament, (the Common School Testament,) and sold one of these to Mathew Carey, of Philadelphia, retaining the other for their own business. But these were not com- pleted till 1814. In 1815, they cast the plates of the 12mo - School Bible, on Nonpareil type, prepared, like the Bourgeois, at their own foundry expressly for stereotyping. They thus gave the first stereotype School Testament and School Bible to America; but not the first stereotype book. John Watts, of England, also commenced stereotyping in New York in 1813, and completed the W estminster Catechism that year, a volume of 120 pages 12mo. David Bruce invented the planing- machine for equalizing the thickness of stereotype plates, which is now used in every stereotype foundry in the United States. The process of stereotyping is, however, entirely 28 TYPE-F0 UNDING 11v AIMEE/CA. different from that of ordinary type-founding, and it is, there- ‘ fore, generally carried on as a separate business, or connected with the composing department of a printing-office. Twenty compositor-s and two proof-readers will furnish full employ- ment for one moulder, one caster, and three finishers, who will, among them, complete, on an average, 50 pages of octavo per day. In 1818, or soon after, a type and stereotype foundry was established in Boston, and another in Cincinnati, principally through the enterprise of the late Elihu White, who, having the means of multiplying matrices with facility, took this method for the extension of his business. Others followed his example, and type-foundries were established in Albany, Bufi'alo, Pitts- burgh, Louisville, and St. Louis, with several additional in New York, Boston, Philadelphia, and Baltimore. The busi- ness, in fact, was overdone, and failures and suppressions took place, as competition reduced the prices of types. The mode of type-founding has within forty years under- gone important changes, which must no doubt be considered improvements. First among them is the introduction of machine-casting, in which a pump forces the fluid metal into the mould and matrix, and gives a sharper outline to the let- ter than was formerly given by the most violent throw of the caster. The old practice of casting-a single type only at a time remains. The first idea of this machine originated with WVilliam M. johnson, who obtained a patent for it in 1828. Elihu White put it into use in his type-foundry, and per- severed in using and trying to improve it as long as he lived; but he did not succeed in removing the greatest fault, which was a hollowness in the body of the types cast by it, that in- clined them to sink under the pressure of the printing-press. The first successful type-casting machine was invented by David Bruce, ]r., of New York, and was patented March 17, 1838. The patent was sold to George Bruce, and the ma- chines were used by him until 1845. David Bruce meanwhile patented another machine in 1843, which, with new improve ments, patented two years later, gave entire satisfaction, and is now in general use in American foundries. By Bruce’s machine, three times the quantity of type that was cast by Binny 8: Ronaldson’s improved mould is now cast in a given time, and nearly five times the quantity that was cast by the .... _.__.,..—_..- ._. - ._ -._,...__. a._-.-a__.___._.__.c .. _..--__. ._._.._ _ t..,__. . .__...___.-____--_ TYPE-F0 UNDLVG [N AMER/CA. 29 common hand-mould eighty years ago. This improvement has passed into Europe, and been adopted by most of the German type-founders; but in Great Britain for some time it found little favour. A so-called “automatic machine,” for casting and finishing type, invented by Johnson & Atkinson, is in operation in London; but its rate of production seems to be less than that of the American machine, while, from its multiform operations, the proportion of imperfect type turned out must of necessity be considerably more. The protection now afforded by the patent laws having checked the piratical production of matrices by electrotyping, (except in plain faces, a practice still pursued by unprincipled type-founders,) the leading founders in this country have been encouraged to produce types of new styles which in beauty and ingenuity surpass those of foreign origin. There are now four type-foundries in Boston, five in New York, one in Buffalo, three in Philadelphia, two in Baltimore, two in Cincinnati, four in Chicago, one in Milwaukee, two in St. Louis, one in Richmond, one at St. Paul, and one in California,—-in all, twenty-seven. These foundries not only supply the printers of the United States, but most of the printers in Canada, some in the British \Vest India Islands, the Spanish and Danish Islands, Mexico, and South America. American type, in quality, style, and finish, is equal, if not superior, to any made in Europe. The following are the prices at which plain types have been sold for the last seventy-five years, given at ten different dates, and naming only the principal and most useful sizes :— 1801. 1806. _1_811. 1819. i 1827. 181.1.§__1860.§1866. 1876. l187.. Pica . . . $0.35 $0.44 $0.55 $0.44 l$0.42 $0.38 i503: '$0.56 !$0.46 $0.38 Small Pica .40 .48 .58 l .48 g .46 .40 I .34 f .58 .48 7 .40 ‘ Lg. Primer .47 .56 .66 ‘ .56 I .50 . 2 .36 ' .62 i .50 ‘ . 2 ‘ Bourgeois .56 .66 .76 .66 .58 .46 i .40 .66 l .52 .44 . . Brevier . . .67 .76 .86 ' .76 .70 .54 l .44 - .70‘ .55 , .48 ' Minion . . 1.03 1.13 1.00 .88 .66; .48 ' .76 .58 , .52 i Nonpareil 1.12 1.40 1.75 1.40i 1.20 .84 l .58 , .84 i .66 .58 i Agate . . . . . . . .i .l 1.44 1.08 .~-i 1.00 .76 .68 Pearl. . . . . . . . . . . . 1.75 1.40f 1.08I 1.40.~ 1.20: 1.08 l “Diamond. . . . l .l. .l 1.60, 1.80) 1.62l 1.50 l 30 s YZEREOTYPIAI’G. STEREOTYPING. TEREOTYPING is said to have been invented by J. Van der Mey, in Holland, about 1698. A quarto Bible and some other books were printed by him from plates, which were formed by soldering the bottoms of common type together. William Ged, of Edinburgh, discovered the present mode in 1725, and stereotyped parts of the Bible and Prayer-Book. l-le encountered malicious opposition, and the business was abandoned, the new method dying with the inventor. About 1745, Benjamin Mecom, a nephew of Dr. Franklin, cast plates for a number of the pages of the New Testament. Dr. Alex- ander Tilloch, of Glasgow, re-discovered the art in 1781. Ste- reotyping gradually spread, and soon eliected a Considerable reduction in the cost of books. The arguments that were advanced against its utility have a ridiculous look at the present day, when almost every important work is stereotyped or electrotyped. Matter for stereotyping is set with high spaces and quad- rates. The forms must be small, containing about two pages of common octavo. A slug type—high is put above the top line and another below the foot line of each page, to protect the ends of the plates from injury when they are passed through the shaving~machine. Beveled slugs, in height equal to the shoulder of the type, are placed on both sides and between the pages, to form the flange by which the plate is to be clasped by the hooks of the printing-block. Before the form is sent into the foundry, the type must be carefully compared with the proof, to detect any errors which may have been left uncorrected. Care must be taken to lock up the form perfectly square and quite tight, to prevent the types from being pulled out when the mould is raised from the pages. It must be evenly planed down, and no ink or dirt or incrustations from the ley be allowed to remain on the surface. The face of the type being clean and dry, and the bottoms free from particles of dirt, the form is laid on a clean mould- ing-stone, and brushed over with sweet-oil, which must be laid on as thinly as possible, care being taken that the entire surface of the types is covered. A moulding-frame, with a .S‘TEREOTYPING. 31 ._____. ,- screw at each corner, (called a flas/tg) and fitting neatly to the form, is next placed around it. The material for moulding is finely ground gypsum, nine parts of which. are mixed with about seven parts of water, and well stirred up. A small quantity of the liquid mixture is poured over the pages, and gently pressed into the counter of the types with a small roller, for the purpose of expelling confined air; after which, the remainder of the gypsum is poured in, until the mould is somewhat higher than the upper edge of the flask. In a few minutes the mixture sets, and the upper side is smoothed over with a steel straight-edge. In about ten minutes the mould is gently raised by means of the screws at the corners of the flask; and, after being nicely trimmed at the sides, and nicked on the surface-edges to make openings for the metal to run in, it is placed on a shelf in an oven, and allowed to remain until the moisture has quite evaporated. The casting-pans may be large enough to hold three or four moulds. The dried moulds are placed in a pan face down- ward, upon a movable iron plate called a floater. The cover - of the casting-pan, which has a hole at each corner for the passage of the metal, is then clamped to it, and lifted by a movable crane and gently lowered into the metal-pot,——con- taining, it may be, a thousand pounds of liquid metal,—till the metal begins to flow slowly in at the corners. When the pan is filled, it is sunk to the bottom of the pot. The metal should be hot enough to light a ‘piece of brown paper held in it. After being immersed eight or ten minutes, the pan is steadily drawn out by means of the crane, and swung over to the cool- ing-trough, into which it is lowered and placed upon a stone so as just to touch the water, in order that the metal at the bottom of the pan may cool first. The metal contracts while cooling, and the caster occasionally pours in a small quantity at the corners from a ladle, till it will take no more. lt may be here remarked that some stereotypers do not dry the moulds, but immerse them in a green condition into the metal. The plates are carefully removed from the solid mass which comes out of the pan, and the plaster is washed from the surface. If, after examination, the face is good and sharply set, the plates are passed over to a picker, who re- moves any slight defects arising from an imperfection of the 32 STEREO TYPIIVG. mould. They are then trimmed and passed through the shav- ing-machine, till all are brought to an equal thickness. The flanges are neatly side-planed, and the plates are then boxed, ready for the printing-press. In England, the plates are merely turned on the back, and consequently vary in thickness. This must be a source of con- tinual expense and annoyance to the pressman. The flanges, besides, are very imperfectly made,—so imperfectly that they cannot be used on American printing-blocks; and English plates, when imported into this country, are therefore sent to a foundry here, to be brought to an equal thickness and to be properly side-planed. An order given some years ago by an English printer for a set of American printing-blocks was afterward countermanded, on account of the prejudice against the introduction of new things. Several methods of stereotyping are now practised. Many of the leading newspapers of England and America are printed from stereotype plates cast in moulds made of prepared paper: this mode, however, yields very inferior plates, quite unfit for fine books. Another method, styled the “ mud-process,” is by spreading a thin coating of pulverized soapstone and gypsum over an iron plate, and a mould is then obtained by pressing the coated face against a page of type. Several of these mould-plates are then set on end in an iron box, separated from one another by a wire of the thickness of the stereotype desired, and hot metal is poured in. This is a very expeditious pro- cess, though not so good as the old method. In 1804, before the introduction of stereotyping into this country, Mathew Carey, the well-known enterprising publisher in Philadelphia, had the Bible in quarto set up entire, and regu- larly imposed in chases, to print from at convenience, according to the demand for the volume. The type was cast by Binny Ronaldson. Stereotyping would have saved much of the large outlay required to carry out the scheme, which, never- theless, even under these circumstances, was doubtless highly remunerative. The weight of type must have amounted to 25,000 pounds, to say nothing of the number of chases and column-rules required. ELECTPOTYPING AND LITIIOGPAPHY. 33 ELECTROTYPING. ATELY, stereotyping has measurably given way to the process of electrotyping, as described below, and may be superseded by it, though the former is better for moderate editions. The pages, after being delicately polished with plumbago, are laid in a press; a pan of prepared wax, warmed, is placed over them and pressed down into the counter of the types. The wax mould is then dusted with plumbago, to give it a metallic surface, and suspended in the battery. On this, in a few hours, is deposited a thin shell of copper, which, after being coated with tin solder, is backed up with metal to the usual thickness of a stereotype plate. This method of electro- stereotyping is desirable for Bibles and other works of which immense editions are required. W ood-cuts are usually elec- trotyped, as a stereotype mould cannot be lifted from its sur— face unless the wood-cut has been previously coated with gum, which thickens the lines and injures the effect of the engraving. The same care in preparing the pages for electrotyping must be observed as ‘or stereotyping. For stereotyping, high slugs are placed only at the top and foot of the page; but, for electrotyping, they must be set around on all sides, and the bevelled flange must be afterward made by side-planing. LITHOGRAPHY. HIS is the art of printing, by a chemical process, from designs made with a greasy material upon stone. It was discovered about the beginning of the present century by Alois Senefelder, an actor of Munich, Bavaria, whose patience and perseverance under the most disadvantageous circum- stances were truly remarkable and praiseworthy. Differing from all other methods of printing, the impressions are ob- tained from a level surface. The stone best calculated for lithographic purposes is a sort of calcareous slate found on the banks of the Danube, in Bavaria, the finest being found near Munich. A good stone is porous, yet brittle, of a pale yellowish drab, and sometimes of a gray neutral tint. The stones are formed into slabs from one and a-half to three inches in thickness. To 34 LITIIO GRAI’IIY. prepare them for use, two stones are placed face to face with some fine sifted sand between them, and then are rubbed together with a circular motion, to produce the requisite granulation, which is made finer or coarser to suit the purpose - of the artist. The principal agents used for making designs on stone are called lithographic chalk and lithographic ink. They are composed of tallow, virgin wax, hard tallow soap, shellac, sometimes a little mastic or copal, and enough lampblack to impart a colour to the mass. These ingredients are put into an iron sauce-pan, and exposed to a strong fire till the mass is in a state of ignition. i/Vhen the quantity is reduced one- half, the pan is carefully covered, or put into water to ex- tinguish the flame and cool the mixture. After being well worked up, it is formed into small cakes or sticks. The ingredients are the same in the chalk and the ink, but the proportions are varied, and a little Venice turpentine is often added to the latter. The chalk is used in a dry state; but the ink is dissolved by rubbing in water, and is used in a pen or with a camel-hair pencil. The presence of soap renders it soluble in water. The artist completes a drawing with the chalk upon a grained stone as he would make a drawing in pencil or chalk upon paper. If while in this state a wet sponge were passed over the face of the stone, the drawing would wash off. To . prevent this, and to make it capable of yielding impressions, a weak solution of nitrous acid is poured over it, which unites with and neutralizes the alkali or soap contained in the chalk, and renders it insoluble in water. After this, the usual course is to float a solution of gum over the whole face of the stone; and, when this is taken ofl", the drawing is no longer removable by the application of a wet sponge, because the chalk is now insoluble. The stone is 'now ready for the printer, who ob~ tains impressions by the following process. Having damped the surface of the stone equally with a sponge filled with water which has been slightly tinctured by acid, the printer finds that the water has been imbibed by only those parts of the stone which are not occupied by the drawing, which, being greasy, repels the water and re— mains dry. A roller covered with ink is now passed over the stone, which will not even be soiled where it is wet, from LJTHO GRAPH)’. 35 the antipathy of oil to water. But the parts occupied by the drawing, being dry and greasy, have an affinity for the print- ing-ink, which, therefore, leaves the roller and attaches itself to the drawing. In this state it is said to be charged or rolled in. A sheet of damped paper is then put over it, and, the whole being passed through a press, the printing-ink is trans- ferred from the stone to the paper, and the impression is obtained. Great nicety is requisite in the preparation of all the agents employed in this art, and in the process of printing as well as in making the drawing on the stone. The most important application of this process is in the production of copies of coloured drawings and paintings,——a process known as chroma-lithography. The object here being to produce as nearly as possible fac-similes in colour, touch, and texture, as well as in drawing and light and shadow, of pictures from the pencils of painters of the highest standing, it has been found necessary to employ a large number of stones, in order to produce the almost infinite varieties of tints which are found united in a single picture, —-every stone giving a separate impression in its own particular colour or tint. The mode of procedure is somewhat as follows. First, an outline of the entire subject is made by means of transfer paper, or otherwise, on a stone which is called the outline or keystone of the work. This stone yields impressions which are transferred as guides to all the other stones. On a second and third stone which serve as the basis of the print the general effect of the drawing is washed in, and from these are printed what may be called the chiaroscuro, in a faint tint of sepia and of a neutral colour or gray,——corresponding, in fact, very nearly to the neutral or dead colouring of a water-colour drawing in the method adopted by the early water-colour painters. The stones which follow are each charged with a particular colour or tint, and each leaves its impression on only a particular portion of the print,—one stone printing only the parts which are intended to be yellow or a modification of yellow, another red, another blue, and so on. Other stones charged in parts with grays or second- ary colours serve to blend and harmonize the crude colours; others follow which modify these; and, finally, one gives the sharp dark touches, and is usually followed by another which supplies a sort of glaze or finishing wash, and subdues and 36 LITHO GRAPH y. harmonizes the whole. Of course, we have merely indicated the general method. It will be understood that the sequence of the colours in the printing, the special quality and strength to be given to each particular tint, the effect to be produced by their super-position, and many other particulars, have all to be taken into account in planning the arrangement of the colours on the stones ;—since a sequence in some respects dif- ferent, and an entirely different modification of colours, have to be employed for the works of most artists; and it happens that much of the colour on each of the earlier stones is covered by that of succeeding stones, and that thus only can the broken tints of the original be imitated. It is, in fact, only by watching the progress of a print through all its stages that any clear idea can be obtained of the beauty and accuracy of the whole process, of the prevision that must be exercised, and of the skill, care, and taste required at every step to carry it to a successful termination. For some of the more elaborate prints, from thirty to forty stones have been required to produce a finished print. And in order to produce this print, it must be borne in mind that each sheet of paper has to be passed as many times through the press as there are stones, since each stone imprints upon it only its own particular section of the work. Of course, in proportion to the increase in the number of the stones, does the difficulty increase of making the work upon each fall exactly upon its proper place in the general design; for, if any one were misplaced only the fiftieth of an inch, the drawing and colour of the whole would be disturbed. Hence it is found neces- sary to arrange the register, or adjustment of the stones, with the utmost care and precision, and .to exercise the most careful supervision in the printing, since the sheet of paper expands considerably in passing through the press, and has to be dried and re-damped before it can be passed through again. But practically this is all accomplished with seeming ease. and a large and most complex subject will be found, when the last stage has been reached, to bear the most minute serutmy; and the result, even when the copy is placed along- side the original, will surprise and delight equally those who have followed the work through its several steps and those who may only examine the completed work. E/VGKA V/NG. 37 Of late, many chromos have been beautifully printed from prepared blocks on an ordinary cylinder-press. HE invention of wood engraving has been claimed for the Chinese, whose books have certainly been printed from engraved wood blocks for ages. until the beginning of the fifteenth century that we find any evidence of the existence of wood engraving as we now understandit. It is probable that Italy was the first European country to make engrav- ings, but only for printing playing~ cards. Holland a n (1 Ge 1 m a n y soon applied the art to better ends. The earliest print of which any cer- tain information can be obtained is in the collection of Earl Spencer. It was discovered in one of the most ancient convents of Germany,——the Chartreuse of Buxheim, near Memmingen in Bavaria,——pasted within the cover of 'a Latin MS.; it represents Saint Christopher carrying the infant Saviour across the sea, and is dated 1423. \\’e give a reduced fac-simile of this curious engraving. ENGRAVING. m1!» . Gurtomammmequaum time? am.» 2/’- a» gilt It is not, however, autumn meme Man tion at the bottom has been thus translated :~ In whichever day thou secst the likeness of St. Christopher, In that same day thou wilt, at least from death, no evil blow incur. -1423. mime s’mw-xe _ The inscrip- 4 E .NG RA VI IV G . /$otatfiatnohm2mebtmuiinibfuotmnnbbmfiansém't Shortly afterward, a series of books printed entirely from wood engravings, called block-books, were issued. The most important of them were the Apocalypsis, sen IIistoria Sancti )Yohannis; the Historia Virginis ea: Cantico Canticorum; \\| \ \\\\\ \ \\ \\ ~2- J ._- _ \ll/(t \,\llll(/ \\\l- l // Till I “ll/,1 \‘Nlll \T/I ,\\ll|,, ‘Nil! ' \\\ ll \\\ll// \\ll \Illl \' I ‘\‘l | l? and the Biblia Pauperum, the last containing representations of some of the principal pas- sages of the Old and New Testaments, with explanatory texts. The illustrations seem to be drawn with a supreme contempt for perspective and proportion, but bear evidence of the draperies and hands and faces having been care- fully studied. The above is a copy of one of the cuts in the Apocalypsis. It represents St. John preaching to three men and a woman, with the inscrip- tion: “Conversi ab idolis, per predicationem beati Yohannis, Drusiana et ceteri,” (By the preaching of St.]ohn, Drusi- ana and others are withdrawn from their idols.) The adjoining ENGRA VINO. 39 cut, from the Biblz'a Pauperum, is curious as showing the general manner of representing the creation of Eve during the fifteenth century. Both have the appearance of careful drawings “spoiled in the engraving.” Previous to the inven- tion of movable types, whole books of text were also en- graved on wood, and the impressions were evidently taken by rubbing on the back of the paper, instead of a steady pressure, as in the printing-press, the ink used being some kind of distemper colour. The woodito be engraved on is carefully selected, and cut up into transverse slices seven-eighths of an inch thick. This is done by circular saws, which are necessarily very rigid, so as to insure good even cuts. After being cut, the slices are placed in racks something like plate-racks, and thoroughly seasoned by slow degrees in gradually heated rooms. When sufficiently seasoned they are reduced to parallelograms of various sizes, the outer portion of the circular section near the bark being cut away, and all defective wood rejected; such, for instance, as knots, irregu~ lar grain, as that resulting from the position of branches, which are indicated by light-coloured markings in the wood, known in the trade as “comets,” from their resemblance in shape to those fiery bodies. They are softer than the sur~ rounding wood, and consequently do not cut well with the graver; therefore much care and a practised eye are needed in selecting suitable wood. A section of boxwood almost always exhibits parts of widely different values; the more so as it deviates from the circle in form, for then the annual rings are compressed, and consequently closer on one side than on the other, the side with the wide open rings being usually far inferior in value to the denser and smaller side. In former times, engravers’ blocks were cut parallel with the grain, the present system of cutting them across the grain being introduced about the middle of the last century. In the preparation of a block, say for a newspaper plate, the parallelograms before spoken of are assorted as to size and fitted together at the back by brass bolts and nuts. So ac- curately do the edges of the wood fit together, that after the artist has finished his drawing on the smooth face of this compound block, the screws and bolts are loosened, and the pieces separated and given to several men to engrave the design; all that is needed after they have finished their work 40 E [VG/BA V I IVG . being to fit the pieces together and screw them up again, when they form one engraved block ready for the printing- press. Turkey boxwood, from a region of country in the vicinity of the Black Sea, is used for fine engravings. The best is of a delicate yellow colour free from spots or “eyes,” and cuts smoothly without crumbling or tearing. The tools or gravers necessary in wood-engraving are of three kinds,—viz., gravers proper (a); tint tools (6); and scoopers, or cutting-out tools, for clearing out the larger pieces (e). They are arranged in different sizes, to suit the various portions of the work.(1) \‘ I \ - . q I ' - ______ __b ........ ..-' ' ...... .. c ....... .: \L-_._._,__ a a - - g - o . - - I .- According to Vasari, the important discovery of chalco- graphy or engraving on brass or copper was made by Tom- maso F iniguerra, a Florentine goldsmith of the fifteenth cen- tury, who lived from I400 to 1460. The manner in which he made this discovery is thus stated by the Rev. T. F. Dibdin :— “Of engraving upon copper, the earliest known impres- sion is that executed by one Tommaso Finiguerra, a gold- smith of Florence, with the date of 1460 upon it. One of the following circumstances is supposed to have given rise ‘to the discovery. F iniguerra chanced to cast, or let fall, a piece of copper, engraved and filled with ink, into melted sulphur; and, observing that the exact impression of his work was left on the sulphur, he repeated the experiment on moistened paper, rolling it gently with a roller. This origin has been admitted by Lord Walpole and Mr. Land- seer; but another has been also mentioned by Huber. ‘It is reported,’ says he, ‘that a washerwoman left some linen upon a plate or dish on which Finiguerra had just been en- graving, and that an impression of the subject engraved, however imperfect, came off upon the linen, occasioned by its weight and moistness.’ ” ' (1) Chambers’s Encyclopasdia. A WAL/t' OVER ()U/t’ FOUA'DPI'. 41 A WALK OVER OUR FOUNDRY. R. TYPOGRAPH, how are you, sir? Glad to see you. How is business with you? Plenty to do, and cus- tomers paying up? You are so prompt in paying us, that we 'BSfiOH 'lViBW have no doubt you have a noble set of customers. You wish to add to your stock our new things? All right, sir. You have a fine olfice already, but you want to keep up with the times, and give your patrons the best the type-founder can invent? That’s the way, sir. The man on the lookout sees 4*‘ ‘ 42 A I/VALK OVER OUR FOUJVDRY. the sun the earliest. Mr. Faithful, show our new things to Mr. Typograph, and take his order. You say, Mr. Typograph, that you have never gone over a type-foundry? We shall be happy to show you every thing. This way, sir. Here is the metal-house. These piles of dull lead, these casks of sparkling antimony, this copper, and this tin go to form the grand amalgam of which type is made. The worthy and kind-hearted man who is stirring at the kettle, unites, in bonds stronger‘than matrimony, immense masses of these metals every week. It may appear to you, Mr. Typograph, to be an exceedingly simple thing to throw into the kettle certain amounts of lead and antimony, and copper and tin, and produce type—metal. Not so, good friend. It is not an easy matter‘ to compose a metal that shall be hard, yet not brittle; ductile, yet tough; flowing freely, yet hardening quickly. All these conditions must be met. Break a bar in two, and examine the grain of our metal: is it not beautiful? Now, sir, let us up-stairs and see how these bars are fitted for printers’ use. This is a punch-cutter—a man of exquisite finger and unerring eye—sitting amid keen and delicate tools and accurate gauges. There are but few of this kind of men in the world. On the end of a piece of steel he is forming a letter. A touch here and a touch there, and frequent testing by gauges,—so he proceeds, till the letter is done; then another, and another, till the alphabet is complete; all the letters harmonizing entirely-in height, breadth, appearance, length of stroke, &c. A smoke-proof of the dies is taken, and if approved the dies are one by one placed in a stamping-machine, so,—and an oblong piece of copper is set under it, so,—and then this lever is brought down, so,——and a perfect im- pression of the die is left, as you see, deep in the copper. This is the matrix. The matrices are passed over to other workmen in the adjoining room. Observe now the carefulness and skill exercised in fitting up these bits of cop- per, so that, when placed in the mould, the types cast in them shall range accurately and be of uniform height. The slightest variation would give the zigzag appearance which you may MATRIX. A WALK OVER OUR FOIL/YURI’. 43 have noticed in badly-made type. This'we endeavour sedu- lously to avoid, and with how much success you can judge from our Specimen Book. Look at this drawer full of ma- trices. You say they are triumphs of art? True saying, evincive of good judgment. You wonder what these curious-looking instruments are which lie, in dusty repose, on the shelves around the room? mmrsiiiisirag ;. E= winininnh. .a' 6' . min'mmmlm " "lilllii I ll! 'I’i‘ gs lllill "‘ l .\'\ \ ! ll -=\\iii\'= \ 1. _ i . i. _ ,-.,' mini 11 v" f I .. g. ‘ -' i "\ll‘ ‘P a" ‘ll I .1 a -_ ' , ‘ ' " ‘i. i .l - ‘lillll ‘l ' lllllllllli‘y CASTING MACHINE. 44 A I'VALK O VER OU/t’ FO U/VDRV. Those, Mr. Typograph, are hand-moulds, and at one time they provoked intense covetousness on the part of rival founders. One of our earliest predecessors, Mr. Archibald Binny (our foundry dates from 1796), added such valuable improvements to the ordinary mould, that no other foundry in the world could rival the expedition and accuracy with which types were cast in the establishment of which he was a co-proprietor. Their day has passed, however. They have been superseded by the machines which you will see in operation in another apartment. But they were capital things in their time, sir, and we regard them with somewhat of an antiquary’s reverence. Now we enter the casting-rooms. These tiny machines, small as they are, can throw out more type in one day than you would be likely to count in a month, even if you could call off one hundred a minute, and occupy ten hours a day. Snug little fellows, are they not? They were invented by a New—Yorker, Mr. David Bruce, jr. A very ingenious man, you say? That is true. Look at one carefully. The metal is kept fluid by a little furnace underneath, and is projected into the mould by a pump, the spout of which, you see, is in front of the metal-pot. The mould is movable, and at every revo- lution of the crank it comes up to the spout, receives a charge of metal, and flies back with a fully-formed type in its bosom; the upper half of the mould lifts, and out jumps a type as lively as a tadpole. You don’t see how the letter is formed on the end of the type? True, we had forgotten: well, this spring in front holds in loving proximity to the mould a cop- per matrix, such as you saw just now in the fitting-room. The letter a, for instance, stamped in the matrix, sits directly opposite the aperture in the mould which meets the spout of the pump; and when a due proportion of a’s is cast, another matrix with b stamped in it takes its place; and so on through- out the alphabet.‘ Slow work, you say, one at a time? Well, the world is peopled after that fashion; and it fills up fast enough. But just time this machine: it is making small, thin type. Count the type made in a minute. One hundred and seventy-five, you say. One hundred per minute will probably be the average of the ordinary sizes of printing type. The types are not finished yet? Oh, no. These nimble- iingered boys are breaking OK the jets, or waste ends of the A WALlf OVER OUR FOUNDRY. 45 type. Quick, a’n’t they? Now let us go up stairs into the dressing-room. An immense beehive? Yes, indeed, it looks like one. The lads clustered around the large circular stones, with leather-protected fingers, rub off the rough edges of the type. But men as well as type require their rough edges taken off before they are good for much in the world. These boys at the tables set up the type in long lines. You think that if you could pick up dollars as fast as they pick up type, you would retire an independent man in a year or two? W’ e wish you could, Mr. Typograph; we wish you could. The lines of type now pass into the hands of the dresser. Observe how deftly he slips them into a long stick, shakes them down on their face, screws them up, fastens them into a planing-board, and with one or two pushes with a planing tool accurately grooves the bottom of the type, removing entirely the burr left when the jet is broken ofl, and giving each type a pair of legs to stand upon, till it is worn out and returned to the melting kettle. What is the eye-glass used for? “'hy, sir, as soon as the types are grooved, the dresser narrowly inspects the face of the type, and if an imperfect letter is dis- covered by the aid of the magnifying glass, it is incontinent] y turned out. Ah, sir, if we were all inspected as severely as he criticizes type, some of us, perhaps, would hardly pass muster. The immaculate types are next put up in pages of convenient size, and are ready for the purchaser. Let us drop into the large machine-room. Does not every thing hum here! Is it not a beautiful sight to see the shafts and belts and pulleys whirling around as if they were all alive? Here we fit up our machines, make our moulds, re- pair damages to machinery, &c. The multifarious uses of these lathes you must be familiar with: this ponderous ma- chine is an iron planer: how it makes the iron chips fly! What is that curiously-arranged lathe? That is for cutting Labour-Saving Rule,—the rule which you have found so con- venient and economical in your job-room. \Ve make it of many different styles of faces: some single, some dotted or hyphen—lines, and others parallel or double, of varying thick- nesses. They are all cut to Pica ems in length, and are furnished with mitred corner-pieces of different angles, so contrived, in most of the sizes, as to allow the rule to be used single or double, and with the fine lines inside or outside. 46 A lVALIr’ OVER OUR FOUNDRY. Here are specimens of our new slotted brass corners, so handsome and useful to the skilled printer. See how accu- rately the slotted pieces fit in one another, so that you cannot detect the joint. Are they not eflective? Our brass is care- "Q. SLOTTED BRASS CORNERS. fully rolled by the best manufacturers in the country, and is sent to us in strips or in sheets. That wicked-looking shears yonder cuts up the thinner brass with as much unctivon as Commissioner Yeh’s executioner slices off heads: the thick brass goes under a circular steam-saw. Now, sir, while we are up here, we will peep into the printers’ furnishing-room. Isn’t this a beautiful stereotype- block? Doesn’t it do your eyes good to look at such perfect workmanship? And these brass galleys, and mahoga- ny galleys and composing sticks, are they not admira- ble? Our effort in this de- partment, as in all others, is to do our work well. All our miscellaneous wood-work is done here,——stands, racks, drawers, stereotype and packing boxes, &c. Some curious work has been designed and executed for the Smithsonian Institution, as well as brass ciphering-frames for the blind. Ah, we forgot to show you our large-type room. On our way to the electrotype department, we will glance in it. The types you see here cool too slowly to be cast in a machine, so we continue to pour them. Look over the drawers, and see the multitude of patterns. Some men fancy one style, and some another. So we try to meet all tastes. Feel how i Wmmnllllllllllllllfllllmmutmmmlmmuumtnnmmmllllllllll'lllllllumnunm] /‘ llllfillllllllllllllllllllllllllmlllllllllllllllllllllllllillllm STEREOTYPE BLOCK. A WALK OVER‘ 0U]? FOUNDRY. 47 solid the type is. You can’t squeeze the life out of that type on a power-press. No, indeed. It is made for wear. Now, Mr. Typograph, we enter the grimed and murky electrotype-room. Electrotyping, you are aware, is simply stereotyping in copper. Its advantages over stereotyping are, sharpness of outline in plates from wood-cuts, and great durability. Plates for books of large circulation are always electrotyped, as well as cuts, engravings, binders’ stamps, &c. The thing to be electrotyped, after being carefully and almost imperceptibly glazed with plumbago, is laid upon a press. and a prepared mould is placed over it, and an exact impression taken. This is well dusted with plumbago, and then deposited in a galvanic battery. Nature immediately takes up her part of the work, and a brilliant coating of copper is deposited upon the mould. W'hen sufiiciently thick, it is taken out of the battery, and, as you may notice, presents on the wrong side the appearance of a printed sheet of copper. This sheet is then filled up on the back to the requisite degree of thick- ness, and fastened to a block, ready to be used with type on a common printing-press. Plumbago, you remark, does not improve the countenances of the operatives? True; but a little soap and. water, vigorously applied, proves the title of these intelligent workmen to rank among white folk. To you, Mr. Typograph, our composing-rooms present no- thing new, except, perhaps, in its vast number of job founts, due to the fact that we now mainly confine our work in this department to all kinds of jobbing; and yet in ten years we have set up in these rooms and stereotyped more than eight hundred considerable works,—most of them consisting of a single volume, but some of from two to twelve volumes each, —besides a multitude of smaller books, tracts, &c. Among the rest we may mention two Quarto Bibles, (one of them, now published by J. B. Lippincott & Co., the grandest ever got up in America,) Lippincott’s two great Gazetteers, Dr. Kane’s Explorations, The North American Sylva, Thiers’ Napoleon, and Macaulay’s England: Allibone’s magnificent Dictionary of Authors and Books among the number. After the pages have been set and carefully read, they are sent down to the casting-room. In the electrotype-room, every thing is as black as the brow of a coal~heaverz in the casting-room, all is as white as the neck of a belle. Take 48 A I/VALK O VEIt’ O UK EU UIVDR I’. care, sir, or your coat will commit a larceny of our plaster. The form of type is laid on this stone, and nicely oiled: and then a mixture of plaster and water—doesn’t it look like a good wife’s buckwheat batter ?——is poured over it, and gently rolled in. In a short time the plaster sets, and the mould is removed by screws as tenderly as a nurse handles a baby. It is then dried in this hot-tempered oven, and, after the moisture is all evaporated, it is laid in a pan and fastened tightly, as you see, and plunged into this terrible bath of a thousand pounds of molten type-metal. Phew! you exclaim, what l'li‘. . . Iilillgin‘illlii,‘;i_' n. 1‘ Tip‘ . .51’ ... s . up In" STEREOTYPE CASTING-ROOM. warm work! Yes, sir; but from that fiery sea of lead soon emerges the pan, and its hissing heat is gradually overcome by the water in the trough into which the pan is lowered. Now, caster, break it out. There, Mr. Typograph, is the plate, fixed,—immovable,~—stereotyped. The mould is ruined; but the plate is comparatively immortalized. It is rough yet, and, like an uncouth boy, needs polishing. This next room is the finishing-room. Here the plates are carefully examined, picked, shaved, trimmed, and boxed, ready for the printer. Take a plate in your hand and examine it: it will bear inspection. You say it is far better than the untrimmed, uneven plates of English founders? We know that, sir; for we have often had to re-finish English plates im- ported by some publisher whoimagined he could save a little by ordering a duplicate set of plates of a popular foreign A WALff OVER OUR_FOUNDRV. 49 book. A mistake, sir. Both in type-founding and in stereo- typing the Americans have driven the foreigner from the field, —and in the only legitimate way, too: simply'by surpassing him. In this nook below, our engraving is done. The drawing is made on the block by the designer, as you see: then patiently and skilfully the engraver cuts and digs out, till the lines and shapes and lights and shades are all revealed in the beautiful picture. Our work in this department gives so much satisfaction that we are seldom without orders. Now, Mr. Typograph, we shall admit you into our editorial parlour. Walk in, sir. It is not carpeted, and its principal furnishings comprise a desk or two, a few presses, stands and cases, with multitudinous type-surroundings. Here, sir, we edit and print our Specimen Books and our Typographic Advertiser. Don’t you see poetical flies buzzing around, and atoms of wit-dust floating in the air, and odours of sentiment stealing out at the key-holes, and grains of common sense sprinkled all over the floor. \Nill you have a few specimens as curiosities? You say you have already a good assortment in our Advertiser and our Book? Very well, sir: we hope you will treasure them up. You say truly when you remark, that the printing done in this room is seldom, if ever, surpassed in America. We know that; and we intend to stand on the topmost round of the typographical ladder, and to show our fellow-artists what can be done with type such as we manufacture. We are afraid, Mr. Typograph, that your long excursion over the house has wearied you. Let us go down-stairs again. These, sir, are our warerooms. On these numerous shelves are ranged founts of all the various sorts of types made by us, carefully put up, labelled and classified, and all accessible at a minute’s notice. Our customers throughout the country keep actively employed all these porters, packers, clerks, salesmen, and bookkeepers. Many of our customers have never visited us; but we put up their orders with as conscien- tious fidelity and care as if they were standing before us and ‘ watching our every movement. W e are happy to see them, and hope none willvisit our city without calling in and taking us by the hand. We like to see them face to face, so that we can hang up their portraits in our mental gallery; and, when we 5 5 O A WA LK O VE R O UR FO UIVDR I’. afterward receive a letter from them, we can imagine that we are hearing them talk to us rather than reading their writing. The side-door on which your eye has just rested leads to one of our fire-proofs. Enter it. Here, sir, are safely stored many thousand matrices, as well as moulds, when not in use. As it would require the labour of many weary years to replace them if destroyed, we endeavour to keep them secure from the danger of ruin by fire. The upbuilding of a complete type-foundry is a work of generations. You will hardly care to look into the basement,——the store- house of ink and other typographical appliances? Your time is exhausted? Then, sir, we bid you good-day. A safe return to your pleasant family, Mr. Typograph. .l _ "‘ Ill-EH!!! t "I i Q‘ r‘ _ r v _ p 5 i] 3:; l ' E ' ii‘. : ' at ~ » V. rl . - ‘ _» ‘51 E e 3" 5| |[{|_] u 5 a’: l - '- - a. z'“ ‘lt‘ii ; ‘. I‘. H '. | _\~ _, __ i- __ l I F‘ ‘ :2 _- i ~ mi’ “"“iiin-‘llb “5'17. E _ ‘ "— ELLAR sm . ‘; _' - " '- - 1 ‘ "l3 r-lli‘it N°R i'l . -- .l' ' 5' '/ s. l~ "J‘ _It\-;_r‘llnnu_tljl;m_mu,m - " r“ . iv 7: ‘at. ‘ 52:“ "” H" “lfillllllil W ._ #5 till] m.‘ it i m : -L' - i 1... E L ' ‘ I’ p I. u: ‘I’: v ‘ ‘ i l g __H '_‘_-'-: “I _ ‘L I:— .&A Il'lllllll'll‘l \ unnuummlmnmwu _‘_“"" -_‘_' 1:; ‘I I “I I I --._z'- > - -- '-' __ '- i I"! 1 i _ waif‘ IMPLEMENTS OR TOOLS OF THE ART. TYPES. i or letters generally used for printing in Europe and America are termed [601mm, [la/2'6, and Old English, or Black Lez‘ler. ROMAN LETTER. ROMAN letters were employed in-MSS. from the fifth to about the close of the twelfth century, when what are called Gothic letters (after- ward Old English) came gradually j into use; these continued for seve- gs; ral centuries, when, in most coun- “ ; tries, they were superseded by the / ’2' ‘ %‘ Roman characters. All printing was in black letter down to 1465, when Sweinheim 8: Pannartz, in Subiaco near Rome, produced .a volume entitled Lactam‘z'us, in a character approaching to the actual forms of our modern types. In 1467, they made an improved set of characters, and printed about forty volumes within the five years following. About 1469 John of Spires, in Venice, made a great advance in improving the form of the Roman character, and printed the Natural Hz'sz‘ozjl 0f Pliny.- the execution of this work is very remarkable. But Nicholas Jenson may fairly be considered the father of the style of Roman letter now in vogue. He printed in Venice four works SI 5 2 TYPES. in the year 1470, the first of which was Ensebii Prn’paralio Novoruni, &c., in types which were cut by him, more perfect in form than those of any earlier printer. The printers named above were all of them Germans. The Roman letters consist of circles, arcs of circles, and straight lines; and, therefore, on the score of simplicity, pre- cision, and elegance, they certainly deserve to be adopted as the standard for all nations. A printer, in choosing type, should not only attend to the cut of the letter, but should also observe that its shank is per- fectly true, and that it lines or ranges with accuracy, and is of equal height. The quality of the metal of which it is com- posed and the finish of the letter demand particular atten- tion, as the competition among some of the smaller foundries (which have sprung into existence through the facilities af- forded of multiplying matrices by the electrotype process) has led them to use an inferior metal, and produce types without due regard to nicety of finish and exactness of body and standing. _ It is important that types should have a deep face, with strong, bevelled bases or foundations under the ceriphs or hairlines, and that the letters should have a deep nick, which should be different from other founts of like body in the same house. ITALIC LETTER. Aldo Mannccio, born at Bassano, succeeded Yenson at Venice and turned to good account the latter’s admirable founts of type. He also made many advances in the art of printing, the most nolable of which is the invenlion of z‘he style of ifype now hnown as Italic. It was firsl used in an oclavo edition of Virgil issued by him in 1501, and Pope Leo X. gave him a lez‘ler of privilege, entitling him to the sole use of the type he had in-.- venled. It was said to be founded on the handwriling of Pez‘rarch, which it closely resembles. Italic was largely employed to distinguish such parts of a book as might be considered appendages, as Prefaces, Intro- duclions, Annotations, &c., all of which were formerly printed in this character; so that perhaps two-fifths of a fount was composed of Italic letter. At present it is used more sparingly, being superseded by BLACK LETTER AND SAXON. 5 3 the more elegant mode of enclosing extracts within inverted commas, and by setting poetry and annotations in a smaller- sized type. It is very appropriately used to distinguish the head or subject-matter of a chapter, and is serviceable in gram- mars and other school-books as well as scientific works. The frequent use of Italic words among Roman in ordinary mat- ter impairs the beauty of the page, and ought to be avoided; yet authors sometimes stubbornly insist on the gratification of their whimsies, even at the sacrifice of every principle of correct taste. ' BLACK LETTER. @Iihia letter, tnhich has nest in the infamy nf Sprinting, 11251221111211 frnm the Qsuthii: shareware: it is lZEtIIBlJ QHuthic by same, EUIU @111 ‘English by anthers; but printers term it ifilatk letter, an account of its heahp appeatame. In Germany, the letters in common use are founded on the Gothic character; but even there scientific works are printed in the German language with Roman letters. The Dutch adhere to the black letter in books of devotion and religious treatises; while they make use of the Roman in their curious and learned works. SAXON CHARACTERS. THE Saxon characters originated probably from the Gothic, but were altered or modified after the Latin ones which the Saxons found in use in England in the fifth century. The first Saxon types were cut by John Daye, under the patronage of Archbishop Parker, about the year 1567. We give the Lord's Prayer in modern Anglo-Saxon types: _ Faebep upe bu be eap: on heopenum. 81 hm nama Sehalgob. To- becume 1am pice. Lepuph‘e hm pilla on eopban, fpa ypa on heoye- num. Upne baeghpamhcan hlay gyye u]: :0 bass. Knb yopgyj: uy upe gylcay, fpa rpa pe yopgiya‘ii upum gylpenbum. 147112) ne 5elaeooe bu uy on coyznunge. ac alyy u]: o}_ yyele. 80 “Ehce. 0-s- . _..-v_..______ 5 4 ' TYPES. NAMES AND SIZES OF TYPE. THE principal bodies to which printing letters are cast in England and America are the following :— 1. Diamond. II. English. 2. Pearl. 12. Columbian. 3. Agate. 13. Great Primer. 4. Nonpareil. I4. Paragon. 5. Minion. 15. Double Small Pica. 6. Brevier. 16. Double Pica. 7. Bourgeois. 17. Double English. 8. Long Primer. 18. Double Great Primer. 9. Small Pica. 19. Double Paragon. IO. Pica. 20. Canon. Besides the foregoing, a smaller size than Diamond, called Brilliant, is now cast in the foundry of MacKellar, Smiths & jordan of Philadelphia, the body of which is just one-half of Minion. Even this is surpassed in smallness by a music type cast in the same foundry, named Excelsior, which is precisely one-half the size of Nonpareil. Another size omitted in the list is Minionette, (equivalent to six of the Didot points,) which is next above Nonpareil, and is largely used for the splendid series of ornamental borders lately originated. Canon is conceded to have been first produced by a French artisan, and was probably employed in some work relating to the canons of the Church ; to which the German title, Missal, alludes. Two-line Double Pica, Two-line Great Primer, Two-line English, Two-line Pica, and Double Pica, owe their names to the respective bodies of which the depth of two em quadrates answers to one of the double sizes. Paragon was probably first cut in France. It is known as Text by the Germans. Pica is universally considered as the standard type, and by it furniture is measured, and quotations and labour-saving rules are graduated. A line 83 Pica ems long is equivalent to 35 centimeters. N/l M125 AN!) 5/255. 55 Great Primer, called Tertia in Germany, is one of the major sizes of type which were early used for printing considerable works, and especially the Bible; on which account some persons term it Bible Text. The French name is Gros Romain. English is called Mittel by the Ger- mans, and St. Augustin by the French and Dutch; the word Mittel (Middle) intimating that the former sizes of letter were seven in number, the centre of which was English, with Prima, Secunda, and Tertia on one side, and Pica, Long Primer, and Brevier on the other. The name St. Augustin was probably given because the writings of that Father were the first works done in that letter. Pica is called Cicero by the French and Germans. As the preceding size was distin- guished by the name of St. Augustin, so this has been honoured with that of Cicero, on account of the Epistles of that writer having been first done in letter of this size. It is doubtful whether the name was given by the French or the Germans. 5 6 TYPES. Small Pica is a grade below Pica, and is now gene- rally employed in oet-avo volumes, and is, indeed, almost the only size used for printing legal reports and other law books. The French call this letter Philosophie, which, however, is merely a Pica face on Small Pica body. The Germans call it Kleine Cicero. Long Primer. Upon the supposition that some bodies of letter took their names from works in which they were first employed, we are induced to believe that the Germans gave the name of Corpus to this character on account of’ their Corpus Juris being first done in this size. The French call this letter Petit Romain. Bourgeois is a very useful and convenient size of letter. It is frequently used in double-column octavo pages. The name indicates that it originated in France; although type of this body is now called Gaillarde by French printers. Two lines of this letter are equivalent to one line of Great Primer, or four lines of Diamond. Brevier was first used for printing the Breviaries, or Roman Catholic Church books, and hence its name. The Germans call it Petit, and Jungfer (maiden letter). It is an admirable type, and cannot conveniently be dispensed with in any considerable printing-office. Minion follows Brevier, and is commonly used for newspapers, and for notes and indexes in book-work. Its name is due probably to its being smaller than any type in use at the period of its invention. It fills a useful place in a printing-ofiice. Nonpareil came next in order; and its originator, supposing that he had reached the extreme of dimimitiveness, gave it this triumphant title. It is exten- sively used, though-mostly on newspapers, and for notes and indexes for duo- decimo books and smaller. It is certainly the smallest type that should be allowed in book-work. Agate probably arose from the necessities of newspaper publishers. As patronage in- creased, it became desirable to have a type less in size than Nonpareil, for the advertise- ments, shipping news, markets, 850.; and Agate was made to meet the emergency. Itis new extensively used for pocket editions of the Bible and Prayer Books. Pearl may be said to have been born of ambition. As punch-cutters became more expert, some one possessed of a keen eye and a delicate mechanical finger determined to surpass in smallness the achievements of his predecessors. Hence the origin of this type. This type is also employed in printing miniature volumes. Diamond followed, as it matter of course; for human ingenuity, when revoked, seems determined to go to the utmost verge of possibility. This type is so minute that a pound of it will) contain more than 3300 of the letter i; yet, to produce each letter of an alphabet, a steel punch has to be cut and a matrix made, in which the types are cast one by one, and, being set up in lines, are rubbed and dressed by the founder for the use of the compositor. Brilliant. Expert penmen, it In said, have succeeded in writing .the Lord's Prayer upon the edge oi'n sheet of‘ paper. A type- eulter In Berlin, more surprisingly, has formed a type so minute as Lobe scarcely readable without it good magnifying glam. The type oi‘ the paragraph, though not so small on UN microscopic letters produced in Prussia, is yet so diminutive that even Diamond is large by comparison. 01' the letter l nearly 4600 go to a pound. PROPORTZOJVS OF TYPES. 57 GRADATION OF TYPES. HE following specimen shows the proportion which one size of type bears to another in widt/z; but it is necessary to observe that it must be taken with certain limitations, be- cause each founder has letter of every size that will either drive out or get in with others of the same body, some faces being more extended and others being more condensed than the standard width of type. The scale contains thirteen sizes in order of gradation, viz., Great Primer, English, Pica, Small Pica, Long Primer, Bourgeois, Brevier, Minion, N onpareil, Agate, Pearl, Diamond, and Brilliant. When in the course of human: When in the course of human' events When in the course of human ' events it b When in the course of human ' events it becomes \Vhen in the course of human- events it- becomes nece \Vhcn in the course of human‘ events it becomes necessary When in the course of human- events it becomes necessary f When in the course of human‘ events it becomes necessary for one When in the course of human’ events it becomes necessary for one people to ‘Vhen in the course of human‘ events it becomes necessary for one people to dissolve When in the course of human‘ events it becomes necessary for one people to dissolve the pol When in the course of human‘ events it becomes necessary for one people to dissolve the political bands wh Whon in the course of human ‘ events it becomes necessary t'or one people to dissolve the political binds which have connected th PROPORTIONS OF TYPES. PRINTER should be acquainted with the exact propor- tion which one body of letter bears to another in depth, as otherwise he will not be able to form an accurate judgment regarding the size of the type most suitable for a work in- tended to be confined to a given number of sheets. “7e, therefore, give a scale showing the relative proportions of various type bodies, beginning with Brilliant, the smallest letter - produced in this country, (and made only by the Johnson Type F oundry,) and ending with Great Primer. Any printer may form a scale by setting up the figures of his various founts. and printing them on a card or dry paper. TYPES. lb, 1 Mo 11. 1 1 h: be in (I) :0 l1‘! :5 23 25251‘ 1e 1s 1% 13' 1s 1 4§ s, 5* 3% -\,~ ~. 23 2x 2% a, . NN 5"" 4" 4N i‘ 3% 3Q N‘ o‘ 2“ 2 2w saris-snags 1, s2 83* 1s 6 6 5s. 4 4 4?.‘ g- 3§- 3 ii 8 g 7 6. 5 4m - 3 1 s 7 6 5 5 r 4 3 2 l? 19 9 8 t- 6 ‘6 5 4 4 2 12 I? 10 9 l 5 5 13 12 11 3 7 7 6 5 14 13 10 8 _ 6 5 15 1, 11 9 8 7 6 _ii_15_14_12__10__ 9__ 9__ 8__ 7_ _ 6__ is r; 13 11 1° 10 s 7 5 _ {-10 18 1" 14 12 11 9 1 .15 ;3 ii 13 12 1 10 9 8 7 6 533.2.15317141312111098 a é; a 18 15 14 13 11 7 1 2'! 24 22 19 16 14 9 e 28 - 20 15 e 29 2° 23 . 17 15 13 12 11 3, 2s 24 .21 16 11 8 *5313553221317161413 * ii 32 21 ii 20 18 17 15__14_12__11_ 9 :18 r 18 3‘. 2E 29 33 21 19 16 15 12 2% *3 27 22 2O 19 7 5,3 g: 3.2 28 23 21 20 1 8 1 6 1 4 1 3 :1 a? a 29 24 22 21 17 15 11 45 as 3,5 2(1) 25 23 22 19 18 3:; :3 g; 32 37 21 23 20 19 16 15 12 ii 3?; 2s 38 24 21 2O 17 2 a‘); M .10 35 9 if. iiTrsiii—w— —2 6_23__21_19__1 7— t." l “ _ 1 31.123332293521122 5b 35 0.1 47 41 311 31 g 223341131353231112522421 19 15 0° so 11 36 33 25 22 64 56 51 45 37 34 32 28 Co 52 46 38 3' 9 66 . _§§__60_55--48_40__36_. _ 4.1 7 35 31_28_25_22_18 70 62 7,1, 63 57 50 38 36 29 32128333937323026231 i23g399344403833 2249 ii 68 62 4.5 41 39 341 2% 2% 2i} 42 40 35 32 1 as 43 41 E; it 22 48 11 12 ii iii 29 26 21 g; 3% 63_60_§g__45_43_ __ 7_ 1 so is 61 46 38 35 31 1 87 77 60 51 .44 1 33 t3 5; 63 52 47 45. 39 36 32 i. 311) 80 73 64 53 48 46 40 37 'neuizdar ,mezg A BILL OF PICA. 59 A BILL OF PICA. HE following is reckoned by the founders a regular fount, complete in all its sorts :— A BILL ‘OF 800 LBS. OF PICA. a 8500 , . . 4500 A . 600 a 300 b . 1600 ; . . 800 B . 400 B 20° 0 3000 : . . 600 C . 500 c 250 d 4400 . . . 2000 D - 500 D 25° e . 12000 - 1000 E . 600 E 300 f 2500 9 200 F . 400 F 200 g 1700 l 150 G . 400 G 200 h . 6400 ’ . . 700 H - 40° H 20° i 8000 ( 300 I . 800 I 400 i 400 [ 150 J - 3°° 1 ‘5° k ‘800 * 100 K - 3°° K I50 1 4000 1- 100 L - 500 L 25" m 3000 I 100 M - 400 M 20° n 8000 Q 100 N - 40° N 20° 0 8000 I] 100 O - 40° 0 20° P l 1700 ll 60 P - 4°° 1’ 2°° q _ 500 Q . 180 Q 90 r 6200 1 1300 R - 400 R 20° s 8000 2 1200 S - 50° 5 25° t 9000 3 1100 T - 65° T 326 u 3400 4 1000 U ~ 300 U I50 v . 1200 5 1000 V - 300 v I5° w . 2000 6 1000 W - 40° “' 20° x 400 7 1000 X . 180 x 90 y . 2000 8 1000 Y - 300 Y 15° 2 . 200 9 1000 Z - 8° 2 4° & . 200 0 1300 E ~ 4° ‘E 2° 3' _ 400 CE . 30 ca 15 fi . 500 é 200 fi . 200 a 200 ffl . 100 it 200 Spaees_ m ' 15° C ' ' 2°° Thick . . . . . . . . 18000 38 1°° All other Middle. . . . . . . . 12000 a? . 6° accents: 10° Thin . . . . . . . . - 8000 each- Hair . . . . . . . . . 3000 _ ~ - 15° Em Quads . . . 1 . . . 2500 —-— 90 En Quads . . . . . . . 5000 — 60 Large Quadrates. about 80 lbs. Italic, one-tent]: of Roman. Owing to the varying styles of authors and the diverse sub- jects of books, some letters will now and then run short in a 60 TYPES. fount, whatever the proportions may have been at first. A new fount of type may run evenly on a work in general literature written in the third person, while a novel filled with dialogues in the first person will rapidly exhaust certain letters, and re- quire sorts to render the fount serviceable to its full general capacity. 50 with scientific and other books. Even in the case of two authors writing on the same subject, there is no certainty that the fount will run alike. The master-printer, therefore, to keep the entire letter in use, is compelled to order sorts, and his fount is thus constantly growing larger. A FOUNT OF TYPE. COMPLETE fount of type may be comprised under nine heads, as follows :— I. CAPITALS. ABCDEFGHIJKLMNO'PQRSTUVWX ' YZ/ECES: 2. SMALL CAPITALS. ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU VWXYZJECE8: 3. LOWER CASE. abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz aeoefffiffiflfll 4.F]GURES. 1234567890 5. POINTS, 69%‘. ,;=-?!-’()[]*’rI%|I1l——fi*~ 6. Four kinds of spaces. 7. Em and en quadrates. 8. Two, three, and four em quadrates. 9. Accents. These are the ordinary sorts cast to a fount, and are classi- fied by founders as long, short, ascending, descending, kerned, and double letters. CAPITALS. 61 LONG LETTERS fill the whole depth of the face of the body, and are both ascending and descending, such in the Roman as Q andj, and in the Italicf. SHORT LETTERS have the face cast on the middle of the body, (by founders called shank,) as a, c, e, m, n, o, r, s, u, v, w, x, z, all of which will admit of being bearded above and below the face, both in Roman and Italic. ASCENDING LETTERS are all the Roman and Italic capitals; in the lower case, b, d, f, h, i, k, l, t. DESCENDING LETTERS are g, p, q, y, in Roman and Italic. KERNED LETTERS are types that have part of the face hanging over either one or both sides of the body. In Roman, f and j are the only kerned letters; but, in Italic, a’, g,j, Z, 3/ are kerned on one side, and f on both sides of its face. Most Italic capitals are kerned on one side of the face. The DOUBLE LETTERS in modern use are fit, ii, iii, fl, Hi; and these are so cast to prevent the breaking of the beak of the f when used before a tall letter. The diphthongs ae and 0e may be classed among double letters. Printers divide a fount of letter into two classes. I. T he uppercase } Sorts. 2. The lower case The upper case sorts are capitals, small capital letters, and references. The lower case consists of small letters, double letters, figures, points, spaces, quadrates, &c. CAPITALS. LINDLEY MURRAY gives the following judicious directions in regard to the use of capital letters :— It was formerly the custom to begin every noun with a capital; but as this practice was troublesome, and gave the writing or'printing a crowded and confused appearance, it has been discontinued. It is, however, very proper to begin with a capital,— I. The first word of every book, chapter, letter, note, or any other piece of writing; and, 2. The first word after a period; and, if the two sentences are totallyz'ndependem‘, after a note of interrogation or excla- mation. But if a number of interrogative or exclamatory sen- 6 62 TYPES. tences are thrown into one general group, or if the construc— tion of the latter sentences depends on the former, all of them, except the first, may begin with a small letter: as, How long, ye simple ones, will ye love simplicity? and the scorners a’e— lzght in their scorning? and fools hate hnowlea’ge?——Alas! how difi’erent/ yet how like the same! 3. The appellations of the Deity: as, God, Yehovah, the Almighty, the Supreme Being, the Lora’, Providence, the [Pies- siah, the Holy Spirit. 4. Proper names of persons, places, streets, mountains, rivers, ships: as, George, London, the Strand, the Alps, the Thames, the Seahorse. 5. Adjectives derived from the proper names of places: as, Grecian, Roman, English, French, Italian. 6. The first word of a quotation, introduced after a colon, or when it is in a direct form: as, Always remember this ancient maxim .' “Know thyself.” —— Our great Lawginer says, “ Take up thy cross daily, and follow me.” But when a quo- tation is brought in obliquely after a comma, a capital letter is unnecessary: as, Solomon observes, “that pride goes before a'e- structio n. ” The first word of an example may also very properly begin with a capital: as, Temptation proves our z/irtae. 7. Every substantive and principal word in the titles of books: as, j‘ohnson’s Dictionary of the English Language,- T homson’s Seasons; Rollin’s Ancient Alistory. 8. The first word of every line in poetry. 9. The pronoun I and the interjection 0 are written in capitals: as, [write .' Hear, 0 earth! Other words, besides the preceding, may begin with capitals when they are remarkably emphatical, or the principal sub- ject of the composition. The method of denoting capital letters in manuscript is by underscoring them with three distinct lines. SMALL CAPITALS. SMALL CAPITALS are in general cast to Roman founts only, and are used for the purpose of giving a stronger emphasis to a word than that conveyed by Italic. They are likewise used for running heads, heads of chapters, &c. The first POINTS. 63 word of every section or chapter is commonly put in small capitals; but when a two-line initial letter is used, the re- mainder of the word should be in capitals. The small capitals c, o, s, v, w, x, 2 so closely resemble the same letters in the lower case, that care is required to prevent intermixing. In manuscript, small capitals are denoted by two lines drawn under the words. W Italic words are designated by a single stroke underneath. POINTS. POINTS consist of a comma, semicolon, colon, period or full-point, mark of interrogation, and mark of admiration. Shortly after the invention of printing, the necessity of stops or pauses in sentences for the guidance of the reader produced the colon and full-point. In process of time, the comma was added, which was then merely a perpendicular line, proportioned to the body of the letter. These three points were the only ones used till the close of the fifteenth century, when Aldo Manuccio gave a better shape to the comma, and added the semicolon; the comma denoting the shortest pause, the semicolon next, then the colon, and the full-point termi- nating the sentence. The marks of interrogation and admira- tion were introduced many years after. Perhaps there never existed on any subject a greater dif- ference of opinion among men of learning than on the true mode of punctuation. Some sprinkle the page with commas almost as promiscuously as if from a pepper-box, and make the pause of a semicolon where the sense will bear only a comma; while others are extremely careless, and omit points even when they are needed to give the true sense of a passage at the first reading. The lack of an established practice is much to be regretted. The loss of time to a compositor occasioned by altering points arbitrarily is a great hardship. Manuscripts are often placed in the printer’s hands without being properly prepared: either the writing is illegible, the spelling incorrect, or the punctua— tion defective. Unless the author will take entirely on himself the responsibility of the pointing, it will be better to omit every point in the copy, except at the end of a sentence, rather 64 TYPES. than confuse the mind of the compositor by commas and semicolons placed indiscriminately, in the hurry of writing, without any regard to proprietyfn The CoMMA [,] divides the clauses of a long or involved sentence, and commonly marks the shortest pause in reading. Commas are used to denote extracts or quotations from other works, dialogue matter, or passages or expressions not original, by placing two of them inverted before the first word of the passage quoted, the ending being denoted by two apos- trophes. A thin space is used to keep the inverted commas free from the matter. The method of running them down the sides to the end of the quotation has been found inconvenient, especially where a quotation occurs within a quotation, or a speech within a speech: the proper method of distinguishing these is by placing a single inverted comma before the extra quotation, and concluding with a single apostrophe. Where both quotations end together, put three apostrophes, observing after the first to place a thin space. Inverted commas were first used by Guillemet, a French- man, to supersede the use of Italic letter in emphasized words. As an acknowledgment, his countrymen call them after his name. French founders cast them double, thus [M]. MacKellar, Smiths & Jordan, Philadelphia, furnish them in this Way when desired. ' A single comma inverted is improperly used‘ as an abbre— viation of the word Mac, as in M‘Gowen: c is preferable, as McGowen. The SEMICOLON [3] denotes a pause greater than that of a comma, and is used between dependent clauses of compound sentences. The CoLoN [z] is employed in a sentence between clauses less connected than those which are divided by a semicolon, but not so independent as separate, distinct sentences. The PERIOD or FULL-POINT [.] serves to indicate the end of a complete sentence. When used in abbreviations, it has no effect as a full stop in the punctuation, unless at the end of a sentence. In some works this point is discarded as a mark of abbreviation, as in Mr Dr &c. WWilson’s Treatise on English Punctuation is a full and explicit work on this subject, and should be studied by every printer and author. It is worthy of adop- tion as the standard authority. APOST]? OPHE. 65 Full-points are sometimes used as leaders in tables of con- tents, figure-work, &c.; but dotted rules or leaders are more economical for this purpose, as they save considerable time in the composition. The Sign of INTERROGATION ['2] is used to denote a ques- tion. Every interrogation or question should begin with a capital letter, (unless several questions follow one another in connected succession,) according to the method observed in the Bible, where questions and responses, and the beginning of sayings, &c. are denoted by a capital letter. The sign of ADMIRATION or EXCLAMATION [2] denotes surprise, astonishment, rapture, and other sudden emotions of the mind, whether of joy or sorrow. This sign is put after the interjections Ah! Alas! Oh! &c.; but there are exceptional cases, as, Ah me! Alas the day! &c. All the points, except the comma and the period, should be preceded by a hair-space; the comma and full-point do not require any space to hear them off. The em dash [——], though not ranked as a point, is often used by careless writers as a substitute for a comma or semi- colon. It may be properly employed in parenthetical sen- ' tences, and in rhapsodical writing abounding in disconnected sentences. A dash stands for a sign of repetition in catalogues of goods, where it implies diz‘z‘o; and in catalogues of books, where a dash signifies ejusder-n, instead of repeating the author’s name with the title of every separate treatise of his writing. A sign of repetition should never appear at the top of a page, but the name of the author, or of the merchandise, should be set out again at length. A dash likewise stands for to; as, chap. xvi. 3-17; that is, from the third to the seventeenth verse inclusive. At other times it serves for an index, to give notice that what follows it is a corollary of what has preceded; thus:— APOSTROPH E. THE apostrophe [’] is a comma cast on the upper edge of a type, and is used as a Sign of contraction or abbreviation of words in poetry or familiar conversation, as We’re, o’er, don’t, &c. In poetry, it should not be employed where the 5-»: 66 TYPES. verb ends with e, as love, change, 8zc., but only in cases where the verb concludes with a consonant, as, reign, obtain, &c. It also marks the elision of a vowel at the beginning of Words, as, ’scape, or of a syllable, as, ’prentice. The monosyllables though and through are sometimes shortened to tho’ and thro’, but very improperly, as they retain the same sound, and the abbreviation cannot in the slightest degree assist the versification. l/Vords in the possessive case are generally known by having ’s for their termination. All quotations which are denoted at the beginning by in- verted commas are closed with apostrophes. There is no space required between the apostrophe and the matter. HYPHEN. A HYPHEN is a sign of connection, and denotes that the part of a word at the end of a line belongs to the portion at the beginning of the next line. - A compositor who studies propriety and neatness in his work will not allow an unnecessary division, even in a narrow measure, if he can avoid it by overrunning two or three lines of matter. In large type and narrow measures, the division of words cannot be avoided; but care should be taken that hyphens do not occur at the end of successive lines. In small type and wide measures, the hyphen may frequently be dis- pensed with, either by driving out or getting in the Word, without interfering with the regularity of the spacing. The compositor who is careful on this point will find his advantage in the preference given to his work, and in the respect attached to his character as a master of his business. Numerous divi- sions down the side of a page and irregular spacing are the two greatest defects in composition. It is proper, if possible, to keep the derivative or radical word undivided: as, occnr—rence, gentle-man, respect-fnl, &c. In other cases, printers generally divide on the vowel, which is an excellent method. The hyphen is also used to connect compound words, which are formed of two substantives, as, bird-cage, love-letter, &c.; also what are termed compound adjectives, as, well- bnilt house, handsome-faced child, &c. PARENTHESJS AND BRACKET. 67 The prepositions after, before, over, 82.0 are often connected with other words, but do not always make a proper com- pound: thus, before-mem‘z'oned is a compound when it pre- cedes a substantive, as, in the bejfore-mem‘z'mzed place; but when it comes after a noun, as, in the place before mentioned, it should be two distinct wordsfll PARENTHESIS AND BRACKET. THE use of the PARENTHESIS ( ) is to enclose interpolated words or sentences which serve to strengthen the argument, although the main sentence would be complete without the interpolated matter. (1) Wilson, in his Treatise on English Pzmctuaz‘z'on, says, veryjudiciously,- The hyphen is employed in words in such a manner as is best calculated to show their origin, composition, or import, and to exhibit the syllables in their neatest form. Agreeably to this rule,— 1. Compound and derivative words are resolved into their primitives ; as, school- master, band-writing, pen-kappa, snufi‘ldox, looking-glass,- arc/uangel, gee-logy, t/zeo-cracy, ortlw-graplzy. 2. Prefixes, affixes, and grammatical terminations are separated; as, dis-cou- z‘z'nue, en-adle, trans-port; shear-er, load-ed, printing; king-dam, false-hood, ({[fi’er-ence, command-went. 3. One consonant between two vowels is to be joined to the latter syllable; as, ta-le1zt,fa-tal; me-lon, le-t/er; spi-rz't, si-lence; cy-m'c, z‘y-ro; le-ga-cy, 1110-720- jfia-ly. Except x, and single consonants when they belong to the former portion of a derivative word; as, ex-z'le, ex-z'st, ex-amz'ne; up-on, dis-ease, cz'rczmz-améz'erzt. 4. Two or more consonants belong to the latter syllable, when they are capable of beginning a word; as, z‘a-ble, sz‘z'y’le, lu~cre, o-gle, mau-gre, sire-pile, de-stroy. 5. But when the consonants cannot begin a word, or when the vowel preceding them is short, the first should be separated; as, ab-bey, ac-eent, 'z'el—lum, abject, gar-den, [mm-dry, [mm-p/zlet; 6las-p/zeme, dis-tress, mz'n-sz‘rel. It is desirable that compound and derivative words should, at the end of lines, be divided in such a manner as to indicate their principal parts. Thus, sc/zool- master is preferable to sc/wolmas-ter, dz's-afiprozle to dzsaji-pro'z/e, resent-1122212‘, to re-sentmem‘, ort/zo-doxy to or-t/zoa’oxy; though, as regards the analysis of words into syllables, the latter mode is unobjectionable. From the narrowness of the printed line, however, in some books, the principle recommended cannot always be adhered to. The terminations tion, sz'on, cz'al, tin], and many others, formerly pronounced as two syllables, but now only as one, must not be divided either in spelling or at the end of a line. A syllable consisting of only one letter, as the a in cre-atz'ou, should not com- mence a line. This word would be better divided area-tion ,- and so all others of a similar kind. A line of print must not end with the first syllable of a word when it consists of a single letter; as, a-bz'de, e-rzormous; nor begin with the last syllable when it is formed of only two letters ; as, nation-a1, teach-er, similar-(y. For regard should be had to the principles of taste and beauty as well as to the laws of syllabication. 68 TYPES. Parentheses are not as much used as formerly: authors place their intercalations between commas,—frequently with a dash at the beginning and ending,-—which make them quite as intelligible as though they were enclosed between paren- theses. Brackets [] are seldom made use of, except to indicate that the word enclosed within them had been carelessly omitted in the old MS. or copy, and was now inserted by the editor. REFERENCES. REFERENCES are marks and signs employed to direct the attention of the reader to notes in the margin or at the bot- tom of a page. . The characters technically known by printers as references are the following, which are used in the order here given :— Asterisk * Double Dagger I Parallel || Dagger ‘f Section % Paragraph TI In Roman church-books, the Asterisk divides each verse of a psalm into two parts, and marks the place where the responses begin: this in the Book of Common Prayer is de- noted by a colon placed between the two parts of each verse. Asterisks also denote an omission, or an hiatus in the original copy; the number of asterisks being multiplied according to the extent of the omission. The Dagger, originally termed the Obelisk, or Long Cross, is frequently used in Roman Catholic church-books, prayers of exorcism, at the benediction of bread, water, and fruit, and upon other occasions, where the priest is to make the sign of the cross; but the square cross (E) is the proper symbol for the purpose. The square cross is used, besides, in the pope’s briefs, and in mandates of archbishops and bishops, imme- diately before the signature of their names. It is not placed among references. Besides its use as a reference mark, the Paragraph is now employed chiefig. in Bibles, to show the parts into which a chapter is divided. In Common Prayer Books, paragraphs are put before the lines that direct the order of the service, and which are called the Rubrics because they were formerly printed in red. ACCENTED AN!) NUMERAL LETTERS 69 The neatest references, when many are required in books, are either superior letters or superior figures,—thus, 1, ‘1,3, or thus, “,",°. Superior letters are used chiefly in Bibles and other books which have more than one sort of notes, and there- fore require different references. When thus used, the letterj should be omitted, as, from its similarity to the i, the reader might at times be led into error. ACCENTED LETTERS. LETTERS called accented by printers are the five vowels, marked thus:—-— Acute. .aéioi'i Grave. aeioii Circumflex.. aeion Diaeresis.. .aéi'oii Long aéioi'i Short...... aeioii We may include the French ‘c, the Spanish n, the Portu- guese a and 6, the Swedish and Norwegian 5 and 6, and the Welsh w and NUMERAL LETTERS. THE Greeks at first employed the letters of the entire alphabet to express the first twenty—four numbers; but the system was cumbrous, and they adopted the happy expe- dient of dividing their alphabet into three portions, using the first to symbolize the 9 digits, the second the 9 tens, and the third the 9 hundreds; and, as their alphabet contained only twenty-four letters, they invented three additional symbols. Their list of symbols then stood as follows :— Units. Tens. Hundreds. arepresents ........... .. 1 L represents .......... .. 10 p represents ....... .. 100 B .......................... .. 2 K ......................... .. 20 o- ...................... .. 200 -y ........................... .. 3 A ......................... .. 30 'r ........................ .. 300 8 .......................... .. 4 p. ......................... .. 40 v ........................ .. 400 e ................. ....... .. 5 v ......................... .. 50 4> ....................... .. 500 g-(introilnccd) ........ .. 6 .f ......................... .. 60 X ....................... .. 600 Q‘ .......................... .. 7 o ......................... .. 70 5!: ...................... .. 700 1) ........................... .. 3 1r ......................... .. 80 w ...................... .. SOD 601's .................... .. 9 5 or 1. (introduced) 90 ‘3, A, R (introd‘d) 900 70 TYPES. By these symbols, only numbers under 1000 could be ex- pressed; but, by putting a mark called iota under any symbol, its value was increased a thousand—fold: thus, a = 1000, I; 2 20,000; or, by subscribing the letter M, the value of a symbol was raised ten thousand-fold. For these two marks, single and double dots were afterward substituted. This improve-' ment enabled them to express with facility all numbers as high as 9,990,ooo,—a range sufi‘icient for all ordinary purposes. It has been supposed that the Romans used M to denote 1000 because it is the first letter of Mille, which is Latin for 1000; and C to denote 100, it being the first letter of Centum, the Latin term for 100. Some also suppose that D, being formed by dividing the old M in the middle, was therefore appointed to stand for 500,—that is, half as much as the M stood for when it was whole; and that L being half a C, was, for the same reason, used to denominate 50. But the most natural account of the matter appears to be this:— The Romans probably put down a single stroke, I, for one, as is still the practice of those who score on a slate, or with chalk; this stroke they doubled, trebled, and quadrupled, to express two, three, and four: thus, I I, I I I, I I I I. So far they could easily number the strokes with a glance of the eye; but they found that if more were added it would be necessary to count the strokes one by one: for this reason, when they came to five, it was expressed by joining two strokes together in an acute angle, thus, V. After they had made this acute angle, V, for five, they then added single strokes to the number of four, thus, VI, VII, VI I l, VI l I I, and then, as the strokes could not be further multiplied without confusion, they doubled their acute angle by prolonging the two lines beyond their intersection, thus, X, to denote two fives, or ten. After they had doubled, trebled, and quadrupled this double acute angle, thus, XX, XXX, XXXX, they then, for the same reason which induced them to make a single angle first, and then to double it, joined two single strokes in another form, and, instead of an acute angle, made a right angle, L, to denote fifty. When this was doubled, they then doubled the right angle, thus, E, to denote one hundred, and, having numbered this double right angle four times, thus, [[1, EEE, EEEE, when they came to the fifth number, as before, they reverted it, and put a single stroke before it, thus, NUMERAL LETTERS. 7 I III, to denote five hundred; and, when this five hundred was doubled, then they also doubled their double right angle, set- ting two double right angles opposite to each other, with a single stroke between them, thus, [I], to denote one thou- sand: when this note for one thousand had been repeated four times, they then put down I] II for five thousand, CE l 3] for ten thousand, and IIIIIII for fifty thousand. The corners of the angles being cut off by transcribers for despatch, these figures were gradually brought into what are now called numerical letters. When the corners of E I II were made round, it stood thus, CIO, which is so near the Gothic 0) that it soon deviated into that character; so that I] having the corners made round stood thus, IO, and then easily de- viated into D. C also became a plain C by the same means: the single rectangle, which denoted fifty, was, without any alteration, a capital L; the double acute angle was an X; the single acute angle, a V; and a plain single stroke, the letter I. And thus these seven letters, M, D, C, L, X, V, I, became nu- merals. As a further proof of this assertion, let it be considered that C l O is still used for one thousand, and I O for five hundred, instead of M and D; and this mark, (‘7, is sometimes used to denote one thousand, which may easily be derived from this figure, E I II, but cannot be deviations from, or corruptions of, the Roman letter M. The Romans also expressed any number of thousands by a line drawn over any numeral less than one thousand: thus, V denotes five thousand, LX sixty thousand; so, likewise, M is one million, MM two millions, &c. Upon the discovery of printing, and before capitals were invented, small letters served for numerals; not only when Gothic characters were in vogue, but when Roman had become the prevailing character. Thus, in early times, i b x I t h m were, and in Roman‘type are still, of the same signification as capi- tals when used as numerals. Though the capital J is not a numeral letter, yet the lower-case 1' is as often and as signifi- cantly used as the vowel i, especially where the former is employed as a closing letter, in ii iii bi in'j in'if htij, &c. In Roman lower-case numerals, the j is not regarded, but the i stands for figure 1 wherever it is used numerically. During the existence of the French Republic, books were dated in France from the first year of the Republic: thus, An. XII. (1803,) or twelve years from 1792. 72 TYPES. I ARITHMETICAL FIGURES. THE arithmetical or Arabic numerals are 0, I, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9. Properly they should be styled Hindu or Indian numerals; for the Arabs borrowed them, along with the deci- mal system of notation, from the Hindus. They were proba- bly first introduced from the East into Italy about 1202; yet they did not come into general use before the invention of printing. Accounts were kept in Roman numerals up to the sixteenth century. Figures are usually made one en thick; but of late a broader figure is cast for newspaper use, which is two-thirds or six-sevenths of an em in width. OLD STYLE FIGURES. THOUGH uniform in height and appearance, we do not deem the modern figures an improvement on the variously- lining figures formerly in vogue, and now happily coming again into use. The latter can be caught by the eye with greater ease and certainty, just as lower-case letter can be read with more facility than continuous lines of capitals. In the new style the 3 and 8 may easily be mistaken for each other, and so with the 6, 9, and 0; but in the old style figures such errors are quite unlikely to happen, as some of them occupy the centre of the body only, and others are ascending or de- scending characters. The example here given will show the justice of our remarks: 1234567890 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 SCRATCHED 0R CANCELLED FIGURES 123§5¢7$9¢‘ ARE used in arithmetical matter when certain figures re- quire to be crossed over in an operation. FRACTIONS. CoMMoN FRACTIONS, or broken numbers in arithmetic, are cast solid to all sizes of type. A great improvement has been introduced by casting the numerator and denominator sepa- rately, on bodies‘of half size, with the line on the under figure, so that odd fractions of any amount may be readily formed, thus: 1 2 3 515;; SIGNS. 73 SIGNS. COMMERCIAL SIGNS. 39 . . Per, each. $ . . Dollar or dollars. @ . . At or to. ,6 . . Libra, libra, pound or 70 . . Percentum. pounds sterling. % . . Account. / . . Solz'a’us, solz'a’i, shilling {l . .Cent. or shillings. MATHEMATICAL, ALGEBRAICAL, AND GEOMETRICAL. + plus, or more, is the Sign of real existence of the quantity it Stands before, and is called an affirmative or positive Sign. It is also the mark of addition: thus, a + Z), or 6 + 9, implies that a is to be added to b, or 6 added to 9. - minus, or less, before a single quantity, is the Sign of negation, or negative existence, showing the quantity to which it is prefixed to be less than nothing. But between quantities it is the sign of subtraction: thus, a—b, or 8 — 4, implies b subtracted from a, or 8 after 4 has been subtracted. : equal. The Sign of equality, though Des Cartes and some others use this mark, >0: thus, a : b signifies that a is equal to 6. Others use the mark : to denote identity of ratios. X into or wit/z. The Sign of multiplication, showing that the quantities on each side the same are to be multiplied by one another: as, a X l) is to be read, a multiplied into 6; 4 X 8, the product of 4 multiplied into 8. I/Volfius and others use a dot between the two factors: thus, 7. 4 signifies the product of 7 and 4. In algebra the Sign is commonly omitted, and the two quantities put together: thus, be’ expresses the product of b and a’. When one or both of the factors are compounded of several letters, they are distinguished by a line drawn over them: thus, the facturn of a+b~——c into a’ is written, a’ X a + b — c. Others distinguish the compound factors by including them in parentheses: thus, (a + b —— c) d. -:— by. The sign of division: thus, a + 6 denotes the quan- tity a to be divided by b. Wolfius makes the Sign of division two dots; 12 : 4 denotes the quotient of 12 divided by 4 = 3. 7 or i:- are signs of majority: thus, a 7 6 expresses that a is greater than 6. A or 1 are signs of minority,——when we would denote that a is less than 6. 7 74 TYPES. m is the character of similitude used by \Nolfius, Leibnitz, and others. It is used in other authors for the difi’erence be- tween two quantities when it is unknown which is the greater of the two. :: so is. The mark of geometrical proportion disjunct, and is usually placed between two pair of equal ratios: as, 3 :6 :: 4: 8 shows that 3 is to 6 as 4 is to 8., : or is an arithmetical equal proportion: as, 7 .3 : I3 . 9; i. e. 7 is more than 3, as 13 is more than 9. El quadrate, or regular quadrangle,——viz. G AB = I] BC; i. e. the quadrangle upon the line AB is equal to the quadrangle upon the line BC. A triangle: as, A ABC :: A ADC. A an angle: as, 4 ABC = A ADC. .J. perpendicular: as, AB .1. BC. III rectangled parallelogram, or the product of two lines. I] the character of parallelism. i want of parallelism. :_/__ equiangular, or similar. =I= equilateral. C7 rhomboid. A concentrix. O circle. L right angle. ° denotes a degree: thus, 45° implies 45 degrees. ’ a minute: thus, 50’ is 50 minutes; ”, ”’, ’”’, denote seconds, thirds, and fourths; and the same characters are used where the progressions are by tens, as it is here by sixties. ‘ the mark of geometrical proportion continued, implies the ratio to be still carried on without interruption: as, 2, 4, 8, I6, 32, 64 are in the same uninterrupted proportion. 1/ When used without a figure above it, indicates the square root, and is called the radical sign. Any other root is expressed by the index figure placed above the sign. 1/16 is the square root of I6, {/27 the cube root of 27, &c. g difference equal. ——: the difference, or excess. Q or q, a square. C or c, a cube. QQ, the ratio of a square number to a square number. SIGNS. 75 In algebraical work, authors should be very exact in their copy, and compositors as careful in following it, so that no alterations may be necessary after it is composed, the over- running of this kind of matter being troublesome and costly. CELESTIAL AND ASTRONOMICAL SIGNS. The Twelve Signs of the Zodiac. ‘Y‘ Aries. 82 Leo. 77 Sagittarius. r5 Taurus. 1K Virgo. 5 Capricornus. 11 Gemini. _ Libra. m Aquarius. 69 Cancer. m Scorpio. I )-( Pisces. The Sun and Major Planets. @ Sun. 69 Earth. I; Saturn. § Mercury. 6‘ Mars. 6 Uranus. 8,? Venus. QT Jupiter. ‘4.1 Neptune. ,3. Ceres, é} Pallas, 6 Juno, E Vesta, {it Astraea, SI Hebe. @ Iris, and the other asteroids, or minor planets, are now com- monly designated by a circle enclosing a number which in- dicates the order of their discovery: thus, (9, @, (a), &c. Luztar Signs. @ New Moon.~ @ Full Moon. E First Quarter. (Q Last Quarter. Aspects and IVodes. Q’ Conjunction; happens when two planets stand under each other in the same sign and degree. 60 Opposition; happens when two planets stand diametri— cally opposite each other. A Trine; happens when one planet stands from another four signs, or 120 degrees, which make one-third of the ecliptic. [j Quartile; happens when two planets stand three signs from each other, which make 90 degrees, or the fourth part of the ecliptic. eIe Sextile; is the sixth part of the ecliptic, which is two signs, and make ‘60 degrees. 76 TYPES. Q The Dragon’s Head, or ascending node, and ES The Dragon’s Tail, or descending node, are the two points in which the eclipses happen. Planets t/mt denote the Seven Days of the Week. Dies Solis—Sunday. Dies Mereurii—Wednesday. Dies Lima—Monday. Dies Yams—Thursday. Dies .ZPfartis—Tuesday. Dies Verzeris—Friday. Dies Satumi—Saturday. Many signs and symbols have been invented by pseudo- astronomers to impose upon the credulity of the ignorant; among which are signs to give notice on what day it is proper to let blood, to bathe and to cup, to sow and to plant, to take physic, to have one’s hair cut, to cut one’s nails, to wean children, and many other absurdities; as well as symbols that serve to indicate hail, thunder, lightning, or any occult phe- nomena. ECCLESIASTICAL SIGNS. B: Response, used in prayer-books. Versicle, used in prayer-books to denote the part recited by the priest. >14 or 1' A sign of the cross employed by Roman Catholic ecclesiastical dignitaries before ‘their signatures. In Roman Catholic prayer-books, it also denotes the place ,where the priest is to make the sign of the cross. ‘it Used in Roman Catholic prayer-books to denote the place in a single verse where the response begins. MEDICAL SIGNS AND ABBREVIATIONS. R stands for Recipe, or Take. ' 5, aa, of each a like quantity. lb a pound. g an ounce. 5 a drachm. 9 a scruple. j stands for 1; ij for 2_; iij for 3; and so on. ss. signifies semi, or half. gr. denotes a grain. METAL RULES, BRACES, ETC' 7'] P. stands for particular, a little part, and means so much as can be taken between the ends of two fingers. P. aeq. stands for parles @quales, or equal parts. q. s. quaulum sufiicz'l, or as much as is sufficient. q. p. quantum placz'l, or as much as you please. 5. a. secuua'em arz‘em, or according to art. METAL RULES OR DASHES. METAL RULES or dashes, [ ] like quadrates, are com~ monly cast from one em to three ems in length. XV hen cast to line and join accurately, they may be used instead of brass rule. BRACES. BRAcEs [PA—s] are used chiefly in tables of accounts, bo- tanical and geological tables, and similar matter. They are placed before or after a series of items of similar import; and are sometimes used horizontally in the margin, to cut ofi” a chronological or other series from the proper notes or mar- ginal references of the work. Braces, two, three, and four ems in length, are now cast for all sizes of common type. fliz'a’dles and ends are also cast, [,— —~ w] which can be filled out with dashes to any length required for the brace. Middles and ends are convenient in genealogical tables, in which they are used the flat way, and in which the directing point is not always in the middle. Brass braces of any length, for music and j obbing purposes, are furnished by type—founders. SPACES. SPACES are short blank types, and are used to separate one word from another. To enable the compositor to space even and to justify with nicety, they are cast to various thick- nesses,—viz. five to an em, [I] or five thin spaces; four to an em, [I] or four middle spaces; three to an em, [I] or three thick spaces; and two to an em, [I] or two en quadrates, , which may with propriety be reckoned among the number of spaces. Besides these, there is what is called the hair-space, which is cast extremely thin, and is found useful in justifying lines and assisting uniformity in spacing. 7* 78 TYPES. TWO-LINE LETTERS ARE equal in depth to two lines of the type in which they are to be used, and of proportionate width. They form the almost only proper type for principal lines in title-pages, and are used at the beginning of chapters and newspaper advertisements. QUADRATEs AN em quadrate [I] is a short blank type, in thickness equal to the square of the letter of the fount to which it be- longs; an en quadrate [I] is half that size. The first line of a paragraph is usually indented an em quad- rate; but when the matter is leaded or the measure is wide, an em and en, or two or even three ems may be used. An em quadrate is the proper space after a full-point when it ter- minates a sentence in a paragraph. En quadrates are generally used after the semicolon, colon, &c., and sometimes after an overhanging letter. They are useful in spacing. Em and en quadrates, and figures as well, should be en— tirely exact and uniform in body, as even a trifling variation will be apparent when they are arranged in table or figure- work; and no ingenuity on the part of a compositor can rectify the zigzag appearance caused by irregular types. The inconvenience arising from founts of the same body not agreeing in depth is great, where the quadrates, through necessity, are sometimes mixed. The founts cast by MacKellar, Smiths 8: jordan are not liable to this charge, as their moulds for all regular type of a specific size harmonize perfectly, and the quadrates and spaces work together. QUOTATIONS. QUoTATIoNs are large blank type used for filling up con- siderable spaces at the beginning or end of a chapter, and also for job—work. They are cast to two sizes, and are called broad and narrow. They vary in size according to the standard of the foundry where they are cast. They are being super- seded, however, by LABOUR-SA VL/VG QUOTA TZON FUKZV/TU/CE. 79 LABOUR-SAVING QUOTATION FURNITURE. mmmmmunuu.» ‘IHIIIEIHII'IIIIMHHIIII 2 x 16 ems. 3 X8 ems. THIS is cast with great accuracy to Pica, of assorted widths and lengths; and, as its name imports, it serves not only for quotations in general job-work, but also for furniture: not being liable to warp or shrink, it forms a highly economical ' substitute for wooden reglet. || lllllIllIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIJW l llllllllllllllllIllllllIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIImmwill"IIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIlllllllllllllllllllll HOLLOW QUADRATES ANSWER many of the purposes of quotations, but are prin- cipally useful as frames or miniature chases for circular or oval jobs. They are cast of various sizes, graduated to Pica ems. 80 TYPES. svl‘dt F‘ INVENTOR 0Q 57 OF THE PATENT ‘2 m SELF-MOVING, U k‘ SELF-STEERING, % VELOCIPEDE. & 6*" %W ' O CIRCULAR QUADRATES. THESE are made of various sizes, so as to form circles or parts of circles from one to twenty-four inches in diameter. Each piece is exactly one-eighth of a full circle, and, when combined with similar pieces, will form quarter, half, three- quarter, and full circles. By reversing the combination of some of the pieces, serpentine and eccentric curves may be made of any length or depth. There are two kinds: inner quadrates, with convex surface, and outer quadrates, with concave surface. The curved line is produced by placing the convex and concave surfaces parallel to each other, so that when locked up firmly they hold the type inserted between them. The other sides of the quadrates are flat and right-angled, to allow a close introduction of type, and an easy justification with common quadrates. As these quadrates are perfect segments of a large circle, they cannot be increased or diminished without destroying the truth of the curve. If the thin ends are pieced out with com- mon quadrates, good justification will be rendered impossible; if they are shortened by cutting off, they are ruined. Bits of LABOUR-SA VL/VG cU/em rams. 81 lead or ‘short pieces of card between the curved surfaces are also wrong: they destroy that exact parallelism which is necessary for the security of the type. Very accurate justifi- cation of the outer extremities of the quadrates is also indis- pensable. If the curved surfaces are kept parallel, and the flat surfaces kept square, no difiiculty will be found in using them, and they will prove a valuable aid in ornamental printing. LABOUR-SAVING CURVATURES, &c. Morris’s Adjustable Line F ormers, or Labour—Saving Cur- vatures, do away with bent leads, plaster, wax, and other methods of making curved lines. Their economical advan- tages, and the neatness and exactitude of curve secured by their use, will be appreciated at a glance by all practical job printers. 8 2 '1 'YPE S—BA’A SS A’ULE S. LEADS. EADS form an essential part of a printer’s outfit, since it is scarcely possible to set up a single page or job in which they may not be usefully employed; but their chief purpose is for spreading the lines apart so as to reduce the amount of mat- ter in a page. Fine works are always thus leaded. They are usually cast by letter-founders in a long mould, and then cut to the required lengths. The bodies are regulated by Pica standard, and they are usually cast four, six, or eight to Pica, but are occasionally varied from one down to fourteen to Pica. Leads for jobbing‘purposes are now cut to graduated lengths, like labour-saving rule. FLOWERS AND BORDERS. HE flowers and borders designed and cast at the present time far surpass any made by founders of earlier days. Their richness and variety enable printers to execute delicate and elaborate work, rivalling plate engraving, and afford a wide scope for the display of taste and artistic skill. The combi- nation borders are especially valuable from being cast on uniform bodies, thus rendering them susceptible of a vast number of changes. The ancient practice of ornamenting pages with head and tail pieces of flowers and odd designs seems to be coming in vogue again, particularly in works printed in the old-style type. BRASS RULES. ULES are required mainly for table-work, and for pages which contain two or more columns. They are also useful in titles and jobs. Brass rules should never be more than type height, unless for perforating purposes, to divide railroad checks, &c. A shade lower would be often better, as the pressman would be enabled to bring off their impression more clearly. In table-work, the rule and figures should be separated by a lead, and all the rules should fit closely and accurately. The lately-invented BRASS LABOUR-SA Vl/VG RULE. 83 BRASS LABOUR-SAVING RULE is of immense economical advantage to the printer. Being cut to a graduated scale, from one em to fifty'ems Pica in length, advancing in the shorter pieces by ens and in the longer by ems, all waste in cutting is avoided by the printer, as rules of any length can be formed by employing two or more pieces. This rule is put up in regular founts, of various styles, with sufficient mitred pieces for outside bordering. Metal space-rules, cast by type-founders, are commonly used for cross-rules in table-work; but the shorter pieces of labour-saving rule will answer as well. On the next page we insert a plan of a case for labour- saving rules, with boxes suited for the various sizes, in which the rule should be kept when not in use. 84 LABOUR-SA VDVG 1i’ ULE. .wobmz afismcfioO 8226M H $0.332 ufizwcfioO+ £332 Efismcfioom a.“ .O J .o .m .wm N %@ Amw<0 @QDM UZH>h eater-wanIwaolsaeieivilraaegstairoars nessnmsaiiimsissmsasasss? W s0 a II‘ ItiQe-stv-l ‘23 MMN\@| ‘l ~ww\\/ /A k’ MNVV\ iQ\\l-__:l I Renpt III izbet III Eat . . . xer [zen 12 sutelz xet xeper-qu-rzi sa-rd usertesen mad-xeru dnx tét/a r ne/g .' 2 suten Xdt m sexti, xeper lgemes m ‘tdtet, netizu re 12 a'mu-Xettf, semer nu 3 . . . dnx utri sent, seru r izsl smmtu, utu tétet Xeft setem set netviu re m _ v 4 sezm tier-sen. Mzi-ten [zen-a Izer sau gal, sera m sep 11: Xut; 5 n-mxel drZ-a' memzu, semen-(ii utu retu 12 lzer Xuti. TRANSLATION- Done in the month of Hatoor of the third year of the King of Upper and Lower Egypt Kheperkara Usertesen I.—-—the blessed and eternally living. The King, wearing the double crown, sat in the royal hall. There was held a council of his attendants, the counsellors of the apartments of the Pharao (may he live!) and the great (chiefs) for the site of the foundation. Speeches were made, while they listened; and they deliberated, stepping forward. “ Well!" said the King, “ let me order the work and fittingly commemorate deeds of glory. Henceforth I will erect buildings and lasting steles to the double Horus," that is to the god of the rising and setting Sun, etc. ~48 88 RUZVJC. RUNIC ALPHABETS. UNES were the earliest alphabets in use among the Teu—_ tonic and Gothic nations of Northern Europe. The ex- act period of their origin is not known. The name is derived from the Teutonic rim, a mystery; whence rzma, a whisper, and lzetrz'in, divination; and the original use of these characters seems to have been for purposes of secrecy and divination. Scandinavian and Anglo-Saxon tradition agree in ascribing the invention of runic writing to Odin or Wodin. The countries in which traces of the use of runes exist include Denmark, Norway, Sweden, Iceland, Germany, Britain, France, and Spain; and they are found engraved on rocks, crosses, monu- mental stones, coins, medals, rings, brooches, and the hilts and blades of swords. Runic letters were also often cut on smooth sticks called VzZn-stafas, or mysterious staves, and used for purposes of divination. But there is no reason to believe that they were at any time in the familiar use in which we find the characters of a written language in modern times, nor have we any traces of their being used in books or on parchment. We have an explanation of the runic alphabet in various MSS. of the early middle ages, prior to the time when runes had altogether ceased to be understood. The systems of runes in use among the different branches of the Teutonic stock were not identical, though they have a strong general family likeness, showing their community of origin. The letters are arranged in an order altogether distinct from that of any other alphabetical system, and have a purely Teutonic nomenclature. Each letter is, as in the Hebrew- Phoenician, derived from the name of some well—known familiar object, with whose initial letter it corresponds. Runes, being associated in the popular belief with augury and divination, were to a considerable extent discouraged by the early Christian priests and missionaries, whose efforts were directed to the supplanting of them by Greek and Roman characters. But it was not easy suddenly to put a stop to their use, and we find runes continuing to be employed in early Christian inscriptions. This was to a remarkable extent the case in the Anglo—Saxon kingdoms of Northumbria, Mercia, and East Anglia, where we have traces of runic writing of dates varying from the middle RUNIC. 89 of the seventh to the middle of the tenth century. Runes are said to have been laid aside in Sweden by the year 1001, and in Spain they were officially condemned by the Council of Toledo in 1115. The different systems of runes, all accordant up to a certain point, have been classed as the Anglo-Saxon, the German, and the Norse, each containing different subordinate varieties. The Norse alphabet is generally considered the oldest, and the parent of the rest. It has sixteen letters corresponding to our f, u, 2%, 0, 1’, la, ll‘, 72, z', a, s, z‘, b, l, m, 3/, but has no equivalent for various sounds which exist in the language, in consequence of which the sound of k was used for g, a’ for z‘, b for p, and u and y for u: 0 was expressed by au, and e, by ai, z', or la; and the same letter otherwise was made to serve for more than one sound. Other expedients came, in the course of time, to be employed to obviate the deficiency of the system,—as the addi- tion of dots, and the adoption of new characters. But the runic system received a fuller development among the Germans and Anglo-Saxons, particularly the latter, whose alphabet was ex~ tended to no fewer than forty characters, in which seem to have been embraced, more nearly than in any modern alpha- bets, the-actual sounds of a language. The table on the fol~ lowing page exhibits the best known forms of the Anglo- Saxon, German, and Norse runic alphabets, with the names and the power of the several letters. The Anglo-Saxon runes, as here given, are derived from a variety of MS. authorities, the most complete containing forty characters, while some only extend as far as the twenty-fifth or twenty-eighth letter. Neither the name nor the power of some of the later letters is thoroughly known, and they are with~ out any equivalents in the Norse runic system. The German runes are given from a MS. in the conventual library of St. Gall, in Switzerland. Though the various runic alphabets are not alike copious, the same order of succession among the letters is preserved, excepting that, in the Norse alphabet, laugr pre~ cedes u-zadr, although we have placed them otherwise, with the view of exhibiting the correspondence of the three systems. The number of characters in the Anglo-Saxon alphabet is a multiple of the sacred number eight; and we have the evidence both of a Swedish bracteate containing twenty-four characters, and of the above mentioned St. Gall MS., that there was a 06‘ ‘DIAL/2 21' ANGLO-SAXON. GERMAN. NORSE. ANGLO-SAXON. GERMAN. N ORSE. V feoh f It feh ‘9 fé |\ lagu l [\ lago f laugr n /\ ur u (short) n uur h ur #i 3% ing ng is inc b thorn th [> dOm P thlll’S H daeg d |>l< ior i0 “f. nyd n ‘l nod k naud queom q l is i(short) \ - iis \ 15 calc ‘l gear Y (Cons) ‘l’ ger /l M [I] stan st \l eoh e(long) I ih gar ' dzh [11K peorth p J‘ perd Z Z ‘r eolhx x X elix g ‘1 sigel s [4 Sigi l4 sol R T tir t 1‘ ti T tyr B beol‘c b B borg [3 biarkan Q vult v M eh e (short) M eh ‘ [>1 man m IX] [x] man T madr Pg RUNIC. 9 I recognized division of the alphabet into classes of eight letters, —a classification which forms the basis of a system of secret runes, mentioned in that MS. Of these secret runes, there are several varieties specified: in particular, I. .lz's-rzma and Lago- rzma (of which specimens exist in Scandinavia), consisting of groups of repetitions of the character its or lago, some shorter and some longer, the number of shorter characters in each group denoting the class to which the letter intended to be indicated belonged; the number of longer ones, its position in the class. 2. Ha/zal-runa, where the letters are indicated by characters with branching stems, the branches to the left denoting the class, and those to the right the position in that class. There is an inscription in secret runes of this descrip- tion at Hackness, in Yorkshire. 3. Stof-ru-rza, in which the class is indicated by points placed above, and the position in the class by points below, or the reverse. The best-known inscriptions in the Anglo-Saxon character are those on two grave-stones at Hartlepool, in Northumber- land, on a cross at Bewcastle, in Cumberland, and on another cross at Ruthwell, in Dumfriesshire. The inscription on the west side of Bewcastle cross, which we give as a specimen of Anglo—Saxon runes, is a memorial of Alcfrid, son of Oswiu, who was associated with his father in the government of the kingdom of Northumbria, in the seventh century. H M It has been-thus deciphered into the MI, NT H H Anglo-Saxon dialect of the period :- + THIS SIGBECUN SETTZE HwAzTRED thaws YMB CYNING ALCFRIDZE GICEGZED HEOSU“ SA\\'LI.’M. D H ix) ii Or, in Modern English:— F i: l> _t/z(t/zz'n) L . .5 gas in gem D . . “6 ll: (t/zz'ue) D19. .11 /l U . .u u I. .1 2' VID. . p to K. .k 12 X . .x x L. .1 Z Y . .y y (D. .m 722 Z . . z z N. .n 12 Two useful Anglo-Saxon letters have disappeared from modern English,—namely, b or l> th (thin), and D or “6 th (Mine). The Anglo-Saxon letters which vary from those now used were doubtless mere corruptions of the Roman forms,—viz. the capitals A, C, E, G, H, M, S, and W, and the small letters d, f, g, i, r, s, t, and w. Several marks of abbreviation were used by the Saxons, as 15 that, 7 and, &c. These were not original members of the alphabet, but were introduced proba- bly for despatch. About the year 1567, john Daye, who was patronized by Archbishop Parker, cut the first Saxon types which were used in England. In this year, Asserz'us .Meueveusz's was published by the direction of the archbishop in these characters; in the same year, Archbishop ZElfric’s Paschal Homily ,- and in 1571, the Saxon Gospels. ’ On the two following pages will be found a plan of cases for Saxon types. 94 SA X ()N. .mHwAwO MHAHQD Zovmawm SAXOZV. 95 .322. cm iSEeesG . . 6.8:; :6 m 80 a. 80m .0023 — .023”. .nmmdwO MmH>>OA ZONZ'....Phi ph 500 X . x Xi‘ . . . .Chi ch 600 \I'. \{1 \I'Z‘....Psi ps 700 Q . to "(Maya . .Oméga 610mg 800 From a desire, probably, to imitate Greek manuscript, a multitude of ligatures, abbreviations, and contractions of letters, as well as duplicates, were cast by the early type- founders. These, however, with two or three exceptions, have been quite discarded; and a fount of modern Greek is readily accommodated in a single pair of cases. The only duplicated GREEK’. IOI characters in the preceding table are ,8 and 6, 19 and 6, and a and c. )8 looks best when used as an initial letter, and 6 as a medial. 19 and 6 are used indiscriminately; but r is employed as a final letter only. There are twelve diphthongs or compound vowels in Greek, viz.:—- Six propen—az, av, 8L, av, oi, 0'0; and Six improper,—a, 27, Q, 171), W, cm. The point under the first three letters denotes the iota, and is therefore called the sub- script iota. ACCENTS AND ASPIRATES. ’ Lenis. ” Lenis acute. "' Circumflex lenis. ‘ Asper. " Lenis grave. 1' Circumflex asper. ’ Acute. ‘’ Asper acute. " Dimresis. ‘ Grave. “ Asper grave. ‘ Diaeresis acute. ' Circumflex. ! " Dimresis grave. Accents are nothing more than small marks which have been introduced into the language to denote the pronunciation of words, and aid its acquisition by learners. The ancient Greeks never used them, as is demonstrated from Aristotle, old inscriptions, and ancient medals. It is not easy to tell the date when the practice of writing with accents first ob- tained, though it is probable not till after the Romans began to learn the Greek tongue and to send their children to study at Athens,—that is, about or a little before the time of Cicero. Accents—by the Greeks called réwl, tones—show the rising or falling of the voice in pronouncing; either separately in dis- tinct syllables, or conjunctively in the same syllable. Wherefore there are two sorts of accents: two simple, viz. the acute, 6513c, figured thus [’ ], which denotes the elevation of the voice; and the grave, fiapiig, shaped thus [‘ ], to signify the falling or depression of the voice: and the circumflex, mpwrrélmvs', which was formed first of these two lines or points joined together thus ["], and afterward was changed into a round sort of a figure like an inverted upsilon, thus [a], but at length came to be figured like an S drawn crosswise [” 1(1) The acute accent raises the voice, and affects one or more of the last three syllables of a word, if it has so many. U) Bell's Greek Grammar. 9*‘ 102 GREEK’. The grave depresses the voice, and affects the last syllable only. The circumflex lengthens the sound, and affects either the last syllable of a word or the last but one. There are two spirits, or breathings: the asper [‘], which is equivalent to the modern letter 11; and the lenis [’ ], which has no perceptible power, and indicates the bare opening of the mouth and simple emission of the voice. All the words that begin with a vowel have one of these breathings over them; but the vowel upsilon admits‘ of no other than the spiritas asper at the beginning‘ of a word. In diphthongs the spiritas is put over the second vowel: as ai'rog, not civrog, The letter p, at the beginning of a word, has an asper over it, as, ,béo; and where two ps meet in a word, the first has a lenis, and the other an asper. The apostrophe [’] is used for cutting off the vowels a, s, i, 0, and the diphthongs (1L and 0t, when they stand at the end of a word and the next word begins with a vowel: as, wafiabrqb for Trapti abrlp; mivr’ éAsyov for 'rrr'wra éheyov, Sometimes the apostrophe contracts two words into one: as, Kgz’ycb for real éyrb; éyé’luai for e'ycb OZ/tat; Ka’rceivog for Kai élcsivog, Sometimes an apostrophe supplies the place of the first vowel beginning a word: as (I) M105 for (B r’lyaflé; W01‘) k1 for not) $0. This is chiefly used in poetry. ' But the prepositions mp2 and apt‘) suffer no apostrophe though the next word begin with a vowel; for we write rrspZ vaov, n'po 1 .. \ 1 \ v .. spov, 'n'spi (wrov, 1rpo srwv, &c. The diaeresis ["1 is put over the last one of two vowels that come together, to show that they must be pronounced separately, and not as a diphthong: thus, him) with a diaeresis makes three syllables; but without a diaeresis av is a diphthong, and makes aim) two syllables. Diastole [,] is put between two particles that would hear a different sense without it: thus, 6,11 5,11 signify whatever,- whereas bra stands for as, and Z'm for that. T6,rs with a diastole GREEK. 103 implies and this; but when without, it answers to the adverb then. The sign of interrogation, in Greek, is made by a semi- colon_[;]. ' The colon is made by an inverted full-point [' ]. All other points are the same as in English. The compositor will find it advantageous to bear in mind the following rules :— 1. No accent can be placed over any other than one of the last three syllables of a word. 2. The grave accent never occurs but on the last syllable; and, this being the case, the asper grave [°] and lenis grave ["1 can be wanted only for a few monosyllables. 3. No vowel can have a spirit, or breathing, except at the beginning of a word. 4. The letter p is the only consonant marked by a breathing. 5. Almost every word has an accent, but very seldom has more than one; and, when this happens, it is an acute thrown back upon the last syllable from one of those words called enclitics (leaning back), which in that case has none, unless it be followed by another enclitic. In no other case than this can a last syllable have an acute accent, except' before a full- point, colon, or note of interrogation, when the grave accent of the last syllable is changed to an acute,—a circumstance which has often led printers, who were ignorant of the reasons for accenting the same word differently in different situa- tions, to think that there was an error in their copy, and thus to make one in their proof. Most errors, however, proceed rom those who do not think at all about the matter. ‘ PLAN OF GREEK CASES. HE following plan of cases for Greek type is probably more convenient than any other. A Roman case may readily be altered to accommodate the lower-case sorts. Compositors who aspire to a full knowledge of their art should by all means make themselves familiar with Greek and Hebrew letters and cases. 31.7127’ 81.‘) GREEK UPPER CASE. ?I T (I) Kerned (5 Kerned 9’ GREEK’. 105 1853.5 .32; :5 m .nmwAwO NEE/DA MHMHMU 106 HEBRE W ALPHABET. HE Hebrew alphabet has twenty-two letters. No.1 of the following table indicates the force of Hebrew Column No.2 gives their HEBREW. letters when read without points. force when the language is printed with the Masoretic points or vowels, which are of later date than the letters. The names Column and numerical value of the characters are also shown. 1 THE HEBREW ALPHABET. ' NUMER. NAMES. No. 1. No. 2. VALUE_ N . . . . . Aleph Sounded a in A gentle aspirate 1 war (vowel) J . . Beth . . . Bk 2 J . . . . . Gimel g hard Ch 3 ‘I . . . . . Daleth Dh 4 TI. . . . . He ain hate (vow.) A rough aspirate 5 1 . . . . .Vau uvowel,orbe- 6 fore a vowel, w 1.....Zain Ds 7 n . . Cheth Hh 8 U . . . . . Teth Th 9 ‘ . . . . . Jod Like ee in Eng- j consonant, or the 10 lish (vowel) softer y D“ final Caph k or c hard . 20 \ LI . . ._ Lamed 30 D D final Mem 40 J Ifinal . Nun 50 D . . Samech Soft s 60 p . . . . . Ain 0 long (vowel) kg, or hgh, the rough— 7o ' est aspirate 5 “final . Phe . . . 80 Y Y final . Tzaddi j soft 90 P . Koph k or qu 100 "I . Resch 200 W . Shin or Sin .9 hard 300 I‘) . Than 400 HEBRE W. I 0 7 LETTERS THAT HAVE A LIKENESS TO OTHERS. Beth Caph D J Daleth Caph Resch ‘I ‘I W Van Zain Jod Nun ‘I 7 ’ I Mem Samech D D Gimel ’ Nun J J He Cheth Thau n n n Teth Mem (0 D Ain Tzaddi J] Y The dividing of Hebrew words not being permitted, the five following letters are cast broad to enable the compositor to justify the lines without irregular spacing :— Aleph He Lamed Mem Thau N n ‘0 c: in Hebrew has no capitals, and therefore letters of the same shape, but of a larger body, are used at the beginning of chapters and other parts of Hebrew works. Hebrew reads from the right to the left, which is the case with all other Oriental languages, except Ethiopic and Arme— nian. In composing it, the general method is to place the nick of the letter downward, and after putting the points to the top, I 08 HEBRE W. to turn the line and set the points that come under the letters. If the letter has but one leg, the point is placed immediately under it; but where the letter has two legs, it is put under the centre. The Masoretic points or vowels are subjoined under the consonant 3 (beth). I. The Long Vowels. 2. T he S/zort Vowels. Kametz . . . raa 1:baa Patach . . . . . - a ;ba Tzeri . . . . --ee ;bee Soegol . . . . . . '-'e ;be Long Chirek 9 ii 9: bii Little Chirek . . ' i bi Cholem . . . 00 1'33 boo Kametz-chataph . r o bo Shurek . . . Pluu fijbuu Kibbutz. . . . . u ;bu 3. S/zeoas, which imply a Vowel to be wanting. Simple Sheva . . . . . . Chataph Patach . . . . no Patach furtive . . . . . . Chataph Soegol . . . . me Chataph Kametz. . . . . ['10 H T: The last three are called compound shevas; and, in fact, they are only the short vowels, to which the simple sheva [z] is joined. ACCENTS. Hebrew accents are either mere points, or lines, or circles. Those which are mere points or dots consist of one or two or three such points, and are always placed above the middle of the accented letter, thus, One, called rebia, J i.e. sitting over. That Com Two, called royal za/eep/z Keaton, 3, or, the little ele- _ Sistinc, of oator, from its figure, which is composed of up. a right points. Three, called royal segolta, an inverted ['-']. The lines are either upright, inclined, or transverse. The upright is either solitary or with points or dots. HEB/35 W. 1 09 E " between two words, 3'3, termed pesiek, or musical pause, '75 and terminating a song. jl’fetkeg, l: or oria’le, an euphonic accent at the 5; (5” beginning of a word. I he ‘1210611121 Royal sillulz, 3, end, which is placed before [z], J H . ’ sop/zpasuk, i. e. toward the end. - with two, above the letter, royal zakep/i gad/zol, 5, the points, great elevator, strains the sound. . namely, I one, below the letter, royal teb/iir, :1, broken sound, from its figure and tone. Inclined lines hang either above or below. ' r Leader pas/zta, 3, extension, extends the voice or sound, and is placedabove the last letter r . ’ ,0 the fight of the Word. Subservient kaa’ma, :, aute— § eea’eut, to the leader geres/z; and is placed . 9‘ q above the penult or antepenult letter. °" , I g _ Leader geres/z, J, expulsion, is sung with an ‘I: impelled voice. ' (the left .. r v Gereslzajzm, 3, two erpellers, from the figure beingdoubled. E the right—Leader tiphc/za, Q, fatigue, from the song or note. ‘2. Of subservient merea, :, leugtlzeuiug out, from o . . ' pg the left its lengthening out the song or note. Merea kep/zula, n, a double lengthening out from its music and figure. The transverse line is either right or curved: thus, " “ The right line is placed between two words, connecting them together, thus, 3'3, and is called maeeap/z, i.e. eon-nee- tion. The curved or waved line, 5, is called leader, zarka, or tlze disperser, from its modulation and figure. Circles are either entire or semi. The entire circle is placed always above, and has a small inclined line attached to it. 1!) 1 IO HEBA’E IV. 9 Either on the left, when it is placed at the head of the word, 3, and is called leader telisha the greater, or the great evulsion, Q Or on the right, when it is placed at the end, I, and is called subservient telisha the less. Q9 On both together, 3, called leader harne para, the horns of the heifer, from its modulation and figure. The semicircle is either solitaiy or pointed. The solitary is either angular or reflected. .J on Subservient hillni, j, elevated, from the eleva- the ri ht tion of the voice. g .Mnnach, j, placed below, from its position. Leader jethith, :, drawing back, from its figure. on < L the left Subservient mahpach, P, inverted, also from The angular is its figure. either single subservient darga, Q, a degree. or double, leader, shalsheleth, j, a chain, from its figure and modulation. When joined with other points, it is either above or below the letter. When above the letter, it has a small line attached to it on The reflected is the left, 5, leader paser, the disperser from the diffusion of the note. \1Vhen below the letter, it is pointed either downward, ;, called royal athnach, respiration, as the voice must rest upon it, and respire; or upward, j, subservient, jera/z-ben-jomo, the moon of its own day, from its figure. PLANS OF HEBREW CASES. ' I ‘HE first plan shows a common case for Hebrew without points; the second exhibits a pair of cases with points. MFAIHZH III HEBREW LOWER CASE. 3 cm quads. s . Quad rates. ZII l/M 3819.711 HEBREW UPPER CASE. 71/151883]! $11 HEBREW LOWER CASE. 4 cm spaces for points Em quads for points. 5 em spnee. 4 em space. —_____—_—_-———- 8 cm space. Quad rates for points Qundrates. II4 ‘AIUS/C. MUSIC TYPE. N no department of letter-founding has the progress of improvement been more decided and satisfactory than in the production of music type. The finest work of the music- stamper cannot surpass-the ingenious combinations of the type-founder and printer. The music of which specimens are here given is cast on the centre of the body, and any intelli- gent workman may learn to compose it with facility. Brass lines are now furnished with founts when desired. EXCELSIOR. ' EXCELSIOR No. 2. DIAMOND NO. I. ,\ _.\ DIAMON D No. 2. AGATE No.3. NONPAREIL No.3. MUSIC. 115 COMPARATIVE TABLE OF BODIES. _ JsoflJaAEx >9. _._ 33 a _________________ we ac :: I: I: I: I: I: I: _e _ or _ “or _ s._e _ Zeaxoexfix >9. \. _____ _._.___ _________ _________ _________ _.____-____ III: I: 3 we we 3 we so inane. >9. ,w. _________F0_______________________________________a__________e_________u . a $0 a: s Q é .\_._~.....a»m.b\..e.\ .______.__H_o_ ________w_e______:wZ:_____F_%_______W_L_______r_L_____::%__ Umsfiseew 2.2.1.0 seam (w. :: ::_:: __:___: we we w _________ 555 555 _____s___ E55 :55: Umaeséeaw. 20. s. ______ :: __.__ as __________.________:___: _____:_____________.__:__________________________:_ wc we #c ma mc 40 ac a: Whekwmex. ____________________ 00 e .______________________________:___:_____________::_______________________:______::________:_:5: 0 ac $0 aC m0 . ac to to use w~¢ Hwc I I 6 IWUSIC. MUSIC COMPOSITION. KNOWLEDGE of the rudiments of the art of music is essential to the correct composition'bf music type; for, unless the compositor is'ii'é'quainted with the relative time- values of the notes and rests, he cannot space th'érn properly. The manuscript copy is given to the compositor, with direc- tions regarding the dimensions of the page required and the size of type to be employed. He counts the number of mea- sures in the piece, and allots to each measure the amount of ems in length which the page will permit, so that there shall be a general equality of space throughout the piece. In instrumental music, and in pieces which are not interlined with poetry, the compositor will set two or more staves simul- taneously, ranging the leading notes in the lower staves pre- cisely under the corresponding ones in the upper staff; that is, a certain amount of space in each staff, in a brace, must contain the same amount of time-value. Where lines of poetry are interspersed, as in ballads and in church music, the staves are necessarily set singly; and in composing the second, third, and fourth staves the workman must therefore constantly refer to the first, in order to make the staves correspond. A good compositor will be careful to make the lines overlap each other, brick-wise, and not allow a joint to fall directly under another. Masters who aim to do cheap rather than good work have the music lines ‘cast double or triple, to expedite composition. Such work has a very slovenly look, as thejoints of the lines, coming under one another, are apparent in the entire depth of the staff. \IVe have seen books set in this manner, in which all the lines seem to be composed of dotted rule, instead of a continuous stroke. The compositor should be careful to make the stems of all the notes in a page of the same length, except those of grace— notes, which should be about half as long. PLAN OF CASES. HE following plan of cases was arranged by the music typographer, ]. M. Armstrong of Philadelphia, expressly for the founts of music cast by MacKellar, Smiths 8: jordan, specimens of which are shown on page 114. A table of comparative bodies is given on page 115. I Page Missing in Original Volume Page Missing in Original Volume Page Missing in Original Volume Page Missing in Original Volume THE ART OF COMPOSITION. GENERAL REMARKS. °I~ XPERIENCE proves that the appren- \ tice foreshadows the workman,_ just as surely as the bend of the twig foretells the inclination of the tree. The upright, obe- dient, industrious lad will become a steady, skilful, and capable man, as unmistakably as the perverse, idling, careless boy will ripen into a lazy, dissolute, and worthless fellow. The fact is, a boy is measurably the maker of his own destiny; and if he fails to acquire a master-knowledge of the trade to which he is put, it will mainly be because he did not at his outset determine to be a master-workman. Good morals and steady industry are indispensable. When a lad who possesses these qualities proposes to learn the art and mystery of printing, it Should be inquired of him, Has he had a fair common-school education? Is he a perfect speller? Has he a turn for reading? Is his eyesight good? Is he under fifteen years of age? A true aifirmative answer to all these queries will entitle him to the position of reading and errand-boy. He is told the hours at which he is to come and go, and a strict punctuality is enjoined upon him. He sweeps the room,—he sorts out the pi,—he learns the position 11 121 122 COJWPOSITIOJV. of the various letters in the case. A year spent in this way is an excellent preparative for “going to case,” or learning the art of composing type. When he is put to composition, he is told to set up one line and show it to the foreman or to the journeyman under whose care he may be placed. The errors in the line are pointed out to him, and he is required to correct them himself. When the words are perfectly correct, he justifies the line tight enough to prevent it from falling down when the composing-stick is slightly inclined, and yet sufficiently loose to enable him to lift it out with ease. In thus spacing out the line, the blanks between the words must be so graduated that, when the matter is printed, all the words will appear at equal distances apart. No matter how impatient he may be to get on, he must be drilled at this exercise till he becomes a thorough master of it. The grand doctrine to be instilled into him at first is, to do his work well and correctly; swiftness will follow as a natural consequence. He sets a second line; and after it has been made faultless he proceeds with the third, and so on till the stick is full. The utmost care must be taken to keep every letter and every line in an exact vertical position; and when he essays to empty the stick he must be taught to lift the entire mass in one square solid body, and to place it squarely and vertically on the galley. If the lines are allowed to slant either backward or sidewise, it is difficult afterward to make them stand accurately. After the apprentice has become thoroughly conversant with the shape of every type, and can distinguish “ u” from “ n,” “b” from “q,” and “d” from “p,” he is allowed to distribute type for his own use. He is taught to take up at one time no more matter than he can conveniently grasp in his left hand, which he holds so that the light falls on the face of the type, and his eye can readily read it. In distributing the various letters, he takes a word or two between the thumb and fore- finger of his right hand, and the types are lightly dropped into their respective boxes. At the outset, and as he proceeds, the novitiate must be cautioned against the acquisition of bad habits; such as swing- ing the body as the types are picked up, nicking the type against the stick several times before placing it in line, stand- ing on one leg, &c. COMPOSITION 123 While avoiding these ridiculous practices, a learner must acquire (if he does not possess them already) certain habitudes or principles which lie at the foundation of successful effort. The first is Pnne‘tnalz'ty. He must conscientiously observe the time- rules of the office in coming and leaving. The early hours are the best for work; and the mind being cheered by the con- sciousness of doing right, the body feels the influence, and is strengthened; and when the quitting hour arrives, the amount of work accomplished will satisfy himself and his master too. The most successful masters have been distinguished for punctuality. The apprentice’s time is not his own, but his master’s property; and wasting it by want of punctuality, or idling during his master’s absence, is simply equivalent to stealing. The second point is Obedience. The apprentice has no right to question orders given by the master or his deputy. His duty is promptly to do as he is told, without grumbling or dissatisfaction. Let him remember that he is under orders, ‘and that, if he ever expects to learn how to command, he must learn in his youth how to obey. He will promote his own interests by seeking to anticipate his master’s wishes, and by endeavouring to make himself so useful that his services cannot well be dispensed with. Akin to this is Courtesy. Good manners in a youth are wonderfully pleas— ing, and effectively aid in his advancement. Courtesy toward his master is a matter of course, and deserving of little com- mendation; but he must be courteous to customers when sent out on an errand, and courteous to the workmen in the oflice. By this means he will secure good-will, and many a friendly hint will be given to him in acquiring a knowledge of the art. The habit when fixed will bless him and others as long as he lives. PLAN OF CASES. HE following schemes show the order in which the let- ters are kept in cases in this country. In some oflfices, however, slight deviations will be found,—such as the trans- position of the comma and w, y, p, &c. 124 C 01”!’ OS! T 1 01V. .nmm<0 MmHnHnHD ZH< 11* 92:1 NOZ/I/SOJli/‘OO PROPOSED NEW PLAN FOR THE LOWER CASE. 3 em space. Quadratea. I’OSITIO/V—LA YING TYPE. I 2 7 POSITION. THE standing position of a compositor should be perfectly upright, without stiffness or restraint; the shoulders thrown back, the feet firm on the floor, heels nearly closed, and toes turned out to form an angle of about forty-five degrees. The head and body should be kept perfectly steady, except when moving from the Roman to the Italic case, the operations of distributing and composing being performed by the various motions of the arm, from the shoulder-joint alone; and if, to reach a box placed in the further part of the cases, to put in or take out a letter, he should incline the body by a slight motion, he should immediately resume his erect position. The height of a compositor and his frame should be so adjusted that his right elbow may just clear the front of the lower case by the a and r boxes, without the smallest elevation of the shoulder-joint; his breast will then be opposite the space, h, and e boxes. Sitting at work should be rarely permitted, ex- cept for lameness, weakness, old age, or other infirmity; and then the stool should be a small piece of board fastened to a single leg. Habit will render a standing position familiar and easy; perseverance in conquering a little fatigue will be amply repaid by the prevention of knock knees, round shoulders, and obstructed circulation of the blood and respiration of the lungs. LAYING TYPE. NWRAP carefully the page received from the type— founder, and, laying it on a galley, soak it thoroughly with thin soap-water, to prevent the types from adhering to one another after they have been used a short time. Then, with a stout rule or reglet, lift as many lines as will make about an inch in thickness, and, placing the rule close up on one side of the bottom of the proper box, slide ofl the lines gently, taking care not to rub the face of the letter against the side of the box. Proceed thus with successive lines till the box is filled. Careless compositors are prone to huddle new types to- gether, and, grasping them up by handfuls, plunge them pell- mell into the box, rudely jostling them about to crowd more in. This is an intolerable practice. I 28 DIS T1311)’ U TIN G. The type left over should be kept standing on galleys, in regular order, till the cases need replenishment. A fount of five hundred pounds of Pica may have, say, four cases allotted to it; the same amount of Nonpareil, from eight to ten cases. DISTRIBUTING. HEN a learner can infallibly distinguish from each other the letters b and q, d and p, n and u, and l and I, he may be allowed to distribute type for himself. The head of the page being turned toward him, the learner sets a composing-rule behind the portion to be lifted, and then, placing his thumbs against the rule and his forefingers against the top line, while his remaining fingers press together both sides, he raises the matter quickly. Then, inclining sidewise his right hand, he removes the left, and allows the matter to balance momentarily in his right, while he doubles in the third finger and stretches out the thumb of the left for the reception of the matter, which he at once places in it, the rule lying as a support on the third finger, while the thumb and other fin- gers embrace the sides. He should take up but a few lines at a time, until he acquires facility in lifting. Large handfuls should always be avoided, as the weight is fatiguing and weakening to the wrist. Keeping the handful in an inclined position, so that he may readily read the lines, he takes up as many letters as he can conveniently hold between his fingers,——an entire word, if practicable,——and drops the types slantingly, but with face upward, into the several boxes. The first aim of the learner must be accuracy, even though his progress be slow. Correct distribution aids in clean com— position. In time he will be able to drop his types rapidly, with hardly a glance at the boxes; and, while his fingers are flying about correctly and expeditiously, his eyes will take in the next word to be distributed; thus proceeding till the case is filled. In distributing, the utmost care should be taken in placing the various spaces in their appropriate boxes. A mixing of spaces characterizes the botch. The letter-board should always be kept clean, and the bot- tom as well as the face of the form well washed before it is COMPOSING. 1 29 laid on the board and unlocked; for, if any dirt remain in the type after the form is unlocked, it will sink into the matter. This precaution taken, the pages should be well opened, and the .whole form washed till the water appears to run from it in ‘ a clean state. If the form is very dirty, it is best to lock it up again and rinse the bottom of it, and proceed as before. It is sometimes necessary to dry the letter at the fire after distributing. In this case, the type should not be used until it is perfectly cold, as very pernicious effects arise from the anti— mony in the composition of which the type is made. The noxious vapour which arises is sufficient warning of the effects. The compositor ought always to avoid it as a pestilence which will affect his respiration and his sinews, inducing lung-complaints, and causing paralysis of the hand or contrac- tion of the fingers. Where it can be conveniently managed, it is better to distribute at night, or before meals, so that the letter may dry without artificial heat. COMPOSING. HEN copy is put into the hands of the compositor, he should receive directions respecting the width and length of the page; whether it is to be leaded, and with white lines between the breaks; and whether any particular method is to be followed in the punctuation and in the adoption of capitals. These instructions being given, the compositor will make his measure to the number of ems directed, which is done by laying them fiatwise in the composing-stick, and then screwing it up sufiiciently tight to prevent the slide from moving. He then fits a composing—rule to the measure, and, his case being supplied with letter, he commences his work. The left hand, which contains the composing-stick, should always follow the right, which takes up the letters. If the left he kept stationary, considerable time is lost in bringing each letter to the stick, because the right hand has, consequently, to traverse a much greater space than is necessary. The eye should always precede the hand, constantly seeking for the next letter while the fingers are picking up one just selected. Each letter should be taken up by the upper end. This method will effectually prevent any false motion, and preclude 1 3O COJl/[POSL/VG. the necessity of turning the letter when in the hand. If pos- sible, a sentence of the copy should be taken at one time, and, while putting in the point and quadrate at the end of the sen- tence, the eye may revert to the copy for the next. It is to dexterity in these particulars that compositors are indebted for swiftness. The time thus gained is very considerable, while all appearance of bustle or fatigue is avoided. By taking a sentence into the memory at one time, the connection of the subject is preserved, and the punctuation rendered less difficult. Those who are careful in distribution find the advantage of it in composition. Foul or slovenly workmanship is disgrace- ful. To avoid this, a compositor should accustom himself to glance over each line as he justifies it, and correct any error as he proceeds, which he may do with little impediment to his progress. SPACING. Uniformity in spacing is, unquestionably, a most important part of a compositor’s occupation; this requires both care and judgment, and, therefore, cannot be too strongly impressed upon the mind of the beginner. Close spacing is as unwork- manlike as wide spacing, and neither ought to be permitted except in very narrow measures; and, frequently, even then with care it might partly be prevented, What is commonly called the thick space is the proper separator between words; though this rule cannot always be adhered to in narrow measures when large type is used. It is not sufficient merely to have a line here and there uniformly spaced: a careful com- positor will give every page that uniformity of appearance which is a chief excellency. The beginner should remember that it is better to do little, and do that little well, than to put together a great number of letters without any regard to accuracy and uniformity. l/Vhere a line is evenly spaced, and yet requires justification, the additional space should be put between those words in the line where it will be least observable: viz. a d and an h, being tall, perpendicular letters, will admit an increase of space between them, but not more than a middle and thin space to a thick-spaced line; and an additional space may be placed after a kerned letter, the beak of which may bear upon the top of an ascending letter,——as the f followed by h, &c. COMPOST/VG. 131 The same rule should be observed where it is necessary to reduce the spacing of a line, less space being required after a sloping letter than after a perpendicular one. The comma requires only a thick space, but the other points should have a hair space before and an en quadrate after them, except the full-point, which should have an em quadrate, as terminating a sentence. Should it be necessary to reduce the spacing generally, the spaces after the points must be altered in the same proportion. Spaces are cast to such regular gradations that the compositor can urge no reasonable excuse either for bad justification or improper spacing. In matter to be stereotyped, a hair space should be placed after the letter f and other kerned letters when they stand at the end of the line. JUSTIFYING. Accurate justification is absolutely essential, as the letters will be warped sidewise in a loose line, making it impossible to get a fair impression from the type. Besides, the letters are liable to be drawn out by the suction of the rollers,_to the de- triment of the form and the press. The instructor of an apprentice should occasionally pass his finger along the side of matter set by him; and if the lines should not prove evenly justified, they should be put into the composing—stick again and properly corrected. HEAD-LINES. Head-lines are generally set in small capitals of the same fount, or in Italic, and sometimes in capitals. Italic capitals of letter somewhat smaller than the body of the work, with folios of a proportionate size, have a neat appearance. NOTES. The usual rule for note-type is two sizes less than the text of the work: thus, to Pica work, Long Primer; Small Pica, Bourgeois; Long Primer, Brevier. Side-notes are usually smaller in proportion. When side-notes or references drive down below the lines of the text to which they refer, the expe— dient of cut-in notes must be resorted to. This is a diflicult I 3 2 COZWPOSING'. part of a compositor’s business, and requires skill and patience to adjust all parts, so that every line of note and text may have proper and equal hearing. The reglet or lead between the lines of matter and the side-note must be cut with as much nicetyas possible to the length of the text, as far as where the note is to run under; and, having accurately adjusted, by means of the quotations and justifiers, the situation of the first line of the note, such lead or reglet is added to thetext as will make it precisely correspond in depth with the lines of note that stand on the side before turning: the remainder of the note is then set in a long measure, to correspond in width with the text, reglet, and side-note; and the page is made up with note, or the text begun again after the note is finished. In Bibles with notes and annotations, in law-books, and other works, it frequently happens that a page exhibits several of these alternate frameworks of note and text, which, if done well, display a workman’s skill to great advantage. BLANKING. If the work is very open, consisting of heads, whites, &c., the compositor must be particularly attentive to their depth; so that though the white may be composed of different-sized quadrates, yet their ultimate depth must be equal to the regu- lar body of the type the work is done in; otherwise the register of the work will be incomplete. The pressman cannot make the lines back if the compositor is not careful in making up his matter. PARAGRAPHS. The first line of a new paragraph is indented an em quad- rate, of whatever type the work may be; though, when the measure is very wide, two or even three ems are preferable. By this means the paragraph is more strongly marked, the indention of an em only being scarcely perceptible in a long line. Authors vary materially in the mode of making para- graphs. Some carry the argument of a position to a great length before they relieve the attention of the reader; while others break off at almost every place that will admit only of a full—point. But the author’s plan is to be followed, unless he direct otherwise. Authors should always make the begin- ning of a new paragraph conspicuous to the compositor, by COMPOSING. 133 indenting the first line of it far enough to distinguish it from the preceding line in case it should be quite full. It is a practice too prevalent among compositors to drive out a word at the close of a paragraph, or even to divide it, in order to reap the advantage of a break-line. Partof a word, or a complete word, in a break-line, if it contain no more than three or four letters, is improper. It should be the business of the proof-reader to notice and check this irregularity. The last line of a paragraph should not on any account begin a page, neither should the first line of a paragraph come at the bottom of a page if the work has white lines between the breaks: to prevent this, the compositor may make his page either long or short, as most convenient, always taking care that the odd and even pages back, so that the extra length or shortness of the page may escape observation. INDEXES. The index is generally placed at the end of the volume, and set in letter two sizes less than that of the work. It is always begun upon an uneven page. In setting an index,.the subject— line should not be indented; but, if the article make more than one line, all but the first should be indented an em. In preparing the copy of an index, care should be taken that the subject-words are arranged alphabetically, as the compositor will not transpose his matter afterward without remuneration. - \Nhere several index-figures are used in succession, a com- ma is put after each folio; but, to save figures and commas, the succession of the former is noted by putting a dash between the first and last figures: thus, 4-8. Again, if an article has been collected from two pages, the folio of the second is sup- plied by sq., or sequeute, and by sqa, or sequieutibus, when an article is touched upon in succeeding pages. A full-point is not put after the last figures, because it is thought that their standing at the end of the line is a sufiicient stop. Neither is a comma or a full-point placed to the last word of an article in a wide measure and open matter with leaders; but it is proper to use a comma at the end of every article where the figures are put close to the matter, instead of running them to the end of the line. 12 I 34 C OflfPOSL/V G. TITLES. Ornamental type may be used to good purpose in fancy jobs, and without violating any of the canons of a correct taste. The universal eye is pleased with ornament; and it is well to foster this fancy, just as we cultivate a poetical feeling, or a passion for music, or flowers, or any beautiful thing that God has made. But, as life should not be all music, or flowers, or poetry, so printing should not be all ornament. And as men whom nature puts in the fore-front of all other men are noted for a becoming simplicity of life and style, so the title-page that heralds all the inner pages of a book should be printed in a style of elegance severe and unadorned: no fancy type, except a line of Scribe Text, or Old English,——no italics, unless perchance a single-line motto in Pearl caps,—no bold-face type, nor Antique, nor Gothic,—but plain, clear, light-faced letters that seem the embodiment of the soul of thought. All experienced printers incline to this simple style; but pub- lishers sometimes interfere with this province of art legitimate only to a typographer, and insist on the indulgence of a taste which certainly owes no allegiance to any of the laws of beauty; and the printer or stereotyper who executes the book receives credit for a title-page which he would fain utterly repudiate. We add a few hints which may assist the learner. Ist. Having divided the title into lines, and decided upon the size of type suitable for the’ principal one, begin by composing those of the second and third class, both in ascending and de- scending order. 2d. Avoid having two lines of equal length to follow or come in contact with each other. 3d. Catch-words should be set on quite a reduced scale, and proportioned ac- cording to the strength of the preceding and succeeding lines; for bold catch-words detract from the general effect of the title. 4th. Close attention should be given to those title-pages which are acknowledged to be displayed with true taste and judgment. ' Authors should endeavour to make their title-pages as con- cise as possible; for a crowded title can never be displayed with elegance or taste. CO/l/IPOSI/VG. I 3 I U1. DEDICATIONS. The dedication generally follows the title, and seldom ex- ceeds one page. It should be set in capitals and small capitals, neatly displayed. The name of the person to whom the work is dedicated should always be in capitals, and the terms, Your very humble and very obedient, &c., should be in a smaller type, and the signature or name of the author in capitals of a ' smaller size than that in which the name of the personage is printed to whom the book is dedicated. CONTENTS. The contents follow the preface or introduction, and may be set either in Roman or Italic, generally two sizes smaller than the body of the work; the first line of each summary full, and the rest indented an em quadrate, with the referring figures justified at the ends of the respective lines. PREFACES. Formerly, the preface was uniformly set in Italic ;_ at present Roman is used, one size larger or smaller than the body of the work. The running title to the preface is commonly set in the same manner as that of the body of the work. If the work has been printed without a running title, and paged in the centre of the line only, then the preface should be treated in like manner. SI'GNATURING. The title, preface, &c. of a volume are commonly left till the body of the work is finished, as circumstances may arise in the course of its progress through the press which will induce the author to alter his original preface, date, &c., or the work may conclude in such a manner as to admit of their being brought in at the end, in order to fill out a sheet, and thus save both paper and press-work. For this reason, it is well to begin the first sheet of every work with signature B (or 2), leaving A (or 1) for the title-sheet. It was formerly the custom to omit the letters J, V, and W in the list of signatures. But the greater convenience attend- ing the use of twenty-five letters has recently induced several of our largest establishments to omit the letter] only. .1‘ 1 36 COAIPOS/NG. ERRATA. The errata are put immediately before the body of the work, or at the end of it. They should consist only of such cor- rections as are indispensably necessary, without noticing any defects in the punctuation, unless where the sense is perverted. It is strongly to he wished that works could be produced per- fectly free from errors; but this is almost a vain hope while imperfection clings to humanity, and while every form is ex- posed to accident and every additional proof may be produc- tive of fresh error. HINTS HONOURED IN THE BREACH. HEN you lay a fount of new type, don’t open the papers carefully, and place the lines evenly with a brass rule in the cases, nick up; but show your skill by tumbling over each package rapidly, and bringing it down with a rush on the imposing-stone; then, roughly throwing the a’s into a chaotic pile, grab them up by handfuls and work them well down in the appropriate box. The harder you jostle them down, the more you will get in. Proceed thus with each letter; and, if the operation has been vigorously performed, the value of the fount will have been reduced, say ten per cent. 2. While you set out one case, let your galley lie on the overheaped type of another case. 3. If a line is rather too tight to permit the last letter to get in easily, push it down hard with your rule or a quadrate. The type may be injured; but why didn’t it fit in just right at first? 4. Empty your matter at a gentle inclination on the galley, and make it up at the same angle. You can bring it right afterward—perhaps—by the energetic application of mallet, shooting-stick, and planer. 5. When the case is half set out, shake up the type ener- getically, and do so very often. The exercise will strengthen your muscles. 6. Don’t brush off the stone before you lay the matter down. If any sand happens to get under, the type will show its im- pression beautifully deep and clear on the face of the planer, ——perhaps a whole word or two. TO THE APPKENTICE. I37 7. Don’t plane till the form is locked up, as thus you save the trouble of the first planing. But, now that you do plane, hammer away, and show your musical ability in playing a tattoo on the form. Don’t lay the planer tenderly and lovingly on the types, as if you were afraid to hurt their feelings, and gently tap it; but hold it off about a quarter or three-eighths of an inch, and then bring down the mallet with a will. Phew! how the planer will descend obedient to the stroke, and re- bound again, and perhaps again. If the form is not smooth on the surface now, it is not your fault. Repeat this each time when the form is locked up, till it goes to press; and you may depend on it the impression will gain in boldness, if not in looks. 8. When correcting your numerous errors, don’t trouble yourself to lift the lines carefully at the ends, but dig right into the head of the erring letter, and, resting your bodkin on the type below it, pry up the sinner: it does not matter if you de- molish two or three types in the under line. 9. Wash your form energetically, and apply the ley bounti- fully with a good stiiT wiry brush. Never mind rinsing: clean type is an old-fogy notion. 10. When the type is out of use, let it lie around promis- cuously,——on a table, or board, or any place where it will be occasionally convenient to lay on it a mallet or tin basin. If one strip of matter is placed on another, room will be econo- mized. Moreover, the under layers will be safe from dust. 11 (comprehensively). Do every thing in a loose way gene— rally, letting matters go as they list, throwing your pi into spare boxes or secretly placing it on the letter-table or some out-of- the-way place, stealing sorts from your neighbour, overcharg- ing time-work and extras, fishing for fat takes, &c. 12. If you observe these things faithfully and constantly, and your employer does not kick you out of his office, why-— you do not get your deserts. TO THE APPRENTICE. ASPIRING apprentice, a word or two in your ear. If you desire success in any matter pertaining to this life or the coming, you must have a purpose,—a determination that, God helping you, you will achieve success. You may be poor, 12*- I 38 T 0 THE A PPA’ENY ‘ICE . friendless, unknown,——your clothing scant, your stomach half filled,—your place may be at the foot of the ladder: no matter. Whatever your position may be, do your duty in it, stoutly and perseveringly, with your eye fixed far ahead and upward. Keeping the purpose before you that you will rise, be obe- dient to your employer, attentive to your business, obliging to your shopmates, and courteous to strangers; and seize every opportunity to improve your heart, your mind, and your work- manship. D0 every thing well,—no slighting, no hiding de- fects, aiming always at perfection. Watch those who are skilful, and strive to equal and excel them. Secure the friend- ship of all by deserving it. Allow no opportunity of rendering a service to pass without improving it, even if it cost you some labour and self—denial. Be of use to others, even if in a small way; for a time may come when they may be of service to you. A selfish man may get ahead faster than you; but selfishness is contemptible,-—and you need not envy his success: when you achieve your object nobly, you will enjoy it, and be re- spected. Always bear in mind that character is capital. To gain this, you must be so scrupulously honest that you would be as willing to put live coals in your pocket as a penny that is not yours. Never run in debt: do without what you cannot at once pay for, even though you should suffer somewhat. No matter what the amount of your earnings may be, save a portion every week, and invest it in a savings-bank of good standing: it will grow, and will stand you in good stead some day. Bet- ter temporary abstinence and constant plenty afterward, than unearned present comfort and future perpetual want. Never lie, openly or covertly, by word or action. A liar may deceive his fellows,—-God and himself never. Conscious of falsity, a liar can have no self-respect; without self-respect, reputation cannot be achieved. With a noble purpose as the end of all your actions, and with actions becoming your purpose, your success is merely a question of time,—always provided you have some brain and abundant common sense. TO BEGIA’A’ERS. 139 TO BEGINNERS. ANGUINE beginners sometimes fail in their attempts to establish themselves in business; and in many cases are disposed to lay the blame on every thing and on everybody except themselves. So we here give some rules—(in an ironi- cal way, to make them stick in the memory)— HOW NOT TO SUCCEED. I. GET from your father, uncle, aunt, grandmother, or some- body, four or five thousand dollars. You need not give notes or any written obligations, as they may prove troublesome some day. 2. Rent a comfortable room somewhere, no matter whether in a business centre or not, but let it be showy and pleasant. 3. Spend one-fourth of your capital in furnishing the room with matters of personal comfort. Provide an elegant desk, a luxurious lounge, and a pivot-chair: why shouldn’t the mas- ter of a printing oflclce “take it easy”? Have a closet in your desk, it is so handy for your whisky-bottle and cigar-boxes. 4. Get all you can from the type-founder, press—maker, and paper-manufacturers. If they will give you credit for one-half of what you buy, well and good: if they trust you for the whole amount, all the better for you, and the more money you will have on hand for jollifications. 5. Put up your sign—a handsome one— 3 (simian gtummnflt, :Q'rilttfit. and signalize its erection by keeping “open house” for all comers between II A. M. and midnight. The mothers and wives of all who become tight and go home loose will long remember your public spirit. 6. Be at your oflice by nine in summer and ten in winter; and, following Charles Lamb’s witticism, that he who goes to work late should quit early, you need not return after dinner. Let your foreman attend to the business: isn’t he paid for it? 7. When you do go into your office, curse and grumble 140 T0 BEGL/VA/ERS. promiscuously, and be sure to swear at the apprentices, to show your spirit, and to let them know that you are master. Be careful never to praise them or any of the hands, or they may think they are worth higher wages. 8. Take work at any price that will keep it from a compe- titor, no matter whether it pays or not. Perhaps you can save something by giving short numbers, counting in imperfect copies, using very common ink, &c. The style is of no con- sequence: you want to make money if you can, let others improve the typographical art if they choose. 9. Cultivate the acquaintance of fancy folk, politicians, and wit-livers. A fast horse or two wouldn’t be a bad thing to bind their friendship; and, besides, you will never be at a loss for a companion in your rides. 10. If you want new type, and the founder who made your outfit won’t sell to you unless you pay off the old score, trans- fer your patronage to another foundry. How can you expect to get along if you pay your debts? Such a course would compel you to sell your horse and to taboo rum-shops and gay saloons, and to live economically; and this, you know, wouldn’t do at all. 11. Get out a newspaper, and advocate the principles of the strongest party, swearing thick and thin through every thing. You need not bother yourself about writing original matter; crib wherever you can. There are plenty of fellows who want ofiice,-—lawyers particularly,—and they will write slang enough to fill your columns. You might quietly levy a little black—mail or hush-money from neighbours guilty of indiscretions: dirty money will buy as much as clean. 12. You needn’t marry, unless some fond rich girl should happen to fancy a fool. You know, you need not trouble your- self much about her after you have secured her money: let her father look after her welfare. If she dies broken-hearted, why—she ought not to have been so sensitive. 13,. You may be troubled occasionally by a qualm of con- science; but this can be settled by a dram or two. After a few doses, conscience will go to sleep, and trouble you no more, unless you should happen to see a Bible or hear a sermon, which as a matter of course you will try to avoid. It is true, wreck and ruin will be sure to overtake you, and the devil will catch you at last; but why worry yourself before the time? IMPOSING, OR PREPARING FOR PRESS. llllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllll'llllllll‘ llllllllllllllllll ' 'l!"°P ‘"4" 3° "llfl my‘ y-ninflw puuwoyqqc (‘q Sum 05 \uqq'poojomouuv Oluqn 0|" "0 1n wilzllm all‘ 30 .IOMOd up u! puu ‘p101 on“ u! Huona oq 'utuquuq Am 'Iuuuld OI - tum um.“ uuosJudjopodwi rump a! minim: :uouxoq n! |q0n|n “plum moi win :lm 'nounniuguowonu flugwoq -.i _ 'uimpoiunuliugqwuiuu oqwp 'n-Hwui 0;‘ ‘pay 5 'ooq .io pu all .mqwqu ‘p.10’! or“ J0 0.1500 -01 cu uuqvauuis m.“ 'anaup L 'Li SNVISHIIJH l I. 8 EPIIESIANS VI. 12 For we Wrestle not nguimt flmlh and blood, but against principalities, Igmvmuowumngmmt n rulura ol tho darkness of thin worldmuainntlpiritunl mchodno.“ in gh cu. \Vhornl‘oro In 2 unto to withnlnnd in thouvildny, and having done all, to stand. N Stand therefore. hi“- lng your loina gin about. with truth, and having on llllllllilllllllllllllfillE-f- .Wlllllllllllllllilllllllllllllllllllllllllllllfill i1 .ulllllllllllllllllllll IMPOSITION umn Km: Sui!“ poo! Jan warm» "in Suiaoug 3 :uau! 0: 10“ pan ‘9101 aqua Iv ‘datum “so? u!» M8 an.“ L zuwaq 9'" “1°13 P°0 3° ll!M “.1 Sump ‘mxqa Jo stuns» eipw'inq :uuuqdmemw ‘saunas-910 in!» 10K 9 :15! Down in ‘uwq .inotjomuolzlup ui‘fluuqman puunzaj qua quoipoqo aq ‘nutmeg 1; 'IA SRVISHUJH 9 lllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllIi _.—_1 E llllllllllllllllllllllll lllllli l‘mhq-i and mother; which in th» first cu'mmaudmunl with pro- mhu: 3 Thu. It. may be well wilhihemund thoumuyest live long on tho earth. 4 And, ye I'nlheni, pro- woke not your childu-n to wrath: but. bring them up in the manure and admo- nition of the Lord. 5 l lllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllllillllllllllllllllllll OM PR EHENDS a knowledge of placing the pages so that they may regularly follow each other when printed and the sheet is folded up; and also the mode of dressing chases and the manner of making the proper margin. As manypages as are required for a whole or half sheet being made up, the compositor lays them upon the imposing— stone, placing the first page with the signa- ture to the left hand facing him, and then proceeds according to one of the schemes on pp. 150—199. These will be found to contain every necessary imposition,—viz. folios, quartos, octavos, twelves, sixteens, eighteens, twenties, twenty-fours, thirty-twos, thirty-sixes, for- ties, forty-eights, sixty—fours, seventy-twos, ninety-sixes, and one hundred and twenty—eights. for imposing from the centre, by which means the blank or Vtl e also introduce schemes 141 142 TYLVG UP PA GES. open pages may be thrown in the centre of the form, leaving the solid pages on the outside to act as bearers for the rollers, as well as for the better regulation of the impression. All odd matter, for any form, should be divided into fours, eights, twelves, and sixteens, which is the groundwork of all the impositions except the eighteens, which diflier from all the others; for instance, sixteens, twenty-fours, and thirty-twos are only octavos and twelves doubled, or twice doubled, and imposed in half sheets: for example, the sixteens are two octavos imposed on one side of the short cross; the twenty- fours are two twelves imposed on each side of the long cross; and a thirty-two is four octavos imposed in each quarter of the chase. Thus, a sheet may be repeatedly doubled. By this division, any form or sheet may be imposed, always bearing in mind that the first page of each class must stand to the left hand, with the foot of the page toward you. Having-set down the first page, then trace the remainder according to the scheme which applies to its number; in proof of which, the standard rule for all other impositions may be adopted,—-namely, the folios of two pages, if placed properly beside each other, will when added together make one more than the number of pages in the sheet; that is, in a sheet of sixteens, pages I and 16 coming together will add up I7, and so 9 and 8 will make 17, &c. In half sheets, all the pages belonging to the white paper, and reiteration, are imposed in one chase. So that when a sheet of paper is printed on both sides with the same form, that sheet is cut in two in the short cross if quarto or octavo, and in the short and long cross of twelves, and folded as octavo or twelves. TYING UP PAGES. N tying up a page, use fine twine, winding it four or five times round it, and fastening at the right-hand corner, by thrusting a noose of it between the several turnings and the matter with the rule, and drawing it perfectly tight, taking care always to keep the end of the cord on the face of the page. While tying it, keep the forefinger of the left hand tight on the corner, to prevent the page from being drawn aside. The twine being fastened, the compositor removes the page from the ledges of the galley, to see if the turns of cord lie LA YING PAGES. 143 about the middle of the shank of the letter ; if they lie too high, ——as most commonly they do,—he thrusts them lower; and if the page be not too broad, he places the fore and middle finger of his right hand on the offside of the head of the page, and his thumb on the near; then, bending his other fingers under, he presses them firmly against the head of the page; he next places the fingers of his left hand in the same position at the foot of the page, and, raising it upright, lays it on a page— paper; then, with his right hand he grasps the sides of the page and the paper, which turns up against the sides of the page, and sets it in a convenient spot under his frame, placing it on the left hand, with the foot toward him, that the other pages that are in like manner set down afterward may stand by it in an orderly succession until he comes to impose them. If the page be a quarto, folio, or broadside, it is, of course, too wide for his grasp; and he therefore carries the galley and page to the imposing-stone, and turns the handle of the galley toward him, and, taking hold of the handle with his right hand, he places the ball of the thumb of his left hand against the inside of the head ledge of the galley, to hold it and keep it steady, and by the handle draws the slice with the page upon it out of the galley, letting the slice rest upon the im- posing-stone; he then thrusts the head end of the slice so far upon it, that the foot of the page may stand an inch or two within the outer edge of the stone, and, placing his left hand against the foot of the page, he quickly draws the slice from under the bottom of the page. LAYING PAGES. N taking up his pages for imposition, the compositor tightly grasps the paper on both sides of the page, in order that it may be kept firm to the bottom of the page; for if it be left slack, the letters will be liable to slip out, unless it be par- ticularly well tied up. Having conveyed it to the stone, he next places the last two fingers of his right hand under the head of the page, but not under the page-paper at the head of it, still grasping the sides with his forefingers and thumb; he then slips his left hand so that the palm of it may turn toward the bottom, and, lifting the page upright on his right hand, 1 44 MAX/N0 UP FURNITURE. with the left he removes the paper; he next grasps again the foot-end of the page with his left hand, in the same manner as the right holds the head of it, and, turning the face of the type toward him, lays it squarely and quickly down, so that the whole page may come in contact with the face of the stone at the same time. As this method, in inexperienced or careless hands, would frequently endanger a page containing intricate matter, it will be safer to place the pages at first on good, strong, but not coarse and rough papers, and, when they are brought to the stone, instead of lifting them up as just noticed, slide them off the papers in the same manner as before directed respecting a folio page on the slice galley, being careful that no particles- of dirt remain under the page. MAKING UP FURNITURE. AVING ascertained that his pages are laid down right, the compositor proceeds to dress the chases, which we will suppose to be for a sheet of octavo. Accordingly he selects a good pair of chases that are fellows in all respects; and, having laid them over the pages for the two different forms, he puts such gutter-sticks between page and page, and such reglets along the sides of the two crosses, as will give the book proper margins after it is bound. To ascertain the proper distance, and to prevent wastage of furniture, he takes short pieces of furniture, or quotations, and quadrates or reglets, to fit the space between two pages; then, pushing the pages close to them, he finds the exact width of the furniture necessary, by trying the ends of various pieces, always measuring from the edge of the lines of type above the page-cords. By observing a proper method in cutting up new furniture, the same will be serviceable for other works as well as the one for which it is intended, even though the size of the page may differ, provided it agrees with the margin of the paper. The gutters should be cut two or three lines longer than the page; the head—sticks wider; the back furniture may run nearly down to the rim of the chase, but must be level with the top of the page, which will admit of the inner head-stick running MAKHVG THE jl/[Aft’GZ/V. I45 in; the difference of the outer head-stick may go over the side-stick, and the gutter will then run up between them. The side-stick only need to be cut exact, and the furniture will completely justify. Wood and metal furniture, cut or cast to specific lengths and widths, may now be had from the type-founders, the use of which will save time, waste, and labour. MAKING THE MARGIN. HE next business is to arrange the margin, so that each page may occupy one side of a leaf, and have the proper proportion of white paper left at the sides as well as at the head and foot. The page when printed should be a little higher than the middle of the leaf, and have a little more margin on the outside than in the back. This rule is often neglected by careless or ignorant printers, and the appearance of the book when bound is repulsive to the eye of taste. One mode of making margin is the following :—F or octavos, measure and mark the width of four pages by compasses, on a sheet of paper designed for the work, beginning to measure at one extremity of the breadth of the sheet. The rest of the paper divide into four equal parts, allowing two-fourths for the width of two separate gutter~sticks; the remaining two- fourths divide again into four equal parts, and allow one-fourth for the margin along each side of the short cross, and one- fourth for the margin to each outside page. But as the thick- ness of the short cross adds considerably to the margin, reduce the furniture in the back accordingly, and thereby enlarge the outside margin, which requires the greatest share to allow for the unevenness of the paper itself, as well as for pressmen laying sheets unevenly when the fault is not in the paper. Having thus made the margin between the pages to the breadth of the paper, in the same manner proportion the mar~ gin at the head to the length, and accordingly measure and mark the length of two pages, dividing the rest into four parts, one-fourth of which is allowed for each side of the long cross, and one-fourth for the margin that runs along the foot of the two ranges of pages. The furniture on both sides of the long one must be lessened to enlarge the bottom margin, for the reason assigned for extending the side margin. 13 1 46 MAKYNG THE MAE 011v. Go the same way to work in twelves, where, for the outer margin along the foot of the pages, allow the amount of two- thirds of the breadth of the head-sticks, and the same for the inner margin, that reaches from the foot of the fifth page to the centre of the groove for the points; and from the centre of that groove to the pages of the quire, or the cut off, allow half of the breadth of the head—stick. The margin along the long cross is governed by the gutter—sticks; and it is common to put as much on each side of the long cross as amounts to. half the breadth of the gutter-stick, without deducting almost any thing for the long cross, since that makes allowance for the inequality of the outer margin. Another plan, more simple, is the following :———Having laid the pages as nearly as possible in their proper places on the stone, with a suitable chase around them, fold a sheet of paper which has been wetted for the work, or one of the same size, into as many portions as there are pages in the form, and, holding the sheet thus folded on the first or left-hand page of the form, one edge even with the left-hand side of the type, place the adjoining page so that its left side may be even with the right-hand edge of the folded paper, which will leave a sufficient space between the two pages to admit the gutter- stick, which should then be selected of a proper width- to suit the form in hand, as follows :——In octavos, about a Great Primer less in width than the space between the pages, as determined by the above rule; in duodecimos, about a Pica less; in sixteens, about a Long Primer; and proportionably less as the number of pages are increased. Having thus secured the proper width for the gutter-sticks, cut them somewhat longer than the page, and holding one of them be- tween the two pages, above the page-cord, close the pages up to it; then open the folded sheet so as to cover the two pages, and, bringing the fold in the paper exactly in the middle of the gutter-stick, secure it there with the point of a pen-knife or bodkin; the right-hand edge of the paper thus opened must be brought to the centre of the cross-bar, which determines the furniture required between it and the pages. Having thus arranged the margins for the back and fore edge of the book, proceed in like manner to regulate the head and foot margins, by bringing the near edge of the folded paper even with the bottom of the first page, and so placing the adjoining off page LOCKING UP FORMS. I47 that its head may be barely covered by the off edge of the folded paper, which will give the required head margin. All other sections of the form must be regulated by the foregoing measurements, when the margins for the whole sheet will be found correct. The greater the number of pages in a sheet, the smaller in proportion should the margin be: the folded paper, therefore, should lie proportionally less over the edge of the adjoining page, both for gutter and back, in a form of small pages than in one of larger dimensions. A folio may require the page to be half an inch nearer the back than the fore-edge; while a duodecimo may not require more than a Pica em. In imposing jobs where two or more of the same size, re- quiring equal margins, are to be worked together, fold the paper to the size appropriate for each, and so arrange the type that the distance from the left side of one page to the left side of the adjoining one shall be exactly equal to the width of the folded paper, as before described. Having dressed the inside of the pages, next place side- and foot-sticks to their outsides; being thus secured by the furni- ture, untie the pages, quarter after quarter, the inner page first, and then the outer, at the same time forcing the letter toward the crosses, and using every precaution to prevent the pages from hanging or leaning; and, in order to guard against accidents, when the quarter is untied, secure it with a couple of quoins. LOCKING UP FORMS. FIRST, carefully examine whether the pages of each quar- ter are of the same length; for even the difi‘erence of a lead will cause them to hang. Test their exactness: place the ball of each thumb against the centre of the foot—stick, raising it a little with the pressure, and, if the ends of both pages rise equally with the stick, it is a proof they will not bind; then fit quoins between the side and foot-stick of each quarter and the chase. After pushing the quoins as far as possible with the fingers, make use of the mallet and shooting-stick, and gently drive the quoins along jthe foot-sticks first, and then those along the side-sticks, taking care to use an equal force in the strokes, and to drive the quoins far enough up the shoulders 1 48 MEMORANDA. of the side- and foot-sticks, that the letter may neither belly out nor hang, and the lines he kept straight and even. Quoins should be slanted on one side only, but the edges should not be bevelled. The several quarters of a form should be par- tially tightened before either quarter is finally locked up; otherwise the cross—bar may be sprung. Before locking up the form, plane the pages gently over all the face. If this be properly done, a second planing is hardly necessary, provided the justification is perfect and the pages are all of the same length. But, as this is seldom the case, the second planing can hardly be dispensed with. It often occurs that the quoins, when locked up wet, stick so tight to the furniture as to render it troublesome to unlock them: in such cases, drive the quoin up a little, and it after- ward unlocks with ease. \ Before lifting a form after it is locked up, raise it gently a short distance, and look under it, to ascertain whether any types are disposed to drop out. If all is right, carry it to the proof—press, and pull a good proof. Then rub it over gently with a ley-brush, rinse it well, and place it in a rack, and deliver the proof, with the copy, to the proof-reader. MEMORANDA. ACH part of the furniture should be in one piece where it is practicable,——as, for instance, the gutters, the backs, and the heads; but sometimes pieces will he wanted of a width that is not equal to any regular size, and then two must be used. All the gutters of one sheet should be cut of a precise length; so also with the backs and the heads; but each sort should be of a different length from that of the others: thus they can be easily distinguished from eaCh other, and mistakes be prevented. The sheet being imposed, the stone should be cleared; the saw and saw-block put in their places, the shears, the mallet, planer, and shooting-stick, the surplus furniture, the leads, the quoins, and every other article. The compositor will tie up his page-cords, and, if he has any companions, will return to them their proportion. ' The chase and furniture of one form should always be used NOMENCLA TURE 0F SIJEE TS. 149 for a similar form; that is, the chase and furniture of the outer form should be again used for an outer form, and the chase ’ and furniture of the inner form should be again used for an inner form; they should also be put round the pages in the same order in which they were put about those of the pre- ceding forms. For want of care or thought in these apparently trifling circumstances, trouble, inconvenience, and loss of time frequently occur; for the register will be almost sure to be wrong when this is neglected, and then the forms must be unlocked and the leads changed, to correct the fault. The preceding rules and directions were intended for type- forms, and were formerly of universal necessity. Now most books are printed from stereotyped or electrotyped plates. The same instructions, however, are generally as applicable to plate as to type pages. NOMENCLATURE OF SHEETS. HEN a sheet of paper of Medium or larger size is folded in two leaves, like most newspapers, it is called a folio ,- when folded in four leaves, it is named a quarto or 4to; when folded in eight leaves, an octavo or 8210; in twelve leaves, a a’uoa’eeimo or Jzmo; in sixteen leaves, sextozteeimo or 16mo ,- in eighteen leaves, oetodeeimo or 181120; in twenty-four leaves, oigesimo-quarto, or 24mo, and so on. The Latin names beyond duoa'eeimo are seldom used. [MPOS] T 1 01V. Abstract Title-Deeds of Estates. 1 Abstract Title- Deeds of Estates are printed with blanks at the back, with all the margin on the left side, and on single leaves, which are stitched together at the corner. This method of im- posing the form is to save presswork and the compositor's charge. ‘an H001 LOCK UP. A Single Sheet of Folio. INNER OUTER I FORM. FORM. IMPOSITIO'IV. 15 I Two Sheets of Folio, QIIII‘GII, or lying one in another. Outer Form of the Outer Sheet. 1 ' 8 Outer Form of the Inner Sheet. 3 I 6 A2 Imposing in quires may be carried to any extent, by observing the following rule z—first ascertain the number of pages, then divide them into so many sheets of folio, and commence laying down the first two and last two, which form the first sheet, and so on to the centre one, always remembering that the odd pages stand on the left and the even on the right; the folios of each two forming one more than the num- ber of pages in the work: for example, let us suppose the work to consist of thirty-six pages, which is nine sheets of folio, then they should be laid down according to the scheme at the foot of the oppo- site page. 152 IMPOSZTIOZV. Two Sheets of Folio, Quired, or lying one in another. Inner Form of the Outer Sheet. 7 l 2 l I'n/ner Form of the Inner Sheet. 5 4 | H H H E a a 2 e U. E s m .94 .9 Ff .94 .93 if 8 ii 5 I 36 35 2- m 3 34 33 4. 2d 5 32 31 6- 3d 7 3o 29 8, 4th 9 28 27 10, 5th 11 26 25 12, 6th 13 24 23 14, 7th 15 22 21 16, 8th 17 20 19 18, 9th The furniture must be reduced in the backs of the inner sheets, to allow for stitching. IMPOSITION I53 A Sheet of Common Quarto. f’ 9 1 8 A Outer Form. A Sheet of Quarto, the Broad Way, commonly used in Works of Music. I’ 9 l 8 l l 1 5 4 [MP 051 TION. A Sheet of Common Quarto. Imae'r Form. A Sheet of Quarto, the Broad Way, commonly used in Works of Music. Inner For'm. [MPOS] T 1 01V. I55 Two Half-Sheets of Quarto, worked together. Outer Form. Half a. Sheet of Common Quarto. 1 5 6 IMPOSITZON. Two Half-Sheets of Quarto, worked together. Z Inner Form. Half 2. Sheet of Quarto, the Broad Way. ! [MP 0S1 T 1 01V. Outer Form of 2. Sheet of Common Octavo. Outer Form of 2. Sheet of Octave, the Broad Way. 14 [.(l/LPOS] T 1 01V. Inner Form of a Sheet of Common Octavo. OI 3 14 Inner Form of a Sheet of Octave, the Broad Way. 15 GI 10 II 14 [111F051 T 1 01V. I59 Outer Form of Two Half-Sheets of Common Octave, worked together. Half a Sheet of Common Cotevo. I60 JM'POSITZOZV. Inner Form of Two Half-Sheets of Common Oetavo, worked together. Two Quarters of a. Sheet of Octave, worked together. 81 IMPOSITION Outer Form of at Sheet of Octavo, 12 of the Work, and 4 of other Matter. Z 8 8 9 l 12 9 4 A l Outer Form of 2. Sheet of Octavo, of Hebrew Work. = I 14s‘- I 62 [MPOSJT/OJV. Inner Form of a Sheet of Octave, 12 of the Work, and 4 of other Matter. Z 9 z. r I 3 10 11 2 Inner Form of a Sheet of Octave, of Hebrew Work. [111]’ OS] 7 '1 0A’. ‘Outer Form of 21 Sheet of Octave, Imposed from the Centre. 81 9 8 6 l3 4 1 16 A Half-Sheet of Cotevo, Imposed from the Centre. [.IIIPOSITIO/V. Inner Form of 21 Sheet of Octave,’ Imposed from the Centre. OI L 9 II Two Quarters of 3. Sheet of Octave, Imposed from the Centre. ZflZFYZSZYYTIAZ 165 0&8. FEB a a. $52 a. 88%;? :52. FEB a a. mg; a. Hiram. NH mH N< RH om w» ow @H @H w mm wH w mm mm 166 [filfWZSfYUQDAh > $53 om @523. figs: 23%. mo H4 m Hm @H m we Hm Hm q Hm Hm oH @H mm HH H» ww some. H.033. H333. H63? JJIPTZSZYYZlAC I67 ON Ha $55»; > 252 a @573? .3? Hi mfiggam. bH NH m< Hw H633. H333; Hug. wH mm mm @H w Hm oH b m we Hm w 168 [JIIPOS] T 1 01V. > 9888 memimga a 652%. m N. w w m OH H 5 : memlmga OH 68.5%. Egg 83%. w w Q Q >w a. a S m. H 5 E w > [MPOS] T 1 01V. 169 v5.35 55% OH HEHOmEm mezvmgaa OH Hiram. HEB ES 952. N< c N. w m. < NH H m HH w RH w Ho 2 N< 5 I5 170 JMPOSITIOZV. > mga ow H.833. Féomg M86 as 958. m... a m NH 2 3 3 2 ma on m w 5 wH A w 2 mm m H we. ww m w mm [MPOS] T 1 01V. 171 Outer Form ‘of a Sheet of Long Twelves. > H <14 r—l 00 CD !—1 (N ‘D v-l 00 l!) H O \‘l N w |-4 ,4; (N One—third, or 8 pages, of at Sheet of Twelves. To be imposed as a slipl or in ‘the off-cross. 1 ‘ 8 5 4 A Outer _ Form. I 7 2 [111F051 T] 01V. Inner Form of at Sheet of Long Twelves. CO 01 H to p-Ps 1—! t—4 o t—1 1—1 05 l\ H 00 <0 r—i R3 S One-third, or 8 pages, of 21. Sheet of Twelves. To be imposed as a slip, or in the off-cross. 3 6 7 2 A2 In/ner [ll/[130$] T 1 01V. I7.3 Has memimgsa SH H.575. 835A Smears" Nm N< SN 5 N NE 2 SS». @633. NH HH HSSS. H343. 15*- 174 [MPOSITIOM mavwgg OH Hiram. 3% w wwmeifiam. # momma 0H 0.26.. 32.8... .» memlmga a. Enema. m m w H He m. w m H w H w m @H H .H Ho 5.. w @ NH H Hm Hm > JfllfNDSYYYTlAZ I75 P 253 &. muggy 3% 9; @5588. H333. Macias. $223. M533. w ma ww m Hw mo NH Hm wH bH *m m H mm mm m > w hm om m HH mm H@ H» oH mm @H @H q mm wH w IALPOSIYYOAZ A Half-Sheet of Eighteensfi" Containing 16 pages. at :2 I: ZI 9 :I: :- 9 II I7 SI 8 6 II 8 1 16 7 10 15 2 A I A. Half-Sheet of Eighteensm er I III 9 OI 6 9 SI f QI ZI L 9T 8 1 18 11 8 17 2 (1) The white paper of this half-sheet being worked off, the centre pages must be transposed,—viz. pages 7 and 10 in the room of 9 and 8, and pages 9 and 8 in the place of 7 and 10: when this is done, your imposition will be true. (2)\Vhen the white paper is worked off, transpose the form,——viz. pages 11 and 8 in the room of 7 and 12, and pages 7 and 12 in the place of II and 8: this being done, the sheet will then fold up right. [WITQZS/YYTZAC Outer Form of 2. Sheet of Eighteons, to be folded together. 5 32 29 8 17 20 f 88 88 6 9I I6 1 36 25 12 13 24 A l Outer Form of 3. Sheet of Eightcons, with One Signature. OI LZ 98 II OZ LI iUMQPCZSIYDQDAK Inner Form of a Sheet of Eighteens, to be folded together. 19 18 7 30 31 6 38 91 01 AZ f8 8 23 14 11 26 35 2 Inner Form of a Sheet of Eighteens, with One Signature. I r 81 6T 81 98 88 6 91 18 9 I8 08 L 13 24 3 34 35 2 A3 [1UP OS] T [ 01V. 179 Outer Form of 21. Sheet of Eighteens, with Two Signatures. gv ZI 81 91 6 .6 8 L1 OZ 9 6 1 24 21 4 12 A Outer Form of 3. Sheet of Eighteens, with Three Signatures. 9 L IA HA 4 T7 6 A! 6 6 1 12 i 12 122 A B 18o [MPOSJTIOM Inner Form of a Sheet of Eighteens, with Two Signatures. ZEI 8 9 CI 9I IYI I I 0T 6’ 9 6 I 8 I L 11 e 3 22 23 2 a2 I Inner Form of a Sheet of Eighteens, with Three Signatures. 60 l W 5v 8’ 9’ IIIA A 8 9 OZ 5‘ OZ Ill CI 8 11 2 11 ii 1 1 2 JWITYZSIYYCDVI 181 A Half-Sheet of Eightoens, without Transposition“) A Half-Sheet of Twenties, with Two Signatures. 0 3v 9 L 8I LI 8 9 V 6 9I QI OI 8 1 12 13 I4 11 2 A n I (‘)This mode of imposition is very objectionable, as there will be, when the paper is cut up, three single leaves. u: N \‘1~ i 01 09 (N 00 lo 00 8 ‘:1 ‘Q <0 *1 co E} (S Q‘: Ob it; H <1 16 182 LMPOSITIOZV. Inner Form of a Sheet of Twenties. 3 <0 E 2 N S 58 es g S 83 21 S S S <7; 1\ t; S to Outer Form of a Sheet of Twenties. f1 00 I e’? 91‘. v .52 S ‘68 8% 5 e is a S 3 s “v ‘A’ I 3 c» r-H [MP OS! T [ OZV. A Half-Sheet of Twenty-Fours. zv I 51 81 91 6 01 9'1 171 11 8 L1 OZ 9 9 61 81 L 1 24 21 4 3 22 23 2 A Outer Form of at Sheet of Twenty-Fours, with Two Signatures. zv ‘ ga 81 81 91 6 98 L8 017 88 8 L1 OZ 9 ZS 11" W 66 1 24 21 4 25 48 45 28 A B I 84 [JIIPOSITIO/V. A Half-Sheet of Twenty-Fours, the Sixteen-way. ZV Z 88 38 8 9I 6 7 18 19 6 13 12 8 LI OZ 9 II II 1 24 21 4 15 10 A Inner Form of a Sheet of Twenty-Fours, with Two Signatures. I78 68 88 98 OI GI PI ()8 8T? ZIY I8 9 6I 8T 27 46 47 26 3 22 23 IMPOSITION A Half-Sheet of Twenty-Fours, without Inset. Z SI OI L 81 88 3 14 11 6 19 22 T? ‘(II 81 9 OZ 1'6 1 16 9 8 17 24 A A2 A Half-Sheet of Twenty-Fours, without Inset. | av 88 E8 61' 08 [Z FZ L1 6 ET 9 9 H O[ L _ 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 16'?‘ I86 IMPOSITIOZV. 1 A Half—Sheet of Twenty-Fours, without Cutting. 520178‘718196 zv 'A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Twas. t 68 88 9 9 L8 08 8 13 20 21 12 11 22 19 14 A6 91 L1 ‘[78 6 CI - 88 8T 91 [MPOSZTZOM Outer Form of a Sheet of Thirty—Twos. A . Outer Form of a Sheet of Thirty-Twos, with Four Signatures. i 40 T? 19 98 OZ 8% L8 09 9 13 52 45 2O 21 44 53 12 A7 91 617 817 L1 173 H7 99 6 l 64 33 32 25 57 8 | O 09 ' 89 '59 19 98 91’ 81' 88 55 58 59 54 37 44 41 4O 8 6 Z1 9 ‘ZZZ L8 98 SZ 1 16 13 4 19 3O 31 18 188 jUMQDCLSIYYZlAZ Inner Form of a Sheet of Thirty-Twos. 9 69 88 L8 08 98 Z9 8 11 54 43 22 19 46 51 14 OI 99 Z? 88 8I LP 09 9I 7 58 39 26 31 34 63 2 Inner Form of a Sheet of Thirty-Twos, with Four Signatures. (1 6? I8 L? 9? 98 89 I9 I9 39 42 43 38 53 60 57 56 13 93 88 IZ 9 II OI L 17 32 29 2O 3 14 15 2 B l [MPOS] T 1 01V. A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Twos, with Two Signatures. I a 81 18 08 61 03 6'6 '58 L1 23 26 27 22 21 28 25 24 8 6 H 9 9 11 01 L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 A I A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Twos, 20 pages of the Work, 4 pages of Title, &c., and 8 of other Matter. | Q a 81 61 Z A 8 I 08 L1 1 iv 3 6 5 4 iii ii 9. b2 8 6 81 9 9 11 01 L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 A 190 [.MPOSJTION. , A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Sixes. I> I—-‘ oo 2 I <0 \1 N oo o: b w o: no 0: m N 00 o co oo 01 <0 N) w ‘H 00 00 N 01 I-—' co I-P to Z 5 o: co to N O I—l w :14 00 (N (N co I—-\ o] j-i 1Q [\ H 1''‘ CO #- H v—l I oo o: H A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Sixes, without Cutting. > 1-‘ ‘<4 or =0 00 N 00 v—1 00 so % 00 [009 C0 I-P co \ N) 00 to O N) :0 C21 (N co 60 \‘I (N H E o: 00 I_\ I5 H +— co I—* 00 H ‘5* oz: H \‘l 1-1 01 H v—I 0 03 oo 53 N ‘ H E N HUPOSITJOZV. 191 A Half-Sheet of Thirty-Sixes, with Two Signatures. :> H 00 a \1 or w r\ to 0: )—l e0 .p. .-4 co cs 00 01 fi 3 g $ 23 31‘ his. to a 83 a: co |--1 ‘=H N 0;, H <5 01 H co H 00 H z; :1 a: | 3 5 m ‘1 A Half-Sheet of Forties. OZ 15 175 L1 1 81 83 '65 61 5 36 33 8 7 34 35 6 91 93 85 81 171 LZ 95 91 9 32 29 12 11 3O 31 10 A2 1 4O 37 4 3 38 39 2 A 192 DUPOSITJOIV. A Quarter-Sheet of Forty-Eights, with Two Signatures. SI 88 88 GI 08 I8 18 LI 8 6 8I 9 9 II OI L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 A l ZV A Half-Sheet of Forty-Eights, with Two Signatures. 8 88 88 8 98 L17 91'? L8 7 18 19 6 31 42 43 3O 11 14 15 10 35 38 39 34 8I 8I 9I 6 98 L8 OI? 88 8 LI 08 9 88 II? II? 68 1 24 21 4 25 48 45 28 A B [AIPOSI T 1 01V. I93 A Quarter-Sheet of Forty—Eights, without Cutting. 5 2O 17 8 7 18 19 6 1 18 91 6 01 91 ZZ 8 1 24 13 12 11 14 23 2 \A A Half-Sheet of Forty-Eights, with Three Signatures. o 18 L? 9? 98 98 9? 8? 88 39 42 43 38 37 44 41 40 H 81 18 O8 61 OZ 6K Z8 L1 23 26 27 22 21 28 25 24 8 6 Z1 9 9 11 01 L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 A 194 JMPOSITIOZV. A Common Quarter-Sheet of Forty-Eights. ZV ZI at 91 e 01 91 H 11 8 1.1 oz 9 9 er st 2. 1 24 21 4 3 22 23 2 A Quarter-Sheet of Sixty-Fours, with Two Signatures. 8 SI 18 08 61 OZ 6Z Z8 LI 23 26 27 22 21 28 25 24 8 6 ZI 9 9 II CI L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 [fl/[POSITION I95 A Common Quarter-Sheet of Sixty-Fours. t ea 82 9 9 L3 02 e 13 2o 21 12 11 22 19 14 91 11 ta 6 or 22 81 91 1 32 25 s 7 2e 31 2 A i A Quarter-Sheet of Sixty-Fours, 20 pages of the Work, 8 of Title, and 4 of other Matter. I Z V 11 HA 5 8 ‘ 7 I 1114 1 iii vi 17 2O 19 18 v iv B 8 6 81 9 9 11 01 L 1 16 13 4 3 14 15 2 A [MPOSITIOM A Half-Sheet of Sixty-Fours. 3 39 178 13 93 33 3s 1 15 5o 47 13 23 42 55 10 171 19 91/ 31 33 317 179 II 3 e2 35 30 27 33 59 e 17 19 93 32; 33 13 ‘ 09 9 13 52 45 2o 21 44 53 12 91 37 37 11 173 It 99 3 1 e4 33 32 25 40 57 3 A [MPOS] TIOJV. I97 A Half-Sheet of Seventy-Twas, with Three Signatures. case was. 4N “is e. a as $88 $3 23% 533% 88 mm $8 88% 52 8% 328 5a $8 8333 :2 $55 a a $2 2% 8?. 01* 23$ 3%? 85 :22 e a as $3 8 a GOP-14 (D (D lsllsilsl > H5325; a. zgqtmwsm. a? we“ mwmeegam. | Is] mm mm ww 8IE] w @Q Is I | el IE1 h3 0| Le’! Ed I#__J|__||_J lelfelkl ILILiILl |E|l3lE| |__ll_ll_| b w l N l"'__l (O llelfl lellflla mm wq A» fi. #0 mm mm mw mo mq U I I W W I T W W a m mm hm mm mm mm mm mm o HH 2 A. — 5 we a _ Hm _ — HH ww — mm mo w H» Hm w l7] WWI—Ed lgllelkl U! 198 111113051 T1011’. 199 gmuw e LSILBIIEHEI tells ll Elle I l ; [TIC—1191?» | Lgllel e ifie‘llsllzllel 03¢ l-‘O 14E 5H2 9» [Tells—ll Elel www 80 C} 10 I e’ilsllilts l leilsjl 115 CO 01 2 o 1: GP 1'11 ‘5 an $01 EMHME P5 'sIlelI gH21 |... to #- 1~ I 8l loll N111] Mfifimé mwmue 11 no en es <9 P‘ c: 8': to F4 co u: on o: b‘ ca c> ca co cc an a) 55 c» . 01 on I l I »* l- \Eh’T OUT- .RKTURSED. PRESS. ! A “I u) {4 ' l I “ e 2 l 1878. 1878. 1878. 1878. j I O Q I May 2 II Decoratlve Printing _ . . . . . . May 2 May 4 May 5 “ 4 23 American Printer, (Revised Edition) “ 4 “ 5 “ 6 i “ 6 20 Specific Heat Tables . . . . . . . “ 8 “ 9 “ 9 “ 10 2 The Great Exhibition . . . . . . . “ IO “ 12 “ 13 “ 27 13 Masterpieces of European Art . . “ 29 “ 3o “ 30 i 1 This account being punctually kept, the reader can furnish the employer or overseer with an exact account of the state of each work without delay or inconvenience. After the compositors have corrected the errors in the form, a clean proof is pulled, which, with the first proof, is handed to the reader, who then collates the corrected sheet with the one before read, in order to ascertain whether the corrections hapietijbieen properly made, and whether new errors have not by negligence in the process; and, if the work be areprinffor if the author is not to examine the proof, he then proceeds to read it very carefully for press. - Some proofs are so foul, that it is almost impossible for the ~compositor to correct all the marks at one time, and it is therefore necessary to have the neglected errors corrected and another sheet pulled before the proof is read finally. It not 204 PRO OF-READZNG. unfrequently happens that compositors, in the course of cor- recting, transpose a letter or word, or alter a letter in a word that is not marked, thus not only leaving one error uncor- rected, but also making another; sometimes also, in respacing a line, a space is transposed or a hyphen is left in. Conse- quently it is absolutely necessary, in revising a proof, that the reader should not only look at the word marked, but he ought also to glance his eye over every line in which an alteration has been made. In offices where two readers are employed, it is advisable that a proof-sheet should be read over by both; because the eye, in traversing the same ground, is liable to be drawn into mistake and oversight. The interest excited by the first read- ing having abated, a degree of listlessness imperceptibly steals upon the mind, which greatly endangers the correctness of a proof. Should onts or doubles occur in a proof, it ought to be again read by copy, to detect any improper correction in the overrunning or transposition of lines. Figure work should always be read twice by copy. The duty of amending the punctuation should be generally confined to one reader. ‘Where a compositor is liable, in this particular, to the whim or Caprice of several readers, he cer- tainly suffers injustice, because his time is unnecessarily frit- tered away; and not only is the work retarded, but the types are needlessly exposed to injury, to say nothing of the liability of creating fresh errors, &c. Before a manuscript is brought to the printer, it ought to be as perfect as the author can make it. The compositor is bound to “follow the copy,” in word and sentiment, unless, indeed, he meets with instances of wrong punctuation or false gram- mar, (and such instances are not rare,) which his intelligence enables him to amend. After the matter has been read and corrected in the office, a proof is sent to the author; and, if it corresponds with the copy, the compositor’s responsibility is at an end. He has done all he is paid for; and, should the author desire any changes made in his matter, of course he must pay for them. Sentiments in print look marvellously different from the same ideas in manuscript; and. we are not surprised that writers should wish to polish a little; nor do we object to their natural desire of amending or beautifying their mental PROOF-READING. 20 5 products. But let them not forget that pay-time will come,— when the item for alterations will loom out with a startling distinctness in the bill. They found it easy in the proof to erase a word or two here and insert a word or two there; without dreaming, perhaps, that in consequence of these little erasures and insertions the compositor would be compelled to alter and reconstruct much of his work. We know of a volume on which the alterations alone have consumed time equal to one man’s work for nearly two and a half years. How unreasonable—nay, how transparently unjust—the ex- pectation that the printer should give gratuitously the time and trouble requisite for the radical changes in the type which an author’s whim or taste may demand! Stower says, “It may not be improper, in this place, just to take notice of the great danger to the correctness of a work which arises from the practice, too common with some authors, of keeping their proof-sheets too long in their hands before they are returned to the printer. As the pages in the metal get dry, the adhesion of the types to each other is weakened, and the swell or extension of the quoins and furniture, which the moisture had occasioned, is removed; so that there is great danger of letters falling out when a form is long kept from the press. Nor is the danger which is hereby occasioned to correctness the only inconvenience: the impatience of authors to see their works in a fit state for publication is almost proverbial. The pleasure arising from beholding, as it were, the ‘form and texture’ of one’s thoughts, is a sensa- tion much easier felt than described. That authors, therefore, may partake of this pleasure in a speedy and regular suc- cession, they should make a point of forwarding their proof- sheets to the printer as quick as possible, not only that they may the sooner be got ready for the press, but that the work may proceed in a regular manner, without being interrupted by the forwarding of other works in lieu of that the proof- sheets of which are detained beyond the proper time in the hands of the author. “Authors are very apt to make alterations, and to correct and amend the style or arguments of their works, when they first see them in print. This is certainly the worst time for this labour, as it is necessarily attended with an expense which, in large works, will imperceptibly swell to a serious 18 206 P16 OOF-A’EADL/VG. sum; when, however, this method of alteration is adopted by an author, the reader must always be careful to read the whole sheet over once more with very great attention before it is finally put to press. “A proof-sheet, having duly undergone this routine of pur- gation, may be supposed to be as free from errata as the nature of the thing will admit, and the word ‘Press’ may be written at the top of the first page of it. This is an important word to every reader: if he have suffered his attention to be drawn aside from the nature of his proper business, and errors should be discovered when it is too late to have them cor- rected, this word ‘Press’ is as the signature of the death- warrant of his reputation. A reader, therefore, should be a man of one business,—always upon the alert,-—all eye,—all attention. Possessing a becoming reliance on his own powers, he should never be too confident of success. Imperfection clings to him on every side. Errors and mistakes assail him from every quarter. His business is of a nature that may render him obnoxious to blame, but can hardly be said to bring him in any very large stock of praise. If errors escape him, he is justly to be censured; for perfection is his duty. If his labours are wholly free from mistake,——which is, alas! a very rare case,——he has done no more than he ought, and, conse- quently, can merit only a comparative degree of commenda- tion, in that he had the good fortune to be more successful in his labours after perfection than some of ‘his brethren in the same employment.” The form being finally laid on the press, and a revise pulled by the pressman, he sends it to the overseer, who carefully examines whether all the marks have been attended to, and looks along the sides and heads of the respective pages, to observe whether any letter has fallen out, or there is any crookedness in the locking up of the form, any battered let- ters, or any bite from the frisket. Should the revise prove faultless, he returns it to the pressman, with the word “Revise” written on the margin; if otherwise, to the compositor to whom the form belongs, for immediate correction. CORRECTING 1N TIJE METAL. 207 CORRECTING IN THE METAL. ORRECTIN G is the most disagreeable part of a composi- tor’s business, diminishing as it does his earnings, and causing great fatigue, and, by leaning over the stone, endan- gering his health. A foul proof, however, is a fault without extenuation, and seems to deserve some punishment. The noise and confusion which prevail in badly governed printing- offices, from light and frivolous conversation, not only retard business, but distract the attention of the compositor from the subject he has in hand, and cause him to make many mistakes. Some men, no doubt, can support a conversation and at the same time compose correctly; but their noise confuses those who are unable to preserve accuracy except by close attention to their copy in silence. ' The first proof should contain merely the errors of the com— positor; but it frequently happens that the corrector heightens them by his peculiarities. \Nhen this is unnecessarily done, it is an act of injustice to the compositor: it is sufficient for him to rectify such mistakes as arise either from inattention to his copy or want of judgment. The compositor ought not _ to suffer from the humour of a reader in capriciously altering commas and semicolons in the first proof, which he not unfre- quently re-alters in the second, from a doubt as to the propri- ety of the points to be adopted. \Nhen a proof is handed to the compositor, he should im- mediately correct it; and the reader, correlatively, should be equally prompt in his department. Can it reasonably be expected that the compositor will feel inclined to forward his proof, when he knows that the reader will delay it for hours? Should a compositor have transposed two or more pages, either from an error in the folios or any other cause, he must unlock the quarter containing them, and, loosening the cross or crosses from the furniture, lift the chase and the remain- ing quarters off the stone. Should he have furniture suificient round each page, he may move them into their proper stations by pressing the balls of his thumbs and fingers against the furniture at the head, foot, and sides of each page. If the letter be small, it will be advisable to wet the pages, because few imposing-stones are horizontal, or so steady that they 208 CORRECTL/VG [./V THE [VET/IL. will not shake when touched, or by the motion of the floor occasioned by persons walking or dragging forms along. Should a compositor find that his pages hang, he must un- lock the quarter, and pat the face of the type with the balls of his fingers until he gets it into a square position. When a compositor unlocks a form, he should be careful not to leave the unlocked quoins too slack, as the force neces- sary to loosen the others ‘may squabble the matter, or occasion it to hang. It has been aptly said, “l/Vhat is required of a compositor when he goes about correcting a foul proof, is a sharp bodkin and patience; because, without them, the letter cannot escape suffering by the steel, and hurrying will not permit him to justify the lines true. No wonder, therefore, to see pigeon- holes in one place, and pi in another.”(1) When the compositor has as many corrections between the thumb and forefinger of his left hand as he can conveniently hold, or, what is better, in his composing-stick, (beginning at the bottom of the page, in order that they may follow regu- larly,) and an assortment of spaces on a piece of paper, or, what is more convenient, in a small square box with parti- tions in it,—-let him take the bodkin in his right hand, and, instead of raising each letter he may have to alter, place the point of the bodkin at one end of the line, and, with the fore- ' finger of his left hand against the other, raise the whole line sufficiently high to afford him a clear view of the spacing; he may then change the faulty letter and alter his spacing be- fore he drops the line. By this method he will not injure the type, which he must do if he force the bodkin into their sides or heads; a greater degree of regularity is insured where there may be occasion to alter the spacing, and no more time is taken up than by the other method. (1) The following epitaph was no doubt written by a printer after performing the most disagreeable task attendant on his profession :— No more shall copy bad perplex my brain, No more shall type’s small face my eyeballs strain; No more the proof '3 foul page create me troubles, By errors, transpositions, outs, and doubles: No more my head shall ache from author’s whims, As overrunnings, driving-outs, and ins ; The sturdy pressman’s frown I now may scoff, Revised, corrected, finally wrought off. CORRECTZZVG [N Th’E METAL. 209 In tables, and other matter, where rules prevent the lines from being raised, the letters must be drawn up by the bodkin. This is done by the compositor holding the instrument fast in his right hand, with the blade between his forefinger and thumb, within about three-quarters of an inch from the point: thus guiding it steadily to the faulty letter, he sticks the point of the bodkin into the neck of the letter between the beard and the face, and draws it up above the other types, so that he can take it out with the forefinger and thumb of his left hand. In performing this operation, the blade of the bodkin should be kept as flat as possible on the face of the type, but it should not touch any of the surrounding types, as the slightest graze imaginable will injure their face, and they will consequently appear imperfect in the next proof, when he will have the trouble of altering them, his employer suffering the loss of the type. The bodkin blade being held almost flat to the form, a small horizontal entrance of its point into the neck of the letter will raise it above the face of the form; but, if the bodkin be held nearly upright, it will not have sufficient purchase to draw the letter up, because the weight of the letter and the pressure of the surrounding types will have greater power than the sharp point of the steel. By pressing sidewise, the bodkin blade acts as a lever, even though it has no other purchase than the slight motion of the hand. ' COMMON BODKIN. In the olden times the printer made his own bodkin by inserting the blunt end of a large steel needle in a piece of wood or cork. At the present day, when every thing is pre- pared to the workman’s hand, bodkins are manufactured by printers’ furnishers, and he may take his choice of styles. The above cut shows a common form; but in some cases (as in table work) tweezers or a spring bodkin may be preferred. POCKET SPRING BODKiN. Knives may also be had with bodkin attached, which serve a double purpose. The objection to the knife-bodkin is that 183‘ ' 2IO CORRECTING [N THE METAL. Will/"mmztmunmtnitllllllllll lllllll/llllllllllIIIII E TWEEZERS. the handle is too heavy and cumbersome, and it is sure to injure type should it happen to slip from the fingers and fall on the page. SPRING BODKIN. The most careful compositor cannot at all times avoid leaving a word out, or composing the same word twice. When this happens, he should consider the best mode of rectifying the accident, by driving out or getting in, either above the error or below it. This ascertained, let the matter be taken upon a galley, and overrun in the composing-stick. Overrunning on the stone is an unsafe, unworkmanlike, and dilatory method, destroying the justification and rendering the spacing uneven. In correcting, care should be taken to avoid hair-spacing a line, by overrunning either back or forward. In overrunning the matter, the division should be used as little as possible; for, though the compositor may carefully follow the instruc- tions laid down in this work on’ the subject of spacing and dividing, yet the effect of his attention will be completely de~ stroyed if not followed up at the stone. TYPOGRAPAUCAL ZUAKKS. 211 We here emphatically remark that, if authors were careful to spell properly the names of persons and places, technical and scientific terms, &c., and to write legibly, marking the end of sentences clearly, the work of the compositor would be facilitated, many errors would be prevented, and time, temper, and expense greatly economized. Further. Let us remind authors that every correction made on their proof that vis a variation from the copy as furnished to the printer is charged for according to the time required to make it. The justice of the charge is obvious; yet, strange to say, there is probably no item so frequently disputed by pub- ' lishers. A man employs a mechanic to build a house accord- ing to fixed specifications; but, in the course of its erection, he improves or changes the plan, and orders certain portions to be torn down and rebuilt: is the mechanic to bear the loss? Certainly not. So, when a compositor builds up his page of type according to the copy furnished, he is right in requiring compensation for alterations made in it. He is not to suffer for the author’s desire to improve his intellectual edifice. PRINTER’S KNlFE. TYPOGRAPHICAL MARKS EXEMPLIFIED. HE following table will be appreciated by authors and by all who desire to become acquainted with the techni- cal marks used by practical readers. ~Due attention to the explanations will insure an apt proficiency in the manual de- partment of proof-reading. 2 I 2 T YPO G11’A PH] CA L 111A [8K3 Ia/ THOUGH severyfl differing opinions exist as to the individual by w om the art of printing was 2@ first discovered; yet all authorities concur in admitting Peter Schoeffer to be the person3 who invented east metal types, having learned the art ef- of eat/ing the letters from the Gu- 5;/ tenbergs/ he is also supposed to have been 6214 the first whoengraved o-n copper/\plates. T he’/-/ following testimony is preseved in the family, 8@/ 9 l/ by l/jo.l/Fred. l/Faustus, l/o/f l/Ascheffenburg: 1°C] A‘ Peter Schoeffer, of Gernsheim, perceivingyga/lw "V his master Fausts design, and being himself 12%fdesirous\ ardentlyl to improve the art, found out (by the good providence of God) the 13 method of cutting (ehieidendi) the characters 452/- ----------------- .- in a matrix, that the letters might easily be 5.~/ singly east/ instead of bieng out. He {xi-‘25% I4] vately ent nzatrieei for the whole alphabet: _- Faust was so pleased with the contrivan only Ute/‘(j promise 3%a/ 18 - ‘96”; f But there were many ifficulties at first nall ere had_been before 3913970972’ ‘vith wooden one , the metal bein too 5 f 3 ‘ g "t fia/ ergat he promised ;{eter to give him 11' / I O I ‘6 /daughter Christina 1n marriage, @ich he soon after performed. . /\ with these letters, as 20 —l— + _ A . to support th force of the 1m pression: but 21“ v V was soon remedied, by mixing 3 2 1 a sub ance with the metal which sufficientlymfl, 5 Q h dened anie/ 204223 %e oaowea/ we.) mete/ti {we /e/e%e oewt‘ /éo2n {Awe mart/ow, EXEMPLJFIED. 213 THOUGH several differing opinions exist as to the individual by whom the art of printing was first discovered; yet all authorities concur in admitting PETER SCHOEFFER to be the person who invented cast metal types, having learned the art of cutting the letters from the Gutenbergs: he is also supposed to have been The following testimony is preserved in the family, by 10. Fred. Faustus, of Ascheifenburg: ‘PETER SCHOEFFER, of Gernsheim, perceiv- the first who engraved on copper-plates. ing his master Faust’s design, and being him- self ardently desirous to improve the art, found out (by the good providence of God) the method of cutting (incidena'i) the characters in a matrix, that the letters might easily be singly cast, instead of being cut. He privately cut matrices for the whole alphabet: and when he showed his master the letters cast from these matrices, Faust was so pleased with the con- trivance, that he promised Peter to give him his only daughter Christina in marriage, a promise which he soon after performed. But there were as many difiiculties at first with these letters, as there had been before with wooden ones, the metal being too soft to sup- port the force of the impression: but this defect was soon remedied, by mixing the metal with a substance which sufficiently hardened it.’ 214 TYPOGRAPHICAL I/IIARKS. EXPLANATION OF THE CORRECTIONS. A wrong letter in a word is noted by drawing a short per- pendicular line through it, and making another short line in the margin, behind which the right letter is placed. (See No. 1.) So with whole words also, a line being drawn across the wrong word and the right one written in the margin opposite. A turned letter is noted by drawing a line through it, and writing the mark No. 2 in the margin. If letters or words require to be altered to make them more conspicuous, a parallel line or lines must be made underneath the word or letter,—viz. for capitals, three lines; small capi- tals, two lines; and Italic, one line; and, in the margin oppo- site the line where the alteration occurs, Cats, Small Caps, or Ital. must be written. (See No. 3.) When letters or words are set double, or are required to be taken out, a line is drawn through the superfluous word or letter, and the mark No.4 placed opposite in the margin. I/Vhere the punctuation requires alteration, the correct point should be written in the margin. (See No.5.) When a space has been omitted between two words, a caret must be made where the separation ought to be, and the sign No. 6 placed opposite in the margin. When a word should form a compound with another, it is denoted as in No. 7. When a letter has been omitted, a caret is put at the place of omission, and the letter marked as No.8. Where a line is too widely spaced, the mark No.9 must be placed between the words and also in the margin. Where a new paragraph is required, a quadrangle is drawn in the margin, and a caret placed at the beginning of the sen- tence. (See No. 10.) No.11 shows the way in which the apostrophe, inverted commas, the star and other references,‘ and superior letters and figures, are marked. bVhere two words are transposed, a line is drawn over one word and below the other, and the mark No.12 placed in the margin; but where several words require to be transposed, their right order is signified by a figure placed over each word, and the mark No. 12 in the margin. I/Vhere words have been struck out that have afterward TABLE OF SIGZVA TUBES. 2 15 been approved of, dots should be marked under them, and sz‘ez‘ written in the margin. (See No. 13.) 1/Vhere a space sticks up between two words, a horizontal line is drawn under it, and the mark No. 14 placed opposite, in the margin. Where several words have been left out, they are tran- scribed at the bottom of the page, and a line drawn from the place of omission to the written words, (see No. 15;) but if the omitted matter is too extensive to be copied at the foot of the page, 0m‘, see copy, is written in the margin, and the missing lines are enclosed between brackets, and the word Out is inserted in the margin of the copy. Where letters stand crooked, they are noted by a line, (see No. 16;) but, where a page hangs, lines are drawn across the entire part affected. \Nhen a smaller or larger letter, of a different fount, is im- properly introduced into the page, it is noted by the mark No. 17, which signifies wrong fount. If a paragraph is improperly made, a line is drawn from the broken—off matter to the next paragraph, and N0 1,1 written in the margin. (See No. 18.) \Nhere a word has been left out or is to be added, a caret must be made in the place where it should come in, and the word written in the margin. (See No. 19.) Where a faulty letter appears, it is denoted by making a cross under it, and placing a similar mark in the margin, (see No. 20;) though some prefer to draw a perpendicular line through it, as in the case of a wrong letter. \IVhere a word has been accidentally separated by a space, it is marked as in No. 21. TABLE OF SIGNATURES. N the two following pages will be found a complete list of signatures for books in octavo, twelves and eighteens, sixteens, and twenty-fours. The 24mo signatures in this table are arranged to bring the second signature on either the 9th or 17th page of the form. If the sheet is to be folded as an 8vo and 161110, the figure sig- natures may be used; but if as two Izmos, the letter signa- tures will be used. ' COZlJPLE TE TABLE 12m0 and 1 A 61 3 L 1 1_ A 313 27 _ 2 B 3 g 3 M 5 1*‘ A 2 317 27*‘ 2 B 2 4 D g g 13 2' B 325 28 2 C 5 E 65 3 P 17 2* B 2 329 28* 2 C 2 e F 33 3Q 25 3_ C 337 29 2D 7 G 67 3 R 29 3"< C 2 341 29* 2 D 2 3 H 68 3 S 37 4 D 349 30 2 E 9 I 39 3T 41 4* D2 353 30* 2E2 10 K 70 3 U 5 E 6 3 F 11 L 71 3 V 49 r 3 I .1 2 12 M 72 3 W 53 0* E 2 365 31* 2 F 2 13 N 73 3 x 61 6 F 373 32 2 G 14 O 7 3 y 65 6* F 2 377 2 G 2 ' 15 P 75 3 Z 73 7 G 385 33 2 H if; g 3 1g 77 7* G 2 389 2 H 2 13 s is 4 C 85 8. H 397 34 21 19 T 79 4 D 89 8* H 2 401 34* 2 I 2 U 80 4 E 97 9_ I 409 2 K V 81 4 F 1°! 9-‘ I 2 413 35* 2 K 2 W 82 4 G 109 10 K 421 36 2 L £5 33 4 H 113 101* K 2 425 33* 2 L 2 Z 2; 2114 121 11 L 433 37 2 M 2 A 86 4 L 125 11* L 2 437 37* 2 M 2 2 B 87 4 M 133 12 N1 445 38 2 N 2 g 33 4 N 137 12-“ M ‘2 449 38* 2 N 2 2 89 4 O 145 13 N 457 39 2 O I 311;) :11 P 149 13* N 2 461 39* 2 0 2 2 G 9,, 4 g 157 14 O 469 40 2 P l 2 H 95 4 S 161 14-k O 2 473 40* 2 P 2 l 2 I 94 4 T 169 15 P 481 41 2 Q 3 II? 95 4 I‘; 173 15* P ._ 485 41* ‘2. Q 2 93 4 131 13 Q 493 42 2 R g 3.1;’ 185 16* Q 2 497 42* 2 R 2 2 P 100 4 Z 197 17*‘ R 2 509 43* 2 S 2 2 Q 101 5 A 205 18 S 517 44 2 T . 2 g 102 5 B 209 18* S 2 521 44* 2 T 2 2 r ‘ 103 5 C 217 19 T 529 45 2 U 9 I1T 104 1E3 221 193 T2 533 45* 2 U 2 iv g F 229 20 U 541 43 2 v 2 W 107 5 G 233 20* U 2 545 46* 2 V 2 2 X 108 5 H 241 21 V 553 47 2 W 2 Y 109 5 1 245 21* ‘ V 2 557 47* 2 W 2 2 Z 110 5 K 253 22 W 565 48 2 X g 11% 111 5 TM 257 22*’ W 2 569 48* 2 X 2 3 C 3N 255 23 X 577 49 2 v 3 D 114 O 269 23* X 2 581 49* 2 Y 2 3 E 115 5 p 277 24_ Y 589 50 2 Z 3 F 113 5 Q 281 24* Y 2 593 50* 2 z 2 3 G 117 5 R 289 25 Z 601 51 3 A 3 H 113 5 S 293 25* Z 2 605 51* 3 A 2 3 I 119 5 T V 301 26 2 A 613 52 3 B 3 K 120 5 U 305 26* 2 A2 617 52* 3 B 2 0/1" SIG/VA TURES. 2 I 7 18mo. l6mo. 24mo. 625 53 3 c 1 1 A 1 l 1 A a 629 302 17 2 15 9 iii T 637 64 3D 33 3 Q 121 --A2 449! --T2 641 54* 3B2 9 ‘,i‘ £2 25 2 B 457 l 20 U 649 66 3 E 8? g I; 33 1 2* 465 203 653 66-5 3E2 97 7 G 41‘ ..B2 4731 ..U2 661 56 3F :13 8 H 49 i 3_ C 481 21 V 665 561‘ 3 F2 129 9 I 57 t 3’r 486 21* 673 57 3G I45 10 K 65 ..C2 497 . .V2 677 67*- 3G2 161 1,1, 1;, 73 i 4* D 505 22 w 685 63 3 H 15 N g‘ 4" D 513 22‘ 689 581? 3 H 2 209 H O 9 ~r - 2 521 _ . \V 2 697 59 31 225 16 P 127 31E 529 .23., k 761 59'?‘ 3 I 2 241 16 Q 5 ' i" 537 13' 113 . . E 2 X o 709 60 3K 257 17 R 545 . . .. 713 60* 3 x2 373 18 S "I 6, F 553 2-1 Y 28 19 12 6”‘ 6r ‘>' 721 61 3L 9 .0 T I? 1" 55 “4 1, 725 61* 3 L 2 22? 51 1;‘ I25 ‘7 ' G“ :7‘; 0'5 ' 2 733 62 3 M 337 22 W 153 7a 585 737 62* 3 M 2 383 22 § 161 . . G 2 593 . . Z 2 745 63 3 N 3 9 2, 169 3 H 661 ‘>6 4 757 64"‘ .2, 0 417 27 B 185 . . H 2 617 . 2 A 2 761 64*‘ 0 O 2 433 28 2 C 193 9_ I 625 27 2 B 769 65 3 P 449 29 2 D | 201 9" 633 27* 773 65* 3 P 2 435 30 211;: 209 . . I 2 641 _ 9 B 2 78: 66 3 4][ 31 2‘ 2I7 10 K 6 23 2C 5 66* 382 437 3? ‘5% 335 107- 6%? 23* 793 67 3R 2,; 34 21 233 - -K2 665 - 2 C2 797 67* 3 R 2 r' 241 11 L 673 29 2 D 545 36 2 K 2 1 a ,, w 365 63 as 561 33 2 L 49 1' ,, 68I 19- 369 68* 3 s 2 s77 37 2 M “57 - ~ L ~ 589 - 2 D 2 817 63 3 '1‘ 593 38 2 N 265 13, M 667 so 2 E 82! 3 T 2 39 2 O 273 1-:' 705 829 70 3U 225 g1) 28‘ I - -M2 713 . 2E2 833 70* 8 U 2 657 412 :89 l N 7“ .314 2 F 341 71 3 v 673 43 2 s 33; _' N 6 31‘ 2 F 2 345 717 3V2 639 44 2T i 14'0" ' 853 72 3 w 7°5 ‘15 2U 313 .4 745 32 2G “.- - 11 46 r 321 14' 753 32* 357 72*- 3 w 2 7 2 V . 85 .-. . 737 47 2w 329 - -02 761 . 2G2 863 13* 2 753 43 2 X 337 15 P 769 33 2 H. I 769 43 2 Y 345 15* 777 33* 877 74 3Y 785 50 22 353 ..P2 735 ..2H2 881 74* 3 Y 2 361 51 3 A 361 16 Q 793 3 21 889 '75 3 Z 817 52 3 B 369 16+:- 801 34* 893 75* 3 z 2 333 9: 377 . . 2 369 . .2 I 2 ~ 49 o' 33; 6* ‘$62 23 at: . 3- R 37 2K 1 6 , I'” 25 ' ‘t 913 i g 2 397 57 3 G 40! . . R 2 833 . 2 K2 917 P 913 58 3H 409 . 18 S 841 36 2L 925 18 4C 929 59 31 1 1 133 3 1 3 73* 4 c 2 4 7 ' 49 36 929 - 945 60 3 K 425 I . S 2 857 . . 2 L 2 19 3 /’ 6!) .‘ Maj/mill» '_ .j )1! ,$$‘ \. :13‘ i. ( " /) \ \‘ r_ ‘ /R .‘U s _\ _ ‘ _~-/‘ .4: GENERAL DUTIES. IGILANT and conscientious over- sight is the price of profit and success. An overseer or foreman of a printing-office should be of more than ordinary capacity, and able to keep his temper in firm control. His conduct should be guided by justice and equity in regard to the interests of the employer and the employed. A strict impartiality should be observed in his treatment of the workmen, and no favour- itism should be displayed. He should make himself acquainted with the capa- city of the men, and apportion work among them accordingly. Some men are value- less except for plain, straightforward com- position; others, distinguished for taste and skill, delight in intricate work or mat- ter requiring ingenuity and delicacy, such as tables, music, and algebra. Put one of the first kind on this sort of composition, and he will botch it, and earn small wages; while a workman of the latter class will become restive and dissatisfied with plain, solid matter. \Vhile dealingjustly with the men under his charge, the foreman should see to it that the employer suffers no detriment from negligent or dis- honest practices of unconscientious workmen. whether from careless correcting, allowing dropped types to lie upon the 218 GEJVERAL DUTIES. 219 -_-_.____-.~__.___-._ .- . floor, or overcharging, or other methods well known in a print- ing-office. He should be the first and the last in attendance, in order to satisfy himself that every person does his duty in coming and leaving at the proper time. The office having been thoroughly swept at an early hour, and the type found in any alley having been placed in the stick of the compositor occupying it, the foreman should pass around the room and see that it is immediately, distributed, LARGE SORT-CASE CABINET, FOR SORTS, QUADS, ETC. instead of being thrown on the window-frame or table. The type found in the body of the rooms should be sorted out and distributed at once, and not be allowed to accumulate. No pi should be permitted to remain over till the next day. This is an essential point to secure a tidy and well-regulated office. He should see to it that the proof-roller and press are in good condition, and that a sufiicient supply of wetted proof-' paper is on hand. A badly-printed proof should never be TffE 11‘0RE/WA1V. "'Hmm I" “I [I ll k ,I ‘,~. _ 11”” y, _,-- I l F—_-__,...r_-——— mm$______.- ' M , .ll H i l Ill”;i ei‘i l PIN’ -—'____:-:_ f’, l" {wit/fig,’ ff’ fi 3:- L; _-- M... M,M____. / ___ : _-:_.._~"‘»— _- _ ___/ I,’ W I’ @I- ._. W /'_’-" L/-/- M 'f I: "1 ;IIII 1V1, ,i H 1 lilliliil Ill ll i $12”; .ill til i | | _ l SORT-CASE CABINET. \ llllll / ,:,. allowed to go to the proof-reader or to the author, as neither can properly read a blurred or im- perfect proof. An author will feel kindly to- ward an office that furnishes him with hand- some impres- sions of his mat- ter. The foreman should keep himself fully in- formed as to the amount and the condition of the materials in the office, not only in gross, but in detail, including every CABINET FOR SPACES, QUADS, ETC. style of type, every variety of accents and pe— culiar sorts, leads, chases, furniture, rules, borders, corner- pieces, &c. In this he will be greatly aided by insisting on the observance of the good old rule, A plaeefm' every thing, and every thing 2'12 its place when not in use, as well as by keep- ing a memorandum-book in which every thing should be entered under its proper head for facility of reference. GE/VERAL DUTIES. 221 If the office be well provided, it will contain one or more of the cabinets for sorts, such as are shown in these pages. Strict atten- tion should be given to keeping them in perfect order, and in preventing them from becoming re- ceptacles for pi. As a matter of course, he should watch the progress of every job and book, and make in“ l h lUlllm '47-'— ‘2 If "u" III ‘\I m H ll ii I l i 0 l l l ‘ 'l-u l, ‘l I l H’ . i .. 7i III 1 l . l ‘l I " 55,1 I I I ' l ‘l ‘I ' I'll .llli "' ll" 1! ., ll l’ l 1 ill 121i ‘0 I all if‘ 11: ll; sure that they shall be completed within the time contracted for. He should never allow a compositor to have a large take of copy : small takes facilitate expedi- tion, and really tend to the profit of the workmen by bring- ing an earlier return of letter. He should see to it that every man has his copy closed in proper time, so as not to detain the make-up, and that he passes the make-up with- out unnecessary de- lay. As soon as a ._ form or sheet is made up, he should order it to be im- QUAD CABINET. posed and a proof pulled, which, with the copy properly arranged, is to be at once handed to the proof-reader. Nor 10* 2 2 2 . THE FOREIIIAI'V. should he allow of any unnecessary delay on the part of the reader, nor on the part of the compositors in correcting the proof when read. I/Vhen proofs are required by an author, the foreman must forward them promptly to him, and request him to return them at the earliest possible moment. If the proof is not to be sent out, he should have the second reading quickly performed, and the forms prepared for the foundry or the press. Systematic attention to the above points will tend to the comfort of the overseer, to the advantage of the workmen, and to the profit and satisfaction of the proprietor of the establish- ment. The foreman will find a memorandum Press-Book very useful, in which to make entries of the amount of the paper ' given out by the warehouseman for the various works, the number printed, &c., as well as the names of the pressmen when the work is done on hand-presses. WHEN Q DATE _ 3 SIGNA- NAMES OF GIVEN OUT NAMES OF \VOkKS. 5 NO. \VHEN LAID I ' TURKS. PRESSMEN. To War. ON. I I 1878. ' 1878. ' 1 May 8 Specific Heat Tables. . . . . 1000 11 May 10 Graham. “ 10 The Great Exhibition. . . . . 5000 18 “ 12 Landsdown; “ 12 The American Printer . . . . 1000 20 “ 13 Windisch. ' “ 15 Masterpieces of European Art. 3000 2 “ 17 Smith. i 1 I I If not done by the proof-reader, the foreman should exa- mine the press revise; in doing which, he will be careful not only to ascertain whether all the corrections marked in the proof are made, but also to look carefully over the sides, head, and bottom of each page. It frequently happens that the folios drop out of the form in lifting it off the imposing-stone; and in leaded matter, letters at the beginning and ends of lines sometimes fall out of place. Before the revise is given to the compositor, the name of the pressman who is to work off the form should be entered in the Press-Book. With foul com- positors, he should require a second revise, in order to ascer- tain if all the corrections have been made which were marked in the first. He should (where there is not a pressman engaged expressly for the purpose, as is the case in houses employing CASTING OFF COPY. 223 numerous machine-presses) go frequently to the different presses, and examine the work, point out defects, if any, and glance again over the heads, sides, and bottoms of the pages, to see if any thing has been drawn out by the rollers, which may occur from bad justification of the lines, and careless and improper locking up of the form. An active and conscientious foreman will not be content with merely managing the concerns of the composing room: he will also see that the business of the warehouse is attended to with regularity and accuracy, and that the warehouseman, errand-boys, and apprentices do their duty. CASTING OFF COPY. 0 cast ofl’ manuscript with accuracy and precision is a task which requires great attention and mature delibera- tion. The trouble and difficulty are much increased when the copy is not only irregularly written, (which is generally the case,) but also abounds with interlineations, erasures, and variations in the size of paper. At times, so numerous are the alterations and additions as to baffle the skill and judgment of the most experienced calculators of copy. Such an imper— fect and slovenly mode of sending works to the press cannot be too strongly censured. The first step necessary is to take a comprehensive \'l€W of the copy, noticing whether it has been written even or has many interlineations, &c., and observing also the number of break-lines, and whether the work be divided into chapters and sub-heads, in order that allowance may be made for them in the calculation. These observations may be noted on a separate piece of paper, to assist the memory and save the trouble of re-examining the manuscript. This preparation being made, we ascertain the number of words contained in the line by counting several separate lines in various parts of the copy, so that the one we adopt may be a fair average. We then take the number of lines in a page, and multiply by the number of words found in the average line: the result we then multiply by the quantity of folios the manuscript copy may contain, and thus we get the, amount of words contained in the work with a tolerable degree of accuracy. The necessary allowances should be made for 2 2 4 THE FOREfl/[A 1V. break~lines, chapters, insertions, &c., according to the obser- vations previously made on‘ the memorandum. If information has been furnished as to the size of letter the work is to be done in and the width of the page, we make our measure accordingly, and, by composing a few lines of the manuscript copy, we ascertain what number of words will come into each printed line: we then take the length of our page in lines, and multiply the one by the other, thus getting the number of words in the printed page. 'We divide the whole number of words in the manuscript by the number contained in the printed page: the quotient gives the number of pages the manuscript will make. If too many, the page must be enlarged; if too few, the page must be diminished in width and length. For example :——'We take the number of words in a line of manuscript at 20, the lines in a page at 50; we multiply 50 by 20, which will produce 1000 words in a page; we then multiply 1000 by 422, the number of folios in the manuscript, and we find that it contains 422,000 words. The work being printed in Pica octavo, 20 ems measure, and each line contain- ing 10 words, each page 40 lines, the case will stand thus :— MANUSCRIPT. PRINTED. 50 4O 20 IO '55; 400)422000 words in MS. _4_23 1055 pages. 2000 2000 Divide 4000 16)1055(65 sheets, 422000 words in MS. 15 pages. Another method for casting off copy is the following, as laid down by a predecessor :— I “After having made the measure for the work, we set a line of the letter that is designed for it, and take notice how much copy will come into the line in the stick,——whether less or more than a line of manuscript; and, as it is seldom that neither one nor the other happens, we make a mark in the copy where the line in the stick ends, and number the words that it contains. But, as this is not the safest way for casting off close, we count not only the syllables, but even the letters, CASTING OFF COPY. 225 that are in a line in the stick, of which we make a memo- randum, and proceed to set off a second, third, or fourth line, till a line of copy falls even with a line in the stick; and, as we did to the first line in the stick, so we do to the other, marking on the manuscript the end of each line in the stick, and telling the letters in each, to see how they balance against each other. This being carefully done, we begin counting off, each time, as many lines of copy as we know will make even lines in the stick. For example, if 2 lines of copy make 3 lines in print, then 4 make 6, 6 make 9, 8 make 12, and so on, call- ing every two lines of copy three in print. In like manner we say, if 4 lines make 5, then 8 make 10, and so on, comparing every four lines of copy to five lines in print. And in this manner we carry our calculation on as far as we have occasion, either for pages, forms, or sheets. The foregoing calculations are intended to serve where a line of print takes in less than a line of copy; and, therefore, where a line of print takes in more than a line of copy, the problem is reversed, and, instead of saying, if 2 lines make 3, we say, in this case, if 3 lines of copy make 2 lines in print, then 6 lines make 4, 9 make 6, 12 make 8, and so on, counting three lines of copy to make two lines in print. In this manner we may carry our calculation to what number of pages, forms, or sheets we will, remembering always to count ofi~ as many lines of copy at once as we have found they will make even lines in the stick. Thus, for example, if 5 lines make 7, the progression of 5 is IO, 15, 20, &c., and the progression of 7 will be I4, 21, 28, &c. In counting oFf copy, we take notice of the breaks; and where we judge that one will drive out, we intimate it by a mark of this shape [; and again, where we find that a break will get in, we invert it, thus, ]. And to render these marks conspicuous to the compositor, we write them in the margin, that he may take timely notice, and keep his matter accord- ingly. We also take care to make proper allowance for heads to chapters, sections, paragraphs, &c. In examining the state of the copy, we must observe whether it has abbreviations, that we may guard against them in casting off, and allow for them according to the extent of the respective words when written out at length.” The foregoing will convey a sufiicient idea as to the best 226 THE EoE'EMAM mode of casting off copy; still, these remarks more properly apply to regularly written and thoroughly revised copy. Upon this subject, Smith justly observes,— “But how often one or more of these requisites are wanting, compositors can best tell; though very few will imagine that among men of learning there should be some who write after such a manner that even those who live by transcribing rather shun than crave to be employed by them: no wonder, there- fore, if compositors express not the best wishes to such pro- moters of printing. But it is not always the capacious genius that ought to be excused for writing in too great a hurry; for sometimes those of no exuberant brains affect uncouth writing, on purpose to strengthen the common notion that the more learned the man, the worse is his (hand) writing; which shows that writing well or bad is but a habit with those that can write.” ' HURRIED WORK. T is sometimes necessary to print pamphlets and other works of a temporary nature in the course of a few hours. When a work of this kind is put in hand, the foreman selects the requisite number of swift and skilful compositors, whose first concern must be to appoint one from among them to make up the matter, and to do every thing which would inter- fere with the regular business of distributing, composing, and correcting. \IVhile they are distributing letter, the clicker, or person appointed to manage the work, procures the copy, with all necessary information respecting it, and provides leads, rules, and every other necessary sort. He then draws out the following table :— ' COMPOSITORS' NAMES. FOLIOS OF COPY. LINES COMPOSED. MEMORANDUMS. 184 ‘ Stratz . . . . . . . . 11-16 I i I Farroe . . . . . . . . 1- 5 | \Vilson . . . . . . . 6—10 \ 168 l i l I In the first column he writes the name of each compositor when he takes copy; and, in the second, the folio of the copy, HURRIED W'OKK'. 227 that he may be able to ascertain instantly in whose hands it lies. man’s name, the number of lines composed, as fast as the galleys are brought to him. In the fourth, he inserts such remarks respecting the copy, &c. as may be necessary, and also any circumstances that may occur in the companionship. \Nhen the work is finished, each man’s share of lines is readily ascertained, and all disputes are avoided. The publisher may expedite the progress of the work by offering a copy of the book, or some other token, as a premium to the compositor who sets the largest number of ems. The maker-up or clicker usually receives for his compensation the head and foot lines, and two or three cents per thousand, which is deducted from the wages paid to the compositor. Sometimes the compositors work “in pocket,” as it is called, or share evenly in the proceeds. This, however, is not a satisfactory mode, and its tendency is to retard the work, as no man will be anxious to do more than his share. hVhen the compositors are ready for their first taking of copy, it should be given to them in pieces as short as possible, the first two beginning with shorter takes than the others, to prevent delay in the making up. During the time the first take is in hand, the clicker sets the half-head, head-lines, white-lines, and signature-lines, together with notes and other extraneous matter. i/Vhen the first person brings his matter, the clicker counts or measures off with a type-measure the number of lines, and inserts them in the table; he then gives him another take of copy, and pro- ceeds with the making up. The same plan is observed with the rest of the compositors. When the first sheet is made up, the clicker lays the pages on the stone, and informs the foreman of it, who 'EltiflSVI-JW BdAJ. fulwltloqlwl lq/g/hl-I‘ I IQZILI I I/ I I I 1/7 2 .? /0IIl/ [III In the third column he sets down, opposite to the work- . I0 III! III! IIIIIIIII has previously had chases and furniture prepared and the clicker immediately imposes the form. The proofs should be read at once and given to the clicker to have them corrected. As soon as this is done, he lays up 2 2 8 T/[E Ii'ORLL'lJ/l N. the forms, and gives the proof to the compositor whose matter stands first, who should immediately correct it, then forward it to the next, and so on, till the sheet be corrected; the clicker then locks it up and pulls the second proof, which must be duly forwarded, and the type be locked up finally for press. The work will now proceed rapidly, provided the composi- tors stick close to their work and there be no hinderance with respect to letter, &c.: this depends on the good management of the foreman. If the clicker find that he cannot make up the matter as fast as it is composed, he should call one of the compositors to his assistance, who must be the person last in copy. COMPANIONSHIPS. ISPUTES sometimes arise in a printing-oflice upon trifling as well as important points, which should be settled by a reference to the general custom and usage of the trade. These annoying misunderstandings take place in companion- ships consisting of several compositors; it is therefore highly desirable that the generally received rules and regulations in this regard should be explicitly laid down for the comfort and government of the compositor. TAKING COPY. When the work to be taken in hand is a reprint which is to be followed page for page, a fixed number of pages should be ‘ given to each compositor as he comes in turn for copy; or, if the work be in manu- script, an equal aver- age amount should be allowed as a take for each compositor. None of the hands should have access to the copy, but the foreman should deal it out as wanted with perfect impartiality, fat or lean as it may happen to run. Otherwise, a compositor who has an acquaintance with the COZl/[J’A NIONSIJIPS. 2 29 copy may be tempted to loiter if the next take to be given out be lean, or, if it be fat, to apply for copy before his work in hand is finished‘. By this course, the foreman will prevent all such sorts of sharp practice, and secure harmony in the companionship. When the foreman gives out copy, he should plainly mark the name of the compositor at the head of the first page of the take if the work be a page-for-page reprint; if it be manuscript, or a reprint in a different measure from that of the copy, he should write the name at the beginning of the first paragraph of the take. Most compositors desire to have a large portion of copy, under the erroneous idea that it will be to their advantage to make up many pages at once. Small takes insure a more rapid execution of the work and bring a quicker return of letter, and so tend to the profit of the hands. If one of the companionship absent himself, the man next in order should close his copy, whether it be good or bad, unless the larger portion of it be not set, in which case the person who has the last take must go on with it. MAKING UP. The compositor who has the first take on the work proceeds without delay to make it up as soon as he has completed it. Having completed as many pages as his matter will make, he passes the overplus, if - less than half a page, with the correct head and folio, to the compo- sitor whose matter fol- lows his, at the same time taking an account of the number of lines loaned; if, on the con- trary, the overplus makes more than half a page, he borrows a sufficient number of lines to complete his page; each com- positor keeping an account of the number of lines borrowed and loaned. The second compositor, following the same course, passes the make-up to the next in succession; each man passing the make-up in like manner without unneces— sary delay. STEEL MAKE-UP RULE. 20 2 30 THE FORE/WAN. MAKING UP OF LETTER. The number of the companionship, if possible, should be determined on at the commencement of the work, to enable all to proceed upon an equal footing. The letter appropriated for the work should be adequate to keep the persons on it fully employed. If any part of the matter for distribution, whether in chase or in paper, be desirable on account of the sorts it may con- tain, it should be divided equally, or the choice of it thrown for. bVhen a new companion is put on the work after the re- spective shares of letter are made up, and if there be not a sufficiency to carry on all the companionship without making up more, he must bring on an additional quantity before he can be allowed to partake of any part of that which comes from the press. MAKING UP FURNITURE. The companions in rotation should make up the furniture in turn, the one who has the last matter in the first sheet lead— ing off. Should an odd sheet be wanted, it will be better to throw for the chance of making it up. IMPOSING AND DISTRIBUTING LETTER. The person to whose turn it falls to impose must lay up the form for distribution. To prevent disputes, it will be well to prepare a blank form, as follows, which may be filled up as the work proceeds :— _ THE GREAT INTERNATIONAL xxmnrrmn. (I) E I . . < in' warm IMI'OH . F >' I” z e it "D A [-1 >' O o i .- m . 0 a a a b a < a 3 < 9 >' u: 0 < E .4 Q S m o n. r 0 a A B 3 2 2 2 2 3 2 Clark. C 2 2 3 2 3 2 2 McGuIgan. D 3 2 2 3 2 2 2 Ftu‘mo E 2 2 3 2 2 2 3 Wilson F COll/[PAN/ONSIIIPS. 231 When the form is laid up, the letter should be divided equally, and, if possible, each person should distribute the matter originally composed by him; by this means, the sorts which may have made his case uneven will return to him. If any man absent himself beyond a reasonable time, his undistributed matter should be divided equally among his companions, and when he returns he may have his share of the next division. CORRECTING, ETC. The compositor whose matter is first in the proof should lay up the forms on the imposing-stone and correct it; he then hands the proof to the person who follows next. The compositor who cor- rects the last part of the sheet locks up the forms. The compositor who has matter in the first and last part, but not the middle of the sheet, only lays up the forms and corrects his matter; the locking up is left to the person who corrects last in the sheet. A compositor having the first page only of the sheet is required to lay up one form; also to _ _ _ lock up one form if he CHASE CABINET. has but the last page. If, from carelessness in locking up the form,—viz. the furni- ture binding, the quoins badly fitted, &c.—-any letters, or even a page, should fall out, the person who locked up the form should repair the damage. But, if the accident occur from bad justification, or from letters riding upon the ends of the leads, the loss should fall upon the person to whom the matter belongs. It is the business of the locker-up to ascertain whether all the pages are of equal length; and, though a defect in this 2 32 ' THE FOREAIAN. respect is highly reprehensible in the maker-up, (whose duty it is to rectify it,) yet, if not previously discovered by the locker- up, and an accident happen, he must make good the defect. The compositor who imposes a sheet must correct the alterations in that sheet. He must also rectify any defect in the register arising from want of accuracy in the furniture. Forms sometimes remain a considerable length of time before they are put to press. In this case, particularly in sum- mer, the furniture is likely to shrink, and the pages may fall out. It is therefore the business of the locker-up to attend to it in this respect, or he will be subject to make good any accident which his neglect may occasion. When forms which have been worked off are ordered to be kept standing, they are considered under the care of the fore- man. \Nhen they are cleared away, it is to be done in equal proportions by the companionship. During the time any forms may have remained under the care of the foreman, should there have been any alteration as to form or substance which were not made by the original compositors, they are not subject to clear away those parts of the form thus altered. T o prevent dust from settling in the face of the type, it is well to keep the forms in a chase cabinet. If the pressman unlock a form on the press, and any part of it fall out from carelessness in the locking up, he is subject to the loss that may happen in consequence. The compositor who locks up a sheet takes it to the proof— press, and, after he has pulled a proof, hands it, together with the foul proof, to the reader, and deposits the form in a place appointed for that purpose. TRANSPOSITION OF PAGES. Each person in the companionship must lay down his pages properly on the stone for imposition. Thecompo'sitor whose turn it is to impose looks them over to see if they are rightly placed. Should they, after this examination, lie improperly, and be thus imposed, it will be his business to transpose them; but, should the folios be wrong, and the mistake arise from this cause, it must be rectified by the person to whom the matter belongs. Pages without folios or head-lines, laid down wrongly for imposition, must be rectified by the person who has been slovenly enough to adopt this plan. RULES FOR A PRINTING OFFICE. 2 33 RULES AND REGULATIONS TO BE OBSERVED IN A PRINTING-OFFICE. OMPOSITORS are to receive their cases from the fore- man or his assistant, free from all pi or improper sorts, with clean quadrate and space boxes, both Roman and Italic, which they are to return to him in equally good condition. 2. \/Vhen a compositor receives letter, furniture, &c. from the foreman, he is to return any portion not used, in as good state as he received it, the same day. 3. \IV hen a case is taken out of the rack, the compositor is to return it into the proper place immediately after he has done with it. 4. No cases to be placed over others, or under the frames, or on the floor. 5. Compositors are to impose their matter and pull a proof as soon as made up, unless directed otherwise, and to correct the proof without unnecessary delay. 6. The proof, when pulled, to be given to the reader, the copy in regular order to accompany the first proof, and the foul proof the second. 7. Compositors are not to leave either type or furniture on the stone. 8. A compositor is not to detain an imposing-stone longer than the nature of the business may require. 9. Head-lines, or other useful materials, on galleys, used during the course of a work, to be cleared away as soon as the work is finished. 10. When a work is done, the compositor, before beginning another work, unless otherwise directed, is to clear away the forms, taking from them the head-lines, white-lines, and odd sorts, as well as the leads and reglets; which, with the furni- ture of each sheet, and the matter properly tied up for paper- ing, are to be given to the foreman. II. Types dropped on the floor to be picked up at once. Matter broken by accident to be cleared away on the same day. 12. The saw, saw-block, bowl, sponge, letter-brush, shears, bellows, &c., to be returned to their respective places as soon as done with. 20*- 2 34. R ULE S FOR A PRL/V I/ ‘II/V G OFFICE. 13. Letter-boards, windows, frames, 8:0, to be kept free from pi. 14. No person to take sorts from the cases of another with- out leave, nor hoard useful sorts, not wanting or likely to want them. ' ' 15. Compositors employed by the week to work not less than ten hours per day. 16. Unnecessary conversation to be avoided. 1mg YIIIIIII-I grmmmnmmm .1- ' Ellzlllllllllllllllllllllllll -, Hm‘, Ellniinliif‘fd'lmnd I ‘ > - ‘ in“ _lminm !nu11|r\-~\- ’ eallllllllllili‘iim ‘ SHIN film“ In“? L. "Inmm '\,|\-~.g__,UIlIIII|u|n|| IIIITQKMJLH > . fir-'— | | I N L IIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIII I _.'~ I GALLEY CABINET. THE PRESS AND ITS WORKING. 1 HISTORY OF THE PRESS. ---- -__ » HILE poets and orators have = " ' ' expatiated on the glory and power of the press, rulers have ex- hausted their cunning in attempts to curb and regulate the art of which it is the symbol. Hedged in by arbitrary restrictions, it is not __ r - wonderful that printing was long 1%TQTT?=F;T%;€MW carried on with clumsy implements. OLD COMMON PREss, The earliest press I'CSSHlblQd a screw-press, with a contrivance for running the form of types under the point of pressure. After the impression was taken, the screw was relaxed, and the form withdrawn and the sheet removed. This rude press continued in general use till 1620, when WILLEu jANsEN BLAEU, at first a joiner and afterward a mathematical instrument maker of Amsterdam, contrived a press in which the bed or carriage was brought under the point of pressure by moving a handle attached to a screw hanging in a beam with a spring, the spring causing the screw to fly back as soon as the impression was given. This move- ment was afterward effected by means of a‘double strap or belt, two ends of which were attached to an axle, and the others to opposite ends of the bed. The platen was so small that two pulls were necessary to print one side of a sheet, and each sheet, therefore, required four pulls to produce a com- plete impression. [C b.) 'J 1 2 3 6 THE PRIN 7 ‘11V G PRESS. ADAM RAMAGE, who came from Scotland to Philadelphia about 1790, and who for a long time was the chief press-builder in the United States, made some improvements in the old press, one of which was the substitution of an iron bed for the stone one before in use. About the year I800, EARL STANI-IOPE contrived a press which obtained much notoriety. It was constructed of iron, and of a size sufficient to print the whole surface of a sheet, and such a'combined action of levers was applied to the screw as to make the pull a great deal less laborious to the pressman. *7’ V" and‘, 12-; ' I I,’ COLUMBIAN PRESS. The Stanhope press, however, was soon surpassed by the Columbian press, invented by GEORGE CLYMER, of Philadel- phia. Mr. Clymer, as early as 1797, endeavoured to improve the common wooden press. His next efforts were directed to the production of an iron press, till finally eminent success was the result of his labours. In beauty, durability, and power, _ as well as facility of pull, the Columbian press stands perhaps unsurpassed. The power in this press is procured by a long bar or handle acting upon a combination of exceedingly pow- erful levers above the platen; the return of the handle or levers being effected by means of counterpoises or weights. THE PRINTING PRESS. 237 The powerful command which the leverage enables the work- man to exercise is favourable to delicacy and exactness of printing,——his arm feeling, as it were, through the series of levers to the very face of the types. The inventor removed to England in 1817, and introduced the press there, where it has long been held in high estimation. In the United States, presses of simpler construction have displaced the imposing Columbian press,——-the first of which was invented by PETER SMITH, of New York, and the latest I ll), u.~\\'—_¥»_ I >1 .15“ will" l?’ ulllnnn flwullltiq ,1 WASHINGTON PRESS. is SAMUEL RUsT’s \Nashington press, which has secured general approbation and adoption, as being more simple and cheaper, if not more efi’ective, than the Columbian press. Hand—presses are now restricted to country papers of small circulation, and to book-offices devoted to extra fine printing. The bed-and-platen power-press invented by ISAAC ADAMS, of Boston, was for a considerable time the only machine- press capable of producing fine work and exact register. It will give from six to eight thousand impressions per day. As the platen rolls off and leaves the bed entirely exposed, forms can be made ready with great facility. The sheets are 2 3 8 TIIE PRIJVTITVG PRESS. taken from the feed-board by fingers, and, after being printed, are laid in a pile by a self-acting sheet-flyer. The Cylinder press, which may be run at a much higherrate ofspeed than the bed-and- platen machine, was of earlier in- vention. FREDE- RICK KoNIG, a Sax- on, early in the present century turned his atten- tion to cylinder printing, and was so successful that on November 28, 1814, the London Times announced the fact that the number issued on that day had been printed by ma- chinery propelled bysteam. Theear- liest suggestion of a cylinder press is due, however, to \VilliamNicholson, of England, who, in 1790 took out a patent for such a machine, but it was never perfect- ed. According to Mr. Isaiah Thomas, a Dr. Kinsley, of Connecticut, afterward produced a press varying somewhat from Nicholson’s. In 1818, Applegath and Cowper made important improve- STOP CYLINDER PRESS. TILE PRINTING PRESS. 2 39 ments in Konig’s press, which greatly enlarged its field of usefulness. This machine, with various modifications and improvements, is in general use in Europe and America, for newspapers of moderate circulation, and even for fine job and book work, as entirely accurate register can now be secured on the new cylinder presses of the best makers, such as Hoe 8: Co.,(1) Cottrell & Babcock, Campbell, and others. The stop cylinder press (the latest improvement) is particularly well adapted for fine printing. (1) We are indebted to a friend for the following sketch of the origin, progress, and present condition of the world-famous house of R. Hoe & Co. Robert Hoe, the founder of the present house of R. Hoe & Co. of New York, was born at Hose, in Leicestershire, England, in 1784. His father was a well-to- do farmer in that pleasant, sequestered district; but, as the family was large, Robert was apprenticed to a carpenter in a neighbouring town. His attention was early attracted and his mind impressed by the prosperity of the people of the United States; and, being a republican at heart, and conscious that the institu- tions of his own country presented almost insurmountable obstacles to the ad- vancement of the working classes, he purchased his indentures from his employer, and in 1803 emigrated to New York. On his arrival he made the acquaintance of Grant Thorburn, who, becoming interested in him, received him into his family, and with great kindness nursed him with his own hands through an attack of the yellow fever, which was then raging in the city. He soon established himself in his trade, and, by his in- dustry, integrity, and enterprise, became advantageously known to the public. At the age of twenty he married the daughter of Matthew Smith, of \Vestchester Co., New York, by whom he had three sons and six daughters. ‘For a time he was in partnership with his brother-in-law, Matthew Smith, _]r., a carpenter and printers’ joiner, who, on their separation, associated with himself his brother, Peter Smith, who was educated at Yale College, and was the inventor of the well- known hand-press bearing his name. On the decease of these two brothers, Robert Hoe, in 1823, succeeded to the business, which was then in its infancy, giving employment to only a handful of men, and being conducted in the middle of the block bounded by Maiden Lane, Pine, \Villiam, and Pearl Streets, in some old buildings to which access was gained by an alley running from Maiden Lane to Pine Street. Here the business, under the style of Robert Hoe & Co., grew rapidly; but the extension of Cedar Street made necessary its removal to the present location in Gold Street. About this time, the flat-bed cylinder press, for newspaper printing, was introduced into Eng- land; and Mr. Hoe sent an intelligent mechanic there to examine it, and it was soon brought into use here, with valuable improvements. In 1832, Mr. Hoe’s failing health obliged him to relinquish the business to his eldest son, Richard M. Hoe, and Matthew Smith, son of his first partner. In the following year he died. Shortly after his decease, the firm erected extensive buildings in Broome Street, in the eastern part of the city, where the greater part of their manufacturing has since been carried on. They also commenced making cast-steel saws, which had previously been exclusively imported from England; and this branch has steadily increased in importance. Matthew Smith, a man of uncommon ability and business talents, died in 1842. The business was then continued by Richard M. Hoe, with his two brothers, 2 40 T {IE PA’fA’TfJVG PA’E SS. The invention of steam printing presses rendered books and periodicals so cheap that the progress of knowledge was amazingly accelerated; and soon the capacity of the cylinder press proved unequal to the work of printing the enormous . ;, . DENY-‘why;- l tip-w‘, 7,:- "*"~> /.7;-- ~ ""3 ‘v . \ ".4 \ ._..-_._. a 'l- I '\ 1 , - .“J ‘ 1'&" _| I. F -> ‘viii i A.‘ \\ _ f}; -‘\v i iI‘P-J i . ' ... --_ .~ ‘7 .' _- ,. - ‘ -..\-uulhil_firl.'rl"l"' \',1' 5g | A .. _. _‘;_—.__.f :2,’ - ‘ ' ' ‘ ' ' ‘ ' ' ' ___.,_,._.~_ ,_‘.¢ -'—_:—.-_ HOE’S TYPE-REVOLVING MACHINE—SIDE VIEW. editions of some of the leading newspapers of the world‘ ) and the first successful invention to meet the exigency was Robert Hoe and Peter Smith Hoe,——the eldest, as before, taking charge of the mechanical department, in which his industry and fertility of invention are attested by the number and value of his patents. In 1837, be patented here and in England his method of grinding circular saws, by which the thickness of any part of a saw can be regulated with accuracy. In 1846, he brought out the so-called “ Lightning Press,” or Type-Revolving Printing Machine, described in the text,-—the greatest innovation on the routine of the printing craft since the days of Gutenberg. This press entirely superseded all others for fast printing, and was introduced into the principal offices, not only in this country, but in England, Scotland, Ireland, and Australia. In 1858, the firm purchased of Isaac Adams, of Boston, Massachusetts, his entire patent-rights, together with his establishment for the manufacture of his bed-and-platen book printing presses, and various machines for binders’ use, which they continue to conduct there, though with increased facilities and many improve- ments. Their works in different places now cover thirty-five city lots, or about two acres, and give employment to nearly six hundred hands. The office and ware~ rooms of the house in England are at 13 Salisbury Square, Fleet Street, London, one of the partners, being a resident in that city, attending to the business there. THE PRINTING PRESS. ‘ 241 made by Col. RICHARD M. HoE, of New York, in the Type- Revolving Printing Machine, of which we give an engrav- ing. It is, as its name indicates, on the rotary principle; that is, the form of type is placed on the surface of a horizontal revolving cylinder of about four and a half feet in diameter. The form occupies a segment of only about one-fourth of the surface of the cylinder, and the remainder is used as an ink- distributing surface. Around this main cylinder, and parallel with it, are placed smaller impression cylinders, varying in number from four to ten, according to the size of the machine. The large cylinder being put in motion, the form of types is carried successively to all the impression cylinders, at each of which a sheet receives the impression of the types as the form passes. Thus, as many sheets are printed at each revo- lution of the main cylinder as there are impression cylinders around it. One person is required at each impression cylin- der to supply the sheets of paper, which are taken at the proper moment by fingers or grippers, and after being printed are carried out by tapes and laid in heaps by means of self- acting flyers, thereby dispensing with the hands required in ordinary machines to‘receive and pile the sheets. The grip- pers hold the sheet securely, so that the thinnest newspaper may be printed without waste. The ink is contained in a fountain placed beneath the main cylinder, and is conveyed by means of distributing rollers to the distributing surface on the main cylinder. This surface being lower, or less in diameter, than the form of types, passes by the impression cylinder without touching. For each im- pression there are two inking rollers, which receive their supply of ink from the distributing surface of the main cylin~ der: they rise and ink the form as it passes under them, after which they again fall to the distributing surface. This press is capable of printing either from type or from stereotype plates bent to fit the curve of the cylinder. When type is used, each page of the paper is locked up on a detached segment of the large cylinder, which constitutes its bed and chase. The column-rules run parallel with the shaft of the cylinder, and are consequently straight; while the head, adver- tising, and dash rules are in the form of segments of a circle. The column-rules are in the form of a wedge, with the thin part directed toward the axis of the cylinder, so as to bind the 2]. 242 THE PRIZVTING PRESS. type securely. These wedge-shaped column-rules are held down to the bed by tongues projecting at intervals along their length, which slide in rebated grooves cut crosswise in the face of the bed. The spaces in the grooves between the column- rules are accurately fitted with sliding blocks of metal even with the surface of the bed, the ends of which blocks are cut away underneath to receive a projection on the sides of the tongues of the column—rules. The form of type is locked up in the bed by means of screws at the foot and sides, by which the type is held as securely as in the ordinary manner upon a flat bed,——if not even more so. The speed of these machines is limited only by the ability of the feeders to supply the sheet. This machine was first used by the Public Ledger of Phila- delphia, and was afterward adopted by the leading newspapers of that city and New York, as well as of the chief cities of Great Britain and other countries. To obtain the best results from the largest size of this press it was necessary to employ a dozen or more hands to feed and run it. This expensive feature was largely avoided in a new machine projected by Mr. WILLIAM BULLOCK, whose press was the forerunner of several machines that may be classed under the general name of Self-feeding or Web Perfecting Presses. THE BULLOCK WEB PERFECTING PRESS. HIS machine is intended for printing on a continuous roll of dampened paper, which passes between a pair of cylinders (one of which is an impression cylinder, and the other a cylinder around which stereotyped plates are bent) and receives an impression on one side, and the sheet then goes forward and is printed on the other side while passing between a second pair of cylinders similar to the first, except that the impression cylinder is four times the diameter of the plate cylinder to prevent more effectually the ink from “set- ting off.” After being printed, and before delivery, the sheet is cut off by a fixed serrated cutting blade, the ingenious in- vention of Victor Beaumont of New York. A French device for making flexible paper-maché moulds rendered it possible to cast the type-plates to fit the printing cylinders. Without THE PRINTING PRESS. 243 0 ‘2 .5- %,\....,ww\\aW\ M l/ I 55m we." ..... .nlflb’h/IW mrnq. ” . 003 ,mmokW.“ _ 10 Hzm mCPFOOX mmrmfiwmmgzm vmmmmOjZm vmmmm. $3.: flOrDmw. AH~ WOFU HA, \Hmwflfl OW QOCW \Hwzmw >‘H a<~fifis CW QC‘? 10rd‘ >ZU Srwfim. “a, >w Hu>m€ arm wxfltwmnv. this adjunct, web perfecting presses would have been useless and impractical. Mr. Bullock, born in Greene county, New York, was a me— chanlcal genius, and was the author of many inventions in 244 TIJE PRfNTL/VG PRESS. various departments of machineryfl) About the year 1860, he began to work out the idea of a rotary self-feeding, or web perfecting press. After making a large working model, which is still in existence, he adopted a simpler plan, and in 1861 constructed a machine for the Cincinnati Times, which was successfully operated, but it was far from perfect. Three of these machines were used for a considerable time in the office of the Philadelphia Inquirer. He continued his efforts, and in 1865 he produced a press which met his original anticipation, and a company was formed to manufacture it. In 1867, while setting up a machine for the Public Ledger in Philadelphia, he suffered a serious injury which terminated his life. More than fifty of the presses are now in use in the United States. The New York flerald press, printing and cutting two copies at each delivery, is said to pro- duce, with but three men to attend to it, 30,000 copies per hour. The New York Sun states: “When our seven Bullock Presses are working, we can turn off, without extravagant assertion, 210,000 copies an hour.” This assertion must be taken with some grains of allowance. The press is twelve feet long by five and a half feet wide. THE WALTER PERFECTING PRESS. HE Bullock press was not long allowed to be the only press for rapid printing from cylindrical stereotype plates fed by a so-called endless roll of paper. The principle was applied to a machine constructed in the London Times ofiice, called, after the name of its celebrated proprietor, the Walter press. This appears to be an effective press, but it seems more complicated than either the Bullock or Hoe machine, and from its mode of delivering the sheets, it is excessively noisy. The New York Times was printed on it at the Centennial Exhibi- tion in Philadelphia. (1) While publisher of a paper in Catskill, he produced within a week, aided by some village mechanics, :1 press for his own use. ‘With the exception of a stone bed, the principal parts were made entirely of wood. It was a flat-bed press, having a series of impression cylinders connected by an endless chain, by means of which they passed over and arounrl the bed continually. He called it the Chain-running Press. It was employed by Frank Leslie to print an edition of his [llustraled Newspaper. TIJE PRl/VYYNG PRESS. 245 THE HOE PERFECTING PRESS. HE enterprise of R. Hoe 8: Co., of New York, soon gave birth to a web perfecting press combined with a folding machine that answers every requirement. The groundwork principle is the same as in other presses of this kind. The first pair of cylinders over which hangs the roll of paper consists of one type and one impression cylinder, and by it the first side of the paper is printed. The second pair, printing the second side, consists likewise of one type and one impression cylinder, but the latter is below the former THE HOE WEB PERFECTING PRESS. and is of much greater size, so that the “set off” from the fresl: ink shall not fall continuously on the same surface of blanket. There is a third pair of cylinders which cuts off the sheet, and a fourth (in which, however, one cylinder is replaced by a brace of rollers) gives the first fold and shoots the doubled sheet in the circular cutter, which slits it into two papers, send- ing them on to be folded again separately and delivered in their respective places in piles at the side of the press; or the papers are rolled up exactly on the top of each other, six in number, and flown perfectly on the fly-board. This machine printed and folded at the rate of more than 28,000 sheets an hour at the Centennial Exhibition, printing and folding at one time two copies of the Philadelphia Times. 21* 246 THE PRf/VTf/VG PRESS. It is already in use in a dozen newspaper establishments in various parts of the world. All these machines were in operation at the great Centen— nial Exhibition in Philadelphia. A fourth press exhibited,—~ claimed by its inventor, Mr. A. Campbell of New York, to be capable of printing much faster than any other,—was set up too late to prove its capacity by actual test. No press how- ever, can be made more simple and with fewer parts than this. RAILROAD-TICKET PRINTING AND NUMBER- ING PRESS. ‘ HESE presses not only print, but at the same operation number consecutively, tickets and coupons of every size and pattern, which are also indented or cut apart by the ma- chines as fast as printed. Ten local tickets twenty-six inches in length can be printed at one operation. The average rate of speed is about fourteen hundred impressions an hour,— equivalent to fourteen thousand tickets. JOB PRESSES. HE invention of machines for printing small work ele- gantly as well as swiftly is of vast advantage to the printer, and has greatly in- creased the job- bing department of typography. Here, as in other \ matters, American -- uummmmrrl-C ingenuity has ta_ ken the lead of all nations; and the ' presses invented by Ruggles, Hoe, Gordon, Degener, \Nells, and Gally, —not to mention numerous other inventors,—defy __ _ competition. The Goanows FRANKLIN PRESS.— Ruggles Presses ‘v THE PRINTING PRESS. N 42.. \! formerly com- manded the trade; but the beautiful machines of Geo. P. Gordon, a man of decided genius, and the presses of other makers above named, have entirely displaced them. Hoe’s half medium cylinder job press will run 2500 impressions an'hour. Gordon’s Fire- fly press is unique, and requires a so-called endless card-board, which it prints and cuts of the required shape as it goes, at the rate of about ten thousand per hour. This is not in general use; but his eighth medium, quarto medium, and half medium Franklin presses, have achieved a high reputation for expedition and excellent performance. Gordon‘s Franklin press has been reproduced in Eu- rope under a differ- ent name. \/Ve here present an engraving of an- other press which - has achieved not a little reputation. It is called the Liberty press, and is manu- factured by Degener 8: \IVeiler, of New York. In sizes as well as in prices, it corresponds with the Franklin. This press also is manu— factured in Europe. NONi’ARElL PRESS. LIBERTY PRESS. 2 / 8 TZIE PRL/VTL/VG PRESS. The Nonpareil, the Globe, the Peerless, and the Universal job press- es all have special points which commend them to favour. Indeed, with so many good machines at the command of the printer, he is without ex- cuse who does not pro- duce handsome work. What are called ama- teur presses may do well enough to amuse the boys of a family and keep them out of mischief; but when they are employed by I'ledgelings in competition with properly trained printers, they become mere paper-smearers, the work produced on them being simply detestable to an educated eye. '8 I III ,. UNIVERSAL PRESS. TA" i I! \ I“ “ \,.;-~‘{;\\\\‘r I‘ .. ‘fl/m‘x3 I I I v . ‘l. ‘A " . ‘i. i I,‘ .', ' 1:":1‘ " ‘ .‘IW a.‘ ~~ ', '|l\'|il'l1|l| PEERLESS PRESS. FOLDf/VG 177?! C if [JVE S . 2 49 I" ?\ a v . ; Ill: ' will I...‘ ll llli . if ‘i m l | v : llil, ml, '\ BOOK-FOLDING MACHINE. FOLDING MACHINES. OOK and Newspaper Folders are entitled to a high rank among modern labour-saving machines. For newspapers of large circulation and in book establishments they have become indispensable. The finest books may be folded by them with accuracy, speed, and economy; and periodicals can be folded, pasted, and covered at about one—fourth the cost of hand—folding alone; while the daily folio newspaper can be folded in two, three, or four folds as fast as the machine press can print; or an eight-page daily or weekly can be folded three or four times, and all the pages pasted together at the back fold, and the head margin trimmed. All these processes are successfully accomplished by the various machines made by Chambers, Brother & Co. of Philadelphia. The engraving given above represents a book~folding machine. 250 SETTL/VG UP A IVASf-[L/VG TOJV PRESS. SETTING UP A WASHINGTON PRESS. LL the connecting parts being marked, or indented by ’ points, if these be observed carefully, the press may be put together without difficulty. After setting the frame upon its legs, and putting on the ribs and bed, lay the platen on the bed, placing under it two bearers about type high. Then put the springs in their places, and the nuts over them, and pass the suspending-rods through them, observing to place the rods so that the number of in- dentations on them correspond with those on the platen. Give the nuts two or three turns, then run in the bed so as to bring the platen under the rods, and screw them fast to the platen; after which, put in the bar-handle, standard, and lever, (or wedge and knees, if a Smith press.) Turn the nuts on the suspending-rods, so as to compress the springs just enough to give the platen a quick retrograde motion, observing at the same time to get the surface of the platen parallel with the surface of the bed. After having put the press together and levelled it by means of a spirit-level, be particular not to raise the end of the ribs by the gallows, but let it go under rather loose, which will have a tendency to make the bed slide with more ease on the ribs. SETTING UP THE ROLLER-STAND. HE roller-stand containing the distributing cylinder should be regulated to the height of the press, bringing the shelf or bridge even with the corner irons, and at sufficient distance from the bed to allow it to run clear; the stand should then be firmly braced, as the constant turning of the rounce is very apt to loosen it; meanwhile being cautious to observe that the rounce, in its revolutions, does not come in contact with the frame of the tympan when up. The position of the distri- buting cylinder should be sufficiently high to allow the two composition rollers, at least one inch apart, to rest on its top without danger of touching the shelf or bridge in front. It is advantageous to nail two narrow strips of sole leather on the face of the shelf, about eight or ten inches from each O SETTING UP YYIE ROLLER STAr/VI). 25I ' l-i‘lla- . pail‘?! ‘ . Mil l,» ‘-. I. Ijmmlmlllllllllllmmg ,1 .3’, ROLLER STAND. end, which, acting as bearers, cause the rollers to pass very smoothly over them. The roller-handle while in use should lie in a horizontal position, the back end being supported by a bar of wood or iron running parallel with the distributing cylinder. There should be a notch, or hook, about two inches from the end of the handle, to catch on the wooden supporter, to prevent the rollers from jumping forward while distributing or changing. It is also necessary to have a back-board for the end of the roller to strike against in coming off the form, to prevent the rollers from falling backward. . The ink-block is placed about five or six inches to the right of the roller-handle, and about on a level with it. It is fur- nished with the ink—slice, and a brayer, or a small roller about four or five inches long, and of the same circumference with the larger rollers, being cast in the same mould. 252 COM'POSJTTOJV ROLLERS. COMPOSITION ROLLERS. UT the glue in a bucket or pan, and cover it with water; let it stand until more than half penetrated with water, taking care that it shall not soak too long, and then pour it off and let it remain until it becomes soft, when it will be ready for the melting kettle. This is a double vessel, like a glue kettle. Put the soaked glue into the inner vessel, and as much water in the outer boiler as it will contain when the inner ves- sel is placed in it. When the glue is all melted, (if too thick, add a little water,) the molas- , _ ses may be slowly poured into . it, and well mixed with the glue 1*,1.» ‘ by frequent stirring. YVhen a properly prepared, the compo- ' sition does not requ1re boiling ‘Q more than an hour. Too much boiling candies the molasses, and the roller, consequently, will be found to lose its suction much sooner. In proportion- ing the material, much depends upon the weather and tempera- ture of the place in which the ‘ rollers are to be used. Eight MELTING KET‘ILE. pounds of glue to one gallon of sugar-house molasses, or syrup, is a very good propor- tion for summer-time, and four pounds of glue to one gallon of molasses for winter use. Glue for rollers should be clear and bright in body, and even in texture, when held up to the light: it should break short, and with a clear, sharp edge like glass. For hand-press rollers more molasses should be used, as they are not subject to so much hard usage as cylinder-press rollers, and do not require to be as strong; for the more mo- lasses that can be used the better will be the roller. Before pouring a roller, the mould should be perfectly clean, and well oiled with a swab, but not to excess, as too much oil makes the face of the roller seamy and ragged. The end pieces should then be oiled, and, together with the cylinder, placed in the mould, the upper-end piece being very open, to CO/IIPOSITION' ROLLERS. 25 3 allow the composition to pass down between the interior of the mould and the cylinder. The cylinder must be well se- cured from rising, before the composition is poured in, by placing a- stick upon the end of it, sufficiently long to reach above the end of the mould, and be tied down with twine. The composition should be poured very slowly, and in such a manner as to cause it to run down only one side of the cylin- der, allowing the air to escape freely up the other. If the mould is filled at night, the roller may be drawn the next morning; but it should not be used for at least twenty- four hours after, except in very cold weather. To determine when a roller is in order for working, press the hand gently on it: if the fingers pass smoothly over its surface, it may be said to be in order; but should it be so adhesive that the fingers cling to it, it is not sufi'iciently dry, and should be exposed to the air. Rollers should not be washed immediately after use, but should be put away with the ink on them, as it protects the surface from the action of the air. NVhen washed and exposed to the atmosphere for any length of time, they become dry and skinny. They should be washed about half an hour before using them. In cleaning a new roller, a little oil rubbed over it will loosen the ink: and it should be scraped clean with the back of a case-knife. It should be cleaned in this way for about one week, when ley may be used. New rollers are often spoiled by washing them too soon with ley. Benzine may be substituted for oil; but, owing to its combustible nature, it is objectionable, as disastrous accidents have ensued from its use. ‘ Mr. Hansard, an eminent English printer, says, “Take glue, made from the cuttings of parchment or vellum, fine green molasses, pure as from the sugar-refiners, and a small quantity of the substance called Paris-white, and you will have every ingredient requisite for good composition. The proportion as follows :— Glue, 2 lbs. Molasses, 6 lbs. Paris-white, % 1b. Put the glue in a little water for a few hours to soak; pour off the liquid; put the glue over the fire, and when it is dissolved add the molasses, and let them be well incorporated together for at least an hour; then, with a very fine sieve, mix the 22 254 COVERl/VG TYAYPAZVS. Paris-white, frequently stirring the composition. In another hour, or less, it will be fit to pour into the mould.” Various patented compositions for rollers may now be had from type-founders. COVERING TYMPANS. TYMPANS are generally covered with parchment, which should be of an even thickness, and about two inches and a half wider and three inches longer than the tympans. Tym- pans have been sometimes covered with linen, which, on account of its evenness, would answer the purpose; but it is so apt to stretch, that the tympans become slack in a short time, and bag (as it is termed), and thus slur the impression. Silk is excellent for fine work. ' The pressman spreads as much good paste on the edges of the skin as will cover the frame of the tympan, which is also well pasted. He then lays the skin on the inner side of the frame, with the flesh side to face the type, and draws it regu- larly, as tight as possible, on all sides. The part of the skin that comes on the grooves of the tympan which receive the point—screws, is cut and wrapped round the inside edge of the grooves, which admits a free passage for the screws. After having fastened the skin on the sides of the tympan, he draws it toward the joints which receive the frisket, and with a knife cuts across these joints to let them through the skin; he then puts the frisket-pins through the parchment, and makes that end of the tympan fast. He next proceeds to the lower joints, and brings the skin as tight as he can round that part of the tympan. The point-screws and duck-bill are then put on, which prevent the skin from starting. The inner tympan, or drawer, is covered in the same manner. To prevent their warping when the skin begins to draw, pieces of furniture or wood of any kind should be placed across the centre till they are perfectly dry. The skins are put on either wet or dry: if dry, they should be afterward well wet, which will make them give some- what; but when they dry they will contract, and by this means will be rendered much tighter than they would be if put on wet. WETTING PAPER. N ~ U1 U1 WETTING PAPER. HE size of the wetting—trough should be about two inches longer and wider than the largest-sized paper, folded, that is to be wet in it, and about six inches deep. It should have a cover with hinges on the left side, that the cover may fall over on that side, and, resting horizontally, serve for a shelf to lay the paper upon previous to wetting it. Having received a certain amount of paper from the ware— houseman, the pressman' lays one heap on the shelf attached to the wetting-trough, laying the first token across the heap with the back of the quires toward his right hand, that he may know when to turn the token—sheet, and that he may more readily catch at the back of each quire with that hand, for the purpose of dipping it. He then places the paper—board with its breadth before him on his right, on a table, laying a wrapper or a waste sheet of paper on the board, to prevent soiling the first sheet of the heap. He then takes a quire by the centre of the back with his right hand, and the edge of it in his left, and, closing his hands a little, that the quire may bend downward between his hands, he clips the back of the quire into the left-hand side of the trough, and, relinquishing his hold with the left hand, draws the quire briskly through the water with his right. As the quire comes out, he quickly catches the edge of it again in his left hand, and brings it to the heap, and, by lifting his left hand, bears the under side of the quire ofi” the paper pre— viously laid down, till he has placed the quire in an even posi- tion; if the paper be weak and spongy, he draws the quire through the water quickly; if strong and stubborn, slowly. T 0 place the quire in an even position, he lays the back of it exactly upon the open crease of the former, and then lets the side of the quire in his left hand fall flat down upon the heap, and, discharging his right hand, brings it to the edge of the quire, and, with the assistance of his left thumb, still in its first position, opens or divides either a third or a half of the quire, according to the quality of the paper; then, spreading the fingers of his right hand as much as he can through the length of the quire, turns over his opened division of it upon his right-hand side of the heap. ' A different process must be used in the wetting of drawing 25 6 I/VE TTL/VG PAPER. and plate papers. These papers are usually sent in quite fiat; that is, not folded into quires or half-quires. The best method of wetting these papers is to use a brush, such as is called a banister brush; and, instead of dipping the paper into the trough, he lays it on the paper-board by the side of the trough, and, dipping the brush into the water, he shakes it gently over the whole surface, to give an equal degree of moisture to all parts; and then proceeds as before described. The drawing- paper, being very hard-sized in the making, will require the brush, and much water, three, four, or even five times a quire; while the plate-paper should have as little water as it is pos- sible to give it, so as to cover it all over; and twice a quire will often be too much. This same mode must also be adopted in wetting paper of extraordinary dimensions. Having wet his first token, he doubles down a corner of the upper sheet of it on his right hand, so that the farther corner may be a little toward the left of the crease in the middle of the heap, and the other corner may hang out on the near side of the heap about an inch and a half. This sheet is called the token-sheet, being a mark for the pressman, when he is at work, to show how many tokens of that heap are worked off. Having wet the whole heap, he lays a wrapper, or waste sheet of paper, upon it; then, three or four times, takes up as much water as he can in the hollow of his hand, and throws it over the waste sheet, to moisten and soak downward into the wet part of the last division of the quire; after which, he places in the heap the label which the warehouseman must always furnish for each heap, and upon which are written the title of the work and the date of wetting, one—half hanging out so as to be easily read. The paper should be pressed for twelve hours, and then carefully turned by each three or four sheets, so that no lift be relaid in the same position with respect to the adjoining lift; at the same time, every fold and wrinkle ‘must be carefully rubbed out by the action of the hand, so that nothing but a flat and even surface shall remain; the heap should'then be pressed for about twenty-four hours in a screw-press, and it will be in good order for working. The wetting of paper must, in all cases, depend entirely upon its fabric; and, since the printer has seldom the choice of the paper, it will require all his skill and patience to adapt BLANKE TS—MAKL/VG READY. 257 his labours to the materials upon which he is to work. The texture of the paper must be suited to the fineness and tena- city of the ink. To attempt doing fine work upon common paper is lost labour. A paper to take the best ink must be made entirely of linen rags, and not b/eae/zed by e/zemz'eals. A fine hand-made paper, fabricated a sufficient time to get properly hardened, and well and equally saturated with size, so as not to imbibe more water in one part of the dip than in another, nor resisting the water like a duck’s back, is most suitable for fine printing. Machines for wetting paper are now used in most large printing-offices. BLANKETS. OOLLEN blankets are unnecessary when a book is printed from new type. Nothing more should be used than a sheet or two of paper, as in fine work only the face of _ the type should show in the impression. But when the types or plates are worn and rounded, fine cassimere or broadcloth should be used in the tympan. In this, as in all matters con- nected with artistic typography, the pressman must display good judgment and discretion. MAKING READY A FORM ON A HAND-PRESS. EFORE a form is laid on the press, the pressman should carefully wipe the bottom of the type and the bed perfectly clean; for, if a particle of sand remain on it, it will cause a type or two to rise, and not only make a stronger impression, but probably injure the letters. An octavo form should be laid on the press with the signa- ture—page to the left hand, or nearest the platen; a duodecimo, or its combinations, with the signature at the right hand, or nearest the tympan. The form should be laid under the centre of the platen, and properly quoined up. The tympan is then laid down, and wet if necessary, and paper or blanket put in. It was formerly customary to wet the tympans for all works, and even jobs of almost every description; but, since the in- troduction of fine printing, and particularly iron presses, the custom is well-nigh banished, excepting for very heavy forms, 22*? 258 .M'AKL/VG READY A FORM composed with old letter, which, of course, require more soft- ness to bring them off. After the inner tympan or drawer is put in, it is fastened with the hooks for that purpose, which serve to keep it from springing out. The tympan being lifted up, a sheet of the paper to be worked is folded in quarto, and the short crease is placed over the middle of the grooves of the short cross, if it lie in the centre of the form, as in octavo. In a form of twelves, the paper is folded in thirds, and the long crease placed in the middle of the long cross, and the short cross over the grooves. The sheet lying evenly on the form, the tympan is brought down, and a gentle pull will cause the paper to adhere, when it should be pasted to the tympan and fully stretched. The points are next screwed to the tympan, for large paper short-shanked points being used, and long- shanked for small paper. In twelves, the points must be placed at precisely equal distances from the edge of the paper. In octavo, the off-point may be a little larger than the near one, as it enables the pressman to detect a turned heap when working the reiteration or second side. ‘ When a press is continued upon the same work, the quoins on the off-side of the bed may remain and serve as gauges for the succeeding forms; for, if the chases are equal in size, the register will be almost, if not quite, perfect. The following operations are comprised in the term of making ready the form :— I. The frisket should be covered with stout even paper, in the manner described for putting on parchment, the paper be- ing carefully placed on the inside of the frame so as to lie close to the tympan, and to confine the sheet in its place when laid on for printing. \1Vhen the paste is dry, the frisket is put on the tympan, and, after inking the form, an impression pulled upon it. The frisket is then taken off and laid on a board, or on the bank, and the impression of the pages cut out with a sharp knife about a Pica em larger than the page. After being replaced on the tympan, it is advisable to put a few cords across, to strengthen the bars of paper, and to keep the sheets close to the tympan. When the margin is too small to admit bars of paper, it is necessary to work with cords only. 2. The form should be examined, to see that it is properly locked up and planed down; that no letters or spaces lie in the white lines of the form, nor between the lines in leaded matter. MAKING READY A FORM 259 3. White pages which occur in a form must not be cut out; but, if the page be already cut out, a piece of paper must be pasted on the frisket, to cover the white page in the form, and a bearer put on to keep the adjoining pages from having too hard an impression. Some pressmen use reglets, others fumi- ture cut to a proper height, and a third class adopt cork, which, from its elasticity, is very useful. Spring bearers, made of hard paper rolled up, are also employed to guard the sides and bottoms of light and open pages, when there is an inclination to slur. 4. The pressman must examine whether the frisket bites; that is, whether it keeps off the impression from any part of the pages. 5. He must consider whether the catch of the frisket stands either too far forward or backward: if forward, he may be much delayed by its falling down, and, if backward, it will come down too slowly, and thus retard the progress of the work and not unfrequently cause the sheet to slip out of its proper place. - He must, therefore, place the catch so that the frisket may stand a little more than perpendicularly backward, that, when lightly tossed up, it may just stand, and not come back. 6. He must fit the gallows so that the tympan may stand as much toward an upright as he can; because it is the sooner let down upon the form and lifted up again. But yet he must not place it so upright as to prevent the white sheets of the paper from lying secure on the tympan. 7. The range of the paper-bank should not stand at right angles with the bed of the press; but the farther end of the bank should be placed so that the near side may make an angle of about seventy-five degrees with the near side of the bed. 8. The heap of paper should be set on the horse on the near end of the paper-bank, near the tympan, yet not touching it. The uppermost or outside sheet should be laid on the bank; and the pressman then takes four or five quires off his heap, and shakes them at each end, to loosen the sheets, till he finds he has sul‘ficiently loosened or hollowed the heap. Then, with the nail of his right-hand thumb, he draws or slides forward the upper sheet, and two or three more commonly follow gra- dually with it, over the hither edge of the heap, to prepare those sheets ready for laying on the tympan. 260 I’ULLLVG. 9. He must next pull a revise sheet, which must be sent up to the overseer for a final revision, and for examining whether any letters have dropped out of the form in putting it on the press, &c. 10. \Nhile the sheet is undergoing a revision, the pressman should proceed to make register, if half-sheet-wise, which is done by pulling a waste sheet, and turning it, (without inking, as the sheets may afterward be used for slip sheets,) being particular not to stretch the point-holes in the least, or to draw the hand along the sheet in leaving it. In making register, the points must be knocked up or down in such a direction as will bring the first impression under the last, knocking the point only half the distance apparent on the sheet. If register cannot be made with the points, the difliculty must then be either in the furniture, the length of the pages, or in the springing of the cross—bars, from the forms being locked up by careless compositors, who commence at one quarter of - the form, and lock it up tightly, and so go around, instead of gently tapping it at opposite sides till the whole is equally tightened. In locking up a form, the quoins at the feet should be gently struck first, to force up the pages and prevent their hanging; but, in unlocking, the side quoins must be first slackened. Altering the quoins will not make good register, when the compositor has not made the white exactly equal between all the sides of the crosses. The pressman, therefore, will ascer- tain which side has too much or too little white, and, unlock— ing the form, will take out or put in as many leads or reglets as will make good register. PULLING. IN taking a sheet off the heap, the pressman places himself almost straight before the near side of the tympan, but nimbly twists the upper part of his body a little backward toward the heap, the better to see that he takes but one sheet ofi". This he loosens from the rest of the heap by drawing the back of the nail of his right thumb quickly over the bottom part of the heap, and, receiving the near end of the sheet with his left-hand fingers and thumb, catches it by the farther edge with his right hand, about four inches from the upper corner PULLZNG. 261 of the sheet, and brings it swiftly to the tympan: having the sheet thus in both his hands, he lays the farther side and two extreme corners of the sheet down even upon the farther side and extreme farther corners of the tympan-sheet. In the reiteration, care should be taken to draw the thumb on the margin, or between the gutters, to avoid smearing the sheet. The sheet being properly laid on, he supports it in the centre by the fingers of the left hand, while his right hand, being disengaged, is removed to the back of the ear of the frisket, to bring it down upon the tympan, laying at the same moment the tympan on the form. He then, with his left hand, o'rasps the rounce, and quickly runs the form under the platen; and, after pulling, he gives a quick and strong pressure upon the rounce, to run the carriage out again. Letting go the rounce, he places the fingers of his left hand toward the bottom of the tympan, to assist the right hand in lifting it up, and also to be ready to catch the bottom of the sheet when the frisket rises, which he conveys quickly and gently to the catch: while it is going up, he slips the thumb of his left hand under the near lower corner of the sheet, which, with the aid of his two fore- fingers, he raises, the right hand at the same time grasping it at the top in the same manner. Lifting the sheet carefully and expeditiously off the points, and nimbly twisting about his body toward the paper-bank, he carries the sheet over the heap of white paper to the bank, and lays it down upon a waste sheet or wrapper; but, while it is coming over the white paper heap, though he has the sheet between both his forefingers and thumbs, yet he holds it so loosely that it may move between them as on two centres, as his body twists about from the side of the tympan toward the side of the paper-bank. \/Vhen the pressman comes to a token sheet, he undoubles it, and smooths out the crease with the back of the nails of his right hand, that the face of the letter may print upon smooth paper; and, being printed off, he folds it again, as before, for a token-sheet, when he works the reiteration. Having worked off the white paper of a form of twelves, he places his right hand under the heap, and, his left hand sup- porting the end near him, turns it over on the horse, with the printed side downward. If the form be octavo, he places his left hand under the heap, supporting the outside near end with 262 Jr’ ULES AND REfl/lED/ES. his right hand, and turns it one end over the other. All turn- ing of the paper for reiteration is treated in one of these modes. In performing this operation, he takes from the heap only as much at once as he can well handle without disordering the evenness of the sides of the paper. Having turned the heap, he proceeds to work it off, as be- fore described, except that with the left hand he guides the point-holes over the points, moving the sheet with the right hand, more or less, to assist him in so doing. The token- sheets, as he meets with them, he does not fold down again. RULES AND REMEDIES FOR PRESSMEN. BOUT every five or six sheets a small quantity of ink should be taken; yet this rule is subject to some variation from the nature of the work and quality of the ink. A form of large type or solid matter will require ink to be taken more frequently, and a light form of small type less fre- quently. During the intervals in which the roller-boy is not employed in brayering out or taking ink, he should be almost constantly engaged in distributing or changing his rollers. He should invariably take ink on the back roller, as it will the sooner be conveyed to the other roller, and, consequently, save time in distributing. \/Vhen, through carelessness, too much ink has been taken, it should be removed by laying a piece of clean waste paper on one of the rollers, and working it off till the‘ink is reduced to the proper quantity. If letters, quadrates, or furniture rise up and black the paper, they should be put down, and the quarter locked up tighter. If any letters are battered, the quarter they are in must be unlocked, and perfect ones put in by the compositor. When bearers become too thin by long working, they should be replaced by thicker ones. ' When the form gets out of register,—which will often happen by the starting of the quoins which secure the chase,—it must be immediately put in again, as there can scarcely be a greater defect in a book than the want of uniformity in this particular. If picks, produced by bits of paper,_composition, or film of ink and grease or filth, get into the form, they must be re- moved with the point of a pin or needle; but if the form is RULES A IVD REfl/IEDI E S. 26 3 much clogged with them, it should be well rubbed over with clean ley, or taken off and washed: in either case, before the pressman goes on again, it should be made perfectly dry by pulling several waste sheets upon it, in order to suck up the water deposited in the cavities of the letter. The pressman should accustom himself to look over every sheet as he takes it off the tympan: he will thus be enabled not only to observe any want of uniformity in the colour, but also to detect imperfections which might otherwise escape notice. In order to make perfect uniformity in the colour, the roller-boy should keep his ink well brayered out with the small roller, in proper quantities for the work in hand, and also should change his rollers well after taking ink, and at other times. The rollers are changed by moving the roller- handle slowly to the right and left, while the crank is being turned briskly with the left hand. Torn or stained sheets met with in the course of work are thrown out and placed under the bank. Creases and wrinkles will frequently appear in the sheets when the paper has been carelessly wet: these should be carefully removed by smooth— ing them out with the back of the nails of the right hand. If the frame of the tympan rub against the platen, it will inevitably cause a slur or mackle: this can easily be remedied by moving the tympan so as to clear the platen. The joints or hinges of the tympan should be kept well screwed up, or slur- ring will be the consequence. When the thumb-piece of the frisket is too long, it always produces a slur: this can be pre- vented by filing off a part of it. Loose tympans will at all times slur the work, and great care must therefore be observed in drawing them perfectly tight. The paper drying at the edges will also cause a slur: this may be remedied by wetting the edges frequently with a sponge. Slurring and mackling will sometimes happen from other causes: it will be well in such cases to paste corks on the frisket, or to tie as many cords as possible across it, to keep the sheet close to the tympan. The pressman should make the boy roll slowly, or the rollers will be apt to jump, and cause a friar. To prevent the rollers from jumping or bounding, bridges or springs made of thin steel, to reach across the gutters, may be used: these 264 TffE LEY-TROUGTL ,_<_ _.__._ springs should taper off at the ends, and having an oblong hole in each end, through which they may be tacked to the gutter- sticks. In very open forms, it may be necessary to put bearers or pieces of reglet where the blank pages occur at the end of the form, to prevent one end of the roller from falling down and leaving a friar at the opposite end. This difficulty may be obviated in a great measure by imposing the form in such a manner as to bring the blank pages in the centre. This mode should always be adopted for title-pages and other light matter. Before the pressman leaves his work, he covers the heap of paper by first turning down a sheet like a token-sheet, to show where he left off, and then putting a quantity of the worked-off sheets on it, and a paper-board if convenient. Laying the blanket on the heap after leaving off work is a bad custom. If the paper be rather dry, it will be well to put wet wrappers on it, after damping the edges well. If the form be clean, he puts a sheet of waste paper between the tympan and frisket, and lays them down on the form; if it be dirty, it must be rubbed over with clean ley, and several waste sheets pulled on it, as before directed, to suck the dirty ley out of the cavities of the letter. On his return to work in the morning, he takes care to wet the tympan, provided the type be worn. If there should be any pages in the form particularly open, the parts of the tympan where they fall must not be wetted. THE LEY-TROUGH. HE form being worked off, it is the pressman’s duty to wash it clean from every particle of ink, not only for the cleanly working and well standing of' the letter in the subse- quent composing, but to save his own time in making ready when the same letter gets to press again. Many an hour is lost from not bestowing a minute or two in thoroughly cleans- ing and rinsing the form. _ For this purpose, printing-offices are provided with a ley- trough, suspended on a cross-frame, and swinging by iron ears fixed somewhat out of the precise centre, so that the gravity of the trough will cause it to fall in a slanting position forward. This trough is lined with lead, the top front edge being guarded from the pitching of the forms by a plate of MA KING READ I’. 2 6 5 iron. The form having been placed in the trough, on its side, the pressman takes hold of the rim of the chase by the hook, or instrument for that purpose, and, laying it gently down, pours the ley upon it, and sluices it by swinging the trough on its pivots two or three times to and fro; then, taking the ley-brush, he applies it to the whole form, type, furniture, and chase; the ley is then let out into a receptacle, and the form well rinsed with clean water, by swinging the trough as be’ fore; the form is then lifted out, and consigned to the care of the compositor. The ley is made of pot or pearl ash, or, what is better, of concentrated ley. A large earthen jar is usually chosen for the purpose; a sufficient quantity of ash or concentrated ley is added to the water to make it bite the tongue sharply in tasting. The ley-brush is made large, the hairs close, fine, and long, in order not to‘ injure the type, while sufificient force is applied to search every interstice in the letter where the ink can have insinuated itself. MAKING READY ON CYLINDER PRESSES. AKE clean the bed of the press and the impression seg- ment of the cylinder. Adjust the bearers a trifle above ordinary type height. See that the impression screws have an even bearing on the journals, and that the cylinder fairly meets the bearers. Select a suitable tympan or impression surface. The tympan may be the India-rubber cloth which is fur- nished with the press, a thick woollen lapping cloth or blanket, several sheets of thick calendered printing paper, or one or more smooth and hard pasteboards. Each of these materials has merits not to be found in any other. Upon the proper selection of the tympan the presswork in great measure de- pends, and the pressman should be thus guided in making choice. A pasteboard iympzm is most suitable for wood-cuts, for perfectly new type, and for the best kinds of presswork. It is not suitable for miscellaneous work, nor for heavy forms, nor mixed old and new type. If the overlaying is properly exe- cuted, a pasteboard tympan will enable the pressman to show a sharper edge and a more delicate impression of the type 23 266 fl/[ARYNG' READY than can be possible with any other, and it will wear the type less than any other. But it will require a very tedious and careful making ready, or it will prove very destructive to type. A woollen Wankel‘ is best adapted for old stereotype plates, for very old type which has been rounded on the edges, for posters with large wood type, and for all common work which requires a clear but dull impression. For such work a woollen blanket will enable the pressman to make ready a form more quickly than with any other material; but it is injurious to new type, and incapable of producing a fine and sharp im- pression. T kick paper is much used for book-work. It also answers well for script circulars and leaded forms. It will not answer so well for mixed old and new type, nor for table-work with unequal heights of brass rulefnor for mixed large and small type. It will prove most serviceable for the average of light and fine presswork. T he India-rubber cloth combines many good qualities not found in other tympans: it has something of the density of the pasteboard, the hardness and evenness of paper, and the flexibility of the blanket, combined with an elasticity pecu- liarly its own. It will compass a greater variety of work than any other: posters, script circulars, news and book forms, stereotype plates, and old or new type, can all be well printed with an India-rubber blanket. \/Vhen it is intended to make one tympan answer for all kinds of work, the India-rubber blanket will be found decidedly superior to all others; but when very extra presswork is wanted, the tympan must be specially adapted to the form of type. There are forms for which none of these tympans are spe- cially suitable. For such cases careful pressmen combine two or more together,——as Welsh flannel over rubber, or thin rub- ber over pasteboard or under paper. These, however, are exceptional cases, and are only ‘thus combined when very good presswork is wanted from imperfect materials. Careful observation of the quality of the impression given by each style of tympan will teach a pressman how to combine to the best advantage. As it requires experience and discrimination, an arbitrary rule cannot be given. \IVhatever may be the material selected, the tympan must be stretched very tightly over the cylinder. All labour in over- 0N CYLINDER PRESSES. 267 laying is but thrown away if this is not carefully attended to. A rubber or woollen blanket can be secured at one end of the cylinder by small hooks projecting inward, while it may be laced tightly with saddler’s thread at the other end; or, by sewing on that end of the blanket a piece of canvas, it may be wound tightly around the reel, and kept secure by the pawl and ratchet. But paper and pasteboard require a different process,—viz.: Take a piece of Nonpareil cherry reglet of the full length of the cylinder. Trim down the paper or pasteboard to the width of the bed between the bearers, but leave it a little longer than the impression segment of the cylinder. Then crease the pasteboard at a uniform distance of half an inch from the nar- rower end, and lay this creased part on the flat edge of the impression segment of the cylinder, under the grippers. Put the reglet over this, and bring down the clamps hard on the reglet, so as to bind all securely. \I'Vhen this is done, a thin web of muslin may be stretched over the whole, in the same way in which a blanket is laid on, and rolled up tightly, which will prevent any slipping of the board or of the overlays pasted on it. A large poster, or newspaper form, or any large form with old type, will require a soft roller with much suction. Book- work, wood-cuts, or fine job-work, will require a harder roller, with very smooth, elastic, and clinging surface. Coloured inks are best printed with a still harder roller and with much less suction. All rollers should be perfectly clean, and free from cracks or holes. The suitableness of these rollers cannot well be explained by words: such a knowledge will be best ac- quired by observation and experience. It may, however, be necessary to state that one roller will not answer for all styles of presswork: the quality of the work, the size and wear of the type, and the speed of the press, must control the press- . man in his choice. Posters, with large wood type, require a semi-fluid ink, but not surcharged with oil. Ordinary news-work requires a bet- ter grade, more tachy, and finely ground. Good book—work should have a stiffer-bodied ink, soft, smooth, and with little oil. job ink, which is made expressly for presswork on dry paper, should be used only for such work. Book and job inks are not convertible: an ink for wet paper will not work well ' 268 - ATARI/VG READY on dry paper, and vice versfi. Very fine presswork—such as wood-cuts, or letter-press upon enamelled paper—calls for an ink impalpably fine, very stiff, of brilliant colour, and nearly or absolutely free from oil. Every job-office should keep four grades of ink,—news, book, job, and wood-cut. They can be compounded (if no ink-manufacturer is near) with each other, or reduced with varnish to suit any form. Good presswork is impossible without good inks. Charge the ink-fountain with the ink selected, and keep it well covered, to protect it from paper dust. Turn down the screws, and cut off all the ink evenly. When the form is ready, turn on the ink cautiously, and wait for ten or twelve impres- sions before again altering the screws. For small forms and short numbers of any piece of presswork in coloured ink or extra ink, a fountain is not necessary. The ink may be applied with a brayer or palette-knife. The adjustment of the margin is the next process. Although type can be printed from any quarter of the bed, it will be found most judicious to lay all forms close to the back part of the bed, and equidistant between the bearers. This will secure a good impression, give a fair average margin to every form, and allow the full use of the bed for a large form, without resetting the cylinder. The bed and cylinder travel together, and the grippers, which bring down the sheet to the form, should barely lap over the back part of the bed. 50 long as the toothed cylinder wheel, and the short toothed rack on the side of the bed, remain undisturbed, the grippers will always pass over the bed in exactly the same place. When the grip- pers are in this position, (slightly lapping over the back of the bed,) take measurement of the distance between the back edge of the bed and the point of one of the nearest grippers. YVith a piece of reglet cut a gauge exactly corresponding to this measurement. Let no form be laid upon the press until the distance between the type and the edge of the chase tallies with the gauge. This will prevent the grippers from closing on the form and crushing the type.‘ If the chase will not admit of so wide a margin, or if an extra margin is wanted on the sheet, put a piece of furniture of the extra width behind the chase: the margin can thus be increased or diminished at ‘ pleasure. ON CYLINDER PRESSES. 269 A book form may be locked up in a chase so large, with the type so far from the edge of the chase, that the grippers will bring down the sheet in such a position that it will be printed with the margin all on one side. To remedy this, the cylinder must be reset. Proceed thus. Remove the screw and washer, and draw the intermediate wheel out of gear, loosen screws in the gauge rack, then turn the cylinder to the point required, connect the intermediate wheel, adjust the gauge rack, and screw up tight. The press having been adjusted, next examine the form to be printed. Not only see that it is gauged correctly, but also see that it is not locked up too tightly,~——that chase, quoins, letter, and furniture are all level, and lie flat upon the bed. If the form springs, the quoins must be slackened; if this loosens the type too much, the justification should be amended. Make clean the type by rubbing it over with a dry brush. The rollers are often made foul and the colour of the ink changed by dust and particles of dirt clinging to the type. Fasten the form so securely on the bed that it will not be moved by the action of the cylinder or the rollers. Take a proof on its own paper, using very little ink. Proceed to adjust the drop guides so as to bring the sheet exactly in the right position. Push out the iron tongues at the edge of the feed-board, and at equal distances from each other, so that they will equally sustain the paper. Slide the drop guides along the rod until they fall squarely over the tongues. Set the side guide so that it will give a true margin in length to the sheet to be printed. Adjust the grippers so that they will seize the sheet at proper intervals, making the margin exactly even by lengthening or shortening the drop guides. Then take a clean proof on its own paper, exactly in the right posi- tion, before making ready, when it may be shown to the reader. It frequently happens that an error in the margin, or an imper- fection in the register, is thus noticed; and its timely discovery and correction before overlaying will save much time and trouble. A readable proof may be taken before overlaying, by running through a sheet or two of proof paper. jlfake register, if it is a book form, before underlayz'ng. When every thing has been found correct, then proceed to regulate the impression. If the type is fair, the proof should show a decently uniform impression; but if the form is large, 23*- 2 70 MAKING READY or if it contains old and new or large and small type, then the proof will show an uneven impression. To rectify this in- equality, pressmen use many expedients. I. By lowering the bearers and putting on more impression. This, of itself, is a very poor way; for it wears down new type in order to show the face of the old, and invariably produces thick and coarse presswork. 2. By raising the low type to a proper height with thick- nesses of paper under them, which is called underlaying. 3. By giving additional thickness to the tympan over every part of the form which shows a weak impression, which is called overlaying. It is very rare that any one of these modes will prove suffi- cient: all should be used in conjunction. l/Vhen the larger part of the proof-sheet shows a weak impression, almost ap— proaching illegibility, then more impression should be added. When one side of the proof-sheet shows a weak impression, while that on the other side is full and clear, then more im- pression should be given to the paler side. The impression should be made decently uniform before any attempt at over- laying or underlaying. But the bearers should follow the impression screws, both being raised and lowered together, in order to secure the type from the unimpeded force of the impression cylinder. Not only should the bearers be of even height, but the cylinder shaft should always revolve on a true level. If the impression screws are carelessly used, and the bearers are rashly raised and lowered, this even bearing will soon be lost; the difficulty of obtaining a good impression will be much increased, and the press will receive a serious injury. For the same reason, the bearers should never be packed, (by the addition of cards, as is usual on a hand-press,) for it strains the cylinder and all its bearings with an irregular resistance. The bearers should be tampered with even less than the im- pression screws. When the impression screws are so set that the cylinder gives a fair uniform impression, they have done all that can be expected, and nothing more should be attempted by them. Sometimes the proof may show that a cut, or a line of type, or a set of brass rules, are higher than any other mate- rial in the form. But the impression should be set regardless of this: it will be found quicker and neater to reduce the impression on one or two such high lines, by cutting out the ON CYLINDER PRESSES. 2 7 I tympan-sheet over them, than it would be to underlay and bring up all other types to such an irregular height. Pitch the impression so that it will face the larger portion of the type, and make the less conform to the greater. Those parts which are high must be cut out of the tympan, and those which are low should be raised by underlays, and all inequalities regu- lated by overlays. When any part of the form is very low, it will not answer to attempt facing it with overlays: it must be brought up to meet the inking rollers as well as the impression cylinder. When the proof shows low type, cut out the impression of it, raise the form, and paste it over the feet of the letter. If some types are high and some are low, make proper distinction, and carefully avoid increasing the height of any type or rule which seems to have a full impression. Pursue the same course when a marked depression appears in the centre, or a dwindling impression at the edges. Cut out that section which is light, and affix it to the defective part. If the impression dwindles in any part, the underlays must be cut of irregular thickness to suit the tapering off of the impression. Cut out an under- lay from the edge where the impression begins to fade; then cut another of smaller size where it is utterly illegible; paste one over the other, laying them carefully in their proper posi- tions, and then paste them all on the bottom of the form, where it is needed, taking care to lay the smallest underlay nearest the bed. This will restore the type to a proper level, and the next proof should show a uniform impression. The same plan will answer for a low corner. Use as little paste as possible, thin and free from lumps. Be careful that the under- lays are laid on smoothly, without fold or wrinkle. Cut all underlays from a proof; for the proof serves as a guide both in cutting and in affixing to the form. Underlaying should not be done to any great extent upon a cylinder press. It is a valuable means of bringing up an old line of type, a hollow, or a low corner. The underlays of any zjI/w form should not constitute more than one-fourth of the surface; if more than this is attempted, they will rarely ever fail to work up the quadrates and furniture. The action of the quickly moving cylinder upon a form of type underlaid with yielding paper, must create a spring and a rocking of all the materials in the chase. 272 MAKING READY Of all materials, old stereotype plates need underlays most, as they are usually very irregular in height. Thin card or pasteboard will be found preferable to paper for the underlay- ing of plates secured on wood bodies. When the plates are on patent blocks, always underlay between the plate and the block. Always cut the underlay for a plate less in size than the faint impression would seem to require. This will allow for the spring of the plate. If it is cut of full size, the next impression will disappoint the pressman, by being much harder at the edges than he intended. Never attempt to build up a type form to a proper impression entirely or chiefly by under- laying. Underlays should be put under all large and bold-faced types when used with much smaller types, so as to raise them above the level of the others. This is needed to give it closer rolling, extra supply of ink, and that extra force of impression to transfer the ink to paper which all large types require. l/Vhen the type has been so levelled by underlays that all parts receive proper bearing from the inking rollers, and when the cylinder has a corresponding even impression, then.over- laying may be commenced. For ordinary news, posters, or job-work, overlaying may be entirely unnecessary; the tapes and fly may be set, and the printing of the form may proceed without further delay. But fine press—work cannot be done without overlays. Underlays are chiefly valuable for securing an even impression; while overlays are indispensable for giv— ing delicacy and finish to that impression. To overlay a form properly, the tympan should be covered with a sheet of thin, smooth, and hard paper, stretched tightly. Then take a pale impression on the tympan-sheet, and also run through the press two or three proofs on thin and hard paper. Examine the proofs carefully on both face and back. If any brass rules or letters appear too high, cut them out of the tympan-sheet in one or two thicknesses, as their varying height may require. Go over the whole proof, examining every line carefully, and, by cutting out, reduce the impres- sion of all projecting letters to a uniform standard. For this, as for all other work on overlays, use a very sharp knife with a thin point, and cut on a smooth surface, so that there will be no dragged or torn edge to the cut. The next step should be to raise the impression of those ON C YLL/VDER PRESSES. 2 7 3 parts of the form when the type appears dull or weak. Cut out carefully, and paste the overlays over the tympan smoothly. Overlays are worse than useless if they are not laid on firmly and smoothly, as the slightest bagginess will cause slur or mackle. If, by accident, the tympan-sheets or overlays should bag or wrinkle, tear them off, and commence anew. Cut out and overlay the more prominent parts first; then try another impression, and from that cut new overlays for minor defects. Thus proceed until a perfectly smooth and even impression is obtained. With common work it will be sufficient to cut overlays in masses, as pages or parts of pages; but with fine work every line and letter needs examination, and letters and parts of single letters are often overlaid by careful pressmen. \V hen the pressman is expert at making ready, it is not necessary that he should take a new impression with every successive set of overlays. Many pressman take a dozen proofs of a form on different styles of paper, and proceed to cut out and over- lay on one of the proofs, and finally paste this proof on the tympan. But this boldness and precision can be acquired only by long practice. It is better for the young pressman to feel his way step by step. T he impression—A diversity of opinion exists among good printers as to the proper force of the impression: by some a heavy and solid indentation of the paper is considered neces- sary; while others insist that an impression which does not indent the paper is preferable. But the indentation of the paper is no test of the force of the impression. A light impres- sion against a woollen blanket will show more forcibly than a strong impression against a paper or a pasteboard tympan. Type is worn out not so much by the direct impression of the platen or cylinder on the flat face of a form, as by a grind- ing or rounding impression on the edges of the type, caused by the forcing of the tympan between the lines and around the corners of every letter. Every fount of worn-out type, whether from cylinder or platen press, has suffered less from a reduction in height than from a rounding of the edges. “7 hen the type is new and the tympan hard and smooth, the impres- sion can be made so flat that the type will not round at the edges, and the impression will not show on the paper. But this cannot be done with old type or with a soft tympan: the impres- 2 7 4 1111A A’! 1V6 REA D l". sion must be regulated to suit the tympan. On fine work, a rounding impression should be avoided, as it not only destroys type, but also thickens the hair-line and wears off the ceriphs. It is not sufficient that the paper should barely meet the type: there must be suflicient force in the impression to trans- fer the ink from type to paper. If there is not sufficient im- pression, it will be necessary to carry much ink on the rollers; and this produces two evils: the type is clogged with ink, and the form becomes foul; too much ink is transferred to the paper, which smears and sets off for want of force sufficient to impress it in the paper. Distinction must be made between a light and weak impression and a firm and even impression. The latter should be secured even if the paper is indented; though that is not always necessary. But a form of old type, a poster, or other solid form, must have a heavy impression, or else a very tedious and careful making-ready. To set 1Vew Tapes—Pass the tape around and close to the cylinder. Lap it over one of the tape pulleys, and then pass it around the small guide pulley on the shaft above. To in- crease its tightness, throw up the guide pulley from the shaft, and set the binding screw more tightly. All these pulleys are movable on their shafts, and distance between them may be altered at pleasure. Let the tapes rest upon the outer margin of the sheet, and see that the overlays on the tympan over which the tapes pass are of equal thickness; if not of equal thickness, the sheet will wrinkle. To set the Fly—Run through a sheet of the paper to be printed, and let it run down the fly so far that it is barely held by the fly pulleys. Then set the cam which works the fly, so that its point just clears the small friction roller on the shaft, and it will throw down the sheet correctly. Tighten the spring according to the size of the sheet, and set the spring crank so that it will prevent the fly from striking too hard on the table. It will be seen that good presswork does not depend entirely upon the press, nor yet upon the workman or the materials. Nor will a superiority in any one point compensate for a de- ficiency in another: the newest type will suffer from a poor roller, and the most careful making-ready will be of no avail if poor ink is used. It is necessary that all the materials should be of the best kind,——that they should be well adapted to each other, and fitly used. Although a good workman can FINE TIA ND-PRESS [IV OR If. 2 7 5 do much with insufficient materials, there are cases where a neglect to comply with one condition is equal to a neglect of allfl) FINE HAND-PRESSWORK. INE presswork is the art of printing perfect impressions from the surface of type or engravings in relief: that is, the subject transferred to paper should be an impression from the surface, and the surface only, of the types or engraved lines, of such a tone as to produce all the effect of which the subject is capable, without either superfluity or deficiency of colour. The press ought to be in the best condition; otherwise it will be impossible to get an equal impression without much trouble and loss of time. The joints of the tympan should not have any play, or the correctness of the register will be affected, and slurs and doubles be caused. The parchments on the tympans should be thin, and of a uniform thickness, and stretched on the tympans so as not to be flaccid. On account of its thinness, smoothness, and uni- formity, silk is probably preferable. The face of the platen ought to be a true plane, and parallel to the press-stone, or table. The advantage of having a good press is unavailing for the production of fine work if the types are much worn; for it is impossible to produce a sharp, clear impression when the type is worn and the fine lines are rounded by much use. In con- sequence of this roundness of the letter, it is necessary to use a thick blanket in the tympan to bring up the type; thus producing a gross and irregular impression of more than the surface. Ink for fine work should be characterized by the following peculiarities :— Intenseness of colour. Impalpability. Covering the surface perfectly of the type or engraving. Quitting the surface of the type or engraving when the paper is pressed on it, and adhering to the paper. Not smearing after it is printed. (1) R. Hoe 8: Co.’s Catalogue. 2 76 PTA/E [1.4 ND-PRE S S PVORff. Complete retention of colour. Ink ought to be reduced to an impalpable smoothness, either in a mill or on a stone with a muller. This is essential, as the process gives it the next quality,—that of completely yet very thinly covering the surface of the type or the lines of the engraving, and insuring an even and perfect appearance to the impression on the paper. Another important requisite is, that the ink shall not only cover the surface of the lines on the paper printed, but that it shall also quit the face of the type or engraving and leave it quite clean when the paper is impressed on it, and attach itself to the paper, so as to give a perfect impression of the subject represented, without the colour of the paper appearing through the ink; and that this peculiarity of quitting the type or engraving and becoming attached to the paper shall continue the same through any number of impressions, without any accumulation of ink on the surface printed from. After having obtained these results, and when the printing is as perfect as it can be made by work- manship, something more is requisite—viz: that the ink shall not smear on being slightly rubbed, and that it shall retain its colour and appearance without spreading at the edges or tinging the paper. The rollers should be in good condition; otherwise the pressman may exert his skill in vain, with a great loss of time and waste of paper. The quality of the paper is of great consequence in fine printing; but it is frequently overlooked by the printer’s employers, who are apt to pay more attention to a showy appearance and a low price than to quality. The best paper for printing on is that which is made of fine linen rags and moderately sized, without the use of acids in bleaching, and without being adulterated with cotton rags: this paper takes water kindly, is easily got into good con- dition, receives a good impression, is durable, preserves its colour, and does not act upon the ink. The use of cotton rags, the introduction of gypsum into the manufacture of fine and other papers, the application of acids and bleaching powders to improve the colour and pro- duce apparently good paper from an inferior staple,——these form the grand hinderances to the American printer in his efforts to equal or excel foreign productions. Hence it is that FL/VE [17A .ND-PRE SS W OR K’. 2 7 7 works printed in this country are less valued than those from the English press, which are printed on paper of fine fabric, made mostly of linen rags, and sufficiently strong to beara fine ink. A pressman should, as a matter of course, be well ac- quainted with the entire routine of presswork; in addition to which, to form his judgment, he should examine the most splendid productions of the press, and study them as patterns of workmanship. In making ready, it must be evident that, when a clear, sharp impression is wanted, the pressure should be on the surface only. Of course the tympan ought not to be very soft, neither should a woollen blanket be used: the most perfect impression will be obtained when fine thick paper alone is placed in the tympans; and even of this article but few thick- nesses should be employed. After an impression is printed, the pressman examines if it be uniform throughout; if it be,——which is very rarely the case,—he goes on with the work; if not, he proceeds to over- lay, in order to produce regularity of pressure and of colour over the whole form. IVherever the impression is weak he pastes a bit of thin, smooth paper, of the size and shape of the imperfect part, on the tympan-sheet; he then pulls another impression, to examine the effect of his overlays, and con- tinues to add to them where wanted, till the pressure of the platen is the same in every part and the impression is of a uniform shade of colour. If the impression come off too strong in parts, or at the edges or corners of the pages or on the head-lines, it will be necessary to cut away the tympan-sheet in those parts, and, if that does not ease the pressure sufficiently, to cut away the same parts from one or more of the sheets that are within the tympans. It is generally preferable to overlay on a sheet of stout smooth paper inside the tympan, particularly where the same press does the whole or great part of the work: this sheet is cut to fit the interior of the tympan, so as not to slip about, and has overlays pasted on it where wanted, to bring up the im- ‘ pression till it is very nearly equal. In all succeeding sheets it saves the pressman a great deal of- time, as he will be certain that when he pulls a sheet of another form of the same work 24 2 7 8 EL/VE HA 1VD-PRESS l/VORR'. it will be nearly right, and he will only have to place thin over— lays on occasional parts to make the impression perfect. It is necessary, where short pages occur in a form, to have bearers to protect their bottom lines and the edges of the ad- joining pages. These may be of double pica reglet, pasted on the frisket, so as to bear on some part of the furniture or chase; but bearers made to the height of the types are better, when they can be used. It happens occasionally that the tympan causes the paper to touch the form partially on being turned down, and occa- sions slurs. This may occur from the parchment being slack or the paper being thin and soft. To prevent this incon- venience, it is customary to roll up a piece of thick paper and paste it on the frisket adjoining the part. Many pressmen prefer pieces of cork cut to about the thickness of double pica, and pasted on the frisket. In working the white paper, instead of pins stuck into the tympan, to prevent the paper slipping, a duck’s bill (a tongue cut in a piece of stout paper) is frequently used: it is pasted to the tympan at the bottom of the tympan-sheet, and the tongue projects in front of it; indeed, the tympan-sheet appears to rest in it. The bottom of each sheet is placed behind this tongue, which supports it while the tympan is turned down. The rollers should be kept clean, but should not be too moist, as this will prevent the ink from distributing equally over them, and from covering evenly the surface of the types or engraving; nor should they be too dry, as in that case they will not dispose of the ink smoothly enough to produce a fine impression, neither will they retain particles of dirt on their surface, but it will part with them to the form, thus causing picks. The ink ought to be rubbed out thinly and equally on the ink-block, so that when it is taken it may be diffused smoothly over the surface of the rollers. It is advisable to keep rubbing the ink out on the block with the brayer, and to distribute the roller almost constantly; the continual friction produces a small degree of warmth, which is of advantage, particularly in cold weather. As uniformity of colour is requisite for beauty in printing, where the form is large the pressman should take ink for every impression: this may be thought troublesome, but it is FL/VE HA ND-PRE SS W ORK 2 7 9 \ advantageous in producing regularity of colour. It is un- pleasant to see in a fine book two pages that face each other differing in colour,—the one a full black, surcharged with ink, the other deficient in quantity and of a gray colour; yet this must happen when, as is frequently the case, three or four sheets are printed with one taking of ink. In fine books, particularly where the paper is large and heavy and the type large, set—off sheets are used to interleave the whole impression while working: these remain till the printed paper is taken down from the poles by the warehouse- man. These set-off sheets are put in when the white paper is working, and moved from one heap to the other during the working of the reiteration. They prevent the ink from setting off from one sheet to another while they are newly printed, from the weight of the paper. To secure uniformity of impression, the pull should be so adjusted in the first instance as to give a proper degree of pressure on the form when the bar is pulled home; then, checking the bar, it should be allowed to rest in that position during a short pause. It will be perceived that, to produce presswork of a highly superior character, great expense and much time are required; and that it is requisite to have a good press in good condi- tion; to have new types, or types whose faces are not rounded by wear; to have good rollers in good condition; that the ink should be strong, of a full black colour, that it will not fade nor stain the paper, and ground so fine as to be impalpable; the paper should be of the best quality, made of linen rags, and not bleached by means of acids or bleaching powders, which have a tendency to decompose the ink; the rolling should be carefully and well done; the face of the type should be completely covered with ink, without any superfiuity, so as to produce a full colour; and the pull should be so regulated as to have a slow and great pressure, and to pause at its maximum in order to fix the ink firmly upon: the paper. These particulars observed, with nothing but paper in the tympans, perfect impressions of the face alone of the type will be obtained, and a splendid book will be produced in the best style of printing“) (ll Adapted from Savage. 2 80 PRLVTL/VG l/VO OD- CU TS. PRINTING WOOD-CUTS. SINGLE block, when imposed in a large chase, may spring out of the chase while being inked, from the quantity of furniture about it. A good plan is to impose it in a job-chase, and to impose this chase in a larger one: this will cause it to lie flatter on the press and firmer in the rolling, the large chas'e being secured firmly on the press by quoins and the corner irons. Before pulling the first impression, the workman should see that the surface of the cut is perfectly clear from particles of dirt, and that no pin or lump of paste is on the tympan. He ought then to pull very gently, or he may injure some of the fine lines of the engraving. , Neither the pressure nor the impression of an engraving on wood should be uniformly equal: if it be, the effect intended to be produced by the artist will fail; and, instead of light, middle tint, and shade, an impression will be produced that possesses none of them in perfection: some parts will be too hard and black, while other parts will have neither pressure nor colour enough, nor any of the mildness of the middle tint, which ought to pervade a large portion of an engraving, and on which the eye reposes after viewing the strong lights and the deep shades. To produce the desired effect, great nicety and patience are required in the pressman: a single thickness of thin India paper, (the best for overlaying,) with the edges scraped down, is frequently required over very small parts. The overlay should never be cut at the edges; but, even where great deli- cacy of shape is not required, it should be torn into the form wanted: this reduces the thickness of the edges, and causes the additional pressure to blend with the surrounding parts. As particular parts of the impression will frequently come up too strong, and other parts too weak, it will be necessary to take out from between the tympans a thickness of paper and add an additional tympan-sheet, cutting away the parts that come off too hard, and scraping down the edges. Scraping away half the thickness of a tympan-sheet in small parts that require to be a little lightened will improve the impression. The light parts require little pressure; but the depths should be brought up so as to produce a full and firm impression. PRINTING WOOD-CUTS. 281 If a block be hollow on the surface, underlaying the hollow part will bring up the impression better than overlaying it, at least so nearly that only a thickness or two of paper will be needed as overlays. If a block be too low, it is better to raise it to the proper height by underlays than to use overlays; as the latter act in some measure as blankets, and are pressed into the interstices, rendering the lines thicker than in the engraving. It will be necessary sometimes, when the surface of the block is very uneven, to tear away parts of the paper in the tympan, to equalize the impression where it is too hard. The pressman will find it convenient to pull a few impres- sions, while he is making ready, on soiled or damaged India paper. Out of these he can cut overlays to the precise shape and size wanted, which are always necessary when great accu- racy is required in overlaying particular portions. He should be provided with a sharp penknife and a pair of good small scissors. A fine sharp bodkin and a needle or two, to take out picks, are also needful; but he should be particularly care- ful so to use them that he do no injury. The best way is, to draw the bodkin or needle point cautiously in the direction of the lines. Engravings in vignette form require great attention to keep the edges light and clear, and in general it is necessary to scrape away one or two thicknesses of paper in order to lighten the impression and keep it clean: the edges being irregular and straggling, they are likely to come off too hard. Bearers type-high placed beside the block will be found ad— vantageous; if they cannot be used, pieces of reglet, pasted on the frisket in the usual way, and taking a bearing on the fur- niture, must be substituted; but the high bearer is to be pre— ferred where it can be adopted. The bearers equalize the pressure on the surface of the engraving, and protect the edges from the severity of the pull, which is always injurious to the delicacy of the external lines. They also render the subject more manageable, by enabling the pressman to add to or diminish the pressure on particular parts, so as to produce the desired effect. ~. \IVhen great delicacy of impression is required in a vignette, it will be found beneficial, after the engraving is inked, to roll the extremities with a small roller without ink: this will not 24*“ 282 PRIJVTING WOOD-CUTS. only take away any superfluity of ink, but will prevent picks, and give lightness and softness to the edges, particularly where the effect of distance is required. ‘ If the extremities are engraved much lighter than the central parts, underlays should be pasted on the middle of the block, which will give a firmer impression to the central parts of the subject. It would save trouble and aid in getting a good im- pression if the block were engraved a little rounded on the face. When highly finished engravings on wood are worked separately, woollen cloth, however fine, should never be used for blankets, as it causes too much impression; a sheet or two of hard smooth paper between the tympans is better; sometimes even a piece of glazed pasteboard is used inside the outer tympan. The parchments ought to be in good con- dition, stretched tight, of a smooth surface, thin, and of regular thickness, so as to enable the pressman to obtain an impres- sion as nearly as possible from the surface only of the en- graved lines. The rollers must be kept in perfect order; and the press- man should be very particular in taking ink and inking the block. He ought to use the best ink that can be procured. When a wood-cut left on the press all night has become warped, lay it on its face upon the imposing-stone, with a few thicknesses of damp paper underneath it, and place over it the flat side of a planer, with sufficient weight upon it: in the course of a few hours the block will be restored to its original flatness. This method is preferable to steeping the block in water; as the steeping swells the lines of the engraving, and, consequently, affects the impression. To preserve the original effect of the cut as it came from the hands of the artist, the block should never be wet with water; and, when it has been worked in a form with types, it should be taken out before the form is washed. To prevent warping during the dinner-hour or the night, turn the tympan down upon the form, run the carriage in, and, pulling the bar-handle home, fasten it so that it will remain in this position during the interim. However long boxwood may be kept in the log, it will always twist and warp when cut into slices for engraving, on account of fresh surfaces being exposed to the air. Large CA RD PRI NI ‘L/V G . 2 8 3 blocks may be restored to their flatness in the course of a night by laying them on a plane surface, with the hollow side downward, without any weight on them. A fine engraving on wood should never be brushed over with ley: the best method is to wipe the ink off with a fine sponge damped with spirits of turpentine, and, if it get foul in working, clean- it with a soft brush and spirits of turpentine; then wipe the surface dry and pull two or three“ impressions on dry waste paper. Spirits of turpentine take off the ink quicker, and affect the wood less, than any other article. The facility with which the block is again brought into a working state more than compensates for the trifling additional ex- pense incurred. \Nhen a few proofs only are wanted from a small engraving, good impressions may be obtained with little trouble on dry India paper, with about six thicknesses of the same sort of paper laid over it, and pulled without the tympan. If proofs are wanted from large ones, it will be found advantageous to put the India paper for a few minutes into a heap of damp paper. To do full justice to an engraving, the pressman should get a good impression from the engraver and place it before him as a pattern, and then arrange the overlays, &c. till he pro- duce a fac-simile in effect. Better still is it for an unpractised hand to obtain the assistance of the artist at the press-side, to direct him in making ready the cut") CARD PRINTING AS, since the introduction of enamelled or polished cards, made rapid strides toward perfection; the fine absorbing quality of the enamel, under proper management, producing the most beautiful results,—in many cases scarcely discernible from copperplate. A card, to be well printed, requires as careful treatment as a wood engraving, (see p. 280,) so far as making ready is concerned, and in working without blankets and using the finest ink. Having made a light impression on the tympan-sheet, place the pins so as to bring the impression as nearly as possible in the centre of the card, one pin at the (“Adapted from Savage. 284 GOLD AJVD BROrVZE PRJNTIA’G. lower side and two at the off side, taking care that the head of the pin does not come in contact with the types. The im- pression should be exceedingly light until properly regulated, ——at no time more than is actually necessary to bring up the face of the type. Cards are now mostly printed on small card-machines, at the rate of one, two, and even ten thousand per hour. All cards should be printed dry. . A small quantity of varnish put on the rollers and well dis- tributed will prevent the enamel from peeling. The addition of a little ultramarine blue will beautifully intensify the black ink used in printing enamelled cards. The patent extension feed guides, or tympan gauge pins, shown on page 310, will be found very convenient and useful. GOLD PRINTING. HE types being made ready for press in the usual manner, the surface is covered in the ordinary way with gold size instead of ink, and the impression taken upon the paper. For a large job, remove only the back from a book of leaf-gold; for a small one, lay a straight edge across the book, and cut it through, of the size required, with the point of a sharp pen- knife. This must be done before using the size. Slightly wet the end of the forefinger of the right hand, and, placing the thumb of that hand on the pile of gold, raise the edge of the paper with the forefinger sufficiently to dampen it with the moisture of that finger; then press the moistened edge of the paper on the gold, and it will adhere sutficiently to enable the fingers to lift gold ‘and paper together and place it on the im- pression. Proceed thus until the size is entirely covered; gently pat the gold with the balls of the fingers, or any soft, pliable substance, until it is set; then, with a very soft hat- brush, remove the superfluous gold, when a clear and beau- tiful impression will appear. Its sharpness will depend on the judgment of the printer in applying the size to the type. BRONZE PRINTING S used more extensively than gold printing, being attended with far less expense in the cost of the material. The method of printing is the same, except that, instead of laying PRINTING IN COLOURS. 285 on the gold—leaf, the impression is rubbed over with the bronze, by dipping a small block, covered with a short, fine fur, or a small wad of raw cotton, into the powder, and brush- ing off the superfluous bronze with a soft brush, as in gold printing. Bronze can be procured of various colours, and when laid on with judgment the effect is beautiful. The palest bronze is best. Chaput’s patent self-feeding bronzing pad, now coming into use, is more expeditious and convenient than the usual method. ' PRINTING IN COLOURS. HEN red and black are to be printed on the same sheet,-—the same pro- cess being applicable to all other colours,— the form is made ready in the usual way, and a Chalk'line is traced INK STONE AND MULLER. around the outside of the chase on the press—bed, to show the exact situation in which the form must be replaced after having been lifted. The form is then laid with its face downward on a letter~board covered with the press-blankets. The words marked in the proof to be printed red are then forced down, and Nonpareil reglets nicely fitted into the vacancies, which raise the red lines and words an equal distance from the other matter. A sheet of paper is then pasted on the form, to keep the i'onpareil underlays in their proper places. The form is again laid on the press, observing the utmost care in placing it in its original position as indicated by the marks before made on the bed. It must then be made perfectly fast to the corner irons, as it is highly important that it remain firm and immovable during its stay on the press. The frisket (which is covered with strong paper) is then put on, the form rolled over with the red ink, and an impression made on it. The red words are then cut out with a sharp-pointed penknife, with so much nicety as not to admit the smallest soil on the paper from the other matter. 286 PRL/VTL/VG [1V COLOURS. The red being finished and the form washed, the com- positor unlocks it, (this should be done on the imposing-stone, as the pressman can easily lay it agreeably to the marks made on the press,) and draws out the red lines, filling up the space with quadrates. l/Vhen this is done, the pressman cuts out the frisket for the black. An extra pair of points are used to pre- vent the black from falling on the red, or, as it is technically termed, riding. Generally, when a great number is to be printed, as many forms are used as there are colours to be printed. Another method of placing the underlays is adopted for broadsides, &c. with large letter and with but two or three lines of red. The red lines are taken out on the press, and underlays are put in, upon which the lines are placed, and the frisket is cut out as before mentioned. A more expeditious method can be employed for forms in which the lines of one colour are not too numerous to be easily lifted. After the form is ready, and the various colours are marked on the proof, a skeleton form is made up, with labour- saving quotation furniture or wood furniture fitted into the spaces of all the lines except those of the colour to be first printed. \Nhen the first colour is printed, its lines are lifted from the form, and the spaces filled with furniture, and the lines for the next colour are set in their proper places and printed; and so on till the job is completed. The custom of printing broadsides, &c. with several colours is so common that ink-makers generally now manufacture coloured inks; consequently the printer can be supplied with- out the delay and labour of making. We give the following particulars, however, for the benefit of those who wish to pre- pare their own colours. Varnish is the common menstruum adopted for all colours in printing. Red is the colour generally used with black. Trieste or English Vermilion, with a small portion of lake, produces a beautiful red, which should be ground with a muller on a marble slab till it be perfectly smooth. If it be in the smallest degree gritty, it clogs the form, and consequently produces a thick and imperfect impression; no pains should, therefore, be spared to render it perfectly smooth; it may then be made to work as clear and free from picks as black. A cheaper red, but not so brilliant, may be prepared with orange mineral, rose pink, and red lead. HOW TO USE DRY COLOURS. 287 Prussian blue makes also an excellent colour, but will require much time and labour to make it perfectly smooth. It is also ground with the best varnish, but made considerably thicker, by allowing a greater portion of colour with the same quantity of varnish than the red; it will then work clear and free from picks. As this colour dries rather rapidly, the rollers should be frequently washed. Other colours may be made,—viz., lake and Indian red, which produce a deep red; verditure and indigo, for blues; orpiment, pink, yellow ochre, for yellows; verdigris and green verditure, for green, &c. All these colours should be ground with soft varnish, being in themselves driers, or they will choke up the form. The consistency of the ink must be governed by the quality of the work to be executed. For a posting-bill or coarse job, the ink should be very thin, the proportion of varnish being much greater than required for fine work. Should the work be a wood-cut, or small type, the pigment should be made as thick as possible. The best colours for printing are those of the lightest body and brightest colour. HOW TO USE DRY COLOURS. O produce fine qualities of coloured printing inks by mix- ing pure dry colours .with varnish, the printer will do well to give heed to the following particulars :— I. No more should be mixed at a time than will be required for the job in hand. 2. Coloured inks should be mixed upon a slate or marble slab, by means of the muller, and never upon an iron or other metallic table. The table, before mixing, should be thoroughly clean, and perfectly free from the slightest soil or trace of other inks. 3. For working coloured inks, the roller should not be too hard, and should possess a biting, elastic face. “7 hen change of colour is required, it should be cleaned with turpentine, and a moist sponge passed over the face, allowing a few minutes for the roller to dry before resuming its use. For bronze printing, the roller should have a firm face, or the tenacity of the preparation may destroy it; yet it must 288 HOI/V TO ll/IULTIPLY'COLOURS. have sufiicient elasticity to deposit the preparation freely and cleanly on the type. 4. Various shades may be produced by observing the fol- lowing directions :— BRIGHT PINK INK.—Use carmine or crimson lake. DEEP SCARLET.-—TO carmine add a little deep Vermilion. BRIGHT RED.—-TO pale vermilion add carmine. DEEP LILAc.———To cobalt blue add a little carmine. PALE LILAc.—To carmine add a little cobalt blue. BRIGHT PALE BLUE—Cobalt. DEEP BRONZE BLUE—Chinese. GREEN.—TO pale chrome add Chinese blue; any shade can be obtained by increasing or diminishing either colour. EMERALD GREEN.—MIX pale chrome with a little Chinese blue, then add the emerald until the tint is satisfactory. AMBER—T0 pale chrome add a little carmine. DEEP BROWN—Burnt umber, with a little scarlet lake. PALE BRO\VN.-—Burnt sienna; a rich shade is made by adding a little lake as above. 5. GoLD PREPARATION. Print as with ordinary ink, then put on the bronze powder with a broad camel-hair brush; allow the impressions to remain a short time for the prepara- tion to set, then clean off the superfluous bronze: the im— pressions will be much improved if passed through rollers. HOW TO MULTIPLY COLOURS. PRINTER who has on hand a stock of yellow, carmine, blue, and black inks, may produce other colours and shades by intermixing as follows :— Yellow and carmine, mixed, will give . . . . . . . . . Vermilion. Carmine and blue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Purple. Blue and black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deep blue. Carmine, yellow, and black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Brown. Yellow and blue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Green. Yellow and black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bronze green. Yellow, blue, and black . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Deep green. Lighter shades may be obtained by adding proper propor- tions of white ink. CONTRAST OF COLOURS. 289 CONTRAST OF COLOURS. T is wrongly supposed that the art of arranging colours so as to produce the best effects in printing is entirely de- pendent on the taste of the operator; for harmony is deter- mined by fixed natural laws. The increasing demand for decorative or ornamental work renders it of some importance to the letter-press printer to make himself acquainted with these laws; as, without some attention to them, the most ele- gant designs of the type founder, and the finest inks that can be made, may yield but an indifferent, if not a decidedly un- pleasing, result. The following remarks will be of use to persons to whom the subject is new; but for a thorough explanation of it they should refer to Chevreul on CoZonmy—a valuable work in the French language, which has been translated into English. 1. We may, in the first place, consider WHITE LIGHT as composed of three primary colours—blue, red, and yellow—- duly blended; these three, in an infinite variety of proportion, serving to produce all the hues in creation. If we take any two of these primaries and mix them, we have a secondary colour. Thus, blue and red form ziz'olez‘, blue and yellow give green, red and yellow make orange. Each of these secondary colours harmonizes perfectly with the primary which does not enter into its composition. Violet, for instance,——itself a mix— ture of red and blue,—-—harmonizes with yellow; green, having no red in its composition, agrees well with red; orange, in the same way, forms a perfect contrast with blue. Either of these contrasts has the effect of mutually brightening the colours employed; a red and a green, &c. being more beautiful when placed side by side than when viewed singly. This is termed the HARMONY OF CONTRAST OF COLOURS; and a good example of it is seen in the scarlet geranium, or the holly; the one showing a light green leaf opposed to a bright red flower, and the other a deep green leaf with a dark red berry. The mixing of colours is a very different thing from eon- Irasz‘z'ng them ; for strange as it may seem, although one com— bination of the primary colours gives while, yet another proportion will produce black. IIVhile, then, red and green look beautiful side by side, it does not generally answer to 25 2 90 COA'TRAST OF COL O URS. print red ink on green paper. The reason is, that as the ink is slightly transparent, some of the green shows through it, and appears somewhat black, and thus lowers the brilliance of the red in the same degree as so much black ink would, if mixed with it. This remark will apply to orange or yellow on a blue paper, &c. The darker and fuller the body of colour used, the less it is affected in this manner. The most perfect contrasts are those above mentioned, which are formed by the complementary colours; yet the pri- maries blue, red, and yellow also agree well together. But if such colours as are not in harmony are placed near each other, the effect is very damaging to their brightness. \Nhile red is made more brilliant by the proximity of green, it is dimmed and spoiled by placing it next an orange. Neither blue nor red contrasts well with violet, because the latter contains each of these colours in its composition. In any case where they must come into juxtaposition, the unpleasant effect may be lessened by adding a little of the opposite colour: so, if a violet is to contrast with red, it will be well to give it a shade of blue, making it more parole; if, on the other hand, it is to contrast with blue or green, it should be made redder. II. CoLouRs WITH BLACK. In all contrasts, the depth of the colour is an important element, but especially so in such as are to be affected by the presence of black. In but few instances will the latter bear the neighbourhood of a very deep colour to advantage, while it harmonizes with the lighter ones by contrast of tone. Yellow, from its near approach to white, should always be worked “full;” orange and green should also be full, and moderately deep in tone, to contrast with black. If a blue employed, it should be light, or it will im- poverish the black and be weakened itself. A very light blue border, with a broad margin of white between it and the body of matter enclosed, will give a clean, bright look to black ink, and whiteness to the paper. A light pink (such as carmine reduced with flake-white or with clear varnish) is also good; yet perhaps the preceding is preferable. Dark and heavy borders are frequently a positive injury to printing, where the working in a light shade would have secured a good effect; for the border should always be so far secondary to the matter enclosed as not to draw off the attention too much to itself. COzVTRAST OP COLOURS. 29I III. CoLoURs ON TINTED PAPERS AND TINTED GRoL'NDs. Besides the kind of harmony already mentioned, there is an- other, which is produced by the contrast of light and dark shades of the same colour. This might be employed in letter- press more frequently than it is at present, with some advan- tage, as the effects it is capable of yielding are very chaste and pleasing. In a photograph or an engraving, all the effect is dependent on difference of tones of one colour; and the beauty of a wood in summer consists chiefly in the contrast displayed by a variety of shades of green only. A deep green ink on a paper of a light tone of the same colour is especially good, if a heavy letter is used; and indeed in most printing in colours, full, solid-faced letter should be preferred to outlines or shaded ones, which are difficult to work, and have at best but an inferior appearance unless the darkest tones are employed. A deep blue on a light blue ground, or against a light blue bor- der, is also good; and without the latter accompaniment it is not unpleasant on a blue wove writing-paper. To secure the proper effect, however, the tints should be of the same law; that is, if the groundwork is of a bluish green, the colour that is to be worked upon it should also be a green inclining to blue; if, on the other hand, the ground is of a yellower green, the body of ink should also be yellower; and so on. This may easily be managed by adding a small portion of ink of the colour required, until the hue is matched. IV. NEUTRAL TINTs. In selecting borders for the more chaste description of printing, it is a pretty safe rule to avoid such as cover much surface, if they are to be worked in any strong colour or in black. \Nhen lighter tints are used, they will bear extension over a larger surface; and in this case a pale gray or neutral border will have a beneficial effect on any body with which it is contrasted, as well as on black itself, which is purified by its proximity. If the central printing is in black only, or in black and yellow, a lavender gray may be substituted for the border. And in any case in which the central matter is all in one colour, it will improve it to have a border of gray which is s/z'g/zfly tinged wz'Z/z z‘lze complonwm‘aliv of such colour. Thus, if the body be red, a very small portion of green may be added to the gray; and so forth. It must be remembered that in ornamental printing abso- 292 CLEANING IVOOD TYPE. lute cleanliness is indispensable. The same roller should never be used for different colours, even after it has been washed. Instead of hanging exposed to dust and to the air, rollers should be kept in a tightly-closed box; and in this manner they will remain a long time in good order. The tins of ink should be similarly preserved, and the lids never left off except at the moment of using from them. These are small matters; but it is only by patient attention to minute details that excellence can be attained in printing. OILING A PRESS. XCESSIVE lubrication is wasteful, unclean, and hurtful to a press. A small quantity of oil should be used at a time, as a large amount will overrun on the press, and hold the dust and grit caused by sweeping the floor; these, working into the journals, will wear the press more than use. The best oil should be used, whether sperm, lard, or coal. Kerosene may be used to clean the ways of a press when they have become gummed by the use of improper oil. Presses should always be kept scrupulously clean. HOW TO TREAT WOOD TYPE. O prevent warping, all very large wood type should be set up on the edge when put away, so that both sides may be equally exposed to the air. In cleaning it, neither ley nor water should be employed under any circumstances. Tur- pentine, camphene, benzine, or kerosene oil may be used; but turpentine and camphene are the best. Procure a small, shallow pan; lay the form flat on a board; pour about six tablespoonfuls of turpentine into the pan; touch the face of the brush to the turpentine, and pass it quickly over the form before it evaporates. Six to eight spoonfuls of fluid will be found sufficient to clean a large form, if thus used. III I" III PALETTE KNIFE. WAREHOUSE DEPARTMENT. THE WAREHOUSEMAN. HE warehouseman should be a man sober and upright, and tho- roughly competent to the business, on whom entire reliance may be placed,——one who will act upon the principle of making his employer’s interest the end of all his action. The employer or foreman should frequently look to the concerns of the warehouse, and see that all the work is forwarded with despatch and accuracy. The warehouseman should be provided with a book, termed “The \IVarehouse Book,” with pages annexed, on the follow- ing plan, and about the size of foolscap quarto :— BuTLnn’s New AMERICAN ARITHMETIC. (No. PRINTED, 5000.) RECEIPT OF NO. OF TO \VHOM DE- DATE. PAPER, AND OF COPIES DE- LIVERED, AND RE— FOR \\'HOI\I. “'IIOM. LIVERED. CEIPTED FOR. May 3. 3 reams of E. C. & P. H. \Varren. June 8. 4o ditto. , “ 24. . . . . . . . . . 2500 Speel & Co. I. H. Butler 1 “ 3o. . . . . . . . . . 2000 R. Eyelet, binder. & Co. Aug.4. . . . . . . . . . 300 Paul Picot. “ ‘ “ 5. With waste 230 \Vm. Crouse. “ 503° 25*‘ 29 3 294 GIVING OUT PAPER TO WET. When the paper is brought, the warehouseman should at once compare it with the bill of delivery, and, if right, enter the quantity immediately into the warehouse book. The number of printed copies delivered to the binder or publisher should also be entered, and his signature be taken at the time of delivery. This plan will prevent disputes with the book- seller or author relative to the receipt of paper or the delivery of sheets. Having entered the receipt of the paper, the warehouseman should then write on each bundle, with red chalk, the title of the book it is to be used for, and remove it into a convenient part of the warehouse, or into a store—room provided for that purpose. GIVING OUT PAPER TO WET. ABUNDLE of paper consists of two reams, or forty quires, each quire containing twenty-four sheets. Formerly, the two outside quires were called cassie quires, as they were mostly made up of torn, stained, wrinkled, or otherwise im- perfect sheets. At present, all the quires are considered good, although some outer sheets are injured by the twine used in tying up the bundles. It is the general custom to print of every work what is termed an even number,—-either 250, 500, 750, 1000, &c. These quantities are given out for the wetter in lo/cens,—viz.: for 250 sheets, one token, containing 10 quires 18 sheets; for 500, two tokens, one II quires, and the other IO quires and a half; for 750, three tokens, two of them II quires each, and the other IO quires 6 sheets; and for 1000, four tokens, three of them II quires each, and the other IO quires. If a work is printed in half-sheets, it of course requires only half the above quantities. It would be dificult to form any positive and invariable rule for the quantity to be given out for short numbers, as it must depend in some degree upon the quality of the paper. The more expensive papers, on which, generally, short num- bers or fine copies are printed, must be given out more sparingly than common paper, and the tympan and register sheets be supplied by a more common sort, cut to the size of the finer. For numbers up to 150, on ordinary paper, six HANGL/VG UP PAPER TO DRY 295 sheets over will be sufficient. Some publishers are very testy on this point of allowance for waste. In giving out paper for what are termed jobs, the amount necessary can easily be found by a simple calculation in division. For example, a job, (label or any thing else,) 750 in number, 32 on a sheet, will require 24 sheets, which will give 32)220(23 an overplus of 18. \IVhere a sheet has to be cut into 376 many parts, allowance must be made for accidents. 96 The overplus sheets are allowed for tympan-sheets, ~12 register-sheets, and other incidents, such as bad sheets, faults committed in rolling, pulling, bad register, &c. ; in any of these casualties, the pressman doubles the sheet in the middle and lays it across the heap. In laying out the paper, the warehouseman reverses every other token, to enable the wetter to distinguish the different tokens. \IV hen this is done, he labels the heap, thus: American Prz'm‘er, flIay IO, 1878,—that the pressman may know how long it has been wet, and the state it is in for working. HANGING UP PAPER TO DRY. HEN the paper is worked off and counted, the ware- houseman carries the heap to the drying-room, where the poles are fixed for the purpose of hanging the sheets upon to dry, and lays it down on a table of convenient height, with one end of the heap toward him. He then takes the handle of the peel in one hand, and lays the top part down upon the heap, so that the upper edge may reach near the middle of the sheet; then, with the other hand, he doubles over as much of the printed paper as he thinks sufficient to hang up at one lift, which should be about twelve sheets, according to the pole- room to hang them. ' In hanging up the lifts, he places them so that each lift will lap about an inch over the preceding one. It is necessary, where the end of the pole is exposed to a strong current of air from a window, to lock the last lift. This is done by fold- ing a lift two or three times, so as to concentrate its weight in a small compass, and hanging this over the last lift near the window. 296 FILLING L/V AND PRESSL/VG STTEETS. TAKING DOWN SHEETS WHEN DRY. HEN the sheets are sufficiently dry, the warehouseman takes his peel and begins with the last lift hung up, on account of the wrapper being with that lift, and proceeds in the reverse order of hanging them up, successively taking them down, and brushing them, if dusty, till he has finished the whole. Another way of taking the sheets down from the poles is, to lay the flat side of the peel against the edge of that lift which hangs over the other sheets, and push the peel forward, forcing them to slide, one lift over another. But by this method the dust which settles on the sheets while hanging is rubbed in. FILLING IN AND PRESSING SHEETS. HEN the sheets are taken down, the warehouseman removes them to the warehouse, where they are filled in between smooth pasteboards made for the purpose. This operation is generally performed by boys, who, after a little practice, become exceedingly expert at it. We shall try to be somewhat minute in our description of this operation. \Ne will suppose the pasteboards to have sheets between them, which will be the case after they have been once used. The warehouse being provided with long tables or benches, secured to the wall, and a sufficient number of movable tables about the size of the largest paper, the warehouseman places one of the small tables endwise against the long one, forming a right angle, upon which to lay the pressed sheets as they come out of the boards; the boy then takes his stand at the right side of the table, with the dry unpressed sheets at his right hand and the pasteboards at his left, somewhat elevated, leaving sufficient space before him to fill in the sheets. He then pro- ceeds as follows. He first moistens the thumb of his right hand and reaches across to the pasteboards at his left, draw- ing one off with his thumb and placing it before him; he then catches a sheet of the dry paper also with his right hand and places it as near the centre of the pasteboard as possible; then, twisting his body nimbly round to the left, he slides the pressed sheet from the pile of pasteboards to the table at his COUNTING OUT. 297 left side, and, in resuming [his former position, again draws off a pasteboard with his thumb; and so on, till the gross or bun- dle is filled. It is then laid aside, and another bundle filled and laid across the former, tak— ing care always to keep the bun- dles separated until they are'put in press, when they are sepa- rated by smooth boards made of cherry or other hard wood. The bundles being all filled in, the warehouseman proceeds to fill up the standing-press, put- ting in one bundle at a time and placing a pressing-board be- tween them; there should also be a stout plank introduced between the top board and the platen. In case the press should not hold quite as much as de- sired, more may be got in by unscrewing the press after it has been once screwed down. The press is finally screwed down as tight as possible. It 'MPROVED STAND'NG PRESS‘ should remain so for at least twelve hours, when it should be entirely emptied before the sheets are taken out of the boards. The sides of the piles or heaps must be kept perfectly even. In large offices, hydraulic presses are used. COUNTING OUT AND PUTTING AWAY SHEETS. HEN the sheets are taken out, the warehouseman knocks them up, and, after counting them into quires, ties them up in wrappers, marking the name of the work and signature on each bundle. Two or three sheets of each signature should be laid aside, in case the author, bookseller, or employer should want a copy of the work or a specimen of as many sheets as are finished. 298 SIZES OF PAPER. STANDARD SIZES OF MACHINE-MADE PAPER. (Furnished oy Charles .Magarge 69° Co., Philadelphia.) PRINTING PAPER. Medium . inches, 19X 24 Royal . . . . . . 20x 25 Super Royal . . . 21 x 27 Imperial . . 22 x 32 Royal and Half, inches, 25 X 30 Double Medium . Imperial and Half . . 32 X 33 Double Super Royal . 27 >< 42 Double Imperial, 32 x 44 .24x38 Other sizes kept on hand, but without technical names, are as follows :—22 X 28; 24 x 36; 25 x 39; 26 x 40; 28 x42. \NRITING PAPER. Note . inches, 8 x 10 F oolscap . Packet Note. . . 9 ><11% Flat Cap. . Letter . . . . . . IO >< I6 Crown . Commercial Post, II ><17 Demy . Packet Post . 11% x 18% Folio . .inches, . . . . .14><2,I . 17x22 A TABLE For ascertaining Z/ze Number of Forms for a Book of any Size, and the Quantity of Paper necessary to print a thousand copies in any form, from Octa'z/o to 361720, lza/f-s/zeetwz'se. $8,182, 810. 121110. l6m0. 18m0. 241110. 321110. ! 361110. 525553.525, 1 l PAGES. PAGES. PAGES. PAGES. PAGES. PAGES; PAGES. ‘REAMSQRS. 1 8 12 16 18 24 32 36 1 2 2 16 24 32 36 48 64 72 :2 4 8 24 36 48 54 2 96 108 8 6 4 32 48 64 72 96 128 I44 4 8 5 4o 60 8o 90 120 160 180 5 10 6 48 72 96 108 144 192 216 I‘ 6 12 7 56 84 112 126 168 224 252 7 14 8 64 96 128 144 192 256 288 8 16 .9 72 108 144 162 216 288 324 9 18 10 80 120 160 180 240 320 360 11 11 88 132 176 198 264 352 396 12 2 2 96 144 192 216 288 384 432 18 4 18 104 1 56 208 234 312 416 468 14 6‘ 14 112 168 224 252 336 448 504 15 8 15 120 180 240 270 360 480 . . . 16 10 16 128 192 256 288 384 512 17 1;? 17 136 204 272 306 408 . . . . . . 18 14 18 144 216 288 324 432 . . . . . . 19 16- 19 152 228 304 342 456 . . . . . . :80 18 20 160 240 320 360 480 . . . . . . :22 21 168 252 336 378 504 . . . . . . :28 2 2.8 176 264 352 396 . . . . . . . . . :2 4 28 I84 276 368 414 . . . . . . . . . 25 6' 24 192 288 384 432 . . . . . . . . . 26 8 25 200 300 400 450 . . . . . . . . . :27 10 26 208 312 416 468 . . . . . . . . . 28 12 27 216 324 432 486 . . . . . . . . . 29 14 28 224 336 448 504 . . . . . . . . . 8 16 2.9 232 348 464 . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 18 80 240 360 480 88 81 248 372 496 84 2 82 256 384 512 8 4 88 264 396 528 86 6 84 272 408 544 87 8 85 280 420 560 . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 10 86 288 432 576 . . . . . . . . . . . . 89 12 87 296 444 592 . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 14 88 304 456 608 . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 16 89‘ 312 468 4.‘? 18 40 320 480 44 EXAMPLE—H0111 many reams will be required for a 121110 600k containing 408 pages? Find the number of pages (408) in the 12mo column : in the outer column on the left of the table the number of forms is seen, and in the outer column on the right the quantity of paper required is given. 299 jOBBING FACILITIES. HERE is no department in the art that is better provided with means for its efficient prosecution than job printing. It is true that an establishment fully provided with all the old and new conveniences will in- volve a very considerable outlay; yet a beginner in a small way, who has to count the cost carefully, may avail himself of many facilities which were unknown a score of years ago. The smaller the capital, the more need for the exercise of a wise dis- cretion in the selection of material. Regard should be had to the special line of work to be undertaken, and the type and presses adapted to that line should be selected. If the master himselfshall work with head and hand, perseveringly and early and late, and shall do good work at fair prices—never cutting-under to secure a job at non-paying rates,—and shall be obliging in manner and punctual in delivery, and shall waste no dimes in drink or other useless expenses, the growth of his business will be only a matter of time; and‘he will gradually be able to order just what that growth necessitates, until he shall find himself the proprietor of a well-appointed office and a paying business. In his first outlay and in all his additions, the best of every kind should be gotten, if possible, as cheap things always prove dear. It matters little how well appointed an ofl'ice may be, there will be no gains in it unless the proprietor, counting the cost carefully, makes sure that every job shall pay a reasonable profit. He will be aided in this by consulting DeVinne’s Printer’s Price List, and other similar works that show the results reached by intelligent practical printers. 300 YOBBIIVG PA CILI TIE S. 30 I When a job is taken in, it should be fully entered in a volume, giving all particulars in regard to the number of copies, style, and price. This may serve as a Day Book or Blotter. A memorandum-slip, like the following, may be filled out for each job, and kept on file after the work shall have been completed:— Zlu. of ('lit‘tim' ......................................... .. Size of Card, Paper or Book, when finished ............................ Quality ......................................................................................................... .. Number of Copies Style of Yjlpe ................................................................ ........................... .. Size of Form ............................................................................................. .. Colour of In/e ............................................................................................ .. Time of Composition ............................................................................. .. Time on Press ................................................................................................. .. Proof wanted ........................................................................................... .. Goods to be called for ........................................................................... .. U H delivered ............................................................................. .. Price ............................................................................................................. .. Paid in advance, ,8‘ ........................................................................................ .. Date ........................................................... .. It will be satisfactory to keep what may be called an Es- timate Book, in which may be entered the particulars of esti- mates given for various kinds of work, whether the job be secured or not, these particulars will be time-saving when a similar piece of work comes in for estimate. Samples of paper, of all grades and colours, may be kept in a convenient receptacle, cut up into various sizes, and with memoranda written on each sample to denote the cost per ream, the weight, and the number of pieces in a sheet. A useful thing to have in a job oflice is Ames’s Paper and Card Scale, for fractional sizes, showing the number of pieces of any required size that can be cut from a sheet without waste, 26 3 O 2 YOBBL/VG PA C I L f T [E S. with a table giving the number of sheets required to cut 1000 pieces, and another showing the cost of paper by the quire, sheet, and hundred sheets, at any given price per ream. Besides the above, we may mention Le Blond’s Chart, a very compact affair, showing the number of any given size of card that can be cut out of a card sheet 22 x 28 inches. I- I - - ~ /. I. -?.?F , l LABOUR-SAVING RULE CASE. The modern printer has every convenience that can be de- sired in the way of cases, and his type and other material are amply provided with receptacles well adapted for each special use. There are not only large and small cabinets, filled with job cases of various styles and capacities, but there may be had cases for rules, leads, and furniture, as well as blank cases for indefinite uses. We give representations of these. YOEBL/VG FA CILI TIES. ” LABOUR-SAVING SLUG CASE. BLANK CASE. 304 J‘YOEBL/VG PA CfLf T [E S. All cases should be labelled, and the label should be printed in the same type that is contained in the case. Capitals and lower-case job types should not be laid to- gether in the same boxes. The saving of time in a year will pay for extra cases. job type-cases should be kept in cabinets, and not in stand- racks, as the latter cannot be used without interfering with the hand whose stand may contain the case wanted. Various kinds of cabinets are shown on pages 219-221, 231 and 234, some of which are constructed to hold cases and quad and space boxes. ‘All matter should be cleared away as soon as done with. This work can be done by careful boys. Standing galleys,or cabinets with galley tops, for type to be kept awhile, will be I found useful and conve- nient; but matter pre- served _for occasional future use were better papered up and label- ed or stored away lock- ed up in a chase cabinet. (See p. 231.) A rack with sloping boards to support the forms will prove to be a safe and convenient place for keeping the forms of type which need to be held standing. Labour—saving leads, and slugs, and reglets, cut to varying lengths, when not in use, should be kept in cases specially provided for them. And so with labour-saving brass rule, quotation furniture, rule, etc. It is economical as well as tidy to have appropriate places for every thing. CABINET OF CASES, WITH GALLEY TOP. yoeB/No FA e/z [TL/35L 305 For fixed measures, or measures not often changed, the standard screw composing-sticks are probably the best; but Ia" IIIIIIIIIIIIIIIWMWIIIIIj IIIII 'XOIIS STUEIAOUE) ')IOI.LS SrAUflHMEIN ')IOI.LS NI‘DINVEH Z iei'll'i Iiiliiihiii ‘II Im II III 1‘, ‘I IIIIIIIIII , HIIIIIIIIII. i I I ' "l" ‘I I III-1 I. I I . I i I III '>IQ|.LS 80f‘ NBOOOM III I I ‘ I .IIIIIIIIII .1» “I .7 _\ all IIY' van... illIlIl ‘)IOLLS NOIB'HI ‘)IOLLS .LNELLVd SrHOH 'HOLLS .LNELLVd SrONOWAVU for jobbing and table-work, where the measure is frequently altered, it will be well to use the new styles, such as are shown above; no screw-key or screw-driver being required, the latter can be quickly and easily set to a new measure. 26-»- 306 j’OBBL/VG FA CILZTZES. The boxwood quoin will probably continue to hold its place, though not a few printers favour the use of the newly-invented iron articles ofl’ered by various inventors, such as Webb’s :- l llllllllllll l I 1 . u,‘ “5' \\\.\ ‘\(Uhiflii \ ' l \ \. .i'_d—__“ \ \_ 'l l ||_|lllillllllllllllllllmllllmmumlmmlllm... l __ ALLEN’S QUOIN. WEBB’S QUOIN. — E AMES'S QUOIN. Mechanical Quoin, (which has a lateral spread of from one- quarter to three-quarters of an inch;) Ames’s Patent Quoin, combining the action of the screw, wedge, and lever; Hoe’s Patent Quoin, Allen’s, and Hempel’s. YOEBING FACILITIES. 307 Among the very handy things to have about an office, we may enumerate the circular and hollow quadrates, shown on pages 79 and 80; corner quadrates, cast in type metal; and CORNER QUADRATES. also the brass line-formers, shown on page 81, that enable the workman to curve lines expeditiously. Even so simple a thing as a shooting-stick, com- monly made of stout ash or hickory, is now to be had'in brass or iron. These latter are certainly dura- ble, but dangerous in care— less hands. b-_ “£5 ‘- lllllll MITERING MACHINE. A miter-ing machine and lead-cutter are among the neces_ sary adjuncts of a printing office. LEAD CUTTER. 308 YOEBL/VG PACZLJTIES. Perforating Rule is slightly higher than type, and is used in printing coupons and tickets which require to be partially severed while going through the press. It is made of brass or steel. A more convenient (as well as more expen- PERFORATING Rum sive) article is Ames’s Patent Perforator: its knife, or perforator, lies below the surface of the type while the rollers pass over the form, and rises and makes a clean cut when the impression is on, without injuring the rollers. Machines for per- forating round holes are manufactured of several sizes. The lowest-priced ma- chine may be worked on a counter, and will perforate every kind of card-board or pa- - per. We give a cut ROUND HOLE PERFORATING MACHINE. of Style_ Imposing Stones may be had with drawers and cases un- derneath; but these we do not deem advisable, unless the printer be cramped in room, as the cases may he wanted when the stone is in use while imposing or correct- ing forms. For common use, the plain stone with a single drawer, and with— out a rim, will be found the nicest. When made otherwise, the rim should be fitted snugly to the stone, or the interstices will become filled with types, dropped in while IMPOSING STONE. ' correcting. yoeeL/vo FACILITIES. 309 A very convenient *xcqggqa, device for the com- ‘ positor is the Copy- Holder. This, how- ever, is for the book compositor rather than for the jobber. Its utility consists in bringing the copy nearer to the eye of the workman, and in leaving all the boxes‘ at command and un- . . covered by the manu- COPY-HOLDER- script or printed page. There is also a Lamp-Holder which Will be found handy Where gas is not accessible. Card Cutters are made of several styles, and at prices from fourteen dol— lars to forty—five; and Paper Cutters are yet more numerous, IIY-ErseQEItIe-ra\ref _,, f l ' “Qf/ TI‘. " ~ - some 0 t iem snn- . ple and low-priced, and others massive and costing twelve hundred dollars. \/Ve give an engraving “\I i" .. ‘III... of one of moderate El, will“ price. An extensive run of business only would require the employment of a large paper cutter. 3 I O YOBBDVG FA CZLITIES. Several contrivances for facilitating press operations have been invented. \Ve may mention Megill’s Patent Gauge Pin, \w‘“ MEGILL’S PATENT GAUGE PIN- of sizes suitable for various margins. Two small teeth, pro- jecting from the lower side of the head of the pin, press into the tympan sheet and prevent the gauge from moving. There is also the Extension Feed- Guide, which furnishes a gauge below the edge of the platen, and is held firmly in place by the tympan-clamp. \IVhen long num- bers are printed, the Automatic Counter may be attached to 7 g , . the press. It counts HARM, COUNTER_ only when the form is being printed, and shows the exact number in plain figures up to 100,000. Se- veral styles of counting machines are made. An ink fountain has been contrived for attachment to the Gordon job press, or any other press with similar plate distribu- tion. It is quite a cosey little thing, and is operated by the impression arm of the press. EXTENSION FEED-GUIDE. ‘ Md?» ' mum v r". “"I“ mullln" “Jinn , ~.. PATENT INK FOUNTAIN. Iron furniture is made in sets containing twenty—one pieces, adapted for use on the eighth, quarter, and half medium job presses. USEFUL RECEIPTS.” RIN T ERS ’ R01167’8.—IO% lbs. genuine Irish glue, 2% gallons black molasses or honey, 1 lb. India-rubber dis- solved in alcohol, 2 oz. Venice turpentine, 12 oz. glycerine, 4 oz. strong vinegar. DIRECTIONS :——Soak the glue over-night, and drain in the morning by means of a. covered colander for one hour. Boil molasses, and skim for twenty minutes. Add the India-rubber, and stir until it combines with the molasses. Add glue, and boil for forty minutes, occasionally stirring the mass. Put in Venice turpentine and glycerine; boil six or seven minutes, and pour. NOTE—This is the receipt for making the mysterious “ black composition” so durable and elastic, and known to but very few persons until recently. If properly handled it cannot be excelled, and contains every element required in a roller. Caution must be taken that only purified rubber is used. German Preserz/ative for RotIers.—Corrosive sublimate 2 drachms, fine table salt 2 oz.; put together in half a gallon _of soft water—let it stand twenty-four hours. ‘When rollers are clean washed with ley, sponge them with the above mix- ture twice a week. Directions for Recasting RoZIers.—Sponge the face of the roller with hot water; scrape ofi?~ the face thoroughly with a knife; take the composition off the stock and cut it up small. If the roller has been used only a short time, it may be melted about as readily as new composition; if it is older, put it in a sieve or basket and soak it in cold water for about fifteen or twenty minutes; take it out of the water, cover with a damp cloth, and leave over-night; then melt as usual. If composi- tll Mostly from the Paper and Printing Trader Yum-9:111, London. 3 I I 312 USEFUL RECEIPTS. K tion is too hard, wait till it is melted, and stir in a sufficient quantity of common molasses; avoid heavy, clarified syrups. Printers’ Ley.———No. I.—Dissolve 28 lbs. of soda in 52 gal- lons of water, to which add 7 lbs. of soft-soap, boiled. Stir well together. Printers’ Ley.——No. 2.—Boil 3 gallons of water in a copper; throw in while boiling % lb. of unslacked lime and 2 lbs. of common soda; stir well for fifteen minutes. Let it settle till cold, when it must be taken out without disturbing the sedi- ment, and the liquid is then fit for use. Printers’ Ley.——-No. 3.—Table salt 2 oz., unslacked lime 2 lb., Scotch washing soda (bruised) 2 lb. Put together in 3 gal- lons of water, stir well; when settled, ready for use. NoTE.—This ley, if prepared carefully, is very strong, and will wash off almost any colour. A Strong W/zite Paste—Dissolve 2% oz. of gum-arabic in 2 quarts of water, and stir it into I pound of wheat flour until the whole becomes of a pasty consistency. It is then to be heated, and 1% oz. each of sugar of lead and alum dissolved in a little water added thereto, and the composition well stirred until it shows signs of boiling, when it must be removed from the fire. Add while hot 6 drops of carbolic acid. This is a very tenacious and durable paste, and may be used on almost any substance. Pastes for Fixing Labels on Glass—No. I.-—Take of gum- arabic 1 oz., boiling water and glycerine 2 fluid ounces each.‘ Make a solution. No. 2.—-Take of gum-arabic and powdered gum tragacanth . % oz. each, water ‘1% oz., acetic acid 20 drops. Mix. The acid is used to prevent chemical change, although a stiff paste made of tragacanth alone is not inclined to spoil by fermen- tation. T 0 .Make a good Mieilage—The best quality of mucilage is made by dissolving clear glue in equal volumes of water and strong vinegar, and adding one-fourth of an equal volume of alcohol, and a small quantity of a solution of alum in water. USEFUL RECEIPTS. 3 I 3 The action of the vinegar is due to the acetic acid which it contains. This prevents the composition from gelatinizing by cooling; but the same result may be accomplished by add- ing a small quantity of nitric acid. Some of the preparations offered for sale are merely boiled starch, or flour, mixed with nitric acid to prevent the gelatinizing. Liquid Glue—Take some good strong glue and mix it with full proof whisky. Let it digest for three or four days, and it will be ready for use. Strong IIIncilage—The Yonrnal de P/zarmacie states that if, to a strong solution of gum-arabic measuring 8% fluid 02., a solution of 30 grains of sulphate of aluminium dissolved in % of an oz. of water be added, a very strong mucilage is formed, capable of fastening wood together, or mending por- celain or glass. Gum for Backing Labels.—Take any quantity of clear, pure dextrine and mix it with boiling water until it assumes the consistency of ordinary mucilage. Apply thinly with a full- bodied, evenly made, and wide camel’s-hair brush. The paper should not be too thin or unsized. The preparation will dry quickly, and adhere when slightly wet. NOTE—NO more of the dextrine should be mixed at one time than can be used at once, as it cannot be remelted easily. Micilage for Postage Stamps, Envelopes, etc., is composed of dextrine 2 parts, acetic acid 1 part, alcohol 1 part, water 5 parts. Common Prepared Glue—Dissolve 2 lbs. good common glue in 3 pints warm water, and add 1 quart of strong vine- gar. Ready to use after twenty-four hours. For making IIIagenta Smface Paper—1% oz. of Magenta, (aniline,) % oz. Bismarck brown, (aniline,) 1 cake of glue; put these into 4 gallons of boiling water. Coat the paper with this, ,using an 8-inch double-filled camel’s-hair brush. Quantity given will coat two reams of double-crown. A hard-sized paper must be used. 27 314 USEFUL RECEIPTS. Coloured Writing Inks—The following receipts have been well tested, and are commended by good authorities as pre- ferable to the solutions of aniline dyes, which are now so extensively used as coloured inks :— GREEN.—Two parts acetate of copper, one part carbonate of potash, and eight parts of water. Boil until half evapo- rated, and filter. BLUE—Three parts Prussian blue, one part oxalic acid, and thirty parts of water. vVhen dissolved, add one part of gum— arabic. YELLOW.——On€ part fine orpiment, well rubbed up with four parts thick gum water. RED.—With the aid of a gentle heat, dissolve four grains of carmine in I 02. of aqua ammoniae, and add 6 grains of gum- arabic. GOLD.—Rtlb gold leaf, such as is used by bookbinders, with honey, till it forms a uniform mixture. When the honey has been washed out with water, the gold powder will settle at the bottom, and must be mixed with gum water in sufficient quantity. SILVER.—-Silver leaf treated in precisely the same manner gives a silver ink. Both these inks may be polished with ivory when dry. ' BLACK.—Th1'€€ ounces crushed gall-nuts, two ounces crys- tallized sulphate of iron, two ounces gum-arabic, and twenty- four ounces water. \IVHITE—Flnti French zinc-white, or white lead, rubbed up with gum water to the proper consistency. Fireproof Ink—Fireproof ink, which can be used either for writing or printingz—Copal 12 grains, graphite 22 drachms, sulphate of iron 2 drachms, tincture of nut-galls 2 drachms, and sulphate of indigo 8 drachms; these are thoroughly mixed and boiled in water, and the ink so obtained is said to be both fire- proof and insoluble in water. \IVhen any other colour than black is desired, the graphite is replaced by any other mineral pigment of the required colour. Prinling [n/c Varnish—Printing ink varnish is made by adding 4 oz. of boiled linseed or neat’s-foot oil to 6 oz. of yellow rosin. USEFUL RECEIPTS. 3 I 5 Lithographic Transfer Ink—Three parts gum copal, 5 parts wax, 5 purified tallow, 4 soap, 5 shellac, 5 mastic, and one-half part sulphur. The copal is to be melted in a copper vessel, mixing in a little sweet oil, add the wax and tallow, and when these are well melted, light the mass and throw in the soap, well dried and cut in small pieces, then the shellac and mastic. The flame is to be increased by the addition of the flowers of sulphur, and so a perfect mixture of the copal with the other substances will be attained. The flame is to be alternately kindled and extinguished till the whole mass is reduced to one-fourth of its former bulk. T 0 give a’ark Printing Inks a Bronze or Ckangeaole III/e.— Take 1% lb. gum shellac and dissolve it in 1 gallon 95 per cent. alcohol spirits of cologne for 24 hours; then add 14 oz. aniline red; let it stand a few hours longer, when it will be ready for use. Add this to good blue, black, or other dark inks, as needed, in quantities to suit, when, if carefully done, they will be found to have a rich bronze or changeable hue. An Ink for Marking Tin 0r Zinc.——An ink composed of copper one part, dissolved in ten parts nitric acid, ten parts water being afterward added, is useful for marking on tin or zinc. Quick-drying Preparations for Printers’ Inks to be used on Bookbinders’ Cases—1 oz. beeswax, % oz. gum-arabic dis- solved in sufficient acetic acid to make a thin mucilage, % oz. Brown’s japan, % oz. asphaltum varnish. Incorporate with 1 lb. of wood-cut ink. A Dryer.—No. I, for fine job work. Damar varnish 6 02., bergamot 2 drachms, balsam copaiba 2 drachms, balsam of fir 3 oz., creosote 1 drachm, copal varnish I drachm. To enough ink for 1000 ordinary business cards, add from 8 to 12 drops of the “Indispensable,” and to larger quantities in pro- portion. \/Vhen used for bronze, dry colours, diamond printing, etc., take twice the quantity; and where an extra quick dryer is desired, add a few drops of dissolved gum-arabic to the ink, after it has been mixed with No. I. In all cases, mix well with the ink before applying to the rollers. 316 USEFUL RECEIPTS. Dryer.——No. 2.—F or news and poster ink. Spirits of tur~ pentine I qt., balsam copaiba 6 oz. Add a sufficient quantity to the ink to thin it to a proper consistency for working. Silvering Solution for Eleetrotype Plates.—-Nitrate of silver 2 drachms, distilled water 37 drachms. Dissolve and add sal ammoniac I drachm, hypophosphate of soda 4 drachms, pre- cipitated chalk 4 drachms. Agitate the preparation occasion- ally for twelve hours, when it will be ready for use. Apply with a piece of fine sponge. How to coat Eleetrotypes with Silver.——Electrotypes can be coated with silver (for working with red ink) in the following manner: One part copper, 5 parts pure tin; this alloy to be granulated, not too fine, and mixed with water and cream of tartar into a paste. To each 200 parts of the granulated alloy add 1 part oxide silver, the electro is then laid in it, and boiled for a short time, when it will be found to be beautifully plated. Fresh oxide must be added from time to time. This coating is quite equal in durability to silver or tin. To soften Leat/zer Belting—Castor oil is a good article for keeping leather belting soft and pliable. How to open a Ball of T wine—A ball of twine, if opened from the‘inside, will run off easily enough and give no trouble in the untwining; but if begun from the outside, it will speedily get tangled and knotted. T 0 prevent Adhesion—M. GARDE, in l’Imprimerie, tells paper-makers how to obviate the inconvenience of the adhe- sion together of sized papers, on damping, by the coagulation of the size. This is effected in the mills, by dipping the sheets in a solution of alum or tannin. A secondary advantage ob- tained is that the paper becomes tougher. . / T o detect gronna’ Wood in Paper.—Mix three parts of strong nitric acid with one part of sulphuric acid: a drop of this solution will immediately turn paper containing an ad- mixture of ground wood a brown colour. USEFUL RECEIP T5. 3 I 7 French Gold Printing—French copal varnish 1 oz., mas- tic varnish % of an 02.; mix together and add twenty drops to the black ink table, and distribute; take an impression and apply, with wool, gold leaf, Dutch metal, or bronze. Apply the bronze with cotton wool and rub hard over the black ink. After each fifty printed, wipe off the superfluous gold from the type with a silk handkerchief. Transfer Varnish—Take equal quantities of fir balsam and spirits turpentine. Mix, shake well, and set in a warm place until clear. Used in decalcomania, and for maps, prints, drawings, and other articles of paper; and also to prepare tracing papers, and to transfer engravings. T 0 make Paper Waterproof.——Dissolve 8 oz. of alum and 3% oz. of white soap in 4 pints of water. In another vessel dissolve 2 oz. of gum-arabic and 4 oz. of glue in 4 pints of water. Mix the two solutions and heat them over the fire. Then immerse the paper, sheet by sheet, in the hot liquid, then hang them up edgewise to dry, or pass them between heated cylinders. Books Preserved—The bindings may be preserved from mildew by brushing them over with the spirits of wine. A few drops of any perfumed oil will secure libraries from the consuming effects of mould and damp. Russia leather, which is perfumed with the tar of the birch tree, never moulds or sustains injury from damp. The Romans used oil of cedar to preserve valuable manuscripts. Russia leather covered books placed in a stationer’s window will destroy flies and other insects. To restore Engraz/ings, eta—Old engravings, wood-cuts, or printed matter, that have turned yellow, may be rendered white by first washing carefully in water containing a little hyposulphite of soda, and then dipping for a minute in javelle water. To prepare the latter, put 4 lbs. bicarbonate of soda in a kettle over a fire; add 1 gallon of boiling water, and let it boil for fifteen minutes. Then stir in I lb. of pulverized chloride of lime. When cold, the liquid can be kept in a jug ready for use. 27*:- ORTHOGRAPHICAL. THOROUGH reformation of the orthography of the English language, desirable as it is, can scarcely be hoped for in this century; though doubtless the time will come when an international convention will settle authoritatively the spelling of every word, as acceptably as has been done by the Academies of France and Spain in regard to the orthography of the languages of those countries. A or AN before a Vozc/el or silent H. In regard to the use of the indefinite article, VValker’s Dic- tionary very judiciously says,— “This indefinite, and, as it may be called, the eaplzonic article, is said by all our grammarians to be used before a vowel or 12 mute; but no notice is taken of using a instead of an before what is called a vowel, as, a useful boo/c, a ZlSéfilZ cere- mony, a nsnrer, &c.; nor is any mention made of its constant usage before lz when it is not mute, if the accent of the word be on the second syllable, as, an heroic acz‘ion, an historical account, &c. This want of accuracy arises from a want of analyzing the vowels, and not attending sufliciently to the influence of accent on pronunciation. A proper investigation of the power of the vowels would have informed our gram- marians that the letter a, when long, is not so properly a vowel as a semi-consonant, and perfectly equivalent to com- mencing y, and that a feeling of this has insensibly influenced the best speakers to prefix a to it in their conversation, while a confused idea of the general rule, arising from an ignorance of the nature of the letters, has generally induced them to prefix an to it in writing. The same observations are appli~ 318 01? THO GRAPHICAL. 3119 cable to the h. The ear alone tells us that, before heroic, his- torical, &c., the an ought invariably to be used; but, by not discovering that it is the absence of accent on the h that makes an admissible in these words, we are apt to prefix an to words where the h is sounded, as, an horse, an house, 820, and thus set our spoken and written language at variance. The article a must be used before all words beginning with a consonant, and before the vowel u when long; and the article an must be used before all words beginning with a vowel, except long u,- before words beginning with h mute, as, an hour, an heir, &c.; or before words where the h is not mute, if the accent be on the second syllable, as, an heroic action, an historical account, 81c.” The few words in our language in which the h is mute are heir, herb, honest, honour, hospital, hostler, hour, humble, humour, and their derivatives. 0, or OH. Oh should be used to express surprise, pain, sorrow, or anxiety. When the interjection is followed by a proper name, or as an exclamation of wishing the 0 should be employed singly, thus: 0 mother dear, Yerusaleml O Lora’! O that I might find him. ABLE ana’ IBLE. All English words, without regard to the source from which they have been derived, and those which come from Latin words ending in abilis or French ones in able, take the termi- nation able in English, as, procurable, amena'able, desirable, allowable, voia’able, available, fora’able, incontestable, &c.; but in words from Latin and French words terminating in ibilis or ible, then the ending will be ible in English. For instance: accessible, sensible, defensible, convertible, &c. In words ending in ce or ge, the final e is preserved before the termination able, for the purpose of indicating the soft sound of the consonant, as in marriageable, chargeable, trace- able, serviceable, &c.; but before the ending ible the final e of the primitive disappears, and there is no e before the termina- tion. Examples: a’ea'ucible, reducible, frangible, &c. The following list of words in ible is here added; all others end in able :— 320 ORTIIOGRAPHICAL. accessible decep tible expressible persuasible admissible decerptible extendible pervertible adustible decoctible extensible plausible appetible deducible fallible possible apprehensible defeasible feasible producible audible defectible fencible quadrible cessible defensible flexible reducible coercible depectible forcible referrible collectible deprehensible frangible reflexible comminuible descendible fusible refrangible compatible destructible horrible regible competible digestible ignoscible remissible comprehensible discernible illegible reprehensible compressible discerptible immarcessible resistible conceptible dispraisible immiscible (1) responsible conclusible dissolvible impassible (2) reversible congestible distensible intelligible revertible contemptible divisible irascible risible contractible docible legible seducible controvertible edible miscible sensible convertible effeetible partible ‘ solvible convincible eligible passible (3) tangible corrigible eludible perceptible terrible corrosible enforcible permiscible transmissible corruptible evincible permissible visible credible expansible IM or 1N, and EM or EN. The prefix in is from the Latin, and that of en from the French and Greek. In generally signifies situation, and en mostly expresses action. Hence, perhaps, in strictness, inclose will signify “to close in,” and enclose, “to make close.” So, to inquire will be “to seek in, or to search in,” and enquire, to “make search.” Immigrate, “to pass into ;” emigrate, “to go out of.” But this distinction is not attended to by writers, and is, indeed, too refined for general practice. Before the letters 6 and p, en becomes em, as in embattle, empower,- and in before some letters becomes ig, il, im, or ir, as in ignoble, illegal, improper, irresolute. We give a list of those generally spelt with im or in ,' leaving it to be inferred that the rest are more usual with em or en. (1) For other words beginning with im, in, z'r, or an negative, look for the simple word. (2)1ncapab1e of suffering. (3) Capable of suffering. OR THO GRAPIIICAL. J imbarn impel indict initiate instop imbibe impen indite inject insure imboil imperil indoctrinate inlapidate inter imbound impinge indrench inlay intertwine imbrue implant induce inlet intort imbrute implead induct inoculate i ntreasure imbue import ineye inosculate intrench imburse impose infer inquire intrude immanacle impound infest inrail intrust immense impregnate infix inscribe inumbrate immerge impress inflame insculp inure immerse imprint inflate inseam inurn immigrate imprison inflect insert invade immingle inarch inflict inset inveigh immit incase infringe inshell invert immix inclasp infuscate inship invest immure inclip infuse insinew invigorate impact incloud ingrane insphere invite impale include ingest inspire invocate imparadise incrassate inhabit inspirit invoice impassioned increase inhale install invoke impawn incur inhere instate in wall impeach indart inhold insteep imveave impearl indent inhume instil IN and UN. In, as a prefix, also marks negation: it is probable that it came from the Romans. Un, as a prefix, is synonymous with in .' it is of Saxon origin, and generally joined to words from a northern source; while in is oftener applied to those of Latin derivation. ISE and IZE. The variation in the terminations ise and ize is due to the different derivations of words,—ize characterizing words from the Greek and Latin, and ise from the French. The rule, how- ever, is not inflexible. The following words are commonly spelled with the s. advertise comprise divertise merchandise advise compromise emprise misprise (mistake) affranchise criticise enfranchise premise aggrandise demise enterprise recognise amortise despise exercise reprise (take again) catechise devise exorcise supervise chastise disfranchise galliardise surmise circumcise disguise manumise surprise 322 ORTHOGRAPHJCAL. OR and OUR. The ending our was in general use until the appearance of Webster’s Dictionary, in which the u was dropped in words terminating with our. This innovation has steadily gained ground. \Ne do not approve of partial tinkerings with English orthography; and, until a general convention of British and American scholars settle the method of spelling English words, we shall adhere to the established usage. We append a list of words terminating in our. arbour colour fervour odour splendour ardour contour flavour parlour succour armour demeanour harbour rancour tambour behaviour dishonour honour rigour tumour candour dolour humour rumour valour' clamour endeavour labour savour vapour clangour favour neighbour saviour vigour The n is dropped when the termination ous is added to any of these words; as, clanzorous, dolorous, humorous, laborious, oa’orous, rancorous, rigorous, valorous, vigorous. And also in derivative words; such as armory, honorary, &c. SION and TION. Primitive words which end in a’, de, ge, init, rt, se, or ss, take sion in their derivatives; but all other words have tion. EXAMPLES. abscina’, abscission revert, reversion condescend, condescension convert, conversion evade, evasion confuse, confusion intrude, intrusion revise, revision absterge, abstersion impress, impression emerge, emersion confess, confession admit, admission admix, admixtion remit, remission promote, promotion IRREGULARS. adhesion divulsion recension attention cohesion evulsion recursion causation compulsion exesion revulsion distention declension expulsion scansion distortion decursion impulsion tension coercion depulsion incursion transcursion suspicion dissension propulsion version crucifixion ORTHOGRAPHICAL. 323 FARTHER and FURTHER. Farther is nowadays only employed when speaking of dis- tance; in all other acceptations of the word, further is gene- rally adopted. PEAS and PEASE. There are scarcely any words in which a mistake is more frequently made than in peas and pease. Yet the distinction between them is simple and well defined. Peas is the plural of pea, and, consequently, only follows numeral adjectives; as, “ ten peas,” “ a hundred peas,” “ afezv peas,” “many peas ;” but pease is used when speaking of the legumen in the aggre- gate, or generally. Thus, we correctly say, “Pease are dear this year,” “Pease were plentifully supplied to the horses,” 81c. Pease is also employed adjectively; as, “pease-pudding,” “pease—soup,” or “pea-soup,” &c. The Omission of s in the Possessive Case. It is not uncommon with some persons to omit the s after the apostrophe in the possessive case of nouns, if the name itself ends in s; as, “Yames’ book,” “Barnes’ Notes.” But this is incorrect; for if we ask, Whose book? we should directly answer, Yames’s. The only case when the s can be judiciously omitted, and this solely to avoid the too hissing sound of so many s’s in succession, is when the first word ends with the sound of s in its last two syllables, and the next word begins with s; as in Misses’ spectacles, righteousness’ sake, conscience’ sake. Formation of the Plurals of Words compounded of a IVoun and an Adjective. Adjectives have no plural number. Therefore, in a word compounded of a noun and an adjective, the s denoting the plural number is attached to the end of the noun, as follows :— Governor-general . . . . . . . . . Governors-general. Attorney-general . . . . . . . . . Attorneys-general. Court-martial . . . . . . . . . . . Courts-martial. But where the adjective is taken substantively, the mark of the plural will properly follow it. For example: Brigadier- generals, major-generals, lieutenant-generals. 324 ORTHOGRAPHICAL. ‘ \Vords compounded of a noun and the adjective full form their plurals thus: spoonfuls, cupfuls, bucket/‘ills, lianafiils, moutlzfiils. Pointing of .Numbers, Weig/zts, IIIeasures, c‘é’c. No comma should be placed between the constituent parts of the same number, however long it may be. Thus, we say, “One million one hundred thousand five hundred and twenty- one,” without any interpunction. The reason is, that there is no more than one numerical aggregate intended, or but one complex notion; and, consequently, no separation of parts or members can take place. The same reasoning holds good as respects values, weig/zts, &c. For instance, when we say, “Six dollars and ten cents,” we merely mean that aggregate amount, but not necessarily any one of the coins indicated. If we did so intend, then two commas should be introduced,——one after “dollars,” and the other after “cents.” In like manner we should act with such sentences as, “Five tons three hundred- weight two quarters and fifteen pounds ;” or, “Ten acres four roods and twenty-seven perches;” and for the same reason: no division of parts is intended, but merely one aggregate amount. When figures are used to express amounts, a comma should not be inserted to cut off the tens unless the sum requires five figures: e. g. $10,600, 20,000 men, &c. In column matter this rule will not apply. Derivation of English Words. Of course the Saxon forms the basis of our language in its essential parts, and is the source whence we derive the greater part of our ordinary and most emphatic words. Nevertheless, various other languages have been put under contribution, especially the French, Latin, and Greek. This will be evident from the following statement of derivations, which will show the unlearned reader how important it is to him that he should acquire some knowledge of those languages, if he desires to attain to a thorough proficiency in his business as an educated printer. I. From the Greek are derived-— 1. I/Vords endingin gram, grap/z, and grapliy; as, telegram, 0R THO GRAPH/CAL. 32 5 telegraph, geography, &c.; from the word ypdqio, ( grab/20,) I write, and some other Greek word. 2. Those in gon ,- from yaw-a, (gonia,) an angle; as, octagon. 3. All words in logue or logy; as, epilogue, astrology; from ‘Myog, (logos,) a discourse. 4. Ic, ic/é, ics are also Greek terminations, generally of adjectives. 5. Words in meter are all of Greek origin, coming from the verb ,uerpcb, (metro,) I measure, in combination with some other word. 6. Most words into which the terminations agogue, asis, esis, or ysis enter are also of Greek origin ; such as demagogae. emphasis, parenthesis, analysis, &c. II. But the main source whence we have derived words. with the exception of the Saxon, is the Latin, as will appear from an inspection of the following list:— I. Words ending in ance, ancy, or ant, and ence, ency, or cnt, come from Latin words ending respectively in ans, antia, or ens, entia; as, abundance, from abnndantia; infancy, from in- fantia; abundant, from abundans; absence, from absentia ,- excellency, from excellentia; and excellent, from excel/ens. 2. Vt/ords in al have their Latin representatives in alts; as. corporal, from corporalis. 3. Verbs in ate mostly come from Latin verbs of the first conjugation; as, moderate, from modero. 4. \IVords in ator are generally the same in both languages; as, orator, senator, moderator. 5. The termination id comes mostly from Latin words end- ing in idns; as, acid, from acidus; but sometimes words of this ending are of Greek origin; as, oxide, (more correctly, oxyd,) from bti'g, (oxys ,') and, indeed, most scientific words of this end- ing; as, carotid, from Kapéfldsg", &c. ; r/Iomboid, from bo/z/iowI/K. 6. It or ile is likewise from the Latin termination of adjec- tives in ilis; as, docile, from docilis ,' civil, from ciz/ilis. 7. The Latin termination osus has its English representa- tive in ions or ous; as, copious, from copiosus; numerous, from numerosus. But sometimes the English ending ous comes from a Latin word in ax; as, capacions, from copay. 8. The Latin ending io has its English corresponding word in ion,‘ as, nation, from natio; oration, from oratio. 28 326 ORTHOGRAPIJICAL. 9. The endings ne, re, and te after a vowel are also for the greater part of Latin origin; as, fortune, from fortuna; aqui- line, from aquilinus; culture, from cultura; pure, from purus; complete, from completus, &c. IO. \Nords in ty come from Latin words in tas; as, equality, from cequalitas; bounty, from bonitas; rarity, from raritas, &c. II. The termination ude is also of Latin origin, coming from words in udo; as, fortitude, from fortitudo; elude, from eludo. - I2. So also is nous, by inserting the letter 0; as, ambiguous, from ambiguus; continuous, from continuus, &c. III. From the French have come—— 1. Most of our words in age; as, page, rage, usage. 2. All those in eau; as, beau, flambeau, &c. 3. The French esse is represented by the English ess: as, princess, from princesse. 4. Words in one mostly come to us from the French directly; some from the Latin directly or indirectly; as, antique, (L. anti~ quus, F. antique,) oblique, opaque. 5. Words ending in ment are nearly the same in both lan~ guages; as, commencement, advancement, (F. avancement,) &c. We subjoin some rules for spelling, adapted from Laid- law’s American Pronouncing Dictionary!“ RULE I. Words ending in silent e after u or a consonant generally drop the e on taking an additional termination beginning with a vowel; as, sale, salable; plague, plaguy; sue, suing; eye, eying. EXCEPTION I.—W0rds ending in ce and ge retain e before able and ous : as, ser- vice, serviceable; tracc, traceable; courage, courageous; advantage, advantageous. EXCEPTION II.——Compounds and prefixes retain e; as, firearms, foreordaz'n, pole-axe, vice-admiral, fire-engine. (1) Published by E. C. Marklcy & Son, Philadelphia. An excellent book. 28 ORTIIOGRAPIIICAL. 327 Remark—From singe, springe, swinge, tinge, we write singeing, sfringeing, s'wingez'ng, tingeing, to distinguish from singing, springing, swinging, and tinging. Dyeing, from dye, retains e, to distinguish it from dying, the present participle of die. Mile retains e in mileage. Derivatives from proper names of persons retain e; as, daguerreotyfie, morseograph. RULE II. \Ivords ending in silent e generally retain the e on taking an additional termination beginning with a consonant; as. bereave, bereavement; issue, issueless. Remark—Artful, arqfnlly, a'zqfulness, argument, argumentation, argumenta- tive, 'woful, 'wofully, wqfulness, duly, truly, and wholly, are undisputed exceptions ; and'abridgment, acknowledgment, judgment, mis/udgment, prcy'udgment, lodg~ ment, wobegone, and rhymster, are disputed exceptions. Some write abridgement, acknowledgement, judgement, misjudgement, priy'udgement, lodgernent, renebe- gone, and rhymester. RULE III. Words ending in ie change them into y before ing.‘ as, lie, lying. The following words conform to this rule :— lie lie di untie belie overlie hie vie outlie underlie tie outvie RU LE IV. Words ending in y preceded by a consonant generally change y into i on taking an additional syllable; as, mercy, merciful, merciless; defy, defied, defies, defieth, defiant,‘ busy, busier, busiest, business; ply, pliers,‘ porphyry, porphyrz'tic. EXCEPTION I.-—Y after a consonant is not changed into 2‘ before ing or ish ,- as, dry, drying, dryislz. EXCEPTION II.-—Compounds usually retain y; as, mercy—seat, county-town, dairy-maid, skylight. Remark—Dryer, dryest, dryly, dryness, shyer, shyest, shyly, shyness, are un- disputed exceptions to the rule ; and slyer, slyest, slyly, slyness, are disputed ex- ceptions. RULE V. Words ending in y preceded by a vowel retain the y; as, gay, gayly, gayness, gayezfy; pray, prayer, praying, prayed, prays. Remark—From day, lay, pay, say, stay, are formed daily. lazd, paid, said, saith, staid. The regular words dayly, layea', payed, sayeth, and stayed, are sometimes used. O.) N 00 OR T H 0 G RA PIII CA L. RULE VI. Monosyllables and words having the primary accent on the last syllable, when they end with a single consonant preceded by a single vowel, double their final consonant before an ad- ditional syllable that begins with a vowel; as, wet, wetter, wettest, wetting, wetted; drum, drumming, drummed ,' dispel, dispelling, dispelled. ExcEP'rioNn—A final .r, or the s in gas, should not be doubled; as, fix,/ixes, fixed, fixing; annex, annexing; gases, gasty’y. Remark I.—U after q is never reckoned a part of a diphthong or triphthong; so that from quit are formed quitting, quilted; and from quag, quaggy. Remark II—This rule applies only to derivatives which retain the accent of their primitives, and not to such as z'nfferable, inference, frtf’erable, firtyf’erence, ref'eralle, and rejf’erence, from infer, prefer, and refer. To the forms z'nfer’rz'lile, riy‘er’rz'lle, which are sometimes met with, the general rule applies. Transfer'aole, from transfer, is an exception to the general rule; the regular form trans/er’rioie is not often used. Although parallel’ogranz, from par’allel, and modal’z'ty from mo’dal, remove the primary accent to the point of duplication, they do not double the final Z. See Remark II. under Rule VII. RULE VII. A final consonant is not doubled when it is preceded by a diphthong, when the primary accent is either not on, or not retained upon, the last syllable, or when the additional syl- lable begins with a consonant; as, beat, beating, beaten; dif’ fer, dif’fering, dif’fered, dif’ference, dif’ferent; prefer’, prefer- ence; refer’, ref’ erence; fit, fitful, fitly, fitness; ben’efit, [7872/— efited, beu’efiting. EXCEPTION I.—Compounds that remove the primary accent from the point of duplication retain the double letter; as, &r0ad'-brimmed, beeW-tafiping. Remark I.—When ly is affixed to words ending in l, the l is not considered doubled; as in cool-1y, real-ly, gravel-1y, royal-ly. Remark IL—Nutnzegged, kidnapping, kidnap/fied, kidnap/Mr, zzgzaggz'ng, zig- zagged, excellence, and some others, are undisputed exceptions to the rule. There are nearly one hundred words, from which more than four hundred derivatives are formed, that are usually made exceptions to this rule. \Vebster is distinguished for making nearly all the derivatives conform to the rule. \Vebster and Smart accent the verb curv’et, on the first syllable, with which accentuation curveting and curveted are correct spellings ; other orthoepists accent upon the last syllable, then cu rvet'ting and curvet'ted are correct. 0R THOGRAPHICAL. 329 RULE VIII. Words ending in c accept of k before a termination begin- ning with e, i, or y; as, frolic, frolicked, frolicking; colic, colicky. ILLUSTRATIONS. colic mimic rollic talc colicky mimicking rollicking talcky . - _ mimicked rollicked frolic _ mimicker zinc frolicking traffic zinckiferous frohcked physio trafficking (zinciferous) havoc physicking trafficked zincky havocking physicked trafficker havocked RULE IX. Words ending in a double letter preserve it double after a prefix or before a termination beginning with a different letter; as, op-press, mis-spell, in-tlzrall, oversee; see-ing, op- pressive, stilf-ness, woo-ed, still-ness, assess-ment. Remark L—Annul, until, twibil, and the conservative fulfil, or the \Vebsterian fulfill, are the only exceptions to the first part of this rule extensively recognized by present usage. The conservative distil and instil are at variance ; but the \Veb- sterian distill and instill, and also t'wz'bill, as written by Reid, are in harmony with the rule. Remark II.—-Pont1]ic, and all other derivatives of pontiff, are exceptions to the latter part of this rule, unless an f is discarded in the primitive word, as \Vebster suggests and the derivation warrants. The derivatives of dull, full, skill, and will, are disputed exceptions: if spelled as Webster writes them, dullness, fullness, skillful, willful, they conform to the rule. RULE X. The plural is usually formed from the singular by adding s; as, brave, braves; night, niglzts; hymn, lzymns. RULE XI. Nouns ending in o preceded by a vowel accept of s in the plural; as, cameo, cameos; studio, studios. 23-2:- 330 OR TJIOGRAPAUCAL. ILLUSTRATIONS. agios curculios koodoos punctilios bagnios embryos nuncios ratios bamboos folios olios seraglios braggadocios imbroglios oratorios solfeggios cameos intaglios pistachios studios cuckoos internuncios port-folios trios R U LE X II . Nouns ending in y preceded by a vowel accept of s in the plural; as, money,moneys; attorney, attorneys; valley, valleys. RULE XIII. Nouns ending in o preceded by a consonant usually accept of es in the plural; as, echo, echoes; embargo, embargoes. Remar/c.--’I'here are more than fifty words that conform to this rule, and about thirty that accept of s only. ILLUSTRATIONS. arehipelagoes frescoes negroes rotundoes armadilloes grottoes palmettoes stilettoes bilboes gustoes passadocs supercargoes bravadoes heroes peccadilloes tcstudoes bravoes innuendoes potatoes tomatoes buffaloes jun toes prunelloes tornadoes buffoes lazarettocs punchinelloes torpedoes calicoes lingoes punctoes umboes cargoes lumbagoes ranchoes vetoes desperadoes mangoes recitativoes violoncelloes echoes manifcstoes relievoes viragoes cmbargoes mottoes renegadoes volcanoes farragoes mulattocs ritornelloes zeroes EXCEPTIONS. albinos inamoratos octavos ron dos cantos lassos pianos salvos centos limbos porticos set-tos dominos major-domos provisos siroccos duodecimos mementos qua rtos solos halos merinos rancheros torsos hidalgos mosquitos ridottos tyros It would be well if all words ending in 0 were made to conform to Rules XI. and XIII. 0R THO GRAPHICAL. 331 RULE XIV. Nouns ending in ss, 2, :c, ch soft, and sh, accept of es in the plural; as, dress, dresses; buzz, buzzes; box, boxes; peach, peaches; dish, dishes. RULE XV. Nouns ending in y after a consonant change y into ies in the plural; as, city, cities; daisy, daisies. RULE XVI. Compound nouns whose parts are connected by a hyphen accept of the sign of the plural after that part which essen- tially constitutes the noun; as, knight-errant, knights-errant; son-in-law, sons-in-lazo; man-of-war, men-of-zoar; step-child, step-children; ember-day, ember-days; man-singer, men- singers. ILLUSTRATIONS. aides-de-camp courts-martial knights-errant prices-current beans-ideal or cousins-german mcsdames sergeants-at-arms beaux-ideal daughteis-in-law men-of-war sisters-in-law cartes-blanche fathers-in-law messieurs sons-in-law charges-d’afl'aires gendarmes or mothers-in-law step-children chevaux-de-frise gens d'armes poets-laureate step-fathers coups-de-main jets d’eau porte-monnaies valets-de-chambre Remark I.—If no hyphen is used, the Sign of the plural is always placed at the end ,- as, spoonful, spoonfuls. Remark IL—The Sign of the possessive case is always placed at the end of com_ pound nouns ; as, son-in-la'w’s house. RULE XVII. The compounds of man form their plural in the same man- ‘ ner as the simple word; as, fisherman, fishermen; man-of- war, men-of-zoar. EXCEPTIONS—The only exceptions to this rule are dragoman, Ilfnssnlman, Otto- man, talisman, Turconzan, German, Norman, and landamman, which accept of s. 332 OR THO GRAPHICAL. RULE XVIII. ,Of the terminations eive and ieve, and of the derivatives of each, the former are found after c, and’the latter after other letters; as, conceive, conceit, receive, receipt; relieve, relief, relieving, thieve, thievish. ILLUSTRATIONS. achieve deceitful misbelief aggrieve deceive misconceive has-relief disbelief perceive belief disbelieve preconceive believe grief receipt conceit grieve I receive conceivable inconceivable relief conceive lief relieve deceit lieve relievo reprieve retrieve sieve thief thieve unbelief unbeliever undeceive Plurals of Nouns which change F or FE into VES. beeves knives selves calves leaves sheaves elves lives shelves halves loaves thieves tipstaves wharves wives wolves All other nouns ending in f conform to Rule X. Wharfs prevails in Great Britain, wharves in America. Plurals of Nouns ending in F or FE which accept of s only in the Plural. briefs caliphs surfs chiefs caufs fifes fiefs clefs strifes griefs ' coifs safes mischiefs ‘ delfs scarfs kerchiefs dwarfs waifs neckerchiefs turfs woofs . handkerchiefs kerfs hoofs roofs proofs reproofs disproofs Waterproofs beliefs reliefs gulfs Plurals of Nouns ending in EAU, IEU, and 0U. beaux fiambeaux portmanteaus bureaux plateaux purlieus chapeaux rondeaux adieux Chateaux jets d’eau batteaux bfioux morceaux rouleaux tableaux A number of these nouns admits of two forms in the plural. HOW TO SECURE COPYRIGHTS. I. A printed copy of the title of the book, map, chart, dramatic or musical composition, engraving, cut, print, pho- tograph, or a description of the painting, drawing, chromo, statue, statuary, or model or design for a work of the fine arts, for which copyright is desired, must be sent by mail or other- wise, prepaid, addressed: Librarian of Congress, Waslzington, D. C. This must be done before publication of the book or other article. 2. A fee of 50 cents, for recording the title of each book or other article, must be inclosed with the title as above, and 50 cents in addition (or $1 in all) for each certificate of copyright under seal of the Librarian of Congress, which will be trans- mitted by return mail. 3. Within ten days after publication of each book or other article, two complete copies of the best edition issued must be sent, to perfect the copyright, with the address: Librarian of Congress, Washington, D. C. It is optional with those sending books and other articles to perfect copyright, to send them by mail or express; but, in either case, the charges are to be prepaid by the senders. Without the deposit of copies above required the copyright is void, and a penalty of $25 is incurred. No copy is required to be deposited elsewhere. 333 334 TIOPV T0 SECURE COPYRIGHTS. 4. No copyright is valid unless notice is given by inserting in every copy published, on the title-page or the page following, if it be a book; or, if a map, chart, musical composition, print, cut, engraving, photograph, painting, drawing, chromo, statue, statuary, or model or design intended to be perfected as a work of the fine arts, by inscribing upon some portion thereof, or on the substance on which the same is mounted, the follow— ing words, viz.: “Entered according to act of Congress, ‘in the year ——, by — ——, in the ofice of the Librarian of Congress, at Washington;” or, at the option of the person entering the copyright, the words: “ Copyright, 18—, by .” The law imposes a penalty of $100 upon any person who has not obtained copyright who shall insert the notice “En— tered according to act of Congress,” or “Copyright,” &c., or words of the same import, in or upon any book or other article. 5. Any author may reserve the right to translate or to dramatize his own work. In this case, notice should be given by printing the words “Right of translation reserved,” or “All rights reserved,” below the notice of copyright entry, and notifying the Librarian of Congress of such reservation, to be entered upon the record. 6. Each copyright secures the exclusive right of publishing the book or article copyrighted for the term of twenty-eight years. Six months before the end of that time, the author or designer, or his widow or children, may secure a renewal for the further term of fourteen years, making forty-two years in all. Applications for renewal must be accompanied by explicit statement of ownership in the case of the author, or of rela- tionship in the case of his heirs, and must state definitely the date and place of entry of the original copyright. A copy of the record of such renewal must, within two months from date of renewal, be published in one or more newspapers in the United States for the space of four weeks. 7. The time within which any work copyrighted may be issued from the press is not limited by any law or regulation; but depends upon the discretion of the proprietor. A copy- right may be secured for a projected work as well as for a completed one. 8. Any copyright is assignable in law by any instrument of writing, but such assignment must be recorded in the office of the Librarian of Congress within sixty days from its IIOI/V TO SECURE COPYRIGHTS. 33 (Jl date. The fee for this record and certificate is $1, and for a certified copy of any record of assignment, $1. 9. A copy of the record (or duplicate certificate) of any copyright entry will be furnished under seal, at the rate of 50 cents each. IO. In the case of books published in more than one volume, or of periodicals published in numbers, or of engravings, pho- tographs, or other articles published with variations, a copy— right is to be taken out for each volume or part of a book, or number of a periodical, or variety, as to size, title, or inscrip- tion, of any other article. 11. To secure a copyright for a painting, statue, or model or design intended to be perfected as a work of the fine arts, so as to prevent infringement by copying, engraving, or vend- - ing such design, a definite description must accompany the application for copyright, and a photograph of the same, at least as large as “cabinet size,” must be mailed to the Libra- rian of Congress within ten days from the completion of the work. 12. Copyrights cannot be granted upon trade-marks, or labels intended to be used with any article of manufacture. If protection for such prints or labels is desired, application must be made to the Patent Office, where they are registered at a fee of $6 for labels, and $25 for trade—marks. I 3. Every applicant for a copyright must state distinctly the name and residence of the claimant, and whether the right is claimed as author, designer, or proprietor. No afifldavit or formal application is required. OFFICE OF THE LIBRARIANoF CONGRESS, Washington, 1877. THE METRIC SYSTEM. HE Metric System is a decimal system of measures and weights, based on the meter as its unit, which originated in France during the last decade of the eighteenth century, and has since been adopted by the greater number of States in Europe and America. In the United States its use was authorized in 1866 by Act of Congress. The length of the meter was intended to be one ten-millionth part of the distance from the equator to either pole, measured at the level of the sea, but it is in reality a trifle less. All other units for measur- ing and weighing are derived from it, and the higher or lower denominations of the same kind of measure are obtained by multiplying or dividing its unit by tens, and prefixing to its name the Greek numerals, de/ca IO, lze/cz‘o IOO, kilo 1000, or myrz'a 10000, for the higher denominations, and the Latin numerals, a’eaz' f5, centz' fiw, or milli film, for the lower. The unit of weight, called the gram, is theoretically the weight in vacuo of a cubic centimeter of distilled water at the tempera- ture of maximum density assumed to be 4° C. or 39° I Fe. Including the meter and gram, five units have been adopted in the metric system, viz. :— I. The Meter, the unit of length, = 3.280899 feet = 39.37079 inches. 2. The Are, the unit of surface, = I square dekameter : 119.60332 square yards. 3. The Liter, the unit of capacity, : 1 cubic decimeter = 0.26418635 gallon = 1.0567454 quarts. 4. The Stere, the unit of solidity, == 1 cubic metcr : 35.336636 cubic feet = 1.308764 cubic yards. 5. The Gram, the unit of weight, = 1543234874 grains troy. For practical purposes the following are commonly used as units, viz.:—- For itinerary measure, the kilometer = 0.62138 mile. For land measure, the hektare = 2.47114 acres. For commercial weight, the kilogram = 2.20462125 pounds. The nickel five-cent piece, coined since 1866. weighs exactly 5 grams. 336 TIIE Il/IETRIC SI’STEII/I. 337 METRIC EQUIVALENTS OF ENGLISH MEASURES AND ‘WEIGHTS. LONG MEASURE. I inch = 2.540 centimeters. 1 foot = 3.048 decimeters. I yard : 9.144 decimeters. I rod = 5.0291 meters. I mile = 1.6093 kilometers. SQUARE MEASURE. I acre = 40.467 ares. LIQUID MEASURE. I gill = 1.1831 deciliters. I pint = 4.7325 deciliters. I quart = 9.4650 deciliters. I gallon = 3.786 liters. TABLE FOR REDUCING POUNDS AND OUNcEs TO KILoGRAMS. Oz. Kilo. Lbs. Kilo. 1 0.028 -1 0.454 2 0.057 2 0.907 8 0.085 8 1.361 4 0.113 4 1.814 5 0.142 5 2.268 6 0.170 6 2.722 7 0.198 7 3.175 - 8 0.227 8 3.629 9 0.255 .9 4.082 10 0.283 10 4.536 11 0.312 11 4.990 12 0.340 12 5.443 18 0.369 LS’ 5.897 14 0-397 14 6-350 15 0.425 15 6.804 16' 7.258 17 7.711 18 8.165 1.9 8.618 20 9.072 21 9.526 21’? 9-979 DRY MEASURE. I pint = 5.5067 deciliters. I quart = 1.1013 liters. 1 peck = 8.8108 liters. I ushel = 3.524. dekaliters. AVOIRDUPOIS \VEIGHT. 1 ounce = 2.835 dckagrams. 1 pound = 4.5359 hektograms. TROY “'EIGHT. I grain = 6.480 centigrams. I ounce = 3.1103 dckagrams. 1 pound : 3.7324 hektograms. 28 10.433 2 10.886 25 11.340 26‘ 11.793 27 12.247 28 12.701 29 13.154 80 13.608 Kilo. Lbs. Kilo. Lbs. Kilo. 14.062 61 27.669 .91 41.277 14.515 62 28.123 2 41.731 14.969 68 28.577 98 42.184 15.‘ 22 64 29.030 9,’. 42.638 15.876 65 29.484 95 43.092 16.330 66' 29.937 90 43.545 16.783 6'?’ 30.391 97 43.999 17.237 68 30.845 98 44.452 17.690 69 31.298 90 44.906 18.144 7 31.752 100 , 45.360 18.597 71 32.205 200 I 90.720 19.051 7:? A 32.659 800 I 136.079 19.505 78 , 33.113 400 181.439 19.958 7.4 33.566 500 226.799 20.412 7'5 I 34.020 600 272.159 20.865 7' 34.473 7'00 317.518 21.319 7 I 34.927 800 362.878 21.773 7 35.380 900 408.238 22.226 7 ; 35.834 1000 453.598 22.680 80 I 36.288 :2000 907.195 23.133 81 36.741 8000 1360.793 23.587 8;’? 37.195 4000 1814.390 24.041 88 37.649 5000 2267.988 24.494‘ 84 38.102 6000 2721.586 24.948 85 38.556 7000 3175.183 25.401 86‘ 1 39.009 8000 5 3628.781 25.855 87 39.463 9000 4082.37 26.309 88 39.917 10000 4535.976 26.762 89 40.370 27.216 .90 40.824 29 TECHNICAL TERMS OF THE CRAFT. Alley—The space between two stands. Ascending letters.—Letters that ascend into the upper shoulder; as, b, d, l, &c. and all the capitals. Author's proof—The clean proof sent to an author after the compositors’ errors have been corrected. Bank—A table about four feet high, to lay sheets on at press. Bastard title—A short title preceding thegeneral title of a work. Bastard type—Type with a face larger or smaller than its regular body: as Nonpareil on Minion body, or Minion on Nonpareil body. Batten—Types accidentally injured in a form. Beard of a letter.-—-The outer angles supporting the face of a type and ex- tending to the shoulder. Bearer.—A strip of reglet to bear off the impression from a blank page. A long piece of furniture, type-high, used in working jobs. A solid-faced type interspersed among the blank parts of a page composed for stereotyping, to resist the pressure of the knife when the plate is shaved. Bearer-lines.—-The top line and bottom line in a page prepared for stereo- typing. ' Bed—The fiat part of the press on which the form is laid. Bevels.—Slugs cast nearly type-high, with a beveled edge, used by stereo- typers to form the flange on the side of the plates. Bite—An irregular white spot on the edge or corner of a printed page, caused by the frisket not being sufficiently cut out. Blanket—A woollen cloth used in the tympan. Blanh-line.——A line of quadrates. Blochs.—-The mahogany forms on which stereotype plates are placed for print- ing. Bloc/zed zen—When the fount of type is all set, and none is available for present use. Bodkin—A delicate awl-like tool used for correcting errors in type. Body—The shank of the letter. Botch.--A bungling, incompetent work- man. Bottled—Type wider at the bottom than at the top. Boxes.--The compartments of a case in which the types are placed. Brayer.—A wooden or glass rubber, flat at the bottom, used to bray or spread out ink on the ink-block. Break-lz'ne.—A short line. Broad-side.—A form of one page, print- ed on one side of a whole sheet of paper. Bro/sen 1natter.—Pagcs of type disrupt- ed and somewhat intermingled. Bundle—Two reams of paper. Bun—Rough edge of a type which the founder neglected to take off in dress- mg. Cabinet—A receptacle for cases, chases leads, &c. ' 338 TECHNICAL TERMS. 339 Cancelled figures—Figures cast with a line across the face. Caret.—A character [ A] used in proof- reading to denote the place where omitted words should be inserted. Case—The receptacle for type, divided into numerous compartments. Cassie japan—Formerly, the two out- side quires of a ream, consisting of de- fective sheets. Casting ofi'.—Estimating how many pages a certain quantity of copy will make in type. Cattz'e.—Imperfect or smutty look of a printed sheet caused by an oily or un- clean roller. Cerz'fhs.—-'I‘he lines or cross-strokes at the ends of the stem of a letter. ChapeL—A printing-ofiice. Chapel laws.--Rules of a printing-office. Chase—A rectangular iron frame in which pages of type are imposed. Circular quadrates—Blank types curv- ed on one side. Clean 15roqf.--A proof containing few faults. Clearing away—Properly disposing of materials after a work has been com- pleted. Clicker.—The chief of a companion- ship. Close nzatter.——Solid matter with few break-lines. Conzfanz'onship.——All the hands em- ployed on a work. Composing—Setting type. Conzposz'ng-rnld—A steel or brass rule, with a beak at one end, used in type- setting. Composing-stick.—An instrument in which types are arranged in words and lines. Corner quadrates—A quarter section of a hollow square or rectangle. Correct.—-A compositor is said to correct when he amends the faults marked in a proof. Corrections.—The alterations or errors marked in a proof. Cut-in letter—A type of large size .ad- justed at the beginning of the first para- graph of a chapter. , Cut-in -note.——-A note justified into the side of a page. Dead horse—Matter charged and paid for before it is set. Dele, 8.—A proof-reader's mark, signi- fying to take out. Descending letters—Letters that go down into the lower shoulder of the body: ass, i. p. (1. y- Devil.-—The errand-boy of a printing- office. Dished.—A defect in electrotyped plates, the centre of a letter being lower than its edges. Distributing—Remrning types to their various boxes after having been printed from. Spreading ink evenly over the surface of a roller. Double.—-Among compositors, repeti- tion of words ; among pressmen, a sheet that is twice pulled and mackled. Dressing a chase or fornz.—-Fitting the pages and chase with furniture and quoins. Drive out—To space widely. Duck’s-bill.—A tongue out in a piece of Stout paper and pasted on the tympan at the bottom of the tympan-sheet, to support the paper when laid on the tympan. Duodeeinzo, or Iznza—Twelve pages to a form. EnL—The square of the body of a type. En.—Half the dimensions of the prece- ding. Even page—The 2d, 4th, 6th, or any even-numbered page of a book. Fat—Poetry and leaded matter. Fat face, or Fat letter—Broad stemmed letter. Father zy‘ the chapeb—President or chairman of a composing-room or press-room chosen by the hands. Feed guide—An implement attached to a press to aid in correct feeding. Reeling—Supplying the press with sheets. First form.—The form first printed, which generally contains the first page of a sheet. Fly. ——The person or apparatus that takes off the sheets from the press. Folio.——Two pages to a form. Foot-sticks.—Sloping pieces of furniture placed at the bottom of pages, between 340 T E CHrV! CA L YZEA’M'S. which and the chase the quoins are driven to fasten the pages. Fw'nL—T he pages when imposed in a chase. ' Foul prozf—A proof with many faults marked in it. Foum‘.——A complete assortment of type, of the same nick, body, and face, put up by type-founders in accordance with an ascertained ratio. Fountain—Reservoir for ink, attached to printing-presses. Frz'ar.—A light patch in a printed sheet, caused by defective rolling. Frz'skeL—An iron frame fastened by a hinge to the upper part of the tympan, to hold the sheet of paper fast as it goes in and comes from the press. Fudge—To contrive without proper ma- terials. Full press—'When two men work at the press with hand rollers. Furniture—Strips of wood or metal placed around and between pages to make the proper margin. Galley—A wooden or brass fiat oblong tray, with side and head ledges, for holding type when composed. GaZley-sZat/es.—An ancient term of de- rision applied by pressmen to composi- tors. Gauge—A strip of reglet with a notch in it, passed with the make-up, to denote the length of the pages. Gauge-pba—An instrument to aid in feeding job presses correctly. Get z'n.—To set close.‘ Good column—Sheets printed neither too black nor too light. Guide—A strip of metal frequently used to denote the last line of copy set. Gutter-sticks.——Furniture used in impo- sition to separate the pages. Half pram—When but one person works at the press. flaZf-tz't/a—The title of a book inserted in the upper portion of the first page of matter. I'Iangz'ng z'ndentz'mz.—Where successive lines are set-in an em or more beyond the first line. Head-sticks.—Furniture put at the head of pages ‘in imposition, to make mar- gm, HeZZ.—The receptacle for broken or bat- tered letters; the old-metal box; the shoe. Hzlgrlz-Zz'ner—Term applied to a type that ranges above the rest in a line. Hzlg/z (or low) to payee—Applied to a type cast higher or lower than the rest of the fount. Hollow quadrates.—Metal quadrates mortised for the insertion of types, &c. Horsen—The stage on the bank on which pressmen set the heap of paper. Homing—Charging for work before it is executed Lapwing—Arranging and locking up a form of type in a chase. [mjosz'ng-stona—The stone on which compositors impose and correct forms. [mprz'nL—The name of the printer or of the publisher appended to jobs or title- pages. bgferz'or letters.—-Small letters cast near the bottom of the line. Inset—Same as ofi‘cut. yefi‘i—To throw for the first choice with em quadrates instead of dice. Yustzfyz'ngr—Spacing out lines accu- rately. Keep z'n.—To crowd in by thin spacing. Keefi out.—To drive out or expand mat- ter by wide spacing. Kerned !etter.—Type of which a part of the face hangs over the body. Laying eases.—Filling cases with a fount of new type. Laying pages—Placing pages of type on the stone in a proper order for im- position. Leaa'ers.—Dots or hyphens placed at in- tervals of one or more ems in length, to guide the eye across the line to the folio in tables of contents, &c. Leads.—-Thin strips of metal cast of various thicknesses, quadrate-high, to separate lines of type. Lean—Close and solid matter. Leanface.—Light, thin type. Letter fimzg-s.—.When the page is out of square. Letter- ress printing—Printing from types. Lzgaz‘ures—Two or more letters cast on the same shank, as fi', fi, fl, ffi, (Tl, 2e, 0e. TE CHNICAL TERIIIS. 341 Lineformers.—Brass rule bent in vari~ ous shapes to aid in making curved lines of type. Locking alt—Tightening up a form by means of quoins. Logotypes—The same as ligatures. Long cross.—The bar that divides a chase the longest way. Long pulL—When the bar is brought close to the cheek of a press. Low case.—\IVhen the compositor has set almost all the letters out of his case. Lower case—The case containing the small letters of the alphabet, figures, points, &c. . Low-line—Applied to a type that ranges lower than the rest in a line. fl'Iackle—W'hen part of the impression appears double. IIIake-rqfi.—To arrange the lines of mat- ter into pages. [Wake-up rule—A steel rule with a pro- jection on the top, for making up matter. IIIakz'ng margin—In imposition, ar— ranging the space between the pages of a form so that the margin will be properly proportioned. Illa/ring ready—Preparing a form on the press for printing. IIIallet.—-A wooden hammer. Matter.—-Composed type. [Pleasure—The width of a page. [Wonk—A black spot in a printed sheet, owing to the ink not being properly distributed. Naked form.-—A form without furniture. Nicks—Hollows cast in the front of the lower part of the shank of a type, to show the compositor how to place it in his stick. Octave, or 8vo.—Eight pages to a form. Octodecimo, or 181no.—Eighteen pages to a form. Odd page or folio—The 1st, 3d, and all uneven-numbered pages. Ofil—Signifies that the pressman has worked off the form. . Ofi'cnt.—-A portion of a sheet that is on off before folding. Ofi" its feet.—When matter does not stand upright. Open nzattcr.—Matter widely leaded or containing numerous break-lines. Out.-An omission marked in a proof by the reader. Out of register.—\Vhen the pages do not back each other. Overlay—A scrap of paper pasted on the tympan-sheet to bring up the im- pression. Overrunning.—Carrying words back- ward or forward in correcting. Page-cord.—T\vine used for tying up pages. Passing the makeup—Passing to the next hand in order the lines remaining (if any) after a compositor has made up his matter, together with the gauge and proper folio. Peel.——A broad, thin board with a long handle. Perfecting—Printing the second form of a sheet. Perforating rule—Brass or steel rule, somewhat higher than type. Pi.-—Type promiscuously intermingled. Pick—A particle of ink or paper im- bedded in the hollow of a letter, filling up its face and occasioning a spot. Pigs—An ancient nickname given in derision by compositors to pressmen. The press-room was called a pigsty. Planer.—-A smooth block of wood used for levelling the surface of pages of type when imposed. Planing down.—To bring down types evenly on their feet, by laying a planer on the page and striking it firmly with a mallet. Platen.—'I‘he part of a printing-press which, acted upon by the lever, gives the impression to a sheet. Point-Izoles.-—Fine holes made by the points to register the second impres- sion by. Points—Two thin pieces of steel with a point at one end, adjusted to the tym- pan with screws, to make register. Quadrate.—A low square blank type, used to indent the first line of a para- graph, and to fill up blank spaces. Quarters.—Octavos and twelves are said to be imposed in quarters, not from their equal divisions, but because they are imposed and locked up in four parts. Quarto, or 4to.—-F0ur pages to a form. 29*»:- 342 . TECHNICAL TERMS. Quz're.—Twenty-four sheets of paper. Quoz'ns.—Small wedges for locking up a form. Quotation furnz'ture.—Quotations cast of various sizes in length and width, used for blanking and as furniture. Quotations—Large hollowed quadrates. Rack—Receptacle for cases. Ratchet.-—An instrument for turning the screws of stereotype blocks. Rattz'ng.—Working at less than the esta- blished prices. Ream.—Twenty quires of paper. Recta—Right-hand page. R¢ferences.—Letters or characters serv- ing to direct the reader's attention to notes at the foot of a page. Regzster.--To cause the pages in a sheet to print precisely back to back. Register sheet.—-The sheet used to make register. Reglet.-—Thin furniture, of an equal thickness all its length. It is made to match the depth of type. Reiteration.-'I‘ he form printed on the second side. Revise—The last proof of a form before working it off. Riding—One colour falling on another. 'I'ype at the end of a line catching against a lead. Risa—A form is said to rise when, in raising it from the correcting stone, no letters drop out. Rotten—A wooden cylinder covered with composition. which, set in an iron frame, revolves upon a rod, and is used for inking type. Rounce ——The handle for running in and out the carriage of a hand-press. Roundpz’ch—A dot in a letter in a stereo- type plate caused by an air-bubble. Running title—The title of the book or subject placed at the top of the pages. Runs on sorts.—-Requiring an inordinate proportion of particular letters. Saw-bloch.—-A box similar to a carpen- ter's mitre-block, to guide in cutting furniture, &c. Schedule—A sheet of paper passed with the make-up, containing folios, on which the compositor marks his name opposite to the pages set by him. Set oj‘l—When sheets that are newly worked off soil those that come in con- tact with them, they are said to set off. Shank—The metal body upon which the face of a letter stands. Sheep’sfoot—An iron hammer with a claw-end. Sheetwise.—When the pages of a sheet are imposed in‘two forms, which are backed in printing. Shooting-stick.-A wedge-shaped instru- ment for locking up a form. Short cross.—The short bar which, cross- ing the long bar, divides the chase into quarters. Shoulder.—The surface of the shank of I a type not covered by the letter. Side sorts.—Types in the side and upper boxes of a case, consisting of letters not frequently used. Sz'de-stic/es.—Sloping furniture on the outside of the pages next to the chase, where the quoins are inserted. Signature—A letter or a figure used at the bottom of the first page of a sheet, to direct the binder in placing the sheets in a volume. Slice galley.-—-A galley with an upper movable bottom, called a slice, used for pages andjobs too large to be lifted by the fingers. Slug—A thick lead. Sometimes with a word or figure on top, used to denote the ownership of matter on galleys. Slur.—A blurred impression in a printed sheet. Solid pick—A letter in a stereotype plate filled up with metal, resulting from an imperfect mould. Sorts—The letters in the several case- boxes are separately called sorts, in printers’ and founders’ language. Sfiace-rules—Fine lines, cast type-high, and of even ems in length, for table and algebraical work. Sjacea—Low blank types used to sepa- rate words. Squabble.——A page or form is squabbled when the letters are twisted out of a square position. Stand—The frame on which the cases are placed. Stem.—The vertical strokes of a type. Stereotype printing—Printing from ste- reotyped plates. TECHNICAL TERMS. 343 SteL—W'ritten opposite to a word in a proof, to signify that the word errone- ously struck out shall remain. Sui—A compositor occasionally em- ployed on a daily paper, to fill the place of an absentee. Superior Zetz‘ers.—Letters of a small face, cast by the founder near the top of the line. IIZzbZe'worh—Matter consisting partly -of rules and figures. Take, or Taking—A given portion of copy. Token—Two hundred and fifty sheets. Turn fir a letter.—When a sort runs short, a letter of the same thickness is substituted, placed bottom upward. Tympam—A frame covered with parch- ment or muslin and attached to the press-bed, to lay the sheet on before printing. UnderZay.—A piece of paper or card placed under types or cuts to improve the impression. 0115p” case.—The case containing capital and small capital letters, fractions, &c. Vers0.—Left-hand page. Wayz-goase.-—A term given in England to the annual dinner customary among printers there during the summer months. White linen—A line of quadrates. l/V/zz'te faga—A blank page. l'V/zz'te japan—Until the second side of a sheet is printed, pressmen call the heap white paper. Work ana’turn.—\Vhen a sheet is print’ ed half-sheetwise, the paper must be turned and worked on the second side. Working in pocket—"When the hands share equally their earnings on a work. PROOF PRESS. I ' \ a; I '. .‘Q'fii'il .' ~.._ . . ‘15 11 wt" .39’ J~l-'-“"'""'-"//..-- -‘ . "1% iii: .-<~ .v tame-J.‘ ‘ \\,-’ Til?" _:_ _\_\ I. ,4? ‘ ‘SW \ ABBREVIATIONS. A.—Acting. a.——are, (of the French metric system.) A. or Ans—Answer. A. A. G.-—Assistant Adjutant-General. A. A. P. S.—American Associationfor the Promotion of Science. A. A. S . —A eademz'w A merz'came .S‘ocz'us, Fellow of the American Academy (of Arts and Sciences). A. A. S. S.-A merz'eanee Antz'quarz'anw Soez'ez‘atz's Socius, Member of the Ame- rican Antiquarian Society. A. B.--A7'z‘z'2mz Baeealaureus, Bachelor of Arts. A. B. C. F. M.--American Board of Com- missioners for Foreign Missions. Abp.—-Archbishop. Abr.—-Abridgment. A. C.——Ante Clzrz'sz‘um, before the birth of Christ. A. C.—Archchancellor. Acct.—Account. A. C. S.—American Colonization Society. A. D.-—Amzo Domini, in the year of the Lord. A. D. C.—Aide-de-camp. Adj .—Adjective. Adjt.—Adjutant. Adjt.-Gen.—Adjutant-General. Ad lib—Ad lz‘éz'tum, at pleasure. Adm—Admiral; Admiralty. Adm. C0.—Admiralty Court. Admr.—-Administrator. Admx.—Administratrix. Ad v.--Ad ?Ialorem, at (or on) the value. Adv.——Adverb. [EL—zEtatz's, of age; aged. A. F. B. S.—American and Foreign Bible Society. A. F. & A. M.—-Ancient Free and Ac- cepted Masons. A. G.——Adj utant-General. Ag.-—~Argentzmz, silver. Agr.—-Agriculture. ’ A. G. S. S.—-American Geographical and Statistical Society. Agt.—Agent. A. H.—Amz0 Hegz'ne, in the year of the Hegira. A. H. M.S.—American Home Missiona- ry Society. Ala—Alabama. Ali—Alderman. Alex.—-Alexander. Alg.——Algebra. AIL—Altitude. A. M.—A7m0 mzma’z', in the year of the world. A. M.—Anz‘e merz'dz'enz, before noon; morning. A. M.—Artz'zmz Magrz'ster, Master of Arts. Amb.—Ambassador. Amen—American. AMM.—Ama/jgmna, amalgamation. Amt.-Amount. An.—Amzo, in the year. An.A. C.—A1m0 (mle C/zrz'stzmz, in the year before Christ. Anat.—Anatomy. Ana—Ancient; anciently. And—Andrew. Ang.-Sax.—Anglo-Saxon. Anon.-——Anonymous. 34.4 ABBRE VIA TJONS. 345 Anth.—Anthony. Aor. or aor.—Aorist. A. O. S. S.—Amerz'c¢mae Orz'em‘alz's So- cz'etatz's Sacz'us, Member of the Ameri- can Oriental Society. Ap.—Apostle; Appius. Ap.—Apud, in the writings of; as quoted by. A. P. G. or Ast. P. G.—Professor of As- tronomy in Gresham College. Apo-—Apogee. Ame—Apocalypse. App—Appendix. Apr.—April. A. Q. M. G.—Assistant Quartermaster- General. A. R.—A1zmz Regina, Queen Anne. A. R.—Amzo regvzz', year of the reign. A. R. A.—Associate of the Royal Aca- demy. Arch.—Archibald. Arg.—Argumento, by an argument drawn from such a law. Arith.—Arithmetic. Ark—Arkansas. A. R. R.—Amzo regnz' regz's, in the year of the reign of the king. A. R. S. S.——Antz'quarz'orum Regz'ze So- cz'ez‘atz's Socz'us, Fellow of the Royal Society of Antiquaries. Art.—-Article. A. S. or Assist. Sec.———Assistant Secretary. A. S.A.—American Statistical Associa- tion. A. S. S. U.—American Union. Astrol.—-Astrology. Astron.——Astronomy. A. T.——Archtreasurer. A. T. S.—American Tract Society. Ats.——At suit of. Atty.-—Attorney. Atty.-Gen.—-Attorney-General. A. U.A.-—American Unitarian Associa- tion. Aub. Theol. Sem.—-Auburn Theological Seminary. A. U. C.—‘Amzo urbz's cona’z'taz, or, a6 urbe condz'tzi, in the year from the building of the city (Rome). Aug—August. Aur.—-Aurum, gold. Auth. Ver.—Authorized Version, (of the Bible.) Sunday-School Av.—Average; Avenue. Avoir.—Avoirdupois. . A. Y. M.——Ancient York Masons. b.—born; book. B.A.—Bachelor of Arts. BaL—Balance. Balt.—Baltimore. Bar.-—Baruch. Bart. or Bt.—Baronet. bbl.——Barrel. B. C.—Before Christ. B. C. L.—Bachelor of Civil Law. B. D.—Baccalau reusDivi/zz'taz‘zlv, Bache- lor of Divinity. Bds. or bds.—-Boards (bound in). Benj.—Benjamin. Bk.—Book. B. LL.—.Baccalaureus Leg‘zmz, Bachelor of Laws. B. M.—Baccalaureus jlledz'cz'na’, Bache- lor of Medicine. Bost.—-—Boston. Bot.—Botany. Bp.——Bishop. B. R.—Banco' Regis or Regime, the King‘s or Queen's Bench. Br.—Brig. Brig—Brigade; Brigadier. Brig-Gen.—Brigadier-General. Brit. MuS.——British Museum. Br0.—Br0ther. Br. Univ.—Br0wn University. B. S.—Bachelor in the Sciences. bu.—bushel. B. V.—-Beata Virgo, Blessed Virgin. B. V.—Bene ‘Hale, farewell. ca.——centiare, (metric system.) C., ch. or chap.—Chapter. C. or cent.— C‘enz‘zmz, a hundred. Caet. par.— Carter-is fiarz‘éus, other things being equal. CaL—California ; Calends. Can—Canon. Cant.-—-Canticles. Cap. or c.-—Caput, capz'tulzmz, chapter. Caps.—-—Capitals. Capt—Captain. Capt.-Gen.—Captain-General. Cash—Cashier, Ca. resp.—Capz'as ad respondcndzmz, a legal writ. Ca. sa.—Ca1$z'as an.’ saz‘zlsfacz'endum, a legal writ. - Cath.-.—Catherine. 346 ABBRE VIA TIOJVS. C. B.-- Commum's Bancus, Common Bench. C. B.—Companion of the Bath. C.C.—Caius College; Account Current. C. C. C.—Corpus Christi College. C. C. P.—Court of Common Pleas C. E.——Canada East. C. E.—-Civil Engineer. Cel. or Celt.—Celtic. Cf. or cfi—Confrzr, compare. cg.—-centigram, (metric system.) C. G.—Commissary-General; General. C. H.—Court-House Ch.—Church; Chapter; Charles. Chanc.—Chancellor. Chap—Chapter. Chas—Charles. Chem.—Chemistry. Chr.—Christopher. Chron.-—Chronicles. Cin.——Cincinnati. C. _I.——Chief-]ustice. cl.—centiliter, (metric system.) Clk.—Clerk. cm.—centimeter, (metric system.) C. M.—Common Metre. C. M. G.—Companion of the Order of St. Michael and St. George. Co.—Company; County. C. O. D.—Cash (or collect) on delivery. COL—Colorado; Colonel; Colossians. COIL—Collector; .Colloquial; College ; Collection. Corn—Commerce; Committee; Com- mentary; Commissioner; Commodore. Com. Arr.—Committee of Arrangements. Comdg.—-Commanding. Comm.——Commentary. Comp—Compare; Compound. Com. Ver.—Comm0n Version (of the Bible.) Con—Contra, against; in opposition. Con. (In—Contra credit. Conch.—Conchology. Cong—Congress. Conj. or conj.—Conjunction. Conn. or Ct.—Connecticut. Const.—Constable; Constitution. Cont.—Contra. Con—Corinthians. CoroL—Corollary. Cor. See—Corresponding Secretary. C. P.——Common Pleas. Consul- C. P.—Court of Probate. C. P. S.— Custos Prz'zlatz' Szlg'z'llz', Keeper of the Privy Seal. C. R.— Custos Rotulorum, Keeper of the Rolls. Cr.—Creditor; credit. Crim. com—Criminal conversation; adul- tery. C. S—Court of Sessions. C. S.— Custos Szlgz'llz', Keeper of the Seal. Ct., cts.——Cent; cents. C. Theod.—Codz'ce T/zeoa'osz'ano, in the Theodosian Code. C. W.—Canada ‘Nest. Cwt.——Hundredweight. Cyc.—Cyclopedia. d.-—Denarz'us or denarz'z', penny or pence. d.—died. D.—Five hundred. Dam—Daniel ; Danish. D. B. or Domesd. B.—Domesday-Book. D. C.—Da Capo, again. D. C.—District of Columbia. D. C. L.—Doctor of Civil Law. D. D.—Dz'7/z'nz'z‘atz's Doctor, Doctor of Divinity. D. D. D.—Dm‘, dz'cat, dedz'cat, he gives, he devotes, he dedicates. Dea.——Deacon. Dec.—December; Declination. Deg—Degree or degrees. Del.—Delaware; Delegate. Del. or del.--Delz‘nea7/z't, he drew it. Dem.—Democrat. Dep.—Deputy. Dept.—-Department. Deut.-——Deuteronomy. D .F.—Dean of the Faculty. Dft. or deft—Defendant. D.G.——Deig7’atiri, by the grace of (3011. D. G.—Dea gratz'as, thanks to God. dg.—-decigram, (metric system.) Dg.—Dekagram, (metric system.) D. H.—Dead-head. Diam.—Diameter. Diet—Dictator; Dictionary. Dim.— Diminutive. Disc.—Discount. Diss.—Dissertation. Dist—District. Dist.-Atty.—District-Attorney. dl.—deciliter, (metric system.) Dl.-—Delulus Romanus, the Roman people. P. R. A.——President of the Royal Aca- clemy. P. R. C.—Post Romamml condz'tum, from the building of Rome. Pref.—Preface. Prep.—Preposition. Pres—President. Prim—Principally. Prob.—Problem. Prof.—Professor. Pron.—Pronoun; Pronunciation. Prop.—Proposition. Prot.—Protestant. Pro tem.—~P1’o tempore, for the time being. Prov.—Proverbs; Provost. prox.—Proxz‘mo, next (month.) P. R. S.—President of the RoyalSociety. P. S.——Post scrzftum, Postscript ; Privy Seal. Ps.-—Psalm or Psalms. Pt.—Part; Pint; Payment; Point; Port. p. t.—Post-town. P. T. O.——Please turn over. Pub—Publisher ; Publication; lished; Public. Pub- Pub. Doe—Public Documents. p. v.—-Post-village. pwt.—Pennyweight; pennyweights. Q.—Queen ; Question. q.—-quintal; Quasi, as it were; almost. Q. B.—Queen’s Bench. Q. C.——Queen’s College; Queen’s Coun- sel. q. d.—Quasz' dz'cat, as if he should say; quasi dictum, as if said; quasi a’ix- z'sset, as if he had said. q. e.-—Quod est, which is. q. e. d.—Quod erat demonstrandum, which was to be proved. q. e. fi—Quoa' crat facz'endzmz, which was to be done. q. e. i.—Quoa' erat z'nvenimzdmn, which was to be found out. q. l.—Quantum lz'oet, as much as you please. Q. LL—Quartermaster. qm.—Quomodo, how ; by what means. Q. M. G.—Quartermaster-General. q. p. or q. pl.—Quantum,olacet, as much as you please. Qr.—Quarter. Q. S.—Quarter Sessions. q. s.—Quautum suficz't, a sufiicient quantity. qt.——Quart. qu. or qy. (?).—Qucere, inquire; query. Quar.—Quarterly. Ques.—Question. q. v.—Quoa' @1212, which see; Quantum 'z/z's, as much as you will. ll—Recz'pe, take; Response, in church books. R.—-Rcgz'na, Queen ; Rex, King; River ; Rood; Rod. R. A.—Royal Academy ; Royal Acade- mician; Royal Artillery. R. A.—Royal Arch; Royal Association. R. E.—Royal Engineers. Rec.—Recipe; Recorder. Recd.—Received. Rec. Sec.——Recording Secretary. Rect.-—Rector; Receipt. Ref.—Reference. Ref. Ch.--Reformed Church. Reg—Register; Regular. Reg. Prof.——Regius Professor. Regr.—Registrar. Regt.—Regiment. Rel.--Rcligion. 30+:- 354 ABBRE VIA TJONS. Rep.-—Representative; Republican ; Re- port. . Rev.-—Reverend; Revelation (Book of;) Review; Revenue; Revise. Rhet.—-Rhetoric. R. I.—Rhode Island. Richd.—Richard. R. M.—-Royal Marines; Royal Mail. R. M. S.—Royal Mail Steamer. R. N.—Royal Navy. Ro.—Recto, right-hand page. Robt.—Robert. Rom.——Romans (Book of.) Rom. Cath.—Roman Catholic. R. P.—Rcgius Professor, the King’s Professor. R. P. E.—Reformed Protestant Episco- pal. R. R.-—Railroad. R. S.—Recording Secretary. Rs-[fmjmzsus to answer. R. S. A.—Royal Society of Antiquaries; Royal Scottish Academy. R. S. D.--Royal Society of Dublin. R. S. E.-——Royal Society of Edinburgh. R. S. L.—Royal Society of London. R. S. S.—-—Reg‘z'a’ Socz'etatz's Socz'zzs, Fel- low of the Royal Society. R. S. V. R-Kc’pondez, s’z'l zlous flail, answer, if you please. Rt. Hon.—-Right Honourable. Rt. Rev.-—Right Reverend. Rt. WpfuL—Right Worshipful. R. W.—Right \Vorthy. S.-—-South; Saint; Scribe ; Sulphur; Sunday; Sun; Series ; Solz'a'us, ashil- ling; Stere, (metric system.) S. A.—South America; South Africa; South Australia. s. a.—Secmzdum artem, according to art. Sam.—-Samuel. S. A. S.—Socz'ctat1's Antz'quarz‘orum So- cz'us, Fellow of the Society of Anti- quaries. Sat—Saturday. Sax.—Saxon. Sax. Chron.—Saxon Chronicle. S. C.-—-Senat:2s Consultum, a decree of the Senate; South Carolina. Sc.—Sculpsz't, he engraved it. sc. or sciL—Scz'lz'cez‘, namely. Scan. Mag—Scandalum mag/zatzmz, scandal of the great. Schol.—Sclzolz'um, a note. Schr.—Schooner. Sci. fa.—Scz're fizcz'as, to show cause. Sclav.—Sclavonic. Sculp. or sculp.——Scul;5sz't, be engraved it. S. D.—Salutem dz'cz't, sends health. S. E.—Southeast. Sec.—-Secretary; Second. Sec. Leg—Secretary of Legation. Sec. leg—Secundum Zegem, according to law. See. reg.—Sccundmu regulam, accord- ing to rule. Sect.—Section. Sem.—-Sem61e, it seems. Sen.—Senate; Senator; Senior. Sept.——September: Septuagint. Seq.—Seguom‘z'a, following; sequz'tur, it follows. Ser.—Series. Serg.—Sergeant. Serg. Maj .—Sergeant~Major. Servt.—Servant. S. G.—South Georgia; Solicitor General. Shak.—-Shakspeare. ' S. H. S.—Socz'ctatz's Hz'storz'w Sacz'us, Fellow of the Historical Society. Sing—Singular. S. Isl.—Sandwich Islands. S. J.—Society of Jesus. S. j. C.-—-Supreme judicial Court. Skr.—Sanskrit. S. L.—Solicitor at Law. S. lat.—South latitude. S. M.—State Militia; Short Metre; Ser- geant-Major; Sons of Malta. sm. c.—Small capitals. S. M. Lond. Soc. Cor.—Socz'etatz's Medi- cce Londonensz's Socz'us Corn, Cone’ sponcling Member of the London Medical Society. 5. n.—-Sccmzdmu naturam, according to nature. Soc. Isl.—-Society Islands. SOL—Solomon; Solution. SOL-Gen.—Solicitor-General. S. of Sol.——Song of Solomon. S.P.—Sz'neprolc, without issue; salute”: ‘firccm‘m', he prays for his prosperity. S. P. A. S.-—Socz'etatz's P/zz'losopkz'cre Americana Socz'us, Member of the American Philosophical Society. S. P. C. A.—Society for the Prevention of Cruelty to Animals. S. P. D.——Salutem plurz'mam dicz'z‘, he ABBRE VIA TIONS. 355 wishes much health, or sends his best respects. S. P. (Fi.—Society for the Propagation of the Gospel. Sp. gr.—Specific gravity. S. P. Q. R.—Senatus Populusque Ro- mam', the Senate and people of Rome. S. P. R. S.——Sublime Prince of the Royal Secret. Sq. ft.——Square foot or square feet. Sq. in.—Square inch or inches. Sq. m.~—Square mile or miles. Sq. r.—Square rood or roods. Sq. yd.—-Square yard. tin—Sir; Senior. 5. R. I.—Sacrzmz Ii’ouzanum Imperz'um, Holy Roman Empire. S. R. S.-—Sooz'etatz's Regz'e Socius, F el- low of the Royal Society. S. S .-—-Sunday-school. SS.—Saints. SS. or ss.—Scz'licet, to wit. sis—Swizz}, half. S. S. C.—-Solicitor of the Supreme Court. S. S. E.———South-southeast. S. S. \V.-—South-southwest. St.—Saint; Street; Strait. Stat.—Statute. S. T. D.—Sacr(2 T/zeologz'e Doctor, Doctor of Divinity. Ster. or Stg.—Sterling. S. T. P.—Sacraz T/zeolog'z'ze Profi’ssor, Professor of Divinity. Subj.——Subjunctive. Subst.-—Substantive. Siifi'.—Suiiix. Su.-Goth.—Suio-Gothic. Su., Sun. or Sund.--Sunday. Sup—Supplement; Superfine. Supt.—Superintendent. Surg.—Surgeon; Surgery. Surg.-Gen.—Surgeon-General. Surv.-—Surveyor. Surv.-Gen.--Surveyor-General. Sus.—Susannah. s. v.—Sub wroo, under the word or title. S. VV.—Senior Warden; Southwest. Syn.—Synonym ; Synonymous. T.—-Territory. t.—tonneau, (metric system.) T.— Tutti, all together. T. or tom.—Tome, volume. Ta.—-Tantalum (Columbium.) T. E.-—Topographical Engineers. T enn.-—-Tennessee. Ter.—Territory. Tex—Texas. Text. Rec.—Textus Receptus, the Re- ceived Text. T hlr.——Thaler, (German coin.) Th. or Thurs—Thursday. Theo—Theodore. 'I‘heoL—Theology; Theological. Theoph.—Theophilus. Thess.—Thessalonians. Tho’.—-Though. Thos.—Thomas. Thro’.—Through. Tim.—-Tim0thy. Tit.—Titus. T. O.——Turn over. Tob.—Tobit. Tom.—Volume. Topog—Topography; Topographical. Tr.—Transpose; Translator; Transla— tion. - Tr.—Trustee. Trs.—Trustees. tr.—Trz'llo, a shake. Trans—Translator; Translation; Trans- actions. Traits—Treasurer. Trim—Trinity. Tues. or Tu.——Tuesclay. Typ.—-Typographcr. U. C.—Upper Canada. U. C.——Urlzo cmzdz'ta, year of Rome. U. E. I. C.—United East India Com- pany. U. G. R. R.——Underground Railway. U. _I. D.-—- Utrz'nsouo YurisDootor, Doc- tor of both Laws, (Civil and Canon.) U. K.—United Kingdom. tilt—Ultimo, last ; of the last month. Unit.—Unitarian. Univ.—University. U. P. C.——United Presbyterian Church. U. S.—United States. 11. s.——Uz‘ supra or m‘z' supra, as above. U. S. A.--United States of America; United States Army. U. S. M.—United States Mail; United States Marines. U. S. M. A.—United States Academy. U. S. N.——United States Navy. U. S. N. A.—United States Naval Aca- demy. U. S. S.-—United States Senate. Military 356. ABBRE VIA TIOZVS. U. S. V.—United States Volunteers. U.’ T.~—Utah Territory. V.—Five or fifth. V.——Violin; VV.—-Violins. v. or vid.— Vz'a’e, see. v. or vs.-——Versus, against; Versz'culo, in such a verse. Va.—Virginia. Vat.—Vatican. V. C.--Vice-Chancellor. V. D. M .— Veroz' Dez‘ Minister, Minis- ter of God’s Word. Ven.—Venerable. Ven. or Ven. Fa.— Venz'refacz'as, a writ to a sheriff to summon a jury. Ven. Ex.—-Vendz'tz'one exjonas, a writ of execution directed to a sheriff to sell goods, etc. Ver.—-Verse. V. G.-—Vicar-General. v. g.-—-Veroz'gratz'd, as for example. VI.—Six or sixth. VII.—Seven or seventh. VIIL—Eight or eighth. Vice. Pres. or V. P.—Vice-President. Visc.-—Viscount. viz. or vl.——Vz'delz'cz't, to wit; namely; that is to say. Vo.—— Verso, left-hand-page. Vol.—-Volume. V. R.—Vz'ctorz'a Regina, Queen Victoria. V t.——Vermont. Vul .—Vulgate ( Version.) vv. ll.-— Varz'e Zeetz'ones, different read- ings. v. y.—-Various years. W.—West. Wash.—\Vashington. \Ved-Wednesday. w. f.—\Vrong fount. Whf.——Wharf. \V. I.-—West India. \Visc.—Wisconsin. Wisd.—\Visdom, (Book of.) \Vk.--Week. W. lon.—West longitude. W. M.-—Worshipful Master. Wm.—William. W. N. W.—West-northwest. Wpful.—Worshipful. W. S.——Writer to the Signet. W. S. W.—-West-southwest. W. T.-——Washington Territory. \VL—Weight. W. Va.—West Virginia. X.—~Ten or tenth. XI.—Eleven. XIL—Twelve. XIIL—Thirteen. XIV.—Fourteen. XV.——Fifteen. XVL—Sixteen. XVIL—Seventeen. XVIII.—Eighteen. XIX.—~Nineteen. XX.—Twenty. XXX.-—Thirty. XL.—-Forty. XC.—-Ninety. X. or Xt.~—Christ. Xmas or Xm.—-Christmas. Xn. or Xtian.——Christian. Xnty. or Xty.—Christianity. Xper. or Xr.—-Christopher. Yd.—Yard. y. or y°.——The. ym.-—Them. yn.--Then. yK—Their; Your. y5.-—~This. yR—That. Y. M. C. A.—Young Men's Christian Association. Yrs—Years; Yours. Zach—Zachary. Zech.—Zechariah. Zeph.-—-Zephaniah. Zool.-——Zoology. &.-And. &c.-—And so forth. FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES, \NITH TR ANSLATIONS. A baa—Down with. A capz'te ad calcem.—From head to foot. Afin.—To the end. A fortz'orz'.—With stronger reason. A l’abandom—At random. A la &omze lzeura—Opportunely; in good time. A [a dérooécn—By stealth. A la mode.—According to the fashion. A main ar11zée.—Witli force of arms. A monsa et Mora—From bed and board. A posterz'orzI—From effect to cause ; from the latter. A priorzl—From cause to effect; from the former. A tempo g'z'asto.——To sing or play in true time. (Music) A tempo rima—To restore the original movement. (.llfusz'c‘.) A zzz'nczdo matrz'monz'i.—From the tie of marriage. A 7102‘)? santé.—To your health. A6 extra.—From without. A6 z'm'tzo—From the beginning. Ab orzlg'z'na—From the beginning. Ao ova—From the beginning. Ao m'ée condz'td—From the building of the city (Rome); abridged A. U. C. Aéz't z'ur/z'dz'd—All offence apart ; let there be no malice. Aosz't omen—May it not prove ominous. Aosque Izoc.—\Vithout this or that. Ac etz'am.——And also. Actum est de repuMz'car—It is all over with the commonwealth. Ad aosurdmm—To show the absurdity. Ad aroz'trz'm)z.—At pleasure. Ad astra for asperd—To the stars through difficulties. Ad captandzu/z r/u/gus.—-To catch the mob or the vulgar. Ad czmdem.—To the same point or de- gree. Adfinem.—To the end. Ad Grzecas Calendas.—An indefinite postponement. (The Greeks had no calends.) Ad komz';zem.—-To the man (that is, to the interests or the passions of the man.) Ad z'ufim'tzmz.—Without end. Ad z'uguz'rendzmz.—F or inquiry. Ad z'ntt'rz'm.—In the mean while. Ad lz'bz'tzmL—At pleasure. Ad Zz'tcm.—-For the action (at law.) Ad naaseam.—To a disgusting degree. Ad mfureudum.—For further considera- tion. Ad worm—To the purpose. Ad mzgzwm.—To the nail ; exactly : nicely. Ad vatorenL—According to the value. AddcndzmL—An addition or appendix. Ad/mc sub judz'ce [is est—The affair is not yet decided. rli‘grescz't 7lzedmzdo.—The remedy is worse than the disease. Equam 8872/6276’ mentom.—To preserve an equable mind. Eouo anz‘mo.—\Vith an equable mind. Aim’ pcrenm'as.——l\lore lasting than brass; enduring ever. Aflaz're du cwma—A love affair; an amour. A flatus.——Inspiration. 357 358 FOKEZGJV PVORDS AND PHRASES. Agenda—Things to be done. Agitato.—A broken style ofperformance, to awaken surprise. (M'usz'a) Agnus Dcz'.—Lamb of God. A{dado-camp.-—Assistant to a general. A z'de-toz', at [e cz'ct t’az'dera—Help thy- self, and Heaven will help thee. A [are flammam.—To feed the flame. A!frcsco.——In the open air. A/ga—A kind of sea-weed. A Zgaazz'L—A Spanish constable. Alias—Otherwise; elsewhere. Altai—Elsewhere ; not present. Alz's 'oolat proprz'zs—She flies with her own wings. AZz'unde.—From some other quarter or person. Al/egrctta—A movement quicker than a-Iza’anto, but not so quick as allcgro. (fl'fuszc) Allemandc.—A kind of German dance. Alma mater.—Benign mother (applied to a university.) Alter cga—A second self. Alto octavo.—An octave higher. Alto ro/ie'oa—High relief. (.S‘culptare.) Alto rzfz'ena—Thc tenor of a great chorus. A [to 'oz'oZz'na—A small tenor violin. Amanda.—Compensation; apology. Ami a’a jfieujfita—Friend of the people. Amz'cus carian—A friend of the court. Amorpatrz'ca—Love of country. Amourproprch—Self-love; vanity. Ancz'cn régima—Former administra- tion; ancient order of things. A ndanta—Moderately slow movement, between largo and aZ/ogro. (llluszc) ArzgZI'c2.-—In English. Angm's in lwroa—A snake in the grass. Am'mz's opz'busquc faratzI—Ever ready with our lives and property. A m'mo ct fido.—By (or with) courage and faith. A nz'mo fact0.—Really and truly. Animus fz¢randz'.——Felonius intent. Amzo Domini—In the year of our Lord. Amzo [acts—In the year of light. A 11110 mzmztz'.—In the year of the world. Amms 1lzz'rabz'lzs—Year of wonders. A rate &c'llunL—Before the war. A ntc Zacem.—Before light. A ntc morz'dz'om.—Before noon. ApcrczL—A brief sketch of any subject. Ajpogz'atura—A note in a smaller char- acter than the regular notes of the piece. (Zilusz'a) Apropos (Fr. a/roposJ—To the purpose. Aqua w'taa—YVater of life; brandy. Aréz'ter elegantz'a rm1z.-—l\’.[aster of cere- monies; an umpire in matters of taste. Arcana z'mjfierz'zI—State secrets. Arca)zzmz.—A secret. Argmlzerztzmz ad crumenam.—An argu- ment to the purse. Argumcntunz adfidem.—An appeal to faith. Argumcntum ad Imminent—An argu- ment to the person. A rgumcntzmz aa' zzgnorantz'ant—An argument founded on an adversary's ignorance of facts. Argumeutum adj-aa'zcz'zmz.——An appeal to the common sense of mankind. Argzmze/ztm/z (ZdjfiOj’ZtlZMiZr-Al'l appeal to the people. Argzmzcntzmz ad 7J87'L’6‘ZfildiflflL—Al] ar- gument to modesty. Argm/zeatum oaculz'mum—Club law. A rz'oso.—Light, airy. ArmIIgen—One bearing arms; an es- quire. A rptgrgia—The notes of a chord played in rapid succession, and not simulta- neously. (Muszc) Arrz'ére-pensée.—Mental reservation. Ars cst cclarc artw/L—True art is to conceal art. Asszmzjiszt—It is assumed or taken for granted. Astra castra, Numen lumen—The stars my camp, the Deity my light. At spas non fracta.—But hope is not broken. Aufaz't.—Well instructed; master of it. AufomL—To the bottom, or main point. An pied do la lcttra—Literally. Au jiz's alZer.—-At the worst. A a rc'z/oz'rr—Farewell. A uctz' altcram jartona—Hear the other side Aura jfiopularzs—The gale of popular favour. A urz' sacrafames.—-The accursed thirst for gold. A uter droz't.——Another’s right. Aatcr foz't.—Another time. Auter zlz'a—Another’s life. FOREIGN WORDS AZVD PHBASES. 359 Aut 'oz'ncero (mt morz'.—Victory or death. A uto-dafé, Auto-de-fe.—An act of faith ; burning of heretics. A uxz'lz'um at} alto—Help from on high. Avant-coureun—A forerunner. Ave, 1Warz'zz.-—Hail, Mary. Badz'nago.—-I.ight or playful discourse. Bagato/le.——A trifle. Bas blew—A blue-stocking; a literary woman. Basso-continua.-—Thorough bass. Basso-relz'ezto.—Figures in low relief. Bateau.——A long light boat. Beau-z'déaL—A model of ideal perfection. Beau Manda—The fashionable world. Be! esprit—A brilliant mind. Bella-dound—T he deadly nightshade ; fair lady. Belles-lettros. —Polite literature. Bel/um internecz'mmz.——A war of exter- mination. Bellum Ictlmle.——A deadly war. Bone p/aoz'to—At pleasure. (fllusz'a) Benzzgno mmzz'ne.—By the favour of Providence. Ben troz/(zto.—-\Vell found; an ingenious solution. Bz'llet-dozz.r.—-A love-letter. Bz's dat qzu' cz'to (lat—He gives twice who gives promptly. Bis peccare in bo/lo non [toot—To blun- der twice is not allowed in war. Bz's 'oz'ncz't, out so vz'ucz't in z/z'ctorz'd.- He conquers a second time, who con- trols himself in victory. Bz'zarro—Odd; fantastic. B!asé.-Surfeited. Bon gre' malgré.—\Villing or unwilling Bon jozuz—Good-day; good-morning. Bou. mot—A witty saying; a jest; a quibble. Bon soz'r.—Good-evening. Bon tom—High fashion; first-class so- ciety. Bon w'vmzt—A high liver. Bonafldo.—Iii good faith. Bon-éom—A sweetmeat ; confectionery. Bon/wmz'a—Good-natured simplicity. Bom's nocot qm'sqm's peporcerz't mall's.— He hurts the good who spares the bad. Bomzo bouc/ze.—A delicious morsel. Bonus.—An extra payment for a service rendered or a thing received. Boreas.—The north wind. Boudoz'r.——A small private apartment. Bourgeoz's.—A citizen of the trading class; a printing type. Bourgeoisie—The body of citizens. Bravura.-—A song of difiicult execution. Brewté.—Pateiited. Brutum fulmem—A harmless thunder- bolt ; unreasoning bluster. Burletta.—A musical farce. Cac/zet.—A seal. Cacoot/zes.-—-A bad habit or custom. Cacoot/zes carpendzI—A rage for finding fault. Cacoet/zes Zoquendz'.——An itch for speak- ing Cacoot/ws sorz'oondzI—A passion for writing. Cadenzm—The fall or modulation of the voice, in music. C(eca ost z'u'zu'dz'd—Envy is blind. Caetera dasm2t.—The remainder is want- ing. Caeterz's parlour—Other things being equal. Calibre—Capacity or compass ; mental power; a term in gunnery. Camera ooscunL—A dark chamber used by artists. Cam/ms [ifartz‘ua—The field of Mars; a place of military exercise. Ca1zaz'ZZo.—-The rabble. Candida Pax.—-—\Vhite-robed Peace. Cantata.—A poem set to music. C(zntatv Domfrld—Sing to the Lord. Caji-ri-jiz'a—From head to foot. Cafiz‘as ad satzlsy‘izcz‘eudzmz.—-You may take to satisfy. Cajirz'oclo—A fanciful irregular kind of musical composition. Caprz'oltn—A leap without advancing; capers. Caput mortuzmz.—-Dead head; worthless remains. Carat—Is wanting or omitted. Carat z'm'tz'o affine—It wants beginning and end. Carpe diam—Enjoy the present day. Carto Handle—Unconditional terms. Casus (Betti—An occasion for war. Casus fieder2's.—A case of conspiracy; the end of the league. Catalogue ra2'som2é.—A catalogue of the 36o FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES. books arranged according to their sub- jects. Cause céleore—A remarkable trial in a court of justice. Caveat actor—Let the doer beware. Caz/eat emptmz—Let the purchaser take heed or beware. Ca'z/ena’o tutus.--Safe through caution.‘ Ce n’est que le firemz'erpas quz' coz‘zte— It is only the first step which is difl‘icult. Cedant arma togze—Let military power yield to the civil. Cede Deo.—-Submit to Providence. Certz'orarz'.—To be made more certain. Cessz'o bonormlz.—Yielding up of goods. C’est une autre chose—That is quite a different thing. C/UZCZUZ 1i solz goat—Every one to his taste. Chanson—A song. C/tansomzette—A little song. C/mpeam—A hat. C/mpette ardenta—The place where a dead person lies in state. Clzajfierom—An attendant on a lady, as a guide and protector. Clam-go d’a_[faz'res.—An ambassador of second rank. C/zdteazL—A castle; a country mansion. C/ze/ld’teuz/re—A masterpiece. Chevalier d’z'ndustrz'e.—A knight of in- dustry; one who lives by persevering fraud. C/zz' tare eon essa.—Silence is confession. Clzz'aro-oseuro or C/zz'aroseuro.—Light and shadow in painting. C/LOSL' gm‘ plait est a demz' r/emtue—A thing which pleases is already half sold. Cicerone—A guide or conductor. Cz'cz'soea—A dangler after a lady. Ci-devanL—Formerly ; former. Circa—About. Cz'to‘ maturzmz ez'to‘ jiutrz'duna—Soon ripe, soon rotten. C/arz'or e teneorzs—More bright from obscurity. Clique—A party; a gang. Cogrzomen.—A surname Comme z'Zfaut.——As it should be. Commune bommL—A common good. Commzmz'a proprz'e a'z'eere—To express common things with propriety. Commzmz'ous muzzle—One year another. with Compos mentz's.—-Of sound mind. Con aware—With love or hearty in- clination. Concz'o aa’ cZerum.—A discourse to the clergy. Congé d’éZz're.—Permission to elect. Comzoz'sseur.—--A skilful judge. Consensus facet [agent—Consent makes the law. Contour.-The outline of a figure. Contra—Against. Contra bones‘ mores.——Against good manners. Contretemfls—A mischance; disap- pointment. Coram nobz's.-—-Before us. Coral/z non _7'udz'ce.—Before one who is not the proper judge. Cornucopia—The horn of plenty. Corpus delz'ctz'.-—The whole nature of the offence. Corrzlgendm—Corrections to be made. Coryp/twus—A leader, or chief. Cotz'llozt—A lively dance. Couleur a'e rose.—Rose-colour; an as- pect of beauty and attractiveness. Coup de grace—The finishing stroke. C0211) de main—A bold and rapid enter- prise. C02215 a'e flied—A kick. Coup de soZez'L—A stroke of the sun. Coup a"e'tat.—A master-stroke of state policy. Coup d’aez'l.--Rapid view or glance. Coz'tte qu’z'l eofzta—Cost what it may. C redat Yua’aaa—A Jew may believe it. Crescz‘t amor mmzmz' quantum zlosa petunia erescz't.—The love of money increases as rapidly as the money itself increases. Crescz't eu1zdo.—It increases by going. Cresez'te et muZtzfZz'cal/u'mI—Increase and multiply. Crz'men falsz'.--Falsehood; perjury. Crux crz'tz'corzmz.—The cross or puzzle of critics. Cuz' 60120 .?—To whose good ? Cuz' malo ?—To whose harm ‘.7 C at de sae.—The bottom of the bag ; a difficulty; astreet or lane that has no outlet. Cum grano salz's.—\Vith a grain of salt , with some allowance. Cum muttz's alz'z's.—With many others. FORE Z G N W ORDS AND Pl-[RA $55. 361 Cum prz'w'legia—With privilege. Cm'z'a adw'sarz' zlulzfl—The court wishes to be advised. Carz'osa felz'cz'tas—A felicitous tact. Currente cala11zo.—With a running pen ; written off-hand. Custos rotulorum.—Keeper of the rolls. Da capo.-—Over again. Danmant quad non z'ntellzlgunL—They condemn what they do not compre— hend. Datd—Things granted, (sing. datum.) De oorizz's nova—Of the goods not yet ad- ministered on. De die in dz‘ena— From day to day. Defizcto.—In fact; in reality. De gustz'ous non est dz'sjiutanduna— There is no disputing about tastes. Define—By law or right. De mortuz's nz'l m‘sz' lament—Say no- thing but what is good of the dead. De nova—Anew. De profzmdzs—Out of the depths. De trot—Out of place; not wanted. Deoz'to_7'ustz'tz'ce.- ~By debt of justice. DéouL—Beginning of an enterprise; first appearance. Deceptz'o ‘visas—An illusion of the sight. Dedz'mus potestatewL—‘We have given power. Deficit—A want of deficiency. Dez'gratz'zi.—By the grace of God. De'jefiner :2 la f0H7’C/lUtl‘6’.—A breakfast or luncheon with meats. Dele.-—Blot out or erase. Delenda est Cart/mga—Carth-age must be blotted out. Delta (the Greek letter A,) a triangular tract of land toward the mouth of a river. Dénouement.—-—An unravelling or wind- ing up. Deo ad/zwante, non tz'mendm;z.—God helping, nothing need be feared. Deofawnte.——\/Vith God's favour. Deo gratz'as.—-Thanks to God. Deojuvante.——\Vith God's help. Deo non fortmzd—From God, not for- tune. Deo volente, or D. V.—God willing. Depot—A store; the recruiting reserve of regiments. Derm'er ressort.—'l‘he last resort. Desz'deratzml.—Something desired or wanted. Desunt ca’terd—The other things are wanting. Det2'net.—He detains ; he keeps. Détour.—A circuitous march. Detur dzlgvzz'orzI—Let it be given to the more worthy. Deus ex maclzz'mi.—A god from the clouds; unexpected aid in an emer- gency. Devastaz/z'L—He wasted. Dwain—Duty. Dexter.—The right hand. Dz'ctum. —-A positive assertion (pl. dicta.) Dz'ctum de dicta—Report upon hearsay. Dz'esfaustus.—A lucky day. Dies z'rcen—Day of wrath. Dz'es 72072.—A day on which judges do not sit. Dz'eu et man droz't.—God and my right. Dz'eu vous garde.—God protect you. Dz'z' majoruuz gentz'am .—The gods of the superior class ; the twelve superior gods. Diz'jfienates—Household gods. Dz'lettantz'.—-Persons who devote them- selves to science merely for amusement or relaxation. (Sing. Dz'lettante.) Dz'lzwz'um.——A deposit of ' superficial loam, sand, &c. caused by a deluge. Dz'rzlga—I direct or guide. Dzsjecta mended—Scattered parts, limbs, or writings. Dx'straz'L—Absent in thought; absent- minded. Dz'strz'ngas—A writ for distraining. Divide et z'mjfierd—Divide and govern. Doce ut dz'scas—Teach, that you may learn. , Docendo dz'cz'mas.—\Ve learn by teach- - ing. Dolce.-—Soft and agreeable. (.Musz'c.) Dolcefar m'ente.—Sweet idleness. Dolz' 1'nca15ax.—Incapable of mischief. Doloroso.—Soft and pathetic. (lWusz'a) ‘Domicile (L. domz'cz'lz'um. )-—An abode. Domino dz'rzge 1zos.—-O Lord, direct us. Domz'nus 'zlobzlscmrL—The Lord be with you. Douéle entendre. —Double meaning (cor- rectly written double entente.) Donavon—A present or bribe ; sweet- ness. 31 362 FOREIGN WORDS AJVD PHRASES. Draco.—-A dragon; a constellation. Dramatz's jéersoma—The characters in a play. Duet (Ital. dzcetto.)—A song for two per- formers. Dulce est ampere z'n loco.——It is pleasant to jest, or revel, at the proper time. Dulce et decorum est pro patrz'a mori— It is sweet and pleasant to die for one’s country. Dalia—An inferior kind of worship. Dam sjfiz'ro, spera—Whilst I breathe, I hope. Dam viz/toms, vivamus—Nvhile we live, let us live. Duo.—Two; a two-part song. Duodecz'nzo.——A book having twelve leaves to a sheet. Durante placz‘to, or durante beneplaci- to.—During pleasure. Durante vita—During life. Dux fozmz'na factz'.—A woman was the leader to the deed. Epturz'ous unum.—One out of many; one composed of many: the motto of the United States. Eau de via—Brandy; water of life. Ecce lzoma—Behold the man. Ecce szgmmL—Behold the sign. Eclaz'rcz'ssement.—The clearing-up of an affair. Eclat.—-—Splendour; applause. Ea'z'tzo prz'zzcefs—The first edition. E/zeu l—Ah, alas ! Elan—Buoyancy; dash. Elegz't.—He hath elected; a writ of exe- cudon Eléve.—A pupil. Elite—The best part. Embonpoz'nt.—Roundness ; good condi- tion. _ Emeritus—One retired from active ofli- cial duties. Emeute.-—Insurrection; uproar. Empressement.-—Eagerness ; ardour. En amz'.——As a friend. E n (want .l—Forward ! Enflfite.—Carrying guns on the upper deck only. E12 grana'e tenua—ln full dress. E12 massa—In a mass; in a body. En passanL—By the way ; in passing. En rapport—In communication. En rez/anclzer-In return. En route.—On the way. Eucz'ente.——Pregnant_ Enf61fl8p67d268.—L05t children ; the for~ lorn hope. Emzuz'.—-—Weariness; lassitude. Ense pair filacz'dam sub lz'lwrtate qui- etem.—By his sword he seeks the calm repose of liberty. Ensemble—The whole taken together. Entente cordz'ale.—'l‘he cordial under- standing between two countries. Entre nous—Between ourselves. Entre'e.—Entrance. Entremets.~—-Small and dainty dishes set between the principal ones at table, Eo nomz'ne.~——By that name. Equilibrium.-—-Equality of weight; even balance. Erga—Therefore. Erz'puz't ceeZo fulmen, sceptrzmzque ty- ramzz's.—He snatched the thunderbolt from heaven, and the sceptre from tyrants. Erratmn.—A mistake or errata.) Escrow.—A deed or writing left with an- other, to be delivered on the perform- ance of something specified. Esjfiz'églerz'a—Waggish tricks. Esprit a'e corps—The animating spirit of a collective body. Est modus in re6us.——There is a medium in all things. EstoppeL—A stop, a preventive plea. Esta perpetua—May it last forever. Et ceetera.—And the rest. Eureka—I have found it. Ex.—Out of; late (as, ex-consul.) Ex anima—Heartily. Ex cat/zedra.—From the chair; high authority. Ex concesso.——From what has been granted. Ex carat—Out of court. Exfzmzo dare lucem.—Out of smoke to bring light. error (pl. with 'Ex m'lzz'lo m'lzz'l fit.—Nothing can come of nothing. Ex qficz'a—By virtue of his office. Exparta—On one side only (before a noun, exjfiarte.) Ex pea’e HercuZem.-—We recognize a Hercules from the size of the foot: FOREIGN W ORDS AND PHRASES. 363 that is, we judge of the whole from the specimen. Ex postfactm—After the deed is done. Ex tempera—Without premeditation. Ex zmo dz'sce amnes.—From one learn all; from one judge of the whole. E_rce!sz'or.—More elevated ; onward. Exeerpz‘m—Extracts. Exemplz'gratz'i—As for example. Exeunt omnes.—All retire. Experimental/z crucz's.-A decisive ex- periment. Exjfierz‘o credo.—Be1ieve one who has experience. Expose—An exposition; recital. Faber suaz fortune—The architect of his own fortune. facile prz'mus, facile prz'ncejs._-—By far the first or chiefest. Facz'lz's est descensus.—Descent is easy. Fae simila—Make it like ; hence, an exact copy. Fae totum.—Do all; a man of all work. Facta est [ma—There was light. .Fas est aé lwste doeerz'.—It is allowable to learn even from an enemy. Fata 06stanL—The fates oppose it. Fauteuz'!.—An easy-chair. Faux [men—A false step. Felo a'e se.—A self-murderer. Feme couverta—A married woman. Feme soZe.—A woman unmarried. Festz'na Zente.—-Hasten slowly; advance steadily rather than hurriedly. Fét'e.—A feast or celebration. Féte c/uzmpéz‘ra—A rural feast. Feu de joz'e.—A bonfire; a discharge of musketry on days of rejoicing. IQ’MZ'ZZL’tO7L—A small leaf; a supplement to a newspaper; a pamphlet. Fz'at.—Let it be done. Fiat justz'tz'a, ruat cazlzmL—Let justice be done, though the heavens should fall. Fiat [mu—Let there be light. Fide, non armz's.—By faith , not by arms. Fz'a'e, sedcuz'w'de—Trust, but see whom. Fz'des ez‘ _;'ustz'tz'a.—Fidelity and justice. Fz'dus Ac/mz‘es.—Faithful Achates (that is, a true friend.\ Fzerz'fizcz'as.——Cause it to he done ( a kind of writ.) Fz'lz'us nuZlz'us.—A son of nobody. Fz'lle-de-c/zamére —A chambermaid. Finale—To close or end. Fz'nem resjfiz'ca—Look to the end. .Fz'nz's.—'l‘he end. Fz'nz's coronal‘ ojfimx—The end crowns the work. Flagrante éella—Vvhile the war is raging. Flagrante delz'ct0.—1n the commission of the crime. Fléneur.—A lounger. Flecz‘z', nan frang'zI—To be bent, not to be broken. FZeur-de-Zzlr.—The flower of the lily (pLfleurs-de-Zz's.) Forte.—In music, a direction to sing or play with force or spirit. Fortes fortumz jzwaL—Fortune assists the brave. Fortz'ssz'mo.——Very loud. Fortz'ter in re.—Resolute in deed. Fracas.—Bustle ; aslight quarrel; more ado about the thing than it is worth. Fruges consumere mull—Born merely to consume the fruits of the earth. Fugam/eez'L—He has taken to flight. Fuz't llz'um.—Troy has been. Fzmctus qfiiez'a—Out of office Furore.—Excitement. Gaz'ete' de cwur.——Gayety of heart. Galilee—In French. Gardez blew—Take good care. Gardez Zajbz'.-—Keep the faith. Gzmcl'zerz'e.—Awkwardness. Gaudeamus zQg‘z‘z‘un—So let us be joyful. Gendarme—A military policeman. Gerzdarmerz'e.—-The body of the gen- darmes. Genius loci—The genius of the place. Genus z'rrz'taéz'le 'z/az‘um.——Irritable tribe of poets. Gloria in exeelsz's.~——Glory to God in the highest. Graz‘zisx—Free of cost. Gratis dz'cz‘zmL—L’Iere assertion. Gravamen.—-The thing complained of. Grz'setz‘e.—Dressed in gray (a term ap- plied to French shop-girls, &c.) Gusto.——Great relish. Habeas comma—You are to have the body; a writ of right, by virtue of which every citizen can, when im- prisoned, demand to be put on his trial. 364 FORE/61V WORDS AIVD PIIRASES. Haéitue. -A frequenter. Ha'e oIz'nz menzz'nz'ssejuz'abit.—It will be pleasant hereafter to remember these things. IIarZ'CoL—A kind of ragout; a kidney- bean. Hand passions a'qnzs—Not with equal steps. [\Vrongly quoted : see Non, &c.] IIam‘ gout—High flavour. /Iautenr.—-Haughtiness. IIelluo Zz'brornm.—-A book-worm. .Hz'c et unique—Here, there, and every- where. ' IIz'e jacet.-—-Here lies. IIz'nc i/Ize laerymee—Hence proceed these tears. I-Ioc age—Do this; attend to what you are doing. Iz’omme (i'Uéf7IL—A man of talent, or of wit. Ifonzo muItarn/n Iz'terarzmz.—A man of much learning. I'Ionz' soz't Quinta! y penstn—Evil be to him that evil thinks. I~Ionores mutant 7ll()7'L’S.—-I‘IOIIOUI'S change men's manners. IIorafug/t—The hour or time flies. I'Iorresco 7‘(:}Q’7'L’IlS.—I shudder to re- late. IIors de combat—Disabled for fighting; vanquished. Hortus sz'ccns.-—A collection of dried plants. I-Iostz's Izumanz' generisa—An enemy of the human race. IIotel de villa—A town-hall. I'Iotel-Dz'em—The chief hospital in French cities. IImnanmn est errare.—-It is human to err. IIunc tn oaneta—Beware of him. Iez'dem, contracted {aid or z'd.——In the same place. Ie/t dz'en.—I serve. Id est—That is; abridged i. e. Id genus 01nne.--All of that sort. Idem, contracted I'd—'l‘he same. (Id. 27)., the same author; in the same place.) Idonens [107710.—-A fit man. (gn0ranms.-—We are ignorant. (gnorantl'a legz's nemz'nem excnsat.—— Ignorance of the law excuses no one. Q Ila 1e diable an corps—The devil is in him. Imz'tatores, servant peens—Imitators, a servile herd. Imperz'um z'n z'mjfierz'a—Orie govern- ment existing within another. Imjiransns.—One who has not dined. Inzjfirz'nzatmz—Let it be printed. Imprz'mzs—In the first place. Impromptu—A prompt rem-ark without study. In artz'enlo warns—At the point of death. In cajh'te—In the head. In ceelo gates—There is rest in heaven. In eommendam.—In trust. In cons/Meta fort—In the eye of the law; in the sight of the court. In curz'd—In the court. In dn/Za—Twice as much. In eqnz'ltérz'a—Equally balanced. In esse.-—In being. In extenso.—-—At full length. In extrenzz's.—At the point of death. In fornza jauperzs—As a pauper. In foro consez'entz'an—Before the tribu- nal of conscience. In [we signo winter—In this sign thou shalt conquer. In [twine—At the threshold. In Iota—In the place. In medias res.—lnto the midst of things. In menzor1'an1.——To the memory of. In perpetuzun.——Forever. In /5etto.-ln reserve; in one’s breast. In posse—In possible existence. In fiOSIL'TIHIL—FOY the time to come. In prop-1'12 persond—In his own per~ son. In [int-2's natnraIz'bns.—Quitc naked. In re.—In the matter of. In sz'tn.——In its original situation. In statn qua—In the former state. In te, Domz'ne, sperawI—ln thee, Lord, have I put my trust. In terrorenL—By way of warning. In totidem nerbr's—In so many words. In toto.—Altogether. In transitn.~—On the passage. In ntrnmrjne fiaratna—Preparcd for either event. In rzaena—In empty space, or in a vacuum. In w'no 'z/erz'tas.—There is truth in wine. FOREIGN WOIi’DS AND I’HIBASES. 365 Incognita—Disguised; unknown. Index expurg'atorz'usw—A list of pro- hibited books. Infra diguitateuL—Beneath one’s dig- nity. Iuuuenda—Covert meaning; hint. ‘ Imps cousz'lz'z'.—Wi thout counsel. indirect lnsouciauce.—-Carelessness ; indifference. ' Iusta r onmz'um.--Onc will suffice for all ; an example to others. Inter aha—Among other things. Inter arma leges silent—In the midst of arms the laws are silent. Inter uos.—Between ourselves. Inter se.--Among themselves. Itse dixz't.—He himself said it; clog- matic assertion. Ipsz'ssima 'z/er6a.—The very words. Ipsofacto—By the fact itself; actually. 11m flue—By the law itself. Ira furor 6re'vis est.—Anger is brief madness. Ila lex scrzfta est—Thus the law is written. Hana—Also. ' yucta est alea—The (lie is cast. Yamais arriére—Never behind. Ye ne sais guoi.—-I know not what. Yet d’eau.—A jet of water. 7m de mots—Play upon words ; a pun. Yeu d'esprz'L—A \vitticism. Yudz'cium Dez'.-—The judgment of God. Yuuiores ad laoores—Young men for labours. Yure dz'w'uo.—-By divine law. Yul-e gentz'zmz.—By the law of nations. Fare lumzauo.———By human law. Yus cz'z/z'le.—Civil law. Yus gladz'z'.—Right of the sword. Yuste mz'lz'eu.—The golden mean ; a just medium. Yustitice sororjides.-Faith is the sister ofjustice. La critique est aisle, et l’art est dif/icile. —Criticism is easy, but art is diffi- cult. Laoor itse voluptas—Labour itself is pleasure. Labor omnz'a vincit—Labour conquers all things. Laz'ssez-nousfaire.—-Let us alone. Lapsus'calamzI—A slip of the pen; an error in writing. Lapsus lingua—A slip of the tongue. Lapsus memoriau—A slip of memory. Lares et jeudtea—Household gods. L’argeuL—Money, or silver. Laudator temporis acti.—A praiser of time past. Laus Deo.—Praise to God. Laus propria sordet.-—Praise of one’s own self defiles. Le beau moude.—The fashionable world. Le bou temps w'endrd—The good time will come. Le grand oeuvre—The great work; the philosopher’s stone. Le pas—Precedence in place or rank. Le savoirfaira—The knowledge how to act; address. Le tout eusemoler-All together. Lege.—Read. Leges legzmz.—The law of laws. Lesa fllflJ'L’Stéw—I‘Iigh treason. L’c‘toile du uord.—The north star. Lettre de cachet—A sealed lettter; a royal warrant. Let/art facias.-—That you cause to be levied; a writ of execution. Levée.—A morning visit or reception. Lex loci.-—The law of the place. Lex magma est, et pwe'z/alediL—The law is great, and will prevail. Lex non scriptd—The unwritten or common law. Lea: scrzftm—Statute law. Lex taliouz's.——The law of retaliation. Lex terree, lexpatrian—The law of the land. L’lzomme propose, et Dieu dispose.— Man proposes, and God disposes. , Liéretta—A little book or pamphlet. l Licentia vanilla—A poetical license. Liugua Frauca.——The mixed language spoken by Europeans in the East. 5 Liquema—A cordial. Lis lz'tem gerzerat.-—Strife begets strife. Lz's suéjudice—A case not yet decided. Lite ,tendente—During the trial. Litera scrzlota mauet.—The written let- ter remains. Literati—Men of letters or learning. Loco citato.—In the place cited. Loco pareutzs—ln the place of the parent. 31*‘ 366 FOA’EIGJV WORDS AND PHRASES. Locum tenens.—One who holds'a place for another. Locus szgz'UZ-(L. S.).—-The place of the seal. Longo z'nter'zIalla—At a great distance. Lua’ere cum sacrz's.--To trifle with sa- cred things. Lnsus naturee.-A sport or freak of na- ture. ji’lacte oz‘rtute—Proceed in virtue. fliadenzoz'selta—A young unmarried lady. zi'fagna C/zarta.—-The great charter of England. Magna cz'w'tas, magna soZz'tua'a—A great city is a great desert. JHagna est 1/erz'tas, etpre211a1e6it.——-The truth is great, and will prevail. Mzgnz' nomz'nz's tundra—The shadow of a great name. ji’lagnzun opus—A great work. Mzgnus Apollo—Great Apollo; one of high authority. [liaison de villa—The town-house. fl’laitre d’lzoteL—An hotel-keeper ; a house-steward. Ilfajordomo (Ital. maz'ordomo.)—One who has the management of a house- hold. ]i/[a/ajia'e—In bad faith ; treacherously. 111a! a Ibropos—Out of time; unbecom- ing. [Malaria—Noxious exhalations. 1V1'aZgré.~—In spite of. {Va/am z'n se.—Bad in itself. lifandamns.—-\Ve command: a peremp- tory writ to compel obedience. Jlfanéga—A riding-school. [llama a pout—Madness caused by drunkenness. JIIanufortz'.—With a strong hand. .M'ara'z' gras.~—Shrove-'I‘uesday. Mare c/ansum. —A closed sea; a bay. 1Waterfamz'lz'as.——The mother of a family. Materz'a medz'ca.——Substances used in the healing art. Alatz'néa—A morning party. fl'lauoaz's goat—Bad taste. lllauoaz's szg'eL—A worthless fellow. {l'faaz/az'se [water—False modesty ; bash- fulness. Maxz'mum.—-The greatest. Illaxz'mus in nzz'nz'mz's.—Very great in trifling things. .Me judz'ce.—I being judge; in my own opinion. .Il/fedz'o tutz'ssz'mus z'ézs—A medium course will be safest. Medz'tatz'oneficgee.—-In contemplation of flight. Memento morz'.—Remember death. Memorabz'lza—Things to be remem- bered. Menzorz'ter.—-By rote. IIIe'naga—Household. li'lens sana z‘n corpore sano.——A sound mind in a sound body. Mons sz'éz‘ conscz'a rectz'.—A mind con- scious of rectitude. Mensa et Mora—From bed and board. Merzmz saZ.—Pure salt; genuine Attic wit. Mezmz et taunt—Mine and thine. Mz'nz'mum.—The least. Mz'nntz'w.—Minute concerns; trifles. Mz'rabz'le dicta—Wonderful to be told. flitraéz'lz'a—Wonders. Illittz'nzus—We send : a warrant for the commitment of an offender. .Moa’us operandzI—Manner of operation. .Montanz' semjfier lz'oerzl—Mountaineers are always freemen. 1l’[orceau.—A morsel. JWore sno.—In his own way. Mot a'u guet.—A watchword. Multnm z'n par'z/a—Much in a small space. Mutana’ar—Things to be altered. Mutatz's nzutandzls.-—'I‘he necessary changes being made. Mutato nonzz'ne.—The name being changed. NaZ'oeté.—Ingenuousness; simplicity. No code malts—Yield not to misfortune. Ne exoat.—Let him not depart. Ne plus ultra—Nothing further; the uttermost point. Ne quz'a' nz'1nz's.-—Not too much of any thing; do nothing to excess. Ne sutor ultra crepidanL—Let not the shoemaker go beyond his last. Ne tentes, aut perfice—Attempt not, or accomplish thoroughly. Nec plurz'éus z'mpar.-—Not an unequal match for numbers. Nec scz'refas est mania—It is not per- mitted to know all things. FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES. 367 Necessz'tatz's mm Izabel legem.—Neces- sity has no law. Ne'e.—Born. Nefasti dz'es.—Days upon which no public business was transacted; also, unlucky days. JVemiue contradz'cente—No one contra- dieting. A’emz’ne dz'ssentz'ente.--Without opposi- tion or dissent. Nemo me z'mpmze lacessz't.——No one wounds me with impunity. Nenw mortalz'um onmz'éus lwrz's said‘.— No one is wise at all times. Nemo repente fm't z‘urpz'ssz'mus.—No man ever became a villain at once. Neuzo solus sapz'L—No one is wise alone. Nz'az'serz'e.—Silliness. Ari/til deéeL—He owes nothing; a plea denying a debt. .Ni/zz'l quad tez‘zjgz't, non ornaw‘L—What- ever he touched he embellished. Ni! admz'rarzZ—To wonder at nothing. Nil desperandum.-_—Never despair. Nz'mz'unz ne crede coZorz'.—Trust not too much to looks. N’ z'mgfiorz‘a—It matters not. Nz'sz' Domz'nus frustra.—-Unless the Lord 'be with us, all efforts are in vain. Nolilesse olz'lzjgen—Rank imposes obliga- tion. Nalerzs edema—Willing or unwilling. Nolz' me iangere.—Don't touch me. NelleprasequzI—Unwilling to proceed. _ JVoIo epz'seoparzI—I am not willing to be made a bishop (an old formal way of declining a bishopric.) 1V0»: de guerre—An assumed name. Now de plume—A literary title. N'omen et omen—Name and omen; a name that is ominous. .Non campus mentzlr.——Not of sound mind. Non deficz'em‘e cmmgend—If the money does not fail. Non est dz'sputandunL—It is not to be disputed. Non est inventus.——Not found. 1V0): lz'beL—It does not please me. Non mi rz'cordo.—I don't remember. Non nobz's soZum.-—Not merely for our- selves. Non obstmzte.—N0twithstanding. Non onmz's morz'arc—I shall not wholly die. Non passz'bus zequz's.-—-Not with equal steps. Non seguz'tur.—It does not follow: an unwarranted conclusion. Non sz'bz', sed onmz'bus.—Not for itself, but for all. None/mlance.—Coolness; easy indiffer- ence. Nonparez'L—Peerless; a small printing type. JVosce tezfsuna—Know thyself. 1Voscz'tur ex saez'z'su—He is known by his companions. Nam 6ene.—-Mark well. Nous verrons.—We shall see. 1V0vus llama—A new man. Nudzmz paetunL—An invalid agreement. Nulla crux, nulla comma—No cross, no crown. Nulla meow/a, éomz uuova.—The best news is no news. NuZlz'usfilius.—-The son of nobody. Num: aut mmqzmm.—N ow or never. 0 tempera .' o mores !———Oh, the times ! oh, the manners! OZu'z't.—He (or she) died. Oéz'ter dz'ctzmz.—A thing said by the way, or in passing. Obsta prz'nczjpz'ia—ResiSt the first be- ginnings. Odz'pru/ImzmL—I loathe the profane. Odin/n t/zeoZogz'cmm—The hatred of theologians. O/ze! jam sulfa—Oh, there is now enough. Ol/a podrz'da. —An incongruous mixture. Omne zlg'notum pro magm_'/ico.——\Vhat- ever is unknown is thought to be mag- nificent. Oumes.—All. - Omru'a 602m éonz's.-All things are good with the good. Omm'a w'ncz‘t amen—Love conquers all things. On-dz'L—A rumour; a flying report. Owes—Burden. Onus pralumdzl—The responsibility of producing proof. Ope et eousilz'o.—\Vith assistance and counsel. Ora et /at$ara.—-Pray and work. 368 FOREIGJV WORDS AND PHRASES. Oratorfit, toeta nascz'tur.—The orator is made by education, but a poet must be born. Ore rotunda—With full-sounding voice. Otfnm cum dzlgnz'tata—Dignified leisure. Ontre'.—Preposterous; eccentric. Oyer and Termz'ner.——A criminal court. t’allida mars—Pale death. Par excellence—By way of eminence. Par nooile fratrzun.—A noble pair of brothers; two just alike. Parz' passza—With equal step; in the same degree. Parole d’lzonneur.—Word of honour. Pars pro toto.—Part for the whole. Partz'ceps crz'mz'nz's.—An accomplice. Partnrlunt montes, nascetur rz'dz'cnlns mus—The mountains are in labour; a ridiculous mouse will be brought forth. Parr/a componere nzagnz's.—To compare small things with great. .Pdf'Z/ZflZL—A. new comer; an upstart. Pas—A step ; precedence. Passe-[fiartouL—A master—key. Passz'm.—ln many places; everywhere. Paterfizmz'lz'as.———The father of a family. Pater noster.—Our Father; the Lord's prayer. Pater patrz'ze—Father of his country. Patoz's.—A provincial dialect. Pax 2'n ln’llo—Peace in war. Pet'ca'z/I.—I have sinned. Penc/zant.—An inclination; toward. Pendente Zita—While the suit is pending. Penetralza—Secret recesses. Per aspera ad astra.—Through trials to glory. ’er'ca1$ita.—By the head; equal divi- sion. Per cent. or per centnln.—By the hun- dred. Per contra.—Contrariwise. Per cnrz'anz.—By the court. Per dawn—By the day. Per fas et ne/as—Through right and wrong. Per saltnnz.—With a leap ; at once. Per sen—By itself; alone. Perdu.—l.ost. I’ere defiunz'lle—The father of a family. Petz't.--Small; little. a leaning Petitz'o principal—A begging of the question. Petz't-maitre.—A fop. Pen a ‘ten—Gradually ; a little by little. Pz'nxz't.——Painted it : placed after the artist's name on a picture. PIIL—IVIOI‘C. Plateau.—A plain; a flat surface. Plebs.—Common people. Plurz'es.—Very often; a third writ, after two writs have issued. Poco.—A little. Poeta nascz'tur, non fit.—A poet is born, not made. Point d’ afifiuzI—Point of support; prop. Poisson d’A'z/rz'L—April fool. Popnlus 'z/nlt deczltzI—People like to be deceived. Posse comz'tatzis—The power of the county. Postea.—Afterward; endorsement of the verdict upon the record. Post mortenz.—After death. Postnlata.—Things assumed. Pra’cognz'td—Things previously known. Przemonz'tas, prtemnnz'tna—Forewarn- ed, forearmed. Preux clzevalz'en—A brave knight. Prz'lndfacze—On the first view. Prz'munz mooz'ltc—The primary motive, or moving power. Prz'mus inter pares—Chief among equals. Prz'ncijfiz'a, non llolnz'nes.—Principles, not men. Prz'ncz'pz'z's oestd—Resist the first inno- vations. Pro arz's et facts—For our altars and our hearths. Pro bonopuolz'ca—For the public good. Pro et con (for contra).—For and against. Pro formd—F or form's sake; accord- ing to form. Pro Izac 'zn'ce.—-—For this turn or occasion. Pro loco et tenzpore._-—F or the place and time. Pro patrz‘d—For our country. Pro rata.—In proportion. Pro re natd—For a special emergency. Pro tanto.—For so much. Pro temlfiore—For the time-being. Probatnzn est.—It has been tried and proved. Proces-oertaL—A written statement. FOREIGN l/VORDS AND PJVRASES. 069 ;\ Proc/zez'u amz'.—The next friend. Procul, Ojrocul este, profauz‘l—Far, far hence, 0 ye profane ! Prouzmcz'amem‘o.—A public declara- tion. Prapagaua'a fide.——For extending the faith. Proz‘eZgi—A person taken charge of, or patronized; a ward, &c. Prudens fidurzI—Thoughtful of the future. Pugm's ez‘ calcz'éua—With fists and heels ; with all the might. Pum'cafides.—Punic faith ; treachery. Qua’na—Query ; inquiry. Quama’z'u se éene gesserz't.—So long as he shall conduct himself properly. Quantum.—The due proportion. Quantum Zz'6et.—As much as you please. Quantum meruz'z‘.—As much as he de- served. Quantum sufiicz'L—A suflicient quan- tity; enough. Quare c/ausun-z fregz't.—-An action for damages to real estate. Quare z'nzpedz't.—\Vhy he hinders. Quasi dz'cas.-—As if you should say. Quelque c/zose.—A trifle. Quz' capz't, z'lle facz't.—He who takes it makes it. Quz'pense ?—Who thinks? Qui tam ?—W ho as well ? the title given to a certain action at law. Quz' z‘rausz‘ulz't susz‘z'uet.——He who brought us hither still preserves us. Quz' 2112 1a ?—Who goes there? Quz' viz/e f—Who goes there? hence, on the qui—w'w, on the alert. Quz'd-uunc f—What now? a newsmon- ger. Quz'a' pm ~qua—One thing for another; “ tit for tat.” Quz'a' rides .?-—Why do you laugh? Quz's separabz't f—Who shall separate us ? Qua auz'mo ?——\Vith what intention. Quojure f—By what right? Quo 'warranta—By what warrant or authority. Quoaa' /zoc.—-To this extent. Quad avertat Deus .?-Which may God avert! Quad w'de.—Which see. Quadlz'éeL—A nice point ; a subtlety. Qu0udam.—Former. Quorum.—Of whom : a term signifying a sufiicient number for a certain business. Qua: Deus Walt perdere, prz'us demen- z‘aL—Those whom God wishes to de- stroy, he first deprives of understand- ing. RagouL—A highly-seasoned dish. Kara aw's -—A rare bird; a prodigy. Re z'ay’ecz‘i—The business being un- finished. Recte et sua'z'z'z‘en—Justly and mildly. Rectus in curz'd.—Upright in the court ; with clean hands. Redolet lucerua.——It smells of the lamp ; it is a laboured production. Reductio ad a&surdum.—-A reducing a position to an absurdity. Regz'na.—Queen. Regz'um do1zzurz.—A royal donation (a grant from the British crown to the Irish Presbyterian clergy.) Reg'naut populzI—The people rule. Reucouz‘re.—An encounter. Renaissance.—New birth : applied to the revival of the classic arts in the fifteenth and sixteenth centuries. Requz'escant z'u idea—May they rest in peace. Reguiescat z'n [facet—Hay he rest in peace. Rerum prz'mardza—The first elements of things. Res augusz‘a domz'.—-Narro\v circum- stances at home: poverty. Res z'uteg‘rm—An entire matter. Respz'ce fillc’lfL—LOOk to the end. Resjublz'ca.-—-The commonwealth. Restaunzteur.—A tavern-keeper who provides dinners, &c. Részmzé.—An abstract or summary. Resurgam.-I shall rise again. Revenons 1‘: nos mouz‘ous.—Let us return to our subject. Kean—King. Rouge—Red colouring for the skin. Rouge at noz'r.—Red and black (a kind of game.) Rus in ur6e.—-The country in town. Ruse contra warm—Diamond cut dia~ mond; trick for trick. ' Ruse da guerre.——A stratagem of war. 37° FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES. Satan—Hall. .S‘aluspopulisuprema [ex est.—The wel- fare of the people is in the supreme law. $611210 pua'ortn—Without offence to mo- desty. Sanctum sanctorunz.—Holy of Holies. Sang- roia'.——Coolness; self-possession. Sans.—\Vithout. Sans cérémonie.—Without ceremony. Sans pour et sans reproc/zen—Without fear and without reproach. Sans souci.—-Without care; free and easy. Sans tac/un—Stainless. Sans-culottes.—Without breeches: a term applied to the rabble of the French Revolution. Sartor resartus.—The cobbler mended. Satz's, superqua—Enough, and more than enough. Satis 'oerooruI/L—Enough of words ; you need say no more. Sauve guz’jfieut—Save himself who can. Savant—A learned man. Saz/oz'rfaire—Ability; skill. Scandalum magnatzun.—Scandal of the great. Scienter.—Knowingly. Scz'Zicet.—That is to say; to wit. Scirefacias.-—Cause it to be known. ScrifisiL—Wrote it. Sculpsit—Engraved it: placed after the engraver's name in prints. Secundum artenz.—-According to rule. Seton {es régles.—According to rule. Semfierfidetia—Always faithful. Senzper ia’em.—A1ways the same. Semperparatus—Always ready. Senatus consu/tum.——A decree of the senate. Seriatinz.—In order; successively; Si guarz's peninsula”: ameenam, cir- culnslfiz'ca—If thou seekest a beautiful peninsula, behold it here. Sic in originalzI—So it stands in the original. Sic z‘tur aa’ astra.—Such is the way to immortality. Sic fiassina—So everywhere. Szc sem/ier tyrannis.——So be it ever to tyrants. Sic transit gloria mundi.——Thus passes away the glory of the world. Sicut ante—As before. Simz'lia similiéus curantur.—Like things are cured by like. Simplex munditiis.—Of simple elegance. Sine die.-—\Vithout naming a day. Sine inw'diri—Without envy. Sine qua non.—An indispensable requi- site. Siste, m'aton—Stop, traveller. S06riquet.—A nickname. Soi-rtisant.—-Self1styled; pretended. Soire'e.-—An evening party. Souvenir.—Remembrance; a keepsake. Spartan: nactus es, Izanc exorna— You have got something good; make the most of it you can. Spectas et spectaéerzs—You will see and be seen. Spes mea C/zrz'stus—Christ is my hope. Spolia opima—The richest booty. Stans pate in uno.--Standing on one foot. Statu quo, or in statu qua—In the same state. Stet.-—Let it stand. Suaw'ter in modo,fortiter in re.~—Gen- tle in manner, resolute in deed. Su6judice.—Under consideration. Sué reset—Under the rose; privately. Sué siZentio.——In silence. Sudfict’nm—Und6r a penalty: 2. sum- mons to attend a court as a witness. Succedaneunu—A substitute. Suz'generis.——Ofits own kind ; peculiar. Summum banana—The chief good. Supersedeas—A writ to stay proceed- ings. Super zlz'sum corporzs—Upon a view of the body. S ujfipressz'o 'z/eri, suggestiofaZsi-A sup- pression of the truth is the suggestion of a falsehood. Supra—Above. Suum cuique.——Let every one have his own. Taole d’lzéte—An ordinary at which the master of the hotel presides. Taouta rasa.—-A smooth or blank tablet. Ta’dium w'tan—Weariness of life. Tale ouale—Such as it is. Tant 1nieux.—-So much the better. Tant iis—So much the worse. Ylzjfiis —-T he carpet. Tartufi’a—A nickname for a hypocriti- FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES. 37I cal devotee, derived from the principal characterin Moliere’s comedy so called. Tejudice.—You may judge. Tempora mutantur, et nos mutamzl-r in illz'sx—The times are changed, and we are changed with them. Temjus 'ea'ax roman—Time the de- vourer ofi all things. Temjusfug‘it—Time flies. Tempus onmz'a rwelaL—Time reveals all things. T eres atque rotuna’us.—Smooth and round ; polished and complete. T erra firma.——Solid earth; a safe foot- ing. Terra z'ncogm'ta.—An unknown country. Terre tenant—A person in actual pos- session of the land. Tertz'um quz'd.—-A third something; a nondescript. ' Téte-a-téte.—A conversation between two parties. 'I‘z'raa'e.-A tedious and bitter harangue. Tova—The fashion. Torso—The fragmentary trunk of a statue. T ort.—A wrong; an injury. Tot Izomz'nes, quot sententiee.—So many men, so many minds. ‘Totz'dem oerozs—In just so many words. Toties quoties.—-As often as. Toto czelo—By the whole heavens ; dia- metrically opposite. Toto carafe—With the whole heart. Tozgours fret—Always ready. Tom’ a tour.—By turns. Tout oz'en ou 7’Z'6‘7L—Th6 whole or noth- ing. Tout ensemolen—The whole. Trz'a juncta in mam—Three united in one. Tu quoque, Brute ./--And thou too, Brutus l Tueéon—I will defend. T utto é ouono o/ze 'oien a’a Dz'o.-—All is good which comes from God. Tumn est.—It is your own. Uoz' jus z'ncertum, z'bz' jus anthem.— Where the law is uncertain, there is no law. ' Uoz' Iioertas, ibi fiatr-‘z‘m—Where liberty dwells, there is my country. Uoi suprm—Where above mentioned. Ultz'ma ratio regwnL—The last argu- mentof kings; militaryweapons; war. U/tz'nza Thule—The utmost boundary or limit. Uttz'matum.—A final answer or decision. Un 6e! esprit—A wit; a virtuoso. Un sot a triple e'tage.—An egregious blockhead. Una vote—With one voice; mously. Unique—Singular; the only one of its kind. Usque ad nauseam.—To disgust. Usus Ioquendz'.——Usage in speaking. Ut infra—As below. Utz' possz'detzs—As you possess ; state of present possession. Utz'le dulez'.—Utility with pleasure. unanL Vade-meczmz.—Go with me ; a constant companion. Va oz'ctis.—-Woe to the vanquished! Vale—Farewell. Valet-de-c/zamore—A servant who as- sists his master in dressing. Vav'z'ce Zectz'ones.—Various readings. Velutz' in speczdu1lz.--—As in a mirror. Venditiom' exfonaa—That you expose to sale; writ of execution. Veni, w'di, m'cz'.—I came, I saw, I con- quered. Venire.-—To come; a writ to a sheriff directing him to summon jurors. Venue—The place from which the jury are drawn. Veroatim et Zz'teratz'm.—\Vord for word and letter for letter. Veroum sat sapz'entzI—A word is enough for a wise man. Vera’aa’ es oera'a—Truth is green. Verz'tas vz'nciL—Truth conquers. Viersua—Against; toward. Vertu, Vz'rtz‘z.—-Virtue; taste; art; skill. Veto.—I forbid. Vi et armz's.—By force and arms. Vii—By the way of. Vz'a media—A middle course. Vice.—In the room of. Vice ‘(Jeni—The terms changed ; reversely. Vida—See. Vide et orede.—See and believe. Vz'de ut supra—See as above. Vz'delzbeL—To wit, namely. being ex- 572 FOREIGN WORDS AND PHRASES. Viz/e 1e rob—Long live the king. Vl've l’z'mpératrz'ca—Long live the em- press. Vz'zle, vale.-—Farewell, and be happy. Voz'l'd tout.-—That's all. Voz'ld une autre c/zose.—That’s quite a difi'erent matter. Voz'r dz're.—A preliminary examination to determine the competency of a wit- ness. Volens etjfiotens.—Willing and able. Volga gran 6estz'a.—The mob is a great beast. Volere é joterer—To will is to do. Voltz' subz'to.-—'I‘urn over quickly. Vox, at pneterea m'lzz'L—A voice, and nothing more. Vox populi, oox Dez'.—The people’s voice is God’s voice. Vox stellarmm—The voice of the stars: applied to almanacs. Vulgd—Vulgarly; commonly. Vuolta.—Over, to next page or (0.) Vulnus z'mmedz'caoz'ler—An irreparable injury. Vultus est index am'mz'.——Thc counte- nance is the index of the mind. Zomzm software—To loose the virgin zone. Vz'a’etz‘es.—Sentinels on horseback. Vignette—A name given to slight en- gravings with which books, bank-notes, &c. are ornamented. Vz'ncz't amor gfiatrz'm—Love of country prevails. Vz'nculum matrz'monz'z'.—'1‘he bond of marriage. Virtuoso—One skilled in matters of taste or art. Vz'rtute Qficz'zI—By virtue of omce. Vz's z'nertz'(e.—Inert power; the tendency of every body to remain at rest. Vz's medz'catrix nature—The healing tendency of nature. Vz's poetz'cm—Poetic genius. Vz's 7/z'z‘m.—The vigour of life. V2's-d-w's.—Faee to face. Vita érevz's, ars longa.—Life is short, and art is long. Viz/d voce.——By word of mouth; by the living voice. Viz/ant rm: 0:‘ regz'nm—Long live the king and queen. Viv/at regz'nm—Long live the queen. Viz/at respulllz'cm—Live the republic. Viva la 6agatelle.—Success to trifling. Viva la_ rez'ne.——Long live the queen. Viz/e l’emjfioreun—Long live the em- peror. ' , ‘If " :Itlhll " ' v Uni’..- INDEX Annaevm'ren SYLLABLES, 21. Abbreviations, list of, 344-356. Abecedarium, probably the earliest at- tempt at printing, 17. Accents and aspirates, Greek, 101-103. Hebrew, 108-110. Accented letters, 69. Acids used in making paper spoil the effect of ink, 276, 277. Adams, Isaac, inventor of the bed-and- platen power-press, 237, 238. Adhesion of paper, how to prevent, 316. Admiration, sign of, 65. Agate type, specimen of, 56. Alcfrid, Runic memorial of, 91. Alexaua'rz' Gallz' Doctrz'ualc, one of the first printed books, 16. Almanac, first printed book in the Mid- dle Colonies, 22, 23. Alphabet, Anglo-Saxon, 93. English, 60. German, 96. Greek, 100. Hebrew, 106. Hieroglyphic, 86'. Runes, 88-92. Alterations in a proof justly chargeable, 204, 205, 211, not allowable in reprints of old and standard authors, 202. Amber ink, how to produce, 288. Ambiguous and compound words to be set uniformly, 202. , American type, superior quality of, 29. American l'Vuc/ely Mercury, third news- paper in America, 23. Ancient ornaments, exquisite and cu- rious, 21, 22. press, clumsy, 235. typographical peculiarities, 21. Anglo~Saxon characters, how originated, 53- alphabetical table of, 93. cases for, 94, 95. Lord’s Prayer in, 53. runes, table of, 0. Apostrophe, how USC(?, 65, 66. Appeala az'ust the Turks, of 1454, 17. Applegat and Cowper, improvers of the cylinder press, 238, 239. Apprentice, how to instruct an, 122 must be punctual, obedient, and courteous, 123. qualifications required in an, 121. ridiculous practices to be avoided by, 122. Apprentices, advice to, 137, 138. Arithmetical figures, when introduced, 72. Article, the indefinite, rule for using, 318. Ascending letters, 61. Asterisk, use of, 68. Astronomical signs, 75, 76. Authors, detention of proofs by, 205. hints to, 211. impatience of, 205. whims of, 63. Automatic counter, illustrated, 310. machine, for casting and finishing type, 2 . BACKING long or short pages, 133. Baine, John, sets up a type-foundry in Philadelphia, 25. Bay Psalm-Book, first book printed at Lambrid e, 22. Bearers on and-presses, how prepared, 259.271.218.281- Beaumont, Victor, inventor of serrated cutting blade, 242. Beginners, irouical rules for, 139, 140. Bewcastle cross, Runic inscription on, 91 . Bible, first, printed at Mentz, by Guten- erg, Fust and Schoefl'er, in 1455, of which there are four copies in Europe and two in the United States, 17. Brinley’s, 17. German, printed in Germantown, by Saur, 25. Lenox’s 17. Mazarin, 17. printed in Iceland in 1584, 20. quarto, in standing type, in Phila- delphia, 32. Bz'blz'a Pauperum, attributed to Koster, 6 1 . Bill of type, 59. Binny, Archibald, first successful founder in Philadelphia, 25, 26. 32 373 374 [NDE X. Binny, improver of the type-mould, 25, 44- Black letter, when used, 53. Blades, NVilliam, 2o. Blaeu, Willem Jansen, early inventor of a press, 235. Blankets for wood-cut printing, 282. India-rubber, 266. thick paper, 266. Welsh flannel, 266. when to be used, 257, 266. Blanking, remarks concerning, 259. Bleaching powders deleterious, 276. Block books, 16. Blue ink, how to make, 287, 288. Bodkin, how to use the, 208, 209. illustrated 209, 210. Books, cheapening of, due to steam- presses, 240. early, printed in Gothic charac- ter, 22. first, printed on one side of the leaf only, 16. how to preserve, 317. Book-folding machine, illustrated, 249. Borders, 82, 120. Boston Gazette, second newspaper pub- lished in America, 23. News-Letter, first newspaper pub- lished in America, 23. Bourgeois, specimen of, 56. Boxwood, description of good, 40. liable to warp, 282, 283. quoin, 306. Braces, use of, 77. Bracket, how used, 67. Bradford, \Villiam, first printer. in the Middle Colonies, 22, 23. Brass rules, remarks concerning, 82. slotted corners, description of, 46. Break-lines improperly driven over, 133. should never begin a page, 133. Brevier, specimen of, 56. Brilliant, smallest type in America, 54. specimen of, 56. Brinley’s collection of bibles, 17. British founders reject American casting- machines, 29. Bronze printing, how executed, 284, 285. Brown ink, how to produce, 288. Bruce, David and George, type-founders in New York, 27, 28. David ]r., type-casting machine invented by, 28. Bullock, William, inventor of the first perfecting press, 242-244. chain-running press, 244. self-feeding perfecting press, illus- trated, 243. Bundle of paper described, 294. CABINET for chases, illustrated, 231. with galley-top, illustrated. 304. Cabinets, job cases should be kept in, 304. Cabinets, of cases, for sorts, quads, etc., illustrated, 219—221. should be kept in perfect order, 221. Cambridge, first press in North Ame- rica at, 22. Campbell’s cylinder presses, 239, 246. self-feeding perfecting press, 246. Cancelled figures, 72. Capital, good character is, 138. letters, 60—62. letters, how to use, 61, 62. Card-cutters, 309. printing, directions for, 283, 284. sheets, chart for cutting, (Le Blond), 302. Carey, Mathew, 32. - Cases, American plan ofRoman, 124, 125. blank, 303. German, 98, 99. Greek, 104, 105. Hebrew, 111-113. how to label job, 304. job, 302. labour-saving lead, 303. labour-saving rule, 84, 302. labour-saving slug, 303. music, 117-119. number of, to a fount, 128. proposed improvement in, 126. quotation furniture, 303. Saxon, 4, 95. triplejo , 302. Caslon, William, 24. Cassie quires, why so called, 294. Casting off copy, methods of, 223-226. Catch-words first used at Venice, 22. in titles, how to be set, 134. Caxton, William, introduces printing into England, 20. his first types not cast or founded, 1 . Centennigl Exhibition, 1876, presses ex- hibited at, 244-246. fast printing at, 245. Chalcography, inventor of, 40. Chromo-lithography, 35. Chromos, printed on cylinder presses, 37. Chronicle of Cologne, 15. Cicero, French and German name for Pica, 55. Circular quadrates, 8o. Clicker, or maker-up, duties of, 226—228. Cl mer, George, inventor of the Colum- ian press, 236, 237. Colon, use of, 64. Colorito, Abraham, printer at Soncino, 1488, 20. Colour, uniformity in, 263, 278, 279. Coloured inks, how to make, 286—288. printing, instructions for, 285-287. Colours, contrast of, 289—292. how to multiply, 288. how to use dry, 287, 288. Columbian press, illustrated, 236. introduced into England, 237. INDEX. L375 Combination borders, 82, 120. Comma, use of, 6 Commercial post paper, size of, 298. signs, 73. Companionships, how managed, 228-232. misunderstandings in, 228 Composing, directions for, 129-136. how to avoid errors in, :30. position in, 127. rule, steel, illustrated, 228. sticks, illustrated, 305. screw, the best for fixed measures, 305. Composition rollers, how to make, 252- 254,311,312- how to wash, 253. melting-kettle for, illustrated, 252. Compositors, differences in, 218. rules to be observed by, 233, 234. Compound words, 66, 67, 331.‘ Contents, rules for, 135. Continuous sheet, printing from a, 242. Contrast of colours, 289-292. Conversation in a printing office to be avoided, 234. Copy, casting off, 223-226. takes of, should be small, 221. to be'carefully prepared, 204. Copyholder, illustrated, 309. Copyrights, how to secure, 333-335. cannot be granted upon trade- marks or labels, 335. form of notice of, 333. on other articles than books, 335. penalty for non-deposit of copies, 33+ renewal of, 334. - term of, 334. Cork bearers, 259. Corner quadrates, illustrated, 307. Corpus, German name for Long Primer, 6 5 . Correcting in the metal, 207-211. directions for, 208-210. rules for, in a companionship, 231, 232. Coster, (see Koster,) 15-17. Cottrell 8: Babcock's cylinder presses, 239. Counting out sheets, 297. Courtesy, importance of, 123. Creases and wrinkles in paper, how to remove, 263. Cross-bar, how to avoid springing, 148. Crown paper, size of, 298. Cut-in notes, how adjusted, 131, I32. Cuts, how to make ready, 280—283. Cylinder press, invention of the, 238. presses, making ready on, 265-275. DAGGER or obelisk, use of, 68. Dash, use of, 65. Dates, method of, during the French Republic, 71. Daye, John, Anglo-Saxon types first cut y, 53- Stephen, first printer in North America, 22. Dedications, how displayed, 135. position of, 135. Degener 8t Weiler’s liberty press, illus- trated, 246, 247. Delicate impression, how to produce, 281, 282. Demy paper, size of, 298. Derivation of English words, 324-326. Descending letters, 61. De Vinne’s History of the Invention of Printing, 18. Prz'nter’s Price List, 300. Diamond type, specimen of, 56. Diphthongs, Greek, 101. Distributing, directions for, 128, 129. how to wash matter for, 128, 129. pernicious effects from heating type for, 12 . proper times or, 129. Dividing words, rules for, 66, 67. Donatus of 1451, 17. Double imperial pap-r, size of, 298. letters, 61. medium paper, size of, 298. super-royal paper, size of, 298. Drawing paper, how to be wet, 256. Dry colours, how to use, 287, 288. Duck’s bill, to prevent paper from slip- ping on the tympan, 278. Duodecimo, or twelves, scheme for im- posing sheet of, 165. the same, without cutting, 166. the same, two signatures, 167. half-sheet, 168. the same, without cutting, 168. the same, from the centre, 169. sheet of, from the centre, 170. the same, long way, 171, 172. one third of a sheet, 171, 172. two half-sheets, together, 173. half-sheet, two signatures, 174. EARL STANHoPE’s printing-press, 236. Earliest printing-press, 235. written sounds, 85-87. Egyptian Hieroglyphics, specimens of type for printing, 85-87. Eighteens, scheme for imposing half- sheet of, 176. the same, with two blanks, 176. sheet of, folded together, 177, 17‘. the same, with one signature, 177, 178. thessame with two signatures, 179, 1 o. the same, with three signatures, 1 9, r o. half-sheet of, without transposi- tion, 181. Electro-stereotyping, 33, 47. Electrotyping, method of, 33. 376 INDEX. Emerald green, 288. - Enamelled cards, to be printed dry, 283, 284. English type, specimen of, 55. Engraver’s proofuseful to pressmen, 283. Engravings, copper-plate, 40. how to print, 280-283. how to restore, 317. tools for, 40. wood, 37-40. Epitaph, printer's, 208. Errata, list of, where placed, 136. Errors inevitable, 136. made in correcting a proof, 203, 204. Escala expirz'tual de San Yuan Cli- maco, the first book printed in Ame- rica, 22. Even impressions on a hand-press, how to obtain, 277-279. Exclamation, sign of, 65. FEED-GUIDES, Megill’s, illustrated, 310. Figgins’s, Vincent, opinion of Caxton’s type, 19.. Figures, arithmetical, 72. old style, 72. scratched or cancelled, 72. Filling the standing press, 296, 297. Fine hand-presswork, remarks concern- i"g.27s—279- printing, character of ink required for, 275, 276. paper suitable for, 257. why difi'icult in the United States, 276, 277. Finiguerra, Thomas, discoverer of chal- cography, 4o. Firefly press, Gordon's, 247. Fireproof ink, 3r4. Flat cap paper, size of, 298 Flowers and borders, remarks on, 82. Fly on cylinder presses, how to be set, 274. Folding machines, 249. Folio, imposing single sheet of, 150. paper, size 0 , 298. two sheets quired, 151, 152. Follow copy, the compositor’s rule, 204. Foolscap paper, dimensions of, 298. Foreign words and phrases, translated, 357—372- _ Foreman, duties and qualifications of, 218-232. Form, how to make ready for hand- press, 257-260. of warehouse book, 2933. Forms, directions for locking up, 147, 148. how to impose, 141, 142. how to wash, 264, 265. precautions in unlocking, 208. Forties, scheme for imposing half-sheet o , 191. Forty-eights , scheme for imposing quarter sheet of, with two signatures, 192. Forty-eights, the same, without cutting, 1 . halF-igheet of, 192. the same, three signatures, r93. quarter sheet of, 194. Foul proof, a grievous fault, 207. Founders, English, ancient regulations concerning, 24. Fount of letter, complete, described, 60. Founts, irregularities of, 60. Fractions, 72. Franklin, Benjamin, founding, 25. james, establ' hes the New Eng- land Courant, 23. Franklin presses, Gordon's, 247. illustrated, 246. Friars, how to obviate, 263. Frisket, directions for preparing, 258. catch of, how to place, 259. Full point, use of, 64, 65. Furniture, how to make up, 144, 145. Fust, John, connection with Gutenberg and Schoeffer, 16—18. attempts type- GAILLARDE, French term for Bourgeois type, 5 . Ga lows, how to be placed, 259. Game of C/zess, first book printed in England by Caxton, 20. Gauge pins, Megill's, illustrated, 310. Ged, William, inventor of stereotyping, 3o. Geometrical signs, 73, 74. German alphabet, 96. plan of cases for, 98 99. similar letters eluci ‘ ated, 96, 97. Germantown, first paper mill in America, near, 23. first quarto Bible in America, printed at, 25. type cast at, by Saur, 25. Giving out book paper to wet, 294. paper for jobs, 294, 295. Globe press, 248. Glover, Jesse, introduces printing into Cambridge, Mass., 22. Glue, common prepared, 313. liquid, how to make, 3I3. Gold preparation, how to use, 288. printing, how practised, 284, 317. size for gold printing, 284. Good habitsinculcated, 121-123, 137, 138. presswork, conditions for securing, 2 . Gordon's ltgranklin press, illustrated, 246. job-presses, 246, 247. Gothic characters, early books printed in, 22. Gradation of types, 57. Grant Thorburn, benevolence of, 2 39. Great Primer, specimen of, 55. Greek accents and aspirates, zoo-103. alphabetical table of, 100. letters, numerical value of, 69, 100. / / INDEX. 137'? Greek ligatures now discarded, 100. numeral letters, table of, 69. plan of cases for, 104, 105. rules for composmg, 103 Green ink, how to make, 288. Gros Romain, French title for Great Primer, 55. Guillemet's quotation marks, 64. Gutenberg, account of, 15-20. Gutter-sticks, directions for cutting, 148. Gypsum in paper, effects of, 276, 277. HAARLEM, the birthplace of printing, 15. Hand-mould improved by Binny, 26. Hand-press, how to prepare impression on, 275-279 how to over ay on, 277. bearers used on, 277, 278. Hand-presswork, fine, how to produce, 215-219. . Handwriting, erroneous notion concern- ing, 226. Hanging pages, how to rectify, 208. up paper to dry, 295. Hansard’s receipt for making rollers, 253,254- Hard roller, best for fine work, 267. Head-lines, how displayed, 131. Heap of paper, how to treat, 25 . Heated type, pernicious effects fi'om dis- tributing, 129. Hebrew accents, 108-110. alphabet, identical with Phoeni- cian, 85. al hahetical table of, 106. bilile, first printed, 20. letters numeral value of, 106. letters of similar appearance, 107. lower case without points, 111. Masoretic points or vowels, 108. method of composing, 107. plan of cases with points, 112, 113. scheme for imposing 8vo sheet of, 161, 162. spacing letters, 107. Hieroglyphic alphabet, 86. Hinderances to fine printing in Ame- rica, 276, 277. Hints honoured in the breach, 136, 137. H00 8: Co.’s cylinder presses, 239-242. Hoe, Richard M., inventor of type-re- volving printing machine, 241. Robert, account of, 239, 240. Hoe's web perfecting press, illustrated, 245. Hollow quadrates, use of, 79. Horn-book, illustration of, xi. Hnmphreys’s History of the Art of Print- ing, 1 . Hurried work, how to expedite, 226—228. Hyphen, how employed, 66, 67. not used by the earliest printers, 21. ICELAND, early printing office in, 20. Imperial and half paper, size of, 298. Imperial paper, dimensions of, 298. Imposing forms, directions for, 1 1, 142. in companionships, rules or, 230, 231. memoranda concerning, 148, 149. abstract title-deeds, 150. Fouo, single sheet, 150. two sheets, qnired, 151, 152. QUARTO, common sheet of, 153, 154. scheme for, music books, 153, 154. two half-sheets, together, 155, 156. half-sheet, broad way, 155, 156. Ocravo, sheet of, 157, 15 . the broad way, 157, 158. half-sheet, 159. two half-sheets, together, 159, 160. two quarters, together, 160. sheet, mixed, 161, 162. sheet of Hebrew, 161, 162. sheet, from the centre, 163, 164. half-sheet, from the centre, 163. two quarters, from the centre, 164. Duonracrmo, or 121110, sheet, 165. the same, without cutting, 166. the same, two signatures, 167. half-sheet, 168. the same, without cutting, 168. the same, from the centre, 169. sheet of, from the centre, 170. the same, long way, 171, 172. one~third of a sheet, 171, 172. two half-sheets, together, 173v half-sheet, two signatures, 174. SIXTEENS, half-sheet of, 174. sheet of, 175. EIGHTEENS, half-sheet of, 176. the same. with two blanks, 176. sheet of, folded together, 177, 178. sheet of, one signature, 177, 178. the same, two signatures, 179, 180. sheet of, three signatures, 179, 180. half-sheet of, without transposi~ . 1. 'I‘wrzxrms, half-sheet of, with two signatures, 181. sheet of, 182. 'l‘wrzxrv-Fouus, half~shcet of, 183. sheet-of, two signatures, 183, 184. half-sheet of, sixteen-way, 184. half-sheet of, long, 185. half-sheet, two signatures, 185. half-sheet, without cutting, 186. THIRTY-TWOS, half-sheet of, 186. sheet of, 187, 188. the same, four signatures, 187, 188. half~sheet, two signatures, 189. half-sheet of, mixed 189. THIRTY-SIXES, hal -sheet of, 190. the same, without cutting, 190. the same, two signatures, 191. Fon'rrrzs, half-sheet of, 191. FOR'l‘Y-EIGHTS, quarter sheet of, with two signatures, 192. the same, without cutting, 193. 32s 378 INDEX. Imposing FORTY-EIGHTS, common quar- ter-sheet of, 194. half-sheet of, two signatures, 192. the same, three signatures, 193. SIX'I‘Y-FOURS, quarter-sheet, 195. the same, two signatures, 194. sixty-fours, mixed, 195. half-sheet of, 196. SEVENTY-TWUS, half-sheet of, 197. NINRTY-SIXES, half-sheet of, 198. ONE HUNDRED AND TWENTY- EIGHTS, half-sheet of. 199. Imposing stone, illustrated, 308. Impression on cylinder presses, how to regulate, 269-275. Indenting paragraphs, rule for, 132. Index, directions for preparing copy of, 133. rule for setting, 133. where placed, 133. India paper suitable for overlays, 280. India-rubber cloth, good qualities of, 2 6. Ink-block, how to be placed, 251. Ink, black, how to intensify, 284. coloured, 286, 287. requires a hard roller, 267. for cylinder presses, 267, 268. for fine work, indispensable quali- ties of, 275, 276. how to prevent setting off, 279. how to remove surplus from the roller, 262. how to produce amber, 288. blue, 287, 288 brown, 288. fire-proof, 314. green, 288. lilac, 288. pink, 288. purple, 288. red, 286-288. scarlet, 288. vermihon, 288. to mark tin or zinc, 315. driers, how to make, 315, 316. Ink-fountain, how to manage, 268. patent, illustrated, 310. Ink stone and muller, illustrated, 285. Interleaving necessary in fine presswork, 279. Interrogation, sign of, 65. Iron furniture, how made, 310. Ironical rules for compositors, 136, 137. or beginners in business, 139, 140. Italic letter, invention of, 52. abuse of, 53. Jon DEPARTMENT, 300-31o. ca itals and lower-case should not e laid together, 304. cases should be labelled with the type which is in case, 304. how to conduct the business, 300. memorandum slip for record, 301. Job department, requisites for, 301-310. selection of material, 300. job presses, American, unsurpassed, 246. varieties of, 246-248. jobbing facilities, 300-310. jobs, making margin for, 147. Johnson, Lawrence, type-founder in _ Philadelphia, 26. \Villiam M., invents a type-casting machine, 28. ourneymen, idle, 24. unius, Hadrianus, 16. justification, accurate, absolutely essen- tial, 131. KERNED LETTERS, 61. _ Kinsley, Dr., invents a cylinder press, 23 . Knowledge, progress of, accelerated by steam-presses, 24o. Konig, Frederick, inventor of the cylin- der press, 238. Koster, (or Coster,) Laurentius, inventor of printing, 15-20. printer of block books, 16. uses wooden and tin type, 16. LABOUR-SAVING BRASS RULE, 83. plan of case for, 84. curvatures 81. quotation furniture, 79. rule, 45, 83. Lamp-holder, 3 . Laying a fount di9type, directions for, 127. P1\g@8,,143, 144- Lead cutter, illustrated, 307. Leads, described, 82. Leather belting, how to soften, 316. Lenox, [James of New York, collection of bib cs, 17. Lepsius, R., hieroglfyphic types of, 85. Letter paper, size 0 , 2 8. Letters oflndu/gence, of 1454-5, 17. Letters, accented, 69. ascending, 61. descending, 61. double, 61. kerned, 61. long, 61. numeral, 69. short, 61. two-line, 78. Ley, directions for making, 312. not to be used on wood-cuts, 283. Ley-brush, how to be made, 265. Ley-trough described, 264, 265. Liberty press, illustrated, 247. Lifting pages, 143. Lightning press, Hoe's, 239-242. illustrated, 24o. Lilac ink, how to make, 288. Lithographic chalk and ink, 34. stone, 33. transfer ink, how to make, 315. INDEX. 37$) Lithography, discovery of, 3.3. practice of, 33-37. Locking up forms, 147, 148. Long letters, 61. Primer, specimen of, 56. Lord's Prayer in Anglo-Saxon, 53. Lower-case sorts, 61. lVIACHINE-CASTING, 28. Machine-made paper, sizes of, 298. Machine~press of Isaac Adams, 237, 238. Frederick Kbni , 238. Applegath and ‘owper, 238. Richard M. oe, 239-242. William Bullock, 242-244. Campbell, 239, 246. Cottrell 8t Babcock, 239. Walter, 244. Mackling, how to remedy, 263. Make-up rule, steel, illustrated, 229. Makin margin, 145-147. or (jobs, 147. rea y a form, directions for, 257- 260. on cylinder presses, 265-275. wood-cuts , directions for, 280-283 register, directions for, 260. Making up furniture, 144, 145. in companionships, 229. letter and furniture in companion- ships, 23o. Ililazmal do Adultos, one of the first books printed in America, 22. Manuccio, Aldo, 63. Mappa, Adam G., one of the early American type-founders, 25. Margin, how to make, 145-147. on cylinder presses, 268. Masoretic points, 108. Mathematical signs, 73, 74. Matrices, copper, 42. electrotyped, 29. Matrix, illustrated, 42. Mazarin Bibles, 17. Measure of stick, how to make by ems, 12 . Mecgm, Benjamin, 30. Medium paper, size of, 298. Melting-kettle, description of, 252. Metal rules, 77. Metric system, 336, 337. Minerva cutting machine, illustrated, 309. Minion type, specimen of, 56. Mitering machine, illustrated, o7. MitteLGerman name for Englis type, 55. Modern conveniences, 120. Mucilagc, directions for making, 312, 313. Mud process in stereotyping, 32. Music, comparative table of bodies, 115. directions for composing, 116. plan of cases for, 117-119. specimens of, 114. New Hampshire Gazette, oldest living paper of the United States, 23. Newspapers, number of, ‘printed in the United States in 1801 and 1810, 26. New types, how to prevent them from adhering together, 127. New York Gazette, first newspaper pub- lished there, 23, ' Nicholson, William, suggester of the cylinder press, 238. Ninety-sixes, to impose half-sheet, 198. Nonpareil press, illustrated, 247. type, specimen of, 56. Norse-Runic alphabet, 89, 90. North American and United States Gazette of Philadelphia, oldest daily paper in the United States, 23. Note paper, size of, 298. Notes, proper size of type for, 131. cut in, how arranged, 132. Numeral letters, Gothic, 7o, 71. Greek, Roman, 70, 71. Numerical value of Greek letters, 69, 100. Hebrew letters, 106. OCTAVO, scheme for imposing sheet of, 157.15- sheet of, the broad way, 157, 158. two half-sheets, together, 159, 160. sheet mixed, 161, 162. half-sheet, 159. two quarters, together, 160. sheet of Hebrew, 161, 162. sheet of, from the centre, 163, 164. half-sheet of, do., 163. two quarter-sheets, do., 164. Oiling a press, 292. Old English letter used by the early printers, 51. Old-style figures, advantages of, 72. Old works, no license of alteration al- lowable in reprinting, 202. One hundred and twenty-eights, scheme for imposing half-sheet of, 199. Ornaments, ancient, exquisite and cu- rious, 21, 22. Orthography, hints on, 318-332. uniformity in, 202. Overlaying on cylinder presses, 272, 273. on hand-presses, 277. Overrunning, proper method of, 210. Overseer, duties of, 218-232. Over-sheets, rules for giving out, 294. PACKET note paper, size of, 298. post paper, size of, 298. Pages, how to tie up, 142, 143. how to lift, 143. how to lay, 143. Palmacrt, Lambert, printed at Valencia 1479,20- Paper-bank, how to be placed, 259. Paper for jobs, rule for giving out, 294. cutters, 309. instructions for wetting, 255-257. qualities of good, 276. 35%0 I IVDE X. Paper, quantity required for a book, 299. sizes of, 298. suitable for fine printing, 257. Papier-mache' moulds, 242. Paragon type, so called by printers in all countries, 54. Paragraph mark, how used, 68. Paragraphs, authors’ irregularities in making, 132, 133. rule for indenting, 132. Parchment tympans, 254. Parenthesis, use of, 67, 68. Pasteboard tympan for a cylinder press, advantages of, 265. Paste, directions for making, 312. Pearl type, specimen of, 56. Peerless press, illustrated, 248. Penn, William, promotes printing in Pennsylvania, 23. Perforating machine for round holes, il- lustrated, 308. Perforating rule, illustrated, 308. Perforator, Ames’s Patent, 308. Period, use of, 64. Petit and jungfer, German names of Brevier, 56. Petit Romain, French name of Long Primer, 56. Pt'z‘ri Hz'syfizuzi Tracz‘atz'lzus Logz'cz's, one of the first printed books, 16. Phoenician alphabetic system, 85. Phrases, foreign, translated, 357-372. Pica, specimen of, 55. the standard type, 54. Picks in types, how to remove, 262. in wood-cuts, how to take out, 281. Pietrison, Thomas, the inventor of print- ers’ ink, 16. Pink ink, how to produce, 288. Planetary signs, 75, 76. Plate paper, directions for wetting, 256. Plumbago, used in electrotyping, 33, 47. Points, how to arrange, 258. Polyglot founders, 24. Position in composing, 127. Prefaces, rules concerning, 135. Press-book, form of, 222. Press arbitrarily restricted, 235. history of invention of, 235-248. old common, 235. to print and number railroad tickets and coupons, 246. Presses—see machine-presses. how to oil, 292. ' Pressing sheets, mode of, 296, 297. Pressmen should examine every sheet as printed, 263. rules and remedies for, 262-264. should study fine specimens of printing, 277. Presswork, requisites for producing fine, 275-279- Prima, 203. Printed sheets, how treated, 295-297. I l Printers, how not to succeed in business, 139, 140. ironical rules for, 136, 137. Printer’s knife, illustrated, 210, 211. Printing, discovery of, 15-20. extension of, 19. in bronzes, 284, 285. in colours, 285-288. in gold, directions for, 284. introduced into America, 22. manner of discovery, 15-18. Printing~machine, type-revolving, 240- 242. Printing-ofi'ices, rules to be observed in, 233.234- Printing-press, Amateur, 248. Bullock, 242—244. Campbell, 239, 246. Cottrell & Babcock, 239. Degener, 246, 247. Earl Stanhope’s, 236. earliest, 235. first set up in North America, 22. Frederick Ktinig’s, 238. Gally, 246. George Clymer’s, 236. George P. Gordon's, 246, 247. invention of the, 235-248. Isaac Adams’s, 237. Job, 246-248. Peter Smith's, 237. Railroad-ticket, 246. Ramage’s, 236. Richard M. Hoe’s, 239-242. Ruggles, 246. Samuel Rust’s, 237. \Valter, 244. \Nells, 246. Willem Jansen Blaeu’s, 235. Proof-marks, explanation of, 214, 215. illustration of, 212, 213. Proof press, illustrated, 343. Proof-reader, author’s obligations 201. duties of a, 202, 207. friendly offices of, 201. qualifications of, 200-206. should be a compositor, 200. Proof-readers, capriccs of, 207. Proof-sheets, alterations in,justly charge- able, 204, 205, 211. detained by authors, 205. errors in correcting, 203, 204. method of reading, 202, 203. plan for keeping account of, 203. remarks concerning, 202. should be read b two readers, 204. Proofs of engravings, ow to take, 283. Proper names should be plainly written, 211. Proportions of types, table of, 57, 58. Prussian blue ink, 287. Publishers’ interference with the printers’ province, 134. Pulling, directions for, 260—262, 279. to, INDEX. 381 Puiich, illustrated, 42,. Punctuality indispensable in an appren- tice, 123. Punctuation, amending of, should be confined to one reader, 204. and orthography to be uniform throughout a book, 202. points of later invention than printing, 63. variations in use of, 63. whims of authors, 63. llvilson’s Treatise on, 64, 67. QUADRA'I‘ES, circular, illustrated, and described, 80, 81. corner, illustrated, 307. directions for composing, 80, 81. hollow, illustrated, 79. Quantity of paper required for a thou- sand copies, 299. Quarto, scheme for imposing, 153, 154. the broad way for music, 153, 154. . two half-sheets, together, 155, 156. half-sheet, the broad way, 155, 1 . Quires, casssie, of what made up, 294. Quitting work, precautions to be used by the pressman in, 264. Quoins, proper form of, 147, 148. how to unlock, 148. various patents, illustrated, 306. Quotation furniture, illustrated, 79. marks, 64. Quotations, broad and narrow, 78. RAILROAD-TICKET printing-machine, 246. ' Ramage, Adam, 236. Reading-boy, 202. Receipts, various, 311-317. Red ink, how to make, 286,288. References, use of, 68, 69. Register, how to make, 260. Regulations for a printing-office, 233, 234. Reprints from standard authors not to vary from the original, 202. Revise, 206. Revise sheet necessary, 26o. Riding, how to prevent, 286. Rittenhouse, \Villiam, the first paper- maker in America, 23. Roller-boy, 262. Roller-handle, how to lie when used, 251. how to check, 251. Roller, hard, best for fine work, 267. soft, required for posters and old type, 267. Roller-mould, directions for using, 252. Roller-stand, how to set up, 250, 251. illustrated, 251. Rollers, composition, how made, 252- 254, 311, 312- for hand-presses, how to keep, 278. l Rollers, hand-press, 252. precautions in using, 252. to be adapted to style of work, 26'- when in working order, 253. Roman letter, invention of, 51. deserving general adoption, 52. Ronaldson, james, type-founder in Phila- delphia, 25. Richard, type-founder in Philadel- phia, 26. Rosetta stone, discovery of, 85. Royal and half paper, size of, 298. Royal paper, size of, 298. Ruggles’s job presses, 246. card cutter, illustrated, 309. Rules, brass, 82. labour-saving, illustrated, 83. plan of case or, 84. Rules and remedies for pressmen, 262— 264. for beginners in business, ironical, 139, 140. for compositors, ironical, 136. 137. for perforating, illustrated, 308. Runes, earliest alphabets of the Teutons and Goths, 88. Runic alphabets, 88—92. inscription on Bewcastle cross. 91. Rust, Samuel, inventor of the \Vashing- ton press, 237. SAUR (or Sower,) Christopher, first Ame~ rlcan typeefounder, 25. issues the Germantown Chronicle in 1729, 25. prints the first quarto bible, 25. Scarlet ink, how to make, 288. Schoelfer, Peter, inventor of type-found- ing, 19, 20. Semicolon, invented by Aldo .\[anuc_ cio, 63. use of, 64. Senefelder, Alois, discoverer of litho- graphy, 33- Setting fly on a cylinder press. 274. off, how to prevent ink from, 279. tapes, process of, 274. up a \Vashington press, 250. up a roller-stand, 250, 251 . Seventy-twos, scheme for imposing half. sheet of, 197. Shades of ink, how to produce, 288. Sheets, counting out and putting away, 294. filling in and pressing, 296. how to take down from the poles, 296. names of, 149. Shooting-sticks, illustrated, 307. ‘ Short letters, 61. numbers of sheets, allowance for, 294. pages, how to back, 133. Side notes, how arranged, 131, 132. Signatures, table of, 216, 217. 382 f ZVDE X. Signatures, inventor of, 22. Signaturing, remarks concerning, 135. Signs, astronomical, 75, 76. commercial, 3. mathematica , 73-75. medical, 76, 77. Silk tympan-covers, 254. Silvering solution, how to make, 316. Sitting at work improper, 127. Sixteens, scheme for imposing half—sheet of, 174. sheet of, 175. Sixty-fours, scheme for imposing quar- ter-sheet of, 195. scheme for imposing quarter-sheet of, with two signatures, 194. quarter sheet of, mixed, 195. half-sheet of, 196. Slotted brass corners, illustrated, 46. Slovenly copy, censurable, 223. Slurring, how to prevent, 263, 278. Small capital letters, 60, 62, 63. Pica, specimen of, 56. Smith, George Frederick, founder in hiladelphia, 26. Matthew, press-maker, 239. Peter, inventor of a hand-press, 237. Sorts, up er and lower case, 61. Sounds 0 German letters, 96. Greek letters, 100. Hebrew letters, 106. Sower—see SaurI Samuel & Co., early American type-founders, 26. Space-rules, metal, 83. Spaces, described, 77. various sizes of, should be kept separate, 128. Spacing, remarks on, 130, 131. Speculum Hzmmme Sah/ationis, the first printed book, 17. Spelling, rules for, 318-332. Spz'qgal cnser Be/wudenz‘sse, one of the first printed books, 16. Spring bearers, 259. Swinging, how to prevent wood-cuts from, 280. Square cross, where used 68. Standing press, how to fill, 296, 297. improved, illustrated, 2 7. Stanhope, Earl, press inventec? by, 236. Star chamber, regulations of, concern- ing English founders, 24. St. Augustin, French and Dutch name for English type, 55. _ Stereotype plates, English, imperfec- tions of, 32. how to underlay, 272. block, illustrated, 46. stereotyping, invention of, 30. mode. of, 30-32, 48. mud process, 32. Stop cylinder press, illustrated, 238. well adapted for fine printing, 239. Stower, extract from, 205, 206. Superiors, 69. Super-royal aper, size of, 298. Syllables, ab reviated, 21. how to divide, 66, 67. Symbols, absurd, 76. TABLE of paper required for a book, 299. proof-marks, 212. signatures, 216, 217. Takes of copy should be small, 221. Taking copy in compamonships, 228, 229. Taking down sheets when dry, 296. Tapes, how to set, 274. Technical terms explained, 38-343. names should be legi ly written, 211. Tertia, German name ofGreat Primer,55. Theinhardt, Ferdinand, Prussian type- founder, 86. Thirty-sixes scheme for imposing half’ sheet of, 190. half-sheet of, without cutting, 190. the same, with two signatures, 191. Thirty-twos, scheme for imposing half- sheet of, 186. sheet of, 187 188. sheet of, with four signatures, 187, 188. half-sheet, two signatures, 189. half-sheet of, mixed, 189. Thomas, Isaiah, 20. Tilloch, Dr. lexander, 3o. Tinted paper, coloured ink on, 291. Tints, neutral, 291. Title-deeds, scheme for imposing, 150. Title-pages, hints for setting, 134. remarks on, 134. Token-sheet, purpose of, 256. Tokens explained, 294. Tools for wood engraving, 4o. Trade-marks, how to secure patents, 335. Transposing pages, directions for, 207. pages in companionships, 232. Turkey boxwood, best for engraving, 40. Turning a heap, directions for, 261, 262. Turpentine, spirits of, best for cleansing wood-cuts, 283. Tweezers, illustrated 210. Twenties, scheme or imposing half- sheet of, with two signatures, 181. sheet of, 182. Twenty-fours, scheme for imposing half- sheet of, 183. sheet of, 183, 184. half-sheet, the sixteens way, 184. half-sheet of, long, 185. half-sheet of, without cutting, 186. Two-line letters, how used, 78. Tympan suitable for cylinder press, 265. Tympans, how to cover, 254. Tying up pages, 142, 143. ype, how to lay a fount of, 127. Type-measure, 22 . Type-casting machine, description of, 44. INDEX. 383 Type-casting machine, illustrated, 43. origin of, 28. perfected by David Bruce, ]r., 28, 2 . Type-fourgiding a distinct calling in the seventeenth century, 24. early, in New York, 25. early, in Philadelphia, 25. in America, 25. in Europe, 24. Type-foundries in the United States, 29. Type-foundry, first American, at Ger- mantown, Pennsylvania, 25. walk over a, 41-50. Type-metal, 42. Type-revolving printing machine, Hoe’s, illustrated, 24o. Types, bill of, 59, Black or Old English letter, 51, 53. directions for choosing, 52. fount of, 60. gradations of, 57. how to prevent them from adhering, 127. Italic, invention of, 52. names and sizes of, 54-56. prices of, since 1801, 2 . process of manufacturing, 41-45. plroportions of, 57, 58. oman, invention of, 5x. specimens of, 55, 56. Typographic Advertiser, 26. Typographical errors, a‘blemish, 200. peculiarities, ancient, 21, 22. UNDERLAYING old stereotype plates, 282. Under-lays, when proper on cylinder presses, 270-2 2. Uniformity in coiours, how to secure , 263. in spacing essential, 130. Universal press, illustrated, 248. Unlocking forms, precautions in, 208. Upper-case sorts, 6r. VAN mm M EY’s method of stereotyping, 3o. Variations from copy chargeable, 2n. Varnish for printing ink, how to make, 314. Varnish, the common menstruum for col- ours, 286. prevents enamel from peeling, 284. Vignettes, how to prepare on the press, 281. WALTER perfectin press, 244. Warehouse book, orm of, 293. department, 293-298. warehouseman, duties of, 293. Warping of a cut, how to cure, 282. how to prevent, 282. ‘Washing forms, directions for, 264, 265. \Vashington press, how to set up, 250. invented by Samuel Rust, illustra- ted, 237. Waterproof paper, how to make, 317. \Vatts, John, 27. \Veb perfecting presses, 242-246. Wells's job presses, 246 Wet paper, how to be protected over- night, 264. \Vetting paper, directions for, 255-257. drawing and plate paper, 256. rules for giving out paper for, 294, 2 5. Wetting-tgough, how to be made, 255. \Vhite,8Elihu, type-founder in New York, 27, 2 . White pages, how to be treated, 259. \Vood-cuts, how to prepare on the press. 280-283. how to wash, 283. how to take proof of, 283. 'Wood engraving, tools for, 40. type, how to be cared for, 292. \Voollen blankets, needless when new type is used, 257, 266. \ \Vords and phrases, foreign, 357-372. \Vorking in pocket unsatisfactory, 227. Works, how to manage hurried, 226. \Vrinkles in paper, how to remove, 263. \Vriting inks, coloured, how to make,3r4. YELLOW mx, how to produce, 287, 288. ZAROTTI, Antonio, the inventor of sig- natures, 22. Zell, Ulrich, printer of the Chronicle (3f Cologne, 15. Zodiacal signs, 75. ET FACTA EST LUX. ll 0.7/8.0 a %@ 6W1. a“ _ \a t . 384 ESTABLISHED, 1790. MA CKELLAR, SMITHS &j’oRDAN, Letter Fouua’ers, Nos. 606-614 Sansone Street, P/u'ladelolua. T his establishment, tlze oldest in America, has kept even pace with all the improvement: in type-founding; and its production: at the present day, in beauty of style, accuracy of standing, and durability of material, are all that skill, ingenuity, and long experience have been able to qua. IVeit/zer pains nor expense will be withheld to maintain its well-founded {fire-eminence. Book and Newspaper Faces. Some are of light and dainty face, others of medium, and others again of broad and massive character. The LIGHTFACE SERIES; the FRENCH-FACE SERIES; the celebrated SCOTCH—FACE SERIES, introduced by us many years ago; the BOOK SERIES; the LARGE— FACE SERIES; the CLASSIC SERIES; the NEWS SERIES; the BROADFACE SERIES; the MODERN SERIES; the QRIGINAL OLD STYLE SERIES; the BRADFORD SERIES; the BINNY SERIES, and all others introduced by us, are kept constantly on hand, in large and small founts. ' German Book and Newspaper Faces, Of various styles, also kept on hand or furnished to order. Elegant Scripts and other Note and Circular Types, In great variety of styles, for all kinds of Notes, Blanks, and Circular Printing. Greek, Hebrew and Music Type. MUSIC TYPE without an equal in America, or a Superior in the world. The sizes are Excelsior, or half-Nonpareil, Diamond, Agate, and Nonpareil. GREEK and HEBREW of all practical sizes. Fancy and Ornamental Type, Unrivalled for beauty, originality, extent, and variety. In this depart- ment, native and foreign genius and inventive skill are alike laid under contribution, and no other foundry in the world can furnish so complete and beautiful an assortment. Borders, Flourishes, Corners and Ornaments, For finest artistic and ornamental printing, to meet every require- ment of the printer. Cuts and Ornaments, For general use, from more than three thousand subjects, many of them very fine. Office Furnishings. CABINETS of various kinds and prices. STANDS, double or single, or made in different styles to order, of walnut or poplar. CASES of all kinds. IMPOSING STONES of regular sizes constantly on hand; special sizes and styles got up to order. GALLEYS of all kinds, either wood or brass. STEREOTYPE BLOCKS, with or without rule borders. CI-IASES of wrought or cast iron. COMPOSING-STICKS of all kinds, large and small. RACKS for cases. INK STONES. Card, Paper, Lead and Rule Cutters. Labour-Saving Wood Rule. Labour- Saving Wood Furniture. Labour-Saving Curvatures. Furniture, Quoins, Mallets; Shooting-Sticks of brass, iron or dogwood; Planers, Bodkins, Ley and Washing Brushes, &c. Eureka Cabinets. Size to fit in space at left of double stand. Stained in imitation of cherry. SORT-CASE CABINET—Contains eight drawers, each divided into sixteen compartments. It will be found useful as a receptacle for quads, leaders or sorts. HANDY CABINET.—Contains five drawers, arranged to hold twenty different sizes of spaces and quads, and eight blank drawers, for cuts or large type. GALLEY CABINET.—-NO. 1, for twenty-four single and fourteen double column galleys. No.2, for forty-eight single galleys. No. 3, for thirty-four double galleys. INK CABINET.—Contains four compartments for ink, &c., and marble slab 18x20 inches on top, for mixing inks. CHASE CABINE’I‘.—Arranged to contain one-eighth, one-quarter, and one-half medium chases. With or without ink stone. COMBINATION CABINET—No. I, contains four blank drawers, three sort-case drawers, and four quad drawers. No. 2, contains four sort-ease drawers and six quad drawers. QUAD CABINET—Contains twelve drawers, each divided into two compartments, suitable for quads or leaders. . - Labour-Saving Leads and Slugs. Four and Six-to-Pica leads, from 4 to 25 ems Pica in length; put up in any useful quantity. NONPAREIL and PICA SLUGS, cut to same lengths. Cases arranged specially for Labour-Saving Leads and Slugs. Labour-Saving Quotation Furniture. Accurately cast, and equally valuable either as furniture or as quota- tions. The pieces range from 4 to 20 ems Pica in length, and from 2 to 4 ems in width, quadrate height, with suitable spaces. Standard Metal Furniture, For imposition of forms and general blank-work. Cast to our standard Pica body. Labour-Saving Rule, (Matching our standard type bodies,) Single, Double, Parallel, Dot- ted, and Triple faces. Cut accurately of various lengths. It will be found of vast utility in tabular and job work, rendering the use of shears and file entirely unnecessary. Cases furnished specially adapted to it. Brass Circles and Ovals, Of various sizes and faces, for label and stamp borders. Slotted Brass Corners, Of beautiful original patterns, matching our brass rules. Hollow Quadrates, For the easy formation of Circles, Ellipses, &c., made in sizes to suit our Brass Circles and Ovals, from Nos. I to 13. Corner Quadrates, On Pica and Nonpareil Metal and Six-to-Pica Brass bodies. Printing Presses and Ink. Presses of the most celebrated makers in the United States, as well as all varieties and colours of American and Foreign PRINTING INKS, SIZES, BRONZES, VARNISHES, &c. at manufacturers‘ prices. Roller Composition. Glue for Rollers, and the various Patent Compositions, furnished to order at manufacturers’ prices. Electrotyping Of Almanacs, Jobs, Wood-Cuts, Labels, Binders’ Stamps, &c. Wood Engraving. Cuts designed and engraved to order in the finest style of art. Outfits for Printing Offices. Estimates given in detail (with the cost) of all the materials required for either Newspaper or job Ofiices. MA CKELLAR, SjlflTf-IS eve/URBAN, 1V0s. 606-614 Sansom Street, Philadelphia. ESTABLISHED, 1804. $588231‘ BRANCH:- qggfflfifl BRAIN-03.. N0. 40 La Salle Street, CHICAGO- (0Y9 N0. 47 Rose Street, NEW was Principal Office: 509 South Tenth Street, PHILADELPHIA. 42>. MESSRS. CHARLES ENEU JOHNSON & Co. manufacture all the various grades of inks and varnishes for printers’ use, both typographic and lithographic. They call attention, also, to their many special inks and ‘ varnishes, recently introduced by them, and refer to their new Specimen Book for grades and prices. Copies may be had on application at their main office at Philadelphia or by addressing any of their agencies. ENE“ (g, Gals’ PRINTING_I_N_K WORKS. PRINCIPAL OFFICES: 47 Rose St., New York. 40 La Salle St, Chicago. Cor. Tenth and Lombard Sts., Philada. A v The perfection to which the typographic art has been carried in this country is one of the notable things which mark the age in which we live. The improvements in printing presses, in types, stereotype and electrotype plates, wood engravings, etc., have been heralded through the columns of public journals, until every one who feels any interest in the progress of mechanical and artistic works has been made acquainted with them; but there are some of the accessories to fine typography, usually looked upon as secondary in point of importance, which are really essential to the production of work of a superior character. The beauty of printed pages depends in a very great degree upon the Ink used by the pressman. The most costly presses, the finest types and cuts, the handsomest paper, and the greatest skill on the part of the printer, will all be in vain, if in- ferior Ink be put upon the types; and persons familiar with this great art know how to appreciate fine Ink. Among the many manufacturing establishments which our city con- tains, there are few so well and so long known to Philadelphians of mature years, as “ Johnson's Printers’ Ink Factory," in Tenth Street below Lom- bard, and none have been more fortunate in establishing and preserving a high reputation for the quality of the articles produced than that one. The firm at present is CHAS. E. JOHNSON & CO., and the principal is of the third generation of those who have conducted the concern. His grandfather, Charles Johnson, established it, January 7th, 1804; he was succeeded by his son, Charles johnson. He in turn has been succeeded by his son,_ Mr. Charles Eneu johnson, who now manages the business with such success, that in addition to his branch ofiice in New York, for the supply of that city and the Eastern States, he has found it necessary to create an additional ofiice at Chicago for the more ready supply of the Western States and Territories. His trade has also reached the Brazils, South America, Australia, West Indies, the Havanas, and Europe. The cut on the opposite page is used as a trade-mark by Messrs. C. E. JOHNSON & CO., but it is in reality a thing of historic and heraldic interest. It is the original printers’ arms, containing those grotesque national designs which the artists of former ages were so good at inventing, but in con- nection with them are some of those useful “tools of the trade," which indicate the practical value of the honor which the device was intended to confer. They in effect exhibit the infancy of the typographic art, and when compared with the wonderful machines which are now used to imprint the thoughts of men's minds upon Sheets of paper, they convey vivid ideas of the grandeur of the genius which in, what is historically a brief time, have accomplished improvements which more than anything else characterize this age of mechanical inventions. PRINTERS’ TEXT—BOOKS. MacKellar-‘s American Printer. A Manual of Typography, containing Practical Directions for Managing all Departments of a Printing Oflice, as well as Complete Instruétions for Apprentices. Fourteenth Edition. Revised and Enlarged. Price, $2.00. By mail, $2.10. " Most successful of the books of this class "A great amount of curious information, known to me."—Corresyflondentyftlze Arc/xiv '; historical and illustrative."—Ji'uenmg Post,‘ fiir Buclzdruckerkunrt, Leipzig. New York. "Any intelligent person will find this work a serviceable companion."—_‘}'ournal of Com- merce. Chicago. 3 " A neat volume, beautifully printed."— L'lmprimerie, Paris. " The most complete work on the sul)je I. _, . ‘- “"IIP'Q‘L a‘ I‘ .. ‘A "at . x w 2 st“ *2 a . l§ la‘; as \air the v _ ‘\L as‘ ., 't‘eti'feaaa" , a ,1 iriitttwft", ' Fermi-Pg‘ ‘ii 1.‘: ‘a ‘1L 1&- -“;:}gifi 7' .‘i' a a m -' .,. 3%“? , " ‘ j 5' ii. ~‘i. D .‘ ' .‘L . in“ 1' ‘ a? 2:.